[gdb] Add 'Concept Index' entry '&' for background execution
[binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185
3186 @kindex thread name
3187 @cindex name a thread
3188 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3189 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3190 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3191 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3192
3193 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3194 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3195 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3196 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3197 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3198
3199 @kindex thread find
3200 @cindex search for a thread
3201 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3202 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3203 matches the supplied regular expression.
3204
3205 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3206 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3207 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3208 is the LWP id.
3209
3210 @smallexample
3211 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3212 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3213 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3214 Id Target Id Frame
3215 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3216 @end smallexample
3217
3218 @kindex set print thread-events
3219 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3220 @item set print thread-events
3221 @itemx set print thread-events on
3222 @itemx set print thread-events off
3223 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3224 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3225 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3226 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3227 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3228
3229 @kindex show print thread-events
3230 @item show print thread-events
3231 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3232 have started and exited.
3233 @end table
3234
3235 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3236 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3237 programs with multiple threads.
3238
3239 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3240 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3241
3242 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3243 @table @code
3244 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3245 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3246 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3247 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3248 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3249 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3250 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3251 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3252 macro.
3253
3254 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3255 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3256 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3257 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3258 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3259 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3260
3261 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3262 refers to the default system directories that are
3263 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3264 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3265 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3266
3267 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3268 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3269 was loaded in the inferior process.
3270
3271 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3272 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3273 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3274 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3275 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3276 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3277 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3278
3279 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3280 only on some platforms.
3281
3282 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3283 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3284 Display current libthread_db search path.
3285
3286 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3287 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3288 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3289 @item set debug libthread-db
3290 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3291 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3292 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3293 @end table
3294
3295 @node Forks
3296 @section Debugging Forks
3297
3298 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3299 @cindex multiple processes
3300 @cindex processes, multiple
3301 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3302 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3303 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3304 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3305 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3306 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3307 will cause it to terminate.
3308
3309 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3310 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3311 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3312 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3313 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3314 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3315 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3316 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3317 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3318 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3319
3320 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3321 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3322 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3323 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3324
3325 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3326 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3327 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3328
3329 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3330 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3331
3332 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3333 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3334
3335 @table @code
3336 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3337 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3338 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3339 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3340 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3341
3342 @table @code
3343 @item parent
3344 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3345 unimpeded. This is the default.
3346
3347 @item child
3348 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3349 unimpeded.
3350
3351 @end table
3352
3353 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3354 @item show follow-fork-mode
3355 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3356 @end table
3357
3358 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3359 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3360 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3361
3362 @table @code
3363 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3364 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3365 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3366 retain debugger control over them both.
3367
3368 @table @code
3369 @item on
3370 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3371 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3372 independently. This is the default.
3373
3374 @item off
3375 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3376 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3377 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3378 is held suspended.
3379
3380 @end table
3381
3382 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3383 @item show detach-on-fork
3384 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3385 @end table
3386
3387 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3388 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3389 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3390 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3391 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3392 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3393
3394 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3395 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3396 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3397 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3398 and Programs}.
3399
3400 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3401 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3402 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3403 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3404 the child process's @code{main}.
3405
3406 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3407 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3408
3409 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3410 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3411 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3412 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3413 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3414 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3415 command.
3416
3417 @table @code
3418 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3419 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3420
3421 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3422 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3423
3424 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3425
3426 @table @code
3427 @item new
3428 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3429 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3430 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3431 original inferior.
3432
3433 For example:
3434
3435 @smallexample
3436 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3437 (gdb) info inferior
3438 Id Description Executable
3439 * 1 <null> prog1
3440 (@value{GDBP}) run
3441 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3442 Program exited normally.
3443 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3444 Id Description Executable
3445 1 <null> prog1
3446 * 2 <null> prog2
3447 @end smallexample
3448
3449 @item same
3450 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3451 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3452 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3453 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3454 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3455
3456 For example:
3457
3458 @smallexample
3459 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3460 Id Description Executable
3461 * 1 <null> prog1
3462 (@value{GDBP}) run
3463 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3464 Program exited normally.
3465 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3466 Id Description Executable
3467 * 1 <null> prog2
3468 @end smallexample
3469
3470 @end table
3471 @end table
3472
3473 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3474 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3475
3476 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3477 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3478 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3479
3480 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3481 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3482
3483 @cindex checkpoint
3484 @cindex restart
3485 @cindex bookmark
3486 @cindex snapshot of a process
3487 @cindex rewind program state
3488
3489 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3490 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3491 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3492 later.
3493
3494 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3495 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3496 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3497 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3498 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3499
3500 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3501 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3502 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3503 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3504 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3505 start again from there.
3506
3507 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3508 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3509
3510 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3511
3512 @table @code
3513 @kindex checkpoint
3514 @item checkpoint
3515 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3516 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3517 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3518
3519 @kindex info checkpoints
3520 @item info checkpoints
3521 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3522 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3523 listed:
3524
3525 @table @code
3526 @item Checkpoint ID
3527 @item Process ID
3528 @item Code Address
3529 @item Source line, or label
3530 @end table
3531
3532 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3533 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3534 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3535 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3536 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3537 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3538 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3539
3540 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3541 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3542 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3543 the debugger.
3544
3545 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3546 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3547 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3548
3549 @end table
3550
3551 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3552 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3553 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3554 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3555 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3556 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3557 previously read data can be read again.
3558
3559 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3560 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3561 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3562 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3563 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3564 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3565
3566 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3567 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3568 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3569 different execution path this time.
3570
3571 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3572 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3573 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3574 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3575 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3576 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3577 potentially pose a problem.
3578
3579 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3580
3581 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3582 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3583 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3584 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3585 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3586 next.
3587
3588 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3589 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3590 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3591 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3592 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3593
3594 @node Stopping
3595 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3596
3597 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3598 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3599 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3600
3601 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3602 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3603 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3604 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3605 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3606 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3607 explicitly request this information at any time.
3608
3609 @table @code
3610 @kindex info program
3611 @item info program
3612 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3613 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3614 @end table
3615
3616 @menu
3617 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3618 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3619 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3620 Skipping over functions and files
3621 * Signals:: Signals
3622 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3623 @end menu
3624
3625 @node Breakpoints
3626 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3627
3628 @cindex breakpoints
3629 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3630 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3631 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3632 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3633 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3634 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3635 program.
3636
3637 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3638 the executable is run.
3639
3640 @cindex watchpoints
3641 @cindex data breakpoints
3642 @cindex memory tracing
3643 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3644 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3645 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3646 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3647 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3648 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3649 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3650 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3651 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3652 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3653 same commands.
3654
3655 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3656 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3657 Automatic Display}.
3658
3659 @cindex catchpoints
3660 @cindex breakpoint on events
3661 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3662 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3663 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3664 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3665 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3666 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3667 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3668
3669 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3670 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3671 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3672 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3673 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3674 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3675 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3676 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3677 enable it again.
3678
3679 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3680 @cindex breakpoint lists
3681 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3682 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3683 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3684 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3685 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3686 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3687 are operated on.
3688
3689 @menu
3690 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3691 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3692 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3693 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3694 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3695 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3696 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3697 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3698 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3699 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3700 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3701 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3702 @end menu
3703
3704 @node Set Breaks
3705 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3706
3707 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3708 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3709 @c
3710 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3711
3712 @kindex break
3713 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3714 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3715 @cindex latest breakpoint
3716 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3717 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3718 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3719 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3720 convenience variables.
3721
3722 @table @code
3723 @item break @var{location}
3724 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3725 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3726 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3727 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3728 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3729
3730 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3731 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3732 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3733 that situation.
3734
3735 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3736 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3737 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3738
3739 @item break
3740 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3741 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3742 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3743 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3744 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3745 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3746 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3747 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3748 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3749 inside loops.
3750
3751 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3752 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3753 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3754 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3755 existed when your program stopped.
3756
3757 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3758 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3759 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3760 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3761 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3762 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3763 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3764
3765 @kindex tbreak
3766 @item tbreak @var{args}
3767 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3768 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3769 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3770 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3771
3772 @kindex hbreak
3773 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3774 @item hbreak @var{args}
3775 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3776 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3777 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3778 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3779 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3780 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3781 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3782 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3783 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3784 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3785 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3786 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3787 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3788 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3789 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3790 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3791 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3792 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3793
3794 @kindex thbreak
3795 @item thbreak @var{args}
3796 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3797 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3798 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3799 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3800 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3801 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3802 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3803 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3804
3805 @kindex rbreak
3806 @cindex regular expression
3807 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3808 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3809 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3810 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3811 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3812 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3813 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3814 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3815 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3816
3817 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3818 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3819 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3820 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3821 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3822 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3823
3824 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3825 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3826 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3827 classes.
3828
3829 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3830 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3831 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3832
3833 @smallexample
3834 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3835 @end smallexample
3836
3837 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3838 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3839 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3840 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3841 every function in a given file:
3842
3843 @smallexample
3844 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3845 @end smallexample
3846
3847 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3848 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3849
3850 @kindex info breakpoints
3851 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3852 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3853 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3854 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3855 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3856 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3857 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3858
3859 @table @emph
3860 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3861 @item Type
3862 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3863 @item Disposition
3864 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3865 @item Enabled or Disabled
3866 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3867 that are not enabled.
3868 @item Address
3869 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3870 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3871 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3872 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3873 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3874 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3875 @item What
3876 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3877 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3878 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3879 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3880 @end table
3881
3882 @noindent
3883 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3884 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3885 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3886 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3887 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3888 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3889
3890 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3891 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3892 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3893 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3894
3895 @noindent
3896 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3897 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3898 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3899 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3900 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3904 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3905 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3906 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3907 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3908 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3909
3910 @noindent
3911 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3912 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3913
3914 @end table
3915
3916 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3917 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3918 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3919 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3920
3921 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3922 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3923 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3924 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3925
3926 @itemize @bullet
3927 @item
3928 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3929
3930 @item
3931 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3932 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3933
3934 @item
3935 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3936 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3937
3938 @item
3939 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3940 several places where that function is inlined.
3941 @end itemize
3942
3943 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3944 the relevant locations.
3945
3946 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3947 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3948 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3949 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3950 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3951 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3952 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3953
3954 For example:
3955
3956 @smallexample
3957 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3958 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3959 stop only if i==1
3960 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3961 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3962 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3963 @end smallexample
3964
3965 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3966 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3967 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3968 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3969 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3970 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3971 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3972 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3973 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3974 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3975 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3976
3977 @cindex pending breakpoints
3978 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3979 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3980 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3981 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3982 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3983 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3984 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3985 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3986 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3987 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3988 is not yet resolved.
3989
3990 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3991 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3992 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3993 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3994 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3995 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3996
3997 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3998 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3999 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4000 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4001
4002 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4003 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4004 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4005
4006 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4007 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4008 address specification to an address:
4009
4010 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4011 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4012 @table @code
4013 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4014 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4015 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4016
4017 @item set breakpoint pending on
4018 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4019 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4020
4021 @item set breakpoint pending off
4022 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4023 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4024 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4025
4026 @item show breakpoint pending
4027 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4028 @end table
4029
4030 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4031 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4032 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4033
4034 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4035 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4036 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4037 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4038 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4039 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4040 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4041 breakpoints.
4042
4043 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4044
4045 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4046 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4047 @table @code
4048 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4049 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4050 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4051 breakpoint must be used.
4052
4053 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4054 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4055 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4056 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4057 @end table
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4060 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4061 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4062 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4063 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4064 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4065 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4066 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4067 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4068
4069 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4070 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4071 @table @code
4072 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4073 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4074 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4075 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4076
4077 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4078 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4079 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4080 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4081 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4082 @end table
4083
4084 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4085 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4086 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4087
4088 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4089 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4090
4091 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4092
4093 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4094 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4095 @table @code
4096 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4097 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4098 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4099 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4100 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4101
4102 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4103 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4104 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4105 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4106 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4107 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4108 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4109 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4110 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4111 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4112 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4113 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4114 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4115
4116 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4117 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4118 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4119 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4120 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4121 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4122 @end table
4123
4124
4125 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4126 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4127 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4128 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4129 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4130 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4131 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4132 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4133
4134
4135 @node Set Watchpoints
4136 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4137
4138 @cindex setting watchpoints
4139 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4140 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4141 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4142 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4143 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4144
4145 @itemize @bullet
4146 @item
4147 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4148
4149 @item
4150 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4151 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4152 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4153
4154 @item
4155 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4156 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4157 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4158 @end itemize
4159
4160 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4161 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4162 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4163 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4164 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4165 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4166 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4167 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4168 the expression changes.
4169
4170 @cindex software watchpoints
4171 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4172 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4173 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4174 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4175 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4176 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4177 culprit.)
4178
4179 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4180 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4181 slow down the running of your program.
4182
4183 @table @code
4184 @kindex watch
4185 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4186 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4187 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4188 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4189 to watch the value of a single variable:
4190
4191 @smallexample
4192 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4193 @end smallexample
4194
4195 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4196 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4197 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4198 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4199 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4200 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4201
4202 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4203 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4204 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4205 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4206 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4207 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4208 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4209 error.
4210
4211 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4212 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4213 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4214 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4215 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4216 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4217 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4218 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4219 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4220 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4221 Examples:
4222
4223 @smallexample
4224 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4225 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4226 @end smallexample
4227
4228 @kindex rwatch
4229 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4230 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4231 by the program.
4232
4233 @kindex awatch
4234 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4235 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4236 or written into by the program.
4237
4238 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4239 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4240 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4241 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4242 @end table
4243
4244 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4245 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4246 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4247 a never-changing value:
4248
4249 @smallexample
4250 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4251 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4252 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4253 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4254 @end smallexample
4255
4256 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4257 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4258 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4259 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4260 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4261 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4262
4263 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4264 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4265 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4266 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4267 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4268 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4269 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4270 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4271
4272 @table @code
4273 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4274 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4275 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4276
4277 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4278 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4279 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4280 @end table
4281
4282 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4283 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4284 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4285
4286 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4287
4288 @smallexample
4289 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 @noindent
4293 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4294
4295 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4296 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4297 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4298 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4299 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4300 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4301 will print a message like this:
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4305 @end smallexample
4306
4307 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4308 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4309 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4310 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4311 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4312 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4313 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4314 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4315
4316 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4317 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4318 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4319 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4320 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4321 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4322
4323 @smallexample
4324 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4325 @end smallexample
4326
4327 @noindent
4328 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4329
4330 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4331 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4332 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4333 expression with separately allocated resources.
4334
4335 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4336 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4337 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4338
4339 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4340 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4341 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4342 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4343 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4344 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4345 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4346 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4347 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4348
4349 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4350 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4351 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4352 watched expression from every thread.
4353
4354 @quotation
4355 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4356 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4357 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4358 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4359 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4360 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4361 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4362 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4363 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4364 @end quotation
4365
4366 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4367
4368 @node Set Catchpoints
4369 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4370 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4371 @cindex exception handlers
4372 @cindex event handling
4373
4374 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4375 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4376 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4377
4378 @table @code
4379 @kindex catch
4380 @item catch @var{event}
4381 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4382
4383 @table @code
4384 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4385 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4386 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4387 @kindex catch throw
4388 @kindex catch rethrow
4389 @kindex catch catch
4390 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4391 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4392
4393 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4394 regular expression will be caught.
4395
4396 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4397 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4398 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4399 exception being thrown.
4400
4401 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4402 @value{GDBN}:
4403
4404 @itemize @bullet
4405 @item
4406 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4407 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4408 supported.
4409
4410 @item
4411 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4412 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4413 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4414 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4415 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4416 built.
4417
4418 @item
4419 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4420 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4421
4422 @item
4423 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4424 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4425 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4426 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4427
4428 @item
4429 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4430 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4431 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4432 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4433 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4434 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4435 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4436 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4437 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4438
4439 @item
4440 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4441
4442 @item
4443 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4444 @end itemize
4445
4446 @item exception
4447 @kindex catch exception
4448 @cindex Ada exception catching
4449 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4450 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4451 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4452 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4453 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4454
4455 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4456 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4457 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4458 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4459 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4460 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4461 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4462 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4463
4464 @item handlers
4465 @kindex catch handlers
4466 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4467 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4468 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4469 specified at the end of the command
4470 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4471 only when this specific exception is handled.
4472 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4473
4474 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4475 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4476 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4477 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4478 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4479 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4480 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4481 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4482 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4483
4484 @item exception unhandled
4485 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4486 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4487
4488 @item assert
4489 @kindex catch assert
4490 A failed Ada assertion.
4491
4492 @item exec
4493 @kindex catch exec
4494 @cindex break on fork/exec
4495 A call to @code{exec}.
4496
4497 @item syscall
4498 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4499 @kindex catch syscall
4500 @cindex break on a system call.
4501 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4502 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4503 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4504 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4505 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4506 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4507 will be caught.
4508
4509 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4510 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4511 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4512 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4513
4514 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4515 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4516 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4517 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4518
4519 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4520 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4521 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4522 available choices.
4523
4524 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4525 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4526 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4527 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4528 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4529 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4530 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4531 behind the OS upgrades).
4532
4533 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4534 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4535 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4536 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4537 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4538 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4539 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4540 syscall groups available on your environment.
4541
4542 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4543 arguments to it:
4544
4545 @smallexample
4546 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4547 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4548 (@value{GDBP}) r
4549 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4550
4551 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4552 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4553 (@value{GDBP}) c
4554 Continuing.
4555
4556 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4557 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4558 (@value{GDBP})
4559 @end smallexample
4560
4561 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4562
4563 @smallexample
4564 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4565 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4566 (@value{GDBP}) r
4567 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4568
4569 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4570 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4571 (@value{GDBP}) c
4572 Continuing.
4573
4574 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4575 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4576 (@value{GDBP})
4577 @end smallexample
4578
4579 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4580 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4581 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4582
4583 @smallexample
4584 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4585 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4586 (@value{GDBP}) r
4587 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4588
4589 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4590 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4591 (@value{GDBP}) c
4592 Continuing.
4593
4594 Program exited normally.
4595 (@value{GDBP})
4596 @end smallexample
4597
4598 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4599
4600 @smallexample
4601 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4602 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4603 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4604 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4605 (@value{GDBP}) r
4606 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4607
4608 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4609 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4610
4611 (@value{GDBP}) c
4612 Continuing.
4613 @end smallexample
4614
4615 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4616 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4617 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4618 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4619
4620 @smallexample
4621 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4622 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4623 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4624 (@value{GDBP})
4625 @end smallexample
4626
4627 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4628 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4629 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4630 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4631 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4632 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4633
4634 @smallexample
4635 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4636 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4637 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4638 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4639 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4640 (@value{GDBP})
4641 @end smallexample
4642
4643 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4644
4645 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4646 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4647
4648 @smallexample
4649 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4650 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4651 @end smallexample
4652
4653 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4654
4655 @item fork
4656 @kindex catch fork
4657 A call to @code{fork}.
4658
4659 @item vfork
4660 @kindex catch vfork
4661 A call to @code{vfork}.
4662
4663 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4664 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4665 @kindex catch load
4666 @kindex catch unload
4667 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4668 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4669 matches one of the affected libraries.
4670
4671 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4672 @kindex catch signal
4673 The delivery of a signal.
4674
4675 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4676 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4677 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4678
4679 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4680 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4681 signal names.
4682
4683 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4684 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4685 will be caught.
4686
4687 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4688 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4689 catchpoint.
4690
4691 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4692 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4693 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4694 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4695 commands.
4696
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @item tcatch @var{event}
4700 @kindex tcatch
4701 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4702 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4703
4704 @end table
4705
4706 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4707
4708
4709 @node Delete Breaks
4710 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4711
4712 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4713 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4714 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4715 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4716 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4717 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4718
4719 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4720 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4721 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4722 their breakpoint numbers.
4723
4724 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4725 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4726 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4727
4728 @table @code
4729 @kindex clear
4730 @item clear
4731 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4732 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4733 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4734 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4735
4736 @item clear @var{location}
4737 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4738 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4739 most useful ones are listed below:
4740
4741 @table @code
4742 @item clear @var{function}
4743 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4744 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4745
4746 @item clear @var{linenum}
4747 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4748 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4749 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @cindex delete breakpoints
4753 @kindex delete
4754 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4755 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4756 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4757 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4758 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4759 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4760 @end table
4761
4762 @node Disabling
4763 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4766 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4767 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4768 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4769 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4770
4771 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4772 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4773 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4774 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4775 do not know which numbers to use.
4776
4777 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4778 affects all of its locations.
4779
4780 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4781 different states of enablement:
4782
4783 @itemize @bullet
4784 @item
4785 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4786 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4787 @item
4788 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4789 @item
4790 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4791 disabled.
4792 @item
4793 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4794 N times, then becomes disabled.
4795 @item
4796 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4797 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4798 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4799 @end itemize
4800
4801 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4802 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4803
4804 @table @code
4805 @kindex disable
4806 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4807 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4808 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4809 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4810 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4811 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4812 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4813
4814 @kindex enable
4815 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4816 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4817 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4818
4819 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4820 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4821 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4822
4823 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4824 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4825 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4826 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4827 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4828 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4829 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4830
4831 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4832 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4833 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4834 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4835 @end table
4836
4837 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4838 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4839 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4840 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4841 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4842 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4843 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4844 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4845 Stepping}.)
4846
4847 @node Conditions
4848 @subsection Break Conditions
4849 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4850 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4851
4852 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4853 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4854 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4855 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4856 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4857 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4858 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4859 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4860
4861 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4862 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4863 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4864 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4865 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4866
4867 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4868 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4869 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4870 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4871 one.
4872
4873 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4874 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4875 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4876 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4877 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4878 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4879 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4880 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4881 conditions for the
4882 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4883 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4884
4885 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4886 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4887 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4888 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4889 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4890 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4891
4892 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4893 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4894 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4895 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4896 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4897
4898 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4899 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4900 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4901 with the @code{condition} command.
4902
4903 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4904 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4905 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4906 catchpoint.
4907
4908 @table @code
4909 @kindex condition
4910 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4911 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4912 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4913 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4914 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4915 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4916 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4917 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4918 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4919 prints an error message:
4920
4921 @smallexample
4922 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4923 @end smallexample
4924
4925 @noindent
4926 @value{GDBN} does
4927 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4928 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4929 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4930
4931 @item condition @var{bnum}
4932 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4933 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4934 @end table
4935
4936 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4937 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4938 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4939 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4940 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4941 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4942 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4943 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4944 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4945 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4946 your program reaches it.
4947
4948 @table @code
4949 @kindex ignore
4950 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4951 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4952 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4953 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4954 takes no action.
4955
4956 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4957 a count of zero.
4958
4959 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4960 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4961 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4962 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4963
4964 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4965 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4966 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4967
4968 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4969 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4970 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4971 Variables}.
4972 @end table
4973
4974 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4975
4976
4977 @node Break Commands
4978 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4979
4980 @cindex breakpoint commands
4981 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4982 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4983 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4984 enable other breakpoints.
4985
4986 @table @code
4987 @kindex commands
4988 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4989 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4990 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4991 @itemx end
4992 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4993 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4994 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4995
4996 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4997 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4998
4999 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5000 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5001 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5002 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5003 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5004 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5005 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5006 Expressions}).
5007 @end table
5008
5009 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5010 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5011
5012 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5013 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5014 that resumes execution.
5015
5016 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5017 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5018 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5019 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5020 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5021
5022 @kindex silent
5023 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5024 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5025 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5026 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5027 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5028 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5029
5030 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5031 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5032 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5033
5034 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5035 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5036
5037 @smallexample
5038 break foo if x>0
5039 commands
5040 silent
5041 printf "x is %d\n",x
5042 cont
5043 end
5044 @end smallexample
5045
5046 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5047 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5048 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5049 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5050 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5051 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5052 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5053
5054 @smallexample
5055 break 403
5056 commands
5057 silent
5058 set x = y + 4
5059 cont
5060 end
5061 @end smallexample
5062
5063 @node Dynamic Printf
5064 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5065
5066 @cindex dynamic printf
5067 @cindex dprintf
5068 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5069 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5070 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5071 having to recompile it.
5072
5073 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5074 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5075 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5076 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5077 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5078 redirects to files and so forth.
5079
5080 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5081 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5082 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5083 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5084 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5085 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5086 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5087
5088 @table @code
5089 @kindex dprintf
5090 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5091 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5092 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5093 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5094
5095 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5096 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5097 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5098 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5099 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5100 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5101
5102 @table @code
5103 @item gdb
5104 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5105 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5106
5107 @item call
5108 @kindex dprintf-style call
5109 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5110 @code{printf}).
5111
5112 @item agent
5113 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5114 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5115 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5116 support running commands on the target.
5117 @end table
5118
5119 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5120 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5121 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5122 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5123 command.
5124
5125 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5126 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5127 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5128 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5129 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5130 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5131
5132 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5133 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5134 you could do the following:
5135
5136 @example
5137 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5138 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5139 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5140 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5141 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5142 (gdb) info break
5143 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5144 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5145 continue
5146 (gdb)
5147 @end example
5148
5149 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5150 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5151 the variable settings.
5152
5153 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5154 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5155 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5156 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5157 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5158 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5159
5160 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5161 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5162 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5163
5164 @end table
5165
5166 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5167 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5168 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5169 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5170 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5171 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5172
5173 @node Save Breakpoints
5174 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5175
5176 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5177 breakpoints}} command.
5178
5179 @table @code
5180 @kindex save breakpoints
5181 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5182 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5183 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5184 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5185 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5186 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5187 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5188 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5189 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5190 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5191 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5192 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5193 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5194 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5195 that can no longer be recreated.
5196 @end table
5197
5198 @node Static Probe Points
5199 @subsection Static Probe Points
5200
5201 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5202 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5203 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5204 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5205 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5206
5207 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5208 ELF-compatible systems:
5209
5210 @itemize @bullet
5211
5212 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5213 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5214 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5215 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5216 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5217 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5218 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5219 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5220
5221 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5222 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5223 C@t{++} languages.
5224 @end itemize
5225
5226 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5227 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5228 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5229 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5230 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5231 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5232 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5233 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5234 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5235
5236 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5237 probes}, with optional arguments:
5238
5239 @table @code
5240 @kindex info probes
5241 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5242 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5243 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5244 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5245
5246 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5247 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5248 probes from all providers are listed.
5249
5250 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5251 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5252 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5253
5254 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5255 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5256 given, all object files are considered.
5257
5258 @item info probes all
5259 List the available static probes, from all types.
5260 @end table
5261
5262 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5263 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5264 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5265 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5266 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5267
5268 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5269 commands, with optional arguments:
5270
5271 @table @code
5272 @kindex enable probes
5273 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5274 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5275 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5276 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5277
5278 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5279 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5280 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5281
5282 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5283 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5284 given, all object files are considered.
5285
5286 @kindex disable probes
5287 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5288 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5289 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5290 @end table
5291
5292 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5293 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5294 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5295 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5296 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5297 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5298 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5299 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5300 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5301 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5302 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5303 at the current probe point.
5304
5305 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5306 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5307 an error message.
5308
5309
5310 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5311 @node Error in Breakpoints
5312 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5313
5314 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5315 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5316
5317 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5318 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5319 @smallexample
5320 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5321 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5322 @end smallexample
5323
5324 @noindent
5325 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5326 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5327 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5328
5329 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5330 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5331
5332 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5333 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5334 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5335
5336 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5337 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5338 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5339 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5340
5341 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5342 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5343 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5344 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5345 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5346 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5347 first in the bundle.
5348
5349 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5350 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5351 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5352 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5353 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5354 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5355 is hit.
5356
5357 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5358 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5359
5360 @smallexample
5361 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5362 @end smallexample
5363
5364 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5365 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5366 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5367 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5368 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5369 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5370 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5371 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5372
5373 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5374 adjusted breakpoints:
5375
5376 @smallexample
5377 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5378 to 0x00010410.
5379 @end smallexample
5380
5381 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5382 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5383 frequently than expected.
5384
5385 @node Continuing and Stepping
5386 @section Continuing and Stepping
5387
5388 @cindex stepping
5389 @cindex continuing
5390 @cindex resuming execution
5391 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5392 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5393 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5394 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5395 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5396 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5397 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5398 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5399 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5400 handlers}).)
5401
5402 @table @code
5403 @kindex continue
5404 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5405 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5406 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5407 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5408 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5409 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5410 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5411 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5412 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5413 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5414
5415 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5416 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5417 @code{continue} is ignored.
5418
5419 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5420 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5421 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5422 @code{continue}.
5423 @end table
5424
5425 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5426 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5427 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5428 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5429
5430 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5431 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5432 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5433 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5434 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5435 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5436
5437 @table @code
5438 @kindex step
5439 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5440 @item step
5441 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5442 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5443 abbreviated @code{s}.
5444
5445 @quotation
5446 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5447 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5448 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5449 @c distinction here.
5450 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5451 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5452 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5453 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5454 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5455 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5456 below.
5457 @end quotation
5458
5459 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5460 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5461 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5462 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5463 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5464 called within the line.
5465
5466 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5467 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5468 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5469 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5470 was any debugging information about the routine.
5471
5472 @item step @var{count}
5473 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5474 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5475 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5476
5477 @kindex next
5478 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5479 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5480 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5481 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5482 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5483 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5484 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5485 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5486
5487 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5488
5489
5490 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5491 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5492 @c
5493 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5494 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5495 @c function are executed without stopping.
5496
5497 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5498 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5499 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5500
5501 @kindex set step-mode
5502 @item set step-mode
5503 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5504 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5505 @itemx set step-mode on
5506 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5507 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5508 information rather than stepping over it.
5509
5510 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5511 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5512 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5513
5514 @item set step-mode off
5515 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5516 debug information. This is the default.
5517
5518 @item show step-mode
5519 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5520 source line debug information.
5521
5522 @kindex finish
5523 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5524 @item finish
5525 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5526 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5527 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5528
5529 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5530 ,Returning from a Function}).
5531
5532 @kindex until
5533 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5534 @cindex run until specified location
5535 @item until
5536 @itemx u
5537 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5538 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5539 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5540 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5541 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5542 than the address of the jump.
5543
5544 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5545 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5546 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5547 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5548 through the next iteration.
5549
5550 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5551 stack frame.
5552
5553 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5554 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5555 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5556 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5557 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5558
5559 @smallexample
5560 (@value{GDBP}) f
5561 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5562 206 expand_input();
5563 (@value{GDBP}) until
5564 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5565 @end smallexample
5566
5567 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5568 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5569 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5570 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5571 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5572 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5573 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5574
5575 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5576 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5577 argument.
5578
5579 @item until @var{location}
5580 @itemx u @var{location}
5581 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5582 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5583 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5584 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5585 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5586 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5587 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5588 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5589 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5590 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5591 invocations have returned.
5592
5593 @smallexample
5594 94 int factorial (int value)
5595 95 @{
5596 96 if (value > 1) @{
5597 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5598 98 @}
5599 99 return (value);
5600 100 @}
5601 @end smallexample
5602
5603
5604 @kindex advance @var{location}
5605 @item advance @var{location}
5606 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5607 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5608 @ref{Specify Location}.
5609 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5610 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5611 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5612 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5613
5614
5615 @kindex stepi
5616 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5617 @item stepi
5618 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5619 @itemx si
5620 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5621
5622 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5623 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5624 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5625 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5626
5627 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5628
5629 @need 750
5630 @kindex nexti
5631 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5632 @item nexti
5633 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5634 @itemx ni
5635 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5636 proceed until the function returns.
5637
5638 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5639
5640 @end table
5641
5642 @anchor{range stepping}
5643 @cindex range stepping
5644 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5645 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5646 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5647 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5648 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5649 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5650 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5651 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5652 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5653 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5654 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5655 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5656 if necessary:
5657
5658 @table @code
5659 @kindex set range-stepping
5660 @kindex show range-stepping
5661 @item set range-stepping
5662 @itemx show range-stepping
5663 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5664
5665 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5666 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5667 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5668 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5669 default is @code{on}.
5670
5671 @end table
5672
5673 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5674 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5675 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5676
5677 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5678 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5679 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5680 a particular file when stepping.
5681
5682 For example, consider the following C function:
5683
5684 @smallexample
5685 101 int func()
5686 102 @{
5687 103 foo(boring());
5688 104 bar(boring());
5689 105 @}
5690 @end smallexample
5691
5692 @noindent
5693 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5694 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5695 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5696 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5697
5698 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5699 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5700 is called from many places.
5701
5702 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5703 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5704 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5705 @code{foo}.
5706
5707 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5708 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5709 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5710
5711 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5712 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5713 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5714 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5715 the underlying system.
5716 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5717 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5718
5719 @table @code
5720 @kindex skip
5721 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5722 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5723 that specify what to skip.
5724 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5725
5726 @table @code
5727 @item -file @var{file}
5728 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5729 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5730
5731 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5732 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5733 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5734 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5735 over when stepping.
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5739 @end smallexample
5740
5741 @item -function @var{linespec}
5742 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5743 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5744 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5745 @xref{Specify Location}.
5746
5747 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5748 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5749 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5750 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5751
5752 This form is useful for complex function names.
5753 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5754 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5755 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5756 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5757 regular expression makes this easier.
5758
5759 @smallexample
5760 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5761 @end smallexample
5762
5763 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5764 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5765
5766 @smallexample
5767 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5768 @end smallexample
5769 @end table
5770
5771 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5772 will be skipped.
5773
5774 @kindex skip function
5775 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5776 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5777 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5778 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5779
5780 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5781 will be skipped.
5782
5783 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5784 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5785
5786 @kindex skip file
5787 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5788 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5789 will be skipped over when stepping.
5790
5791 @smallexample
5792 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5793 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5794 @end smallexample
5795
5796 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5797 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5798 @end table
5799
5800 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5801 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5802
5803 @table @code
5804 @kindex info skip
5805 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5806 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5807 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5808 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5809
5810 @table @emph
5811 @item Identifier
5812 A number identifying this skip.
5813 @item Enabled or Disabled
5814 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5815 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5816 @item Glob
5817 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5818 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5819 @item File
5820 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5821 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5822 @item RE
5823 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5824 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5825 @item Function
5826 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5827 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5828 @end table
5829
5830 @kindex skip delete
5831 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5832 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5833 skips.
5834
5835 @kindex skip enable
5836 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5837 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5838 skips.
5839
5840 @kindex skip disable
5841 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5842 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5843 skips.
5844
5845 @end table
5846
5847 @node Signals
5848 @section Signals
5849 @cindex signals
5850
5851 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5852 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5853 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5854 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5855 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5856 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5857 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5858 requested an alarm).
5859
5860 @cindex fatal signals
5861 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5862 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5863 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5864 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5865 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5866 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5867
5868 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5869 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5870 signal.
5871
5872 @cindex handling signals
5873 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5874 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5875 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5876 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5877 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5878
5879 @table @code
5880 @kindex info signals
5881 @kindex info handle
5882 @item info signals
5883 @itemx info handle
5884 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5885 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5886 the defined types of signals.
5887
5888 @item info signals @var{sig}
5889 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5890
5891 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5892
5893 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5894 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5895 for details about this command.
5896
5897 @kindex handle
5898 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5899 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5900 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5901 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5902 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5903 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5904 say what change to make.
5905 @end table
5906
5907 @c @group
5908 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5909 Their full names are:
5910
5911 @table @code
5912 @item nostop
5913 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5914 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5915
5916 @item stop
5917 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5918 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5919
5920 @item print
5921 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5922
5923 @item noprint
5924 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5925 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5926
5927 @item pass
5928 @itemx noignore
5929 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5930 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5931 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5932
5933 @item nopass
5934 @itemx ignore
5935 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5936 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5937 @end table
5938 @c @end group
5939
5940 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5941 program until you
5942 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5943 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5944 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5945 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5946 program sees that signal when you continue.
5947
5948 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5949 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5950 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5951 erroneous signals.
5952
5953 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5954 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5955 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5956 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5957 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5958 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5959 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5960 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5961 Program a Signal}.
5962
5963 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5964 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5965
5966 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5967 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5968 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5969 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5970 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5971 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5972 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5973 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5974 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5975 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5976 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5977 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5978 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5979
5980 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5981
5982 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5983 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5984 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5985 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5986
5987 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5988 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5989 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5990 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5991
5992 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5993 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5997 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5998 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5999 (@value{GDBP}) c
6000 Continuing.
6001
6002 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6003 main () sigusr1.c:28
6004 28 p = 0;
6005 (@value{GDBP}) si
6006 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6007 9 @{
6008 @end smallexample
6009
6010 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6011 program to receive the signal first:
6012
6013 @smallexample
6014 (@value{GDBP}) n
6015 28 p = 0;
6016 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6017 (@value{GDBP}) si
6018 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6019 9 @{
6020 (@value{GDBP})
6021 @end smallexample
6022
6023 @cindex extra signal information
6024 @anchor{extra signal information}
6025
6026 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6027 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6028 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6029 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6030 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6031 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6032 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6033 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6034 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6035 system header.
6036
6037 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6038 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6039
6040 @smallexample
6041 @group
6042 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6043 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6044 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6045 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6046 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6047 type = struct @{
6048 int si_signo;
6049 int si_errno;
6050 int si_code;
6051 union @{
6052 int _pad[28];
6053 struct @{...@} _kill;
6054 struct @{...@} _timer;
6055 struct @{...@} _rt;
6056 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6057 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6058 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6059 @} _sifields;
6060 @}
6061 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6062 type = struct @{
6063 void *si_addr;
6064 @}
6065 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6066 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6067 @end group
6068 @end smallexample
6069
6070 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6071
6072 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6073 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6074 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6075 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6076 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6077 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6078 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6079 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6080 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6081 information is displayed.
6082
6083 The usual output of a segfault is:
6084 @smallexample
6085 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6086 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6087 68 value = *(p + len);
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 While a bound violation is presented as:
6091 @smallexample
6092 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6093 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6094 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6095 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6096 68 value = *(p + len);
6097 @end smallexample
6098
6099 @node Thread Stops
6100 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6101
6102 @cindex stopped threads
6103 @cindex threads, stopped
6104
6105 @cindex continuing threads
6106 @cindex threads, continuing
6107
6108 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6109 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6110 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6111 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6112 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6113 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6114 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6115 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6116 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6117
6118 @menu
6119 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6120 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6121 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6122 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6123 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6124 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6125 @end menu
6126
6127 @node All-Stop Mode
6128 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6129
6130 @cindex all-stop mode
6131
6132 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6133 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6134 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6135 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6136 underfoot.
6137
6138 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6139 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6140 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6141
6142 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6143 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6144 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6145 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6146 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6147 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6148 stops.
6149
6150 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6151 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6152 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6153 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6154
6155 @cindex automatic thread selection
6156 @cindex switching threads automatically
6157 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6158 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6159 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6160 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6161 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6162 thread.
6163
6164 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6165 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6166
6167 @table @code
6168 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6169 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6170 @cindex lock scheduler
6171 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6172 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6173 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6174 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6175 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6176 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6177 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6178 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6179 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6180 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6181 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6182 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6183 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6184 @code{on} in replay mode.
6185
6186 @item show scheduler-locking
6187 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6188 @end table
6189
6190 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6191 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6192 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6193 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6194 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6195 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6196 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6197 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6198 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6199 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6200 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6201 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6202 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6203 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6204
6205 @table @code
6206 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6207 @item set schedule-multiple
6208 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6209 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6210 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6211 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6212 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6213 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6214
6215 @item show schedule-multiple
6216 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6217 multiple processes.
6218 @end table
6219
6220 @node Non-Stop Mode
6221 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6222
6223 @cindex non-stop mode
6224
6225 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6226 @c with more details.
6227
6228 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6229 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6230 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6231 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6232 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6233 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6234
6235 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6236 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6237 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6238 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6239 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6240 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6241 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6242 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6243 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6244 independently and simultaneously.
6245
6246 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6247 or attach to your program:
6248
6249 @smallexample
6250 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6251 set pagination off
6252
6253 # Finally, turn it on!
6254 set non-stop on
6255 @end smallexample
6256
6257 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6258
6259 @table @code
6260 @kindex set non-stop
6261 @item set non-stop on
6262 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6263 @item set non-stop off
6264 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6265 @kindex show non-stop
6266 @item show non-stop
6267 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6268 @end table
6269
6270 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6271 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6272 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6273 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6274 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6275 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6276 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6277 default.
6278
6279 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6280 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6281 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6282
6283 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6284 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6285 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6286 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6287 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6288
6289 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6290 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6291 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6292 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6293 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6294
6295 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6296
6297 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6298 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6299 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6300 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6301 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6302 previously current thread.
6303
6304 @node Background Execution
6305 @subsection Background Execution
6306
6307 @cindex foreground execution
6308 @cindex background execution
6309 @cindex asynchronous execution
6310 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6311
6312 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6313 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6314 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6315 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6316 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6317 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6318
6319 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6320 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6321
6322 @cindex @code{&}
6323 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6324 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6325 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6326 are:
6327
6328 @table @code
6329 @kindex run&
6330 @item run
6331 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6332
6333 @item attach
6334 @kindex attach&
6335 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6336
6337 @item step
6338 @kindex step&
6339 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6340
6341 @item stepi
6342 @kindex stepi&
6343 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6344
6345 @item next
6346 @kindex next&
6347 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6348
6349 @item nexti
6350 @kindex nexti&
6351 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6352
6353 @item continue
6354 @kindex continue&
6355 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6356
6357 @item finish
6358 @kindex finish&
6359 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6360
6361 @item until
6362 @kindex until&
6363 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6364
6365 @end table
6366
6367 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6368 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6369 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6370 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6371 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6372 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6373
6374 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6375 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6376
6377 @table @code
6378 @kindex interrupt
6379 @item interrupt
6380 @itemx interrupt -a
6381
6382 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6383 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6384 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6385 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6386 @end table
6387
6388 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6389 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6390
6391 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6392 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6393 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6394
6395 @table @code
6396 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6397 @cindex thread breakpoints
6398 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6399 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6400 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6401 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6402 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6403 specify some source line.
6404
6405 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6406 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6407 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6408 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6409 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6410
6411 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6412 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6413 program.
6414
6415 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6416 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6417 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6418
6419 @smallexample
6420 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6421 @end smallexample
6422
6423 @end table
6424
6425 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6426 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6427 thread list. For example:
6428
6429 @smallexample
6430 (@value{GDBP}) c
6431 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6432 @end smallexample
6433
6434 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6435 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6436 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6437 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6438 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6439 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6440 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6441 command.
6442
6443 @node Interrupted System Calls
6444 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6445
6446 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6447 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6448 @cindex premature return from system calls
6449 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6450 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6451 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6452 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6453 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6454 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6455 stop execution.
6456
6457 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6458 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6459 style anyways.
6460
6461 For example, do not write code like this:
6462
6463 @smallexample
6464 sleep (10);
6465 @end smallexample
6466
6467 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6468 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6469
6470 Instead, write this:
6471
6472 @smallexample
6473 int unslept = 10;
6474 while (unslept > 0)
6475 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6476 @end smallexample
6477
6478 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6479 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6480 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6481 @value{GDBN}.
6482
6483 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6484 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6485 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6486 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6487
6488 @node Observer Mode
6489 @subsection Observer Mode
6490
6491 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6492 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6493 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6494 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6495 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6496
6497 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6498 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6499 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6500 mode.
6501
6502 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6503 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6504 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6505 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6506 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6507
6508 @table @code
6509
6510 @kindex observer
6511 @item set observer on
6512 @itemx set observer off
6513 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6514 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6515 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6516 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6517
6518 @item show observer
6519 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6520
6521 @kindex may-write-registers
6522 @item set may-write-registers on
6523 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6524 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6525 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6526 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6527
6528 @item show may-write-registers
6529 Show the current permission to write registers.
6530
6531 @kindex may-write-memory
6532 @item set may-write-memory on
6533 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6534 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6535 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6536 defaults to @code{on}.
6537
6538 @item show may-write-memory
6539 Show the current permission to write memory.
6540
6541 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6542 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6543 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6544 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6545 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6546 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6547
6548 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6549 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6550
6551 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6552 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6553 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6554 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6555 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6556 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6557 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6558
6559 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6560 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6561
6562 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6563 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6564 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6565 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6566 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6567 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6568 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6569
6570 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6571 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6572
6573 @kindex may-interrupt
6574 @item set may-interrupt on
6575 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6576 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6577 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6578 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6579 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6580
6581 @item show may-interrupt
6582 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6583
6584 @end table
6585
6586 @node Reverse Execution
6587 @chapter Running programs backward
6588 @cindex reverse execution
6589 @cindex running programs backward
6590
6591 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6592 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6593 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6594 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6595
6596 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6597 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6598 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6599 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6600 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6601 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6602
6603 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6604 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6605 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6606 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6607 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6608 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6609 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6610 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6611 prior values@footnote{
6612 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6613 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6614 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6615
6616 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6617 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6618 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6619 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6620 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6621 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6622 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6623 }.
6624
6625 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6626 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6627
6628 @table @code
6629 @kindex reverse-continue
6630 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6631 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6632 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6633 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6634 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6635 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6636 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6637
6638 @kindex reverse-step
6639 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6640 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6641 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6642 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6643
6644 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6645 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6646 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6647 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6648 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6649 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6650
6651 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6652 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6653
6654 @kindex reverse-stepi
6655 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6656 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6657 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6658 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6659 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6660 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6661 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6662
6663 @kindex reverse-next
6664 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6665 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6666 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6667 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6668 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6669 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6670 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6671 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6672 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6673 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6674
6675 @kindex reverse-nexti
6676 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6677 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6678 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6679 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6680 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6681 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6682 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6683 frame) is reached.
6684
6685 @kindex reverse-finish
6686 @item reverse-finish
6687 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6688 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6689 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6690 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6691
6692 @kindex set exec-direction
6693 @item set exec-direction
6694 Set the direction of target execution.
6695 @item set exec-direction reverse
6696 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6697 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6698 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6699 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6700 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6701 @item set exec-direction forward
6702 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6703 This is the default.
6704 @end table
6705
6706
6707 @node Process Record and Replay
6708 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6709 @cindex process record and replay
6710 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6711
6712 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6713 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6714 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6715
6716 @cindex replay mode
6717 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6718 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6719 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6720 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6721 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6722 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6723 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6724 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6725 execution log.
6726
6727 @cindex record mode
6728 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6729 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6730 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6731 for future replay.
6732
6733 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6734 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6735 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6736 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6737 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6738 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6739
6740 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6741 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6742 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6743 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6744
6745 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6746 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6747
6748 @table @code
6749 @kindex target record
6750 @kindex target record-full
6751 @kindex target record-btrace
6752 @kindex record
6753 @kindex record full
6754 @kindex record btrace
6755 @kindex record btrace bts
6756 @kindex record btrace pt
6757 @kindex record bts
6758 @kindex record pt
6759 @kindex rec
6760 @kindex rec full
6761 @kindex rec btrace
6762 @kindex rec btrace bts
6763 @kindex rec btrace pt
6764 @kindex rec bts
6765 @kindex rec pt
6766 @item record @var{method}
6767 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6768 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6769 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6770 recording methods are available:
6771
6772 @table @code
6773 @item full
6774 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6775 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6776 execution.
6777
6778 @item btrace @var{format}
6779 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6780 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6781 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6782 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6783 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6784 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6785 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6786
6787 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6788 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6789 formats are available:
6790
6791 @table @code
6792 @item bts
6793 @cindex branch trace store
6794 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6795 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6796 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6797
6798 @item pt
6799 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6800 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6801 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6802 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6803
6804 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6805 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6806 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6807
6808 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6809 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6810 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6811 buffer-size with care.
6812 @end table
6813
6814 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6815 @end table
6816
6817 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6818 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6819 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6820 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6821
6822 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6823 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6824 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6825 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6826 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6827
6828 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6829 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6830 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6831 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6832 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6833 does not support these two modes.
6834
6835 @kindex record stop
6836 @kindex rec s
6837 @item record stop
6838 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6839 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6840 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6841
6842 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6843 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6844 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6845 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6846 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6847
6848 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6849 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6850 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6851 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6852 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6853
6854 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6855 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6856
6857 @kindex record goto
6858 @item record goto
6859 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6860 ways to specify the location to go to:
6861
6862 @table @code
6863 @item record goto begin
6864 @itemx record goto start
6865 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6866
6867 @item record goto end
6868 Go to the end of the execution log.
6869
6870 @item record goto @var{n}
6871 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6872 @end table
6873
6874 @kindex record save
6875 @item record save @var{filename}
6876 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6877 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6878 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6879
6880 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6881
6882 @kindex record restore
6883 @item record restore @var{filename}
6884 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6885 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6886
6887 @kindex set record full
6888 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6889 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6890 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6891 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6892
6893 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6894 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6895 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6896 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6897 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6898 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6899 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6900 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6901
6902 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6903 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6904 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6905
6906 @kindex show record full
6907 @item show record full insn-number-max
6908 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6909 recording method.
6910
6911 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6912 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6913 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6914 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6915 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6916 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6917 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6918 oldest one to be deleted.
6919
6920 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6921 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6922
6923 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6924 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6925
6926 @item set record full memory-query
6927 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6928 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6929 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6930 case.
6931
6932 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6933 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6934 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6935 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6936 results.
6937
6938 @item show record full memory-query
6939 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6940
6941 @kindex set record btrace
6942 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6943 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6944 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6945 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6946 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6947 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6948 You can use the following command for that:
6949
6950 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6951 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6952 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6953 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6954 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6955 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6956 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6957 position.
6958
6959 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
6960 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
6961 errata when decoding the trace.
6962
6963 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
6964 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
6965 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
6966 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
6967 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
6968 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
6969 which the trace was recorded.
6970
6971 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
6972 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
6973 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
6974 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
6975 disable the workarounds.
6976
6977 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
6978 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
6979 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
6980 (default).
6981
6982 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
6983 identifiers are currently supported:
6984
6985 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
6986
6987 @item @code{intel}
6988 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
6989
6990 @end multitable
6991
6992 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
6993 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
6994
6995 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
6996 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
6997 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
6998
6999 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7000 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7001 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7002 supports.
7003
7004 @smallexample
7005 (gdb) info record
7006 Active record target: record-btrace
7007 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7008 Buffer size: 16kB.
7009 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7010 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7011 (gdb) info record
7012 Active record target: record-btrace
7013 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7014 Buffer size: 16kB.
7015 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7016 @end smallexample
7017
7018 @kindex show record btrace
7019 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7020 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7021
7022 @item show record btrace cpu
7023 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7024 workarounds.
7025
7026 @kindex set record btrace bts
7027 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7028 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7029 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7030 format. Default is 64KB.
7031
7032 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7033 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7034 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7035 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7036 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7037 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7038 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7039
7040 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7041 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7042
7043 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7044 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7045
7046 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7047 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7048 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7049
7050 @kindex set record btrace pt
7051 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7052 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7053 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7054 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7055
7056 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7057 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7058 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7059 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7060 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7061 actual buffer size for each thread.
7062
7063 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7064 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7065
7066 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7067 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7068
7069 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7070 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7071 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7072
7073 @kindex info record
7074 @item info record
7075 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7076 method:
7077
7078 @table @code
7079 @item full
7080 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7081 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7082
7083 @itemize @bullet
7084 @item
7085 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7086 @item
7087 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7088 @item
7089 Highest recorded instruction number.
7090 @item
7091 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7092 @item
7093 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7094 @item
7095 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7096 @end itemize
7097
7098 @item btrace
7099 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7100
7101 @itemize @bullet
7102 @item
7103 Recording format.
7104 @item
7105 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7106 @item
7107 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7108 instructions.
7109 @item
7110 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7111 @end itemize
7112
7113 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7114 @itemize @bullet
7115 @item
7116 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7117 @end itemize
7118
7119 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7120 @itemize @bullet
7121 @item
7122 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7123 @end itemize
7124 @end table
7125
7126 @kindex record delete
7127 @kindex rec del
7128 @item record delete
7129 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7130 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7131 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7132 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7133
7134 @kindex record instruction-history
7135 @kindex rec instruction-history
7136 @item record instruction-history
7137 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7138 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7139 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7140 are printed in execution order.
7141
7142 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7143 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7144 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7145
7146 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7147 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7148 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7149 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7150 @code{/p} modifier.
7151
7152 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7153 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7154 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7155
7156 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7157 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7158
7159 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7160 disassemble:
7161
7162 @table @code
7163 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7164 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7165 @var{insn}.
7166
7167 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7168 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7169 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7170 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7171 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7172 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7173
7174 @item record instruction-history
7175 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7176
7177 @item record instruction-history -
7178 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7179
7180 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7181 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7182 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7183 number @var{end} is included.
7184 @end table
7185
7186 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7187
7188 @kindex set record
7189 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7190 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7191 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7192 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7193 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7194
7195 @kindex show record
7196 @item show record instruction-history-size
7197 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7198 instruction-history} command.
7199
7200 @kindex record function-call-history
7201 @kindex rec function-call-history
7202 @item record function-call-history
7203 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7204 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7205 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7206 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7207 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7208 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7209 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7210 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7211 given together.
7212
7213 @smallexample
7214 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7215 1 void foo (void)
7216 2 @{
7217 3 @}
7218 4
7219 5 void bar (void)
7220 6 @{
7221 7 ...
7222 8 foo ();
7223 9 ...
7224 10 @}
7225 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7226 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7227 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7228 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7229 @end smallexample
7230
7231 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7232 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7233 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7234 to print:
7235
7236 @table @code
7237 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7238 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7239
7240 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7241 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7242 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7243 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7244 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7245
7246 @item record function-call-history
7247 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7248
7249 @item record function-call-history -
7250 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7251
7252 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7253 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7254 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7255 @end table
7256
7257 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7258
7259 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7260 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7261 Define how many lines to print in the
7262 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7263 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7264
7265 @item show record function-call-history-size
7266 Show how many lines to print in the
7267 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7268 @end table
7269
7270
7271 @node Stack
7272 @chapter Examining the Stack
7273
7274 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7275 stopped and how it got there.
7276
7277 @cindex call stack
7278 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7279 is generated.
7280 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7281 the arguments of the call,
7282 and the local variables of the function being called.
7283 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7284 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7285 stack}.
7286
7287 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7288 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7289
7290 @cindex selected frame
7291 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7292 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7293 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7294 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7295 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7296 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7297
7298 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7299 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7300 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7301
7302 @menu
7303 * Frames:: Stack frames
7304 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7305 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7306 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7307 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7308
7309 @end menu
7310
7311 @node Frames
7312 @section Stack Frames
7313
7314 @cindex frame, definition
7315 @cindex stack frame
7316 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7317 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7318 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7319 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7320 which the function is executing.
7321
7322 @cindex initial frame
7323 @cindex outermost frame
7324 @cindex innermost frame
7325 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7326 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7327 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7328 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7329 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7330 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7331 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7332 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7333
7334 @cindex frame pointer
7335 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7336 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7337 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7338 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7339 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7340 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7341
7342 @cindex frame number
7343 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7344 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7345 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7346 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7347 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7348
7349 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7350 @c underflow problems.
7351 @cindex frameless execution
7352 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7353 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7354 @smallexample
7355 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7356 @end smallexample
7357 generates functions without a frame.)
7358 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7359 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7360 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7361 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7362 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7363 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7364 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7365
7366 @node Backtrace
7367 @section Backtraces
7368
7369 @cindex traceback
7370 @cindex call stack traces
7371 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7372 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7373 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7374 stack.
7375
7376 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7377 @kindex backtrace
7378 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7379 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7380 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7381 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7382 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7383 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7384
7385 @table @code
7386 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7387 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7388 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7389 be one of the following:
7390
7391 @table @code
7392 @item @var{n}
7393 @itemx @var{n}
7394 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7395 number.
7396
7397 @item -@var{n}
7398 @itemx -@var{n}
7399 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7400 number.
7401
7402 @item full
7403 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7404 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7405
7406 @item no-filters
7407 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7408 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7409 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7410 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7411 support.
7412
7413 @item hide
7414 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7415 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7416 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7417 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7418 @end table
7419 @end table
7420
7421 @kindex where
7422 @kindex info stack
7423 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7424 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7425
7426 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7427 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7428 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7429 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7430 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7431 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7432 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7433 multi-threaded program.
7434
7435 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7436 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7437 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7438 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7439 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7440 line number.
7441
7442 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7443 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7444
7445 @smallexample
7446 @group
7447 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7448 at builtin.c:993
7449 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7450 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7451 at macro.c:71
7452 (More stack frames follow...)
7453 @end group
7454 @end smallexample
7455
7456 @noindent
7457 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7458 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7459 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7460
7461 @noindent
7462 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7463 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7464 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7465 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7466 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7467
7468 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7469 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7470 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7471 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7472 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7473 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7474 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7475 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7476 such a backtrace might look like:
7477
7478 @smallexample
7479 @group
7480 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7481 at builtin.c:993
7482 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7483 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7484 at macro.c:71
7485 (More stack frames follow...)
7486 @end group
7487 @end smallexample
7488
7489 @noindent
7490 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7491 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7492
7493 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7494 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7495 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7496
7497 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7498 @cindex program entry point
7499 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7500 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7501 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7502 @code{main}@footnote{
7503 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7504 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7505 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7506 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7507 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7508 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7509
7510 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7511 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7512
7513 @table @code
7514 @item set backtrace past-main
7515 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7516 @kindex set backtrace
7517 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7518
7519 @item set backtrace past-main off
7520 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7521 default.
7522
7523 @item show backtrace past-main
7524 @kindex show backtrace
7525 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7526
7527 @item set backtrace past-entry
7528 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7529 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7530 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7531 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7532
7533 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7534 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7535 application. This is the default.
7536
7537 @item show backtrace past-entry
7538 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7539
7540 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7541 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7542 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7543 @cindex backtrace limit
7544 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7545 or zero means unlimited levels.
7546
7547 @item show backtrace limit
7548 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7549 @end table
7550
7551 You can control how file names are displayed.
7552
7553 @table @code
7554 @item set filename-display
7555 @itemx set filename-display relative
7556 @cindex filename-display
7557 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7558
7559 @item set filename-display basename
7560 Display only basename of a filename.
7561
7562 @item set filename-display absolute
7563 Display an absolute filename.
7564
7565 @item show filename-display
7566 Show the current way to display filenames.
7567 @end table
7568
7569 @node Selection
7570 @section Selecting a Frame
7571
7572 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7573 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7574 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7575 of the stack frame just selected.
7576
7577 @table @code
7578 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7579 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7580 @item frame @var{n}
7581 @itemx f @var{n}
7582 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7583 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7584 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7585 @code{main}.
7586
7587 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7588 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7589 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7590 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7591 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7592 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7593 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7594 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7595
7596 @kindex up
7597 @item up @var{n}
7598 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7599 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7600 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7601
7602 @kindex down
7603 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7604 @item down @var{n}
7605 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7606 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7607 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7608 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7609 @end table
7610
7611 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7612 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7613 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7614 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7615
7616 @need 1000
7617 For example:
7618
7619 @smallexample
7620 @group
7621 (@value{GDBP}) up
7622 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7623 at env.c:10
7624 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7625 @end group
7626 @end smallexample
7627
7628 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7629 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7630 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7631 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7632 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7633 for details.
7634
7635 @table @code
7636 @kindex select-frame
7637 @item select-frame
7638 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7639 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7640 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7641 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7642
7643 @kindex down-silently
7644 @kindex up-silently
7645 @item up-silently @var{n}
7646 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7647 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7648 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7649 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7650 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7651 distracting.
7652 @end table
7653
7654 @node Frame Info
7655 @section Information About a Frame
7656
7657 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7658 stack frame.
7659
7660 @table @code
7661 @item frame
7662 @itemx f
7663 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7664 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7665 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7666 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7667 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7668
7669 @kindex info frame
7670 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7671 @item info frame
7672 @itemx info f
7673 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7674 including:
7675
7676 @itemize @bullet
7677 @item
7678 the address of the frame
7679 @item
7680 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7681 @item
7682 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7683 @item
7684 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7685 @item
7686 the address of the frame's arguments
7687 @item
7688 the address of the frame's local variables
7689 @item
7690 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7691 @item
7692 which registers were saved in the frame
7693 @end itemize
7694
7695 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7696 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7697 the usual conventions.
7698
7699 @item info frame @var{addr}
7700 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7701 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7702 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7703 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7704 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7705 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7706
7707 @kindex info args
7708 @item info args
7709 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7710
7711 @item info locals
7712 @kindex info locals
7713 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7714 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7715 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7716
7717 @end table
7718
7719 @node Frame Filter Management
7720 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7721 @cindex managing frame filters
7722
7723 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7724 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7725
7726 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7727 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7728
7729 @table @code
7730 @kindex info frame-filter
7731 @item info frame-filter
7732 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7733 their name, priority and enabled status.
7734
7735 @kindex disable frame-filter
7736 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7737 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7738 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7739 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7740 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7741 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7742 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7743 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7744 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7745 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7746 may be enabled again later.
7747
7748 @kindex enable frame-filter
7749 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7750 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7751 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7752 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7753 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7754 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7755 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7756 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7757 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7758
7759 Example:
7760
7761 @smallexample
7762 (gdb) info frame-filter
7763
7764 global frame-filters:
7765 Priority Enabled Name
7766 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7767 100 Yes Reverse
7768
7769 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7770 Priority Enabled Name
7771 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7772
7773 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7774 Priority Enabled Name
7775 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7776
7777 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7778 (gdb) info frame-filter
7779
7780 global frame-filters:
7781 Priority Enabled Name
7782 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7783 100 Yes Reverse
7784
7785 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7786 Priority Enabled Name
7787 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7788
7789 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7790 Priority Enabled Name
7791 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7792
7793 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7794 (gdb) info frame-filter
7795
7796 global frame-filters:
7797 Priority Enabled Name
7798 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7799 100 Yes Reverse
7800
7801 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7802 Priority Enabled Name
7803 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7804
7805 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7806 Priority Enabled Name
7807 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7808 @end smallexample
7809
7810 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7811 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7812 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7813 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7814 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7815 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7816 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7817
7818 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7819 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7820 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7821 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7822 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7823 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7824 dictionary resides.
7825
7826 Example:
7827
7828 @smallexample
7829 (gdb) info frame-filter
7830
7831 global frame-filters:
7832 Priority Enabled Name
7833 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7834 100 Yes Reverse
7835
7836 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7837 Priority Enabled Name
7838 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7839
7840 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7841 Priority Enabled Name
7842 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7843
7844 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7845 (gdb) info frame-filter
7846
7847 global frame-filters:
7848 Priority Enabled Name
7849 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7850 50 Yes Reverse
7851
7852 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7853 Priority Enabled Name
7854 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7855
7856 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7857 Priority Enabled Name
7858 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7859 @end smallexample
7860 @end table
7861
7862 @node Source
7863 @chapter Examining Source Files
7864
7865 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7866 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7867 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7868 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7869 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7870 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7871 source files by explicit command.
7872
7873 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7874 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7875 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7876
7877 @menu
7878 * List:: Printing source lines
7879 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7880 * Edit:: Editing source files
7881 * Search:: Searching source files
7882 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7883 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7884 @end menu
7885
7886 @node List
7887 @section Printing Source Lines
7888
7889 @kindex list
7890 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7891 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7892 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7893 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7894 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7895
7896 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7897
7898 @table @code
7899 @item list @var{linenum}
7900 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7901 current source file.
7902
7903 @item list @var{function}
7904 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7905 @var{function}.
7906
7907 @item list
7908 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7909 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7910 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7911 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7912 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7913
7914 @item list -
7915 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7916 @end table
7917
7918 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7919 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7920 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7921
7922 @table @code
7923 @kindex set listsize
7924 @item set listsize @var{count}
7925 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7926 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7927 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7928 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7929
7930 @kindex show listsize
7931 @item show listsize
7932 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7933 @end table
7934
7935 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7936 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7937 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7938 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7939 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7940
7941 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7942 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7943 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7944 to specify some source line.
7945
7946 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7947
7948 @table @code
7949 @item list @var{location}
7950 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7951
7952 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7953 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7954 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7955 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7956 the same source file as the first location.
7957
7958 @item list ,@var{last}
7959 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7960
7961 @item list @var{first},
7962 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7963
7964 @item list +
7965 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7966
7967 @item list -
7968 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7969
7970 @item list
7971 As described in the preceding table.
7972 @end table
7973
7974 @node Specify Location
7975 @section Specifying a Location
7976 @cindex specifying location
7977 @cindex location
7978 @cindex source location
7979
7980 @menu
7981 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7982 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7983 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7984 @end menu
7985
7986 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7987 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7988 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7989 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7990 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7991
7992 @node Linespec Locations
7993 @subsection Linespec Locations
7994 @cindex linespec locations
7995
7996 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7997 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7998 specifying a linespec:
7999
8000 @table @code
8001 @item @var{linenum}
8002 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8003
8004 @item -@var{offset}
8005 @itemx +@var{offset}
8006 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8007 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8008 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8009 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8010 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8011 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8012 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8013 linespec.
8014
8015 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8016 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8017 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8018 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8019 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8020 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8021 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8022
8023 @item @var{function}
8024 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8025 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8026
8027 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8028 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8029 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8030 means in all packages.
8031
8032 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8033 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8034 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8035
8036 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8037 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8038 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8039 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8040
8041 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8042
8043 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8044 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8045
8046 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8047 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8048 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8049 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8050 functions in different source files.
8051
8052 @item @var{label}
8053 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8054 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8055 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8056 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8057
8058 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8059 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8060 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8061 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8062 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8063 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8064
8065 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8066 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8067 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8068 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8069 each one of those probes.
8070 @end table
8071
8072 @node Explicit Locations
8073 @subsection Explicit Locations
8074 @cindex explicit locations
8075
8076 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8077 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8078
8079 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8080 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8081 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8082 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8083 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8084
8085 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8086 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8087 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8088 the symbol table to know.
8089
8090 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8091 following table:
8092
8093 @table @code
8094 @item -source @var{filename}
8095 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8096 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8097 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8098 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8099 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8100
8101 @item -function @var{function}
8102 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8103 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8104 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8105 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8106
8107 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8108 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8109 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8110 means in all packages.
8111
8112 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8113 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8114 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8115 breakpoint on both symbols.
8116
8117 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8118
8119 @item -qualified
8120
8121 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8122 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8123
8124 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8125 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8126 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8127
8128 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8129 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8130 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8131
8132 @item -label @var{label}
8133 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8134 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8135 selected stack frame.
8136
8137 @item -line @var{number}
8138 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8139 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8140 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8141 relative to the current line.
8142 @end table
8143
8144 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8145 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8146
8147 @node Address Locations
8148 @subsection Address Locations
8149 @cindex address locations
8150
8151 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8152 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8153
8154 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8155 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8156 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8157 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8158 source files.
8159
8160 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8161 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8162 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8163 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8164 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8165 of @var{address}:
8166
8167 @table @code
8168 @item @var{expression}
8169 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8170
8171 @item @var{funcaddr}
8172 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8173 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8174 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8175 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8176 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8177 (although the Pascal form also works).
8178
8179 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8180 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8181
8182 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8183 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8184 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8185 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8186 functions with identical names in different source files.
8187 @end table
8188
8189 @node Edit
8190 @section Editing Source Files
8191 @cindex editing source files
8192
8193 @kindex edit
8194 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8195 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8196 The editing program of your choice
8197 is invoked with the current line set to
8198 the active line in the program.
8199 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8200 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8201
8202 @table @code
8203 @item edit @var{location}
8204 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8205 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8206 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8207 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8208 command most commonly used:
8209
8210 @table @code
8211 @item edit @var{number}
8212 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8213
8214 @item edit @var{function}
8215 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8216 @end table
8217
8218 @end table
8219
8220 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8221 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8222 @footnote{
8223 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8224 following command-line syntax:
8225 @smallexample
8226 ex +@var{number} file
8227 @end smallexample
8228 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8229 the file where to start editing.}.
8230 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8231 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8232 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8233 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8234 @smallexample
8235 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8236 export EDITOR
8237 gdb @dots{}
8238 @end smallexample
8239 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8240 @smallexample
8241 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8242 gdb @dots{}
8243 @end smallexample
8244
8245 @node Search
8246 @section Searching Source Files
8247 @cindex searching source files
8248
8249 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8250 regular expression.
8251
8252 @table @code
8253 @kindex search
8254 @kindex forward-search
8255 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8256 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8257 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8258 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8259 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8260 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8261 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8262 @code{fo}.
8263
8264 @kindex reverse-search
8265 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8266 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8267 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8268 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8269 this command as @code{rev}.
8270 @end table
8271
8272 @node Source Path
8273 @section Specifying Source Directories
8274
8275 @cindex source path
8276 @cindex directories for source files
8277 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8278 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8279 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8280 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8281 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8282 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8283 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8284
8285 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8286 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8287 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8288 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8289 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8290 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8291 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8292 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8293 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8294 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8295 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8296
8297 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8298 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8299 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8300 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8301 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8302 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8303
8304 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8305 source files.
8306
8307 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8308 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8309 each line is in the file.
8310
8311 @kindex directory
8312 @kindex dir
8313 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8314 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8315 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8316
8317 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8318 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8319
8320 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8321 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8322 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8323 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8324 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8325 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8326 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8327 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8328 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8329 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8330 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8331 name to look up the sources.
8332
8333 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8334 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8335 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8336 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8337 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8338 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8339 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8340 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8341
8342 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8343 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8344 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8345 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8346 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8347 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8348 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8349
8350 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8351 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8352 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8353 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8354 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8355 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8356 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8357 command.
8358
8359 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8360 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8361 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8362 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8363 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8364 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8365 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8366
8367 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8368 @cindex default source path substitution
8369 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8370 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8371 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8372 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8373 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8374 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8375 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8376 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8377 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8378 together.
8379
8380 @table @code
8381 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8382 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8383 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8384 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8385 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8386 part of absolute file names) or
8387 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8388 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8389
8390 @kindex cdir
8391 @kindex cwd
8392 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8393 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8394 @cindex compilation directory
8395 @cindex current directory
8396 @cindex working directory
8397 @cindex directory, current
8398 @cindex directory, compilation
8399 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8400 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8401 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8402 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8403 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8404 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8405
8406 @item directory
8407 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8408
8409 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8410 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8411
8412 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8413 @kindex set directories
8414 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8415 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8416
8417 @item show directories
8418 @kindex show directories
8419 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8420
8421 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8422 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8423 @kindex set substitute-path
8424 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8425 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8426 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8427
8428 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8429 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8430
8431 @smallexample
8432 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8433 @end smallexample
8434
8435 @noindent
8436 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8437 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8438 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8439
8440 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8441 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8442 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8443 the substitution.
8444
8445 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8446
8447 @smallexample
8448 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8449 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8450 @end smallexample
8451
8452 @noindent
8453 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8454 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8455 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8456 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8457
8458
8459 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8460 @kindex unset substitute-path
8461 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8462 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8463 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8464
8465 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8466
8467 @item show substitute-path [path]
8468 @kindex show substitute-path
8469 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8470 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8471
8472 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8473 rules.
8474
8475 @end table
8476
8477 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8478 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8479 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8480
8481 @enumerate
8482 @item
8483 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8484
8485 @item
8486 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8487 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8488 directories in one command.
8489 @end enumerate
8490
8491 @node Machine Code
8492 @section Source and Machine Code
8493 @cindex source line and its code address
8494
8495 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8496 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8497 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8498 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8499 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8500 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8501 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8502 well as hex.
8503
8504 @table @code
8505 @kindex info line
8506 @item info line
8507 @itemx info line @var{location}
8508 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8509 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8510 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8511 information about the current source line is printed.
8512 @end table
8513
8514 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8515 the object code for the first line of function
8516 @code{m4_changequote}:
8517
8518 @smallexample
8519 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8520 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8521 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8522 @end smallexample
8523
8524 @noindent
8525 @cindex code address and its source line
8526 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8527 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8528 @smallexample
8529 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8530 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8531 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8532 @end smallexample
8533
8534 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8535 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8536 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8537 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8538 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8539 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8540 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8541 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8542 Variables}).
8543
8544 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8545 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8546 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8547 line.
8548
8549 @table @code
8550 @kindex disassemble
8551 @cindex assembly instructions
8552 @cindex instructions, assembly
8553 @cindex machine instructions
8554 @cindex listing machine instructions
8555 @item disassemble
8556 @itemx disassemble /m
8557 @itemx disassemble /s
8558 @itemx disassemble /r
8559 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8560 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8561 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8562 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8563 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8564 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8565 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8566 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8567 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8568 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8569
8570 @table @code
8571 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8572 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8573 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8574 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8575 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8576 @end table
8577
8578 @noindent
8579 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8580 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8581
8582 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8583 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8584
8585 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8586 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8587 @end table
8588
8589 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8590 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8591
8592 @smallexample
8593 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8594 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8595 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8596 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8597 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8598 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8599 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8600 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8601 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8602 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8603 End of assembler dump.
8604 @end smallexample
8605
8606 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8607 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8608 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8609
8610 @smallexample
8611 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8612 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8613 5 @{
8614 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8615 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8616 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8617 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8618 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8619
8620 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8621 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8622 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8623
8624 7 return 0;
8625 8 @}
8626 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8627 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8628 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8629
8630 End of assembler dump.
8631 @end smallexample
8632
8633 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8634 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8635 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8636 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8637 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8638 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8639 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8640 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8641 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8642
8643 @file{foo.h}:
8644
8645 @smallexample
8646 int
8647 foo (int a)
8648 @{
8649 if (a < 0)
8650 return a * 2;
8651 if (a == 0)
8652 return 1;
8653 return a + 10;
8654 @}
8655 @end smallexample
8656
8657 @file{foo.c}:
8658
8659 @smallexample
8660 #include "foo.h"
8661 volatile int x, y;
8662 int
8663 main ()
8664 @{
8665 x = foo (y);
8666 return 0;
8667 @}
8668 @end smallexample
8669
8670 @smallexample
8671 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8672 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8673 5 @{
8674
8675 6 x = foo (y);
8676 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8677 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8678
8679 7 return 0;
8680 8 @}
8681 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8682 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8683 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8684 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8685
8686 End of assembler dump.
8687 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8688 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8689 foo.c:
8690 5 @{
8691 6 x = foo (y);
8692 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8693
8694 foo.h:
8695 4 if (a < 0)
8696 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8697 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8698
8699 6 if (a == 0)
8700 7 return 1;
8701 8 return a + 10;
8702 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8703 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8704 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8705 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8706
8707 foo.c:
8708 6 x = foo (y);
8709 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8710
8711 7 return 0;
8712 8 @}
8713 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8714 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8715
8716 foo.h:
8717 5 return a * 2;
8718 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8719 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8720 End of assembler dump.
8721 @end smallexample
8722
8723 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8724
8725 @smallexample
8726 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8727 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8728 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8729 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8730 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8731 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8732 End of assembler dump.
8733 @end smallexample
8734
8735 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8736 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8737 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8738 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8739
8740 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8741 mnemonics or other syntax.
8742
8743 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8744 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8745 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8746 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8747 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8748
8749 @table @code
8750 @kindex set disassembler-options
8751 @cindex disassembler options
8752 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8753 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8754 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8755 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8756 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8757 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8758 The default value is the empty string.
8759
8760 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8761 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8762 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8763 and S/390.
8764
8765 @kindex show disassembler-options
8766 @item show disassembler-options
8767 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8768 @end table
8769
8770 @table @code
8771 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8772 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8773 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8774 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8775 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8776 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8777
8778 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8779 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8780 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8781 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8782
8783 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8784 @item show disassembly-flavor
8785 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8786 @end table
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8790 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8791 @item set disassemble-next-line
8792 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8793 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8794 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8795 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8796 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8797 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8798 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8799 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8800 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8801 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8802 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8803 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8804 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8805 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8806 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8807 instruction.
8808 @end table
8809
8810
8811 @node Data
8812 @chapter Examining Data
8813
8814 @cindex printing data
8815 @cindex examining data
8816 @kindex print
8817 @kindex inspect
8818 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8819 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8820 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8821 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8822 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8823 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @item print @var{expr}
8827 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8828 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8829 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8830 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8831 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8832 Formats}.
8833
8834 @item print
8835 @itemx print /@var{f}
8836 @cindex reprint the last value
8837 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8838 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8839 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8840 @end table
8841
8842 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8843 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8844 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8845
8846 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8847 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8848 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8849 Table}.
8850
8851 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8852 @kindex explore
8853 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8854 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8855 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8856 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8857 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8858 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8859 embedded in the higher level data types.
8860
8861 @table @code
8862 @item explore @var{arg}
8863 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8864 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8865 @end table
8866
8867 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8868 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8869 C program as
8870
8871 @smallexample
8872 struct SimpleStruct
8873 @{
8874 int i;
8875 double d;
8876 @};
8877
8878 struct ComplexStruct
8879 @{
8880 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8881 int arr[10];
8882 @};
8883 @end smallexample
8884
8885 @noindent
8886 followed by variable declarations as
8887
8888 @smallexample
8889 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8890 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8891 @end smallexample
8892
8893 @noindent
8894 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8895 @code{explore} command as follows.
8896
8897 @smallexample
8898 (gdb) explore cs
8899 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8900 the following fields:
8901
8902 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8903 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8904
8905 Enter the field number of choice:
8906 @end smallexample
8907
8908 @noindent
8909 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8910 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8911 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8912 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8913 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8914 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8915 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8916 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8917
8918 @smallexample
8919 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8920 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8921 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8922 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8923
8924 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8925 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8926
8927 Press enter to return to parent value:
8928 @end smallexample
8929
8930 @noindent
8931 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8932 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8933 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8934 to explore.
8935
8936 @smallexample
8937 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8938 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8939
8940 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8941
8942 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8943
8944 Press enter to return to parent value:
8945 @end smallexample
8946
8947 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8948 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8949 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8950 level data structure).
8951
8952 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8953 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8954 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8955 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8956 same example as above, your can explore the type
8957 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8958 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8959
8960 @smallexample
8961 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8962 @end smallexample
8963
8964 @noindent
8965 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8966 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8967 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8968 example.
8969
8970 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8971 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8972 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8973 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8974 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8975
8976 @table @code
8977 @item explore value @var{expr}
8978 @cindex explore value
8979 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8980 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8981 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8982 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8983 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8984
8985 @item explore type @var{arg}
8986 @cindex explore type
8987 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8988 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8989 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8990 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8991 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8992 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8993 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8994 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8995 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8996 @end table
8997
8998 @menu
8999 * Expressions:: Expressions
9000 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9001 * Variables:: Program variables
9002 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9003 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9004 * Memory:: Examining memory
9005 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9006 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9007 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9008 * Value History:: Value history
9009 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9010 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9011 * Registers:: Registers
9012 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9013 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9014 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9015 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9016 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9017 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9018 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9019 character set than GDB does
9020 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9021 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9022 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9023 @end menu
9024
9025 @node Expressions
9026 @section Expressions
9027
9028 @cindex expressions
9029 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9030 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9031 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9032 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9033 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9034 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9035 @ref{Compilation}.
9036
9037 @cindex arrays in expressions
9038 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9039 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9040 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9041 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9042 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9043 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9044
9045 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9046 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9047 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9048 languages.
9049
9050 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9051 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9052
9053 @cindex casts, in expressions
9054 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9055 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9056 at that address in memory.
9057 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9058
9059 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9060 to programming languages:
9061
9062 @table @code
9063 @item @@
9064 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9065 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9066
9067 @item ::
9068 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9069 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9070
9071 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9072 @cindex type casting memory
9073 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9074 @cindex casts, to view memory
9075 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9076 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9077 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9078 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9079 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9080 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9081 @end table
9082
9083 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9084 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9085 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9086
9087 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9088 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9089 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9090 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9091 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9092 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9093 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9094
9095 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9096 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9097 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9098 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9099 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9100 as well.
9101
9102 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9103 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9104 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9105 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9106 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9107 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9108 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9109 choices.
9110
9111 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9112 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9113 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9114
9115 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9116 @smallexample
9117 @group
9118 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9119 [0] cancel
9120 [1] all
9121 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9122 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9123 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9124 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9125 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9126 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9127 > 2 4 6
9128 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9129 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9130 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9131 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9132 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9133 breakpoints.
9134 (@value{GDBP})
9135 @end group
9136 @end smallexample
9137
9138 @table @code
9139 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9140 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9141 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9142
9143 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9144 is ambiguous.
9145
9146 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9147 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9148 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9149 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9150 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9151 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9152 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9153 in the use of the menu.
9154
9155 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9156 when an ambiguity is detected.
9157
9158 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9159 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9160
9161 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9162 @item show multiple-symbols
9163 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9164 @end table
9165
9166 @node Variables
9167 @section Program Variables
9168
9169 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9170 in your program.
9171
9172 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9173 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9174
9175 @itemize @bullet
9176 @item
9177 global (or file-static)
9178 @end itemize
9179
9180 @noindent or
9181
9182 @itemize @bullet
9183 @item
9184 visible according to the scope rules of the
9185 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9186 @end itemize
9187
9188 @noindent This means that in the function
9189
9190 @smallexample
9191 foo (a)
9192 int a;
9193 @{
9194 bar (a);
9195 @{
9196 int b = test ();
9197 bar (b);
9198 @}
9199 @}
9200 @end smallexample
9201
9202 @noindent
9203 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9204 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9205 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9206 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9207
9208 @cindex variable name conflict
9209 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9210 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9211 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9212 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9213 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9214 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9215 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9216
9217 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9218 @ifnotinfo
9219 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9220 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9221 @end ifnotinfo
9222 @smallexample
9223 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9224 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9225 @end smallexample
9226
9227 @noindent
9228 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9229 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9230 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9231 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9232
9233 @smallexample
9234 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9235 @end smallexample
9236
9237 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9238 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9239 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9240 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9241 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9242
9243 @smallexample
9244 void
9245 foo (int a)
9246 @{
9247 if (a < 10)
9248 bar (a);
9249 else
9250 process (a); /* Stop here */
9251 @}
9252
9253 int
9254 bar (int a)
9255 @{
9256 foo (a + 5);
9257 @}
9258 @end smallexample
9259
9260 @noindent
9261 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9262 here is what you might see
9263 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9264
9265 @smallexample
9266 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9267 $1 = 10
9268 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9269 $2 = 5
9270 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9271 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9272 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9273 $3 = 5
9274 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9275 $4 = 0
9276 @end smallexample
9277
9278 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9279 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9280 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9281 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9282 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9283
9284 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9285 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9286 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9287 @code{some_global}.
9288
9289 @smallexample
9290 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9291 $1 = 23
9292 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9293 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9294 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9295 $2 = 27
9296 @end smallexample
9297
9298 @cindex wrong values
9299 @cindex variable values, wrong
9300 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9301 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9302 @quotation
9303 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9304 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9305 scope, and just before exit.
9306 @end quotation
9307 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9308 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9309 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9310 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9311 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9312 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9313 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9314 variable definitions may be gone.
9315
9316 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9317 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9318 when compiling.
9319
9320 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9321 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9322 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9323 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9324 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9325 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9326 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9327
9328 @smallexample
9329 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9330 @end smallexample
9331
9332 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9333 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9334 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9335 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9336 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9337
9338 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9339 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9340 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9341 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9342
9343 @cindex no debug info variables
9344 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9345 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9346 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9347 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9348 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9349 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9350 example, in a C program:
9351
9352 @smallexample
9353 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9354 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9355 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9356 $1 = 3.14
9357 @end smallexample
9358
9359 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9360 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9361 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9362 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9363 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9364
9365 @smallexample
9366 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9367 29 i++;
9368 (gdb) next
9369 30 e (i);
9370 (gdb) print i
9371 $1 = 31
9372 (gdb) print i@@entry
9373 $2 = 30
9374 @end smallexample
9375
9376 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9377 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9378 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9379 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9380 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9381 For program code
9382
9383 @smallexample
9384 char var0[] = "A";
9385 signed char var1[] = "A";
9386 @end smallexample
9387
9388 You get during debugging
9389 @smallexample
9390 (gdb) print var0
9391 $1 = "A"
9392 (gdb) print var1
9393 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9394 @end smallexample
9395
9396 @node Arrays
9397 @section Artificial Arrays
9398
9399 @cindex artificial array
9400 @cindex arrays
9401 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9402 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9403 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9404 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9405 program.
9406
9407 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9408 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9409 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9410 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9411 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9412 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9413 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9414 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9415 example. If a program says
9416
9417 @smallexample
9418 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 @noindent
9422 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9423
9424 @smallexample
9425 p *array@@len
9426 @end smallexample
9427
9428 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9429 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9430 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9431 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9432 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9433
9434 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9435 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9436 The value need not be in memory:
9437 @smallexample
9438 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9439 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9443 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9444 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9445 @smallexample
9446 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9447 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9448 @end smallexample
9449
9450 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9451 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9452 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9453 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9454 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9455 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9456 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9457 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9458 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9459 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9460
9461 @smallexample
9462 set $i = 0
9463 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9464 @key{RET}
9465 @key{RET}
9466 @dots{}
9467 @end smallexample
9468
9469 @node Output Formats
9470 @section Output Formats
9471
9472 @cindex formatted output
9473 @cindex output formats
9474 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9475 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9476 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9477 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9478 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9479
9480 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9481 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9482 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9483 letters supported are:
9484
9485 @table @code
9486 @item x
9487 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9488 hexadecimal.
9489
9490 @item d
9491 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9492
9493 @item u
9494 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9495
9496 @item o
9497 Print as integer in octal.
9498
9499 @item t
9500 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9501 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9502 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9503 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9504
9505 @item a
9506 @cindex unknown address, locating
9507 @cindex locate address
9508 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9509 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9510 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9511
9512 @smallexample
9513 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9514 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9515 @end smallexample
9516
9517 @noindent
9518 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9519 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9520
9521 @item c
9522 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9523 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9524 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9525 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9526
9527 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9528 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9529 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9530 data.
9531
9532 @item f
9533 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9534 using typical floating point syntax.
9535
9536 @item s
9537 @cindex printing strings
9538 @cindex printing byte arrays
9539 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9540 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9541 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9542 natural types.
9543
9544 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9545 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9546 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9547 array.
9548
9549 @item z
9550 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9551 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9552 to the size of the integer type.
9553
9554 @item r
9555 @cindex raw printing
9556 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9557 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9558 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9559 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9560 pretty-printer which might exist.
9561 @end table
9562
9563 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 p/x $pc
9567 @end smallexample
9568
9569 @noindent
9570 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9571 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9572
9573 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9574 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9575 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9576
9577 @node Memory
9578 @section Examining Memory
9579
9580 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9581 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9582
9583 @cindex examining memory
9584 @table @code
9585 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9586 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9587 @itemx x @var{addr}
9588 @itemx x
9589 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9590 @end table
9591
9592 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9593 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9594 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9595 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9596 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9597
9598 @table @r
9599 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9600 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9601 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9602 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9603 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9604 @c 4.1.2.
9605
9606 @item @var{f}, the display format
9607 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9608 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9609 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9610 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9611 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9612
9613 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9614 The unit size is any of
9615
9616 @table @code
9617 @item b
9618 Bytes.
9619 @item h
9620 Halfwords (two bytes).
9621 @item w
9622 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9623 @item g
9624 Giant words (eight bytes).
9625 @end table
9626
9627 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9628 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9629 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9630 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9631 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9632 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9633 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9634 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9635 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9636 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9637 be altered.
9638
9639 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9640 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9641 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9642 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9643 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9644 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9645 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9646 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9647 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9648 a value from memory).
9649 @end table
9650
9651 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9652 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9653 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9654 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9655 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9656
9657 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9658 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9659 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9660
9661 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9662 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9663 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9664 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9665 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9666
9667 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9668 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9669 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9670 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9671 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9672 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9673 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9674 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9675 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9676
9677 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9678 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9679 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9680 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9681 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9682 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9683
9684 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9685 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9686 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9687 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9688 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9689 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9690 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9691
9692 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9693 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9694
9695 @smallexample
9696 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9697 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9698 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9699 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9700 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9701 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9702 @end smallexample
9703
9704 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9705 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9706 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9707 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9708 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9709 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9710 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9711 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9712 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9713
9714 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9715 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9716 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9717
9718 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9719 @cindex addressable memory unit
9720 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9721 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9722 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9723 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9724 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9725 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9726 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9727 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9728 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9729
9730 @cindex remote memory comparison
9731 @cindex target memory comparison
9732 @cindex verify remote memory image
9733 @cindex verify target memory image
9734 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9735 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9736 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9737 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9738 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9739 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9740
9741 @table @code
9742 @kindex compare-sections
9743 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9744 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9745 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9746 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9747 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9748 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9749
9750 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9751 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9752 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9753 @end table
9754
9755 @node Auto Display
9756 @section Automatic Display
9757 @cindex automatic display
9758 @cindex display of expressions
9759
9760 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9761 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9762 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9763 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9764 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9765 The automatic display looks like this:
9766
9767 @smallexample
9768 2: foo = 38
9769 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9770 @end smallexample
9771
9772 @noindent
9773 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9774 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9775 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9776 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9777 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9778 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9779
9780 @table @code
9781 @kindex display
9782 @item display @var{expr}
9783 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9784 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9785
9786 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9787
9788 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9789 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9790 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9791 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9792 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9793
9794 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9795 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9796 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9797 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9798 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9799 @end table
9800
9801 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9802 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9803 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9804
9805 @table @code
9806 @kindex delete display
9807 @kindex undisplay
9808 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9809 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9810 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9811 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9812 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9813 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9814 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9815
9816 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9817 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9818
9819 @kindex disable display
9820 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9821 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9822 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9823 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9824 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9825 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9826 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9827 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9828
9829 @kindex enable display
9830 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9831 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9832 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9833 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9834 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9835 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9836 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9837
9838 @item display
9839 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9840 done when your program stops.
9841
9842 @kindex info display
9843 @item info display
9844 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9845 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9846 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9847 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9848 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9849 @end table
9850
9851 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9852 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9853 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9854 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9855 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9856 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9857 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9858 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9859 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9860 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9861 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9862
9863 @node Print Settings
9864 @section Print Settings
9865
9866 @cindex format options
9867 @cindex print settings
9868 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9869 and symbols are printed.
9870
9871 @noindent
9872 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9873
9874 @table @code
9875 @kindex set print
9876 @item set print address
9877 @itemx set print address on
9878 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9879 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9880 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9881 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9882 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9883 @code{set print address on}:
9884
9885 @smallexample
9886 @group
9887 (@value{GDBP}) f
9888 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9889 at input.c:530
9890 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9891 @end group
9892 @end smallexample
9893
9894 @item set print address off
9895 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9896 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9897
9898 @smallexample
9899 @group
9900 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9901 (@value{GDBP}) f
9902 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9903 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9904 @end group
9905 @end smallexample
9906
9907 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9908 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9909 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9910 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9911
9912 @kindex show print
9913 @item show print address
9914 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9915 @end table
9916
9917 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9918 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9919 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9920 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9921 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9922 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9923 it prints a symbolic address:
9924
9925 @table @code
9926 @item set print symbol-filename on
9927 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9928 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9929 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9930 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9931
9932 @item set print symbol-filename off
9933 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9934 default.
9935
9936 @item show print symbol-filename
9937 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9938 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9939 @end table
9940
9941 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9942 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9943 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9944
9945 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9946 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9947
9948 @table @code
9949 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9950 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9951 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9952 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9953 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9954 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9955 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9956 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9957
9958 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9959 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9960 symbolic address.
9961 @end table
9962
9963 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9964 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9965 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9966 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9967 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9968 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9969 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9970 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9974 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9975 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9976 @end smallexample
9977
9978 @quotation
9979 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9980 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9981 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9982 @end quotation
9983
9984 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9985 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9986
9987 @table @code
9988 @item set print symbol on
9989 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9990 one exists.
9991
9992 @item set print symbol off
9993 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9994 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9995 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9996
9997 @item show print symbol
9998 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9999 address.
10000 @end table
10001
10002 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10003
10004 @table @code
10005 @item set print array
10006 @itemx set print array on
10007 @cindex pretty print arrays
10008 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10009 but uses more space. The default is off.
10010
10011 @item set print array off
10012 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10013
10014 @item show print array
10015 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10016 arrays.
10017
10018 @cindex print array indexes
10019 @item set print array-indexes
10020 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10021 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10022 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10023 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10024
10025 @item set print array-indexes off
10026 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10027
10028 @item show print array-indexes
10029 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10030 arrays.
10031
10032 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10033 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10034 @cindex number of array elements to print
10035 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10036 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10037 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10038 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10039 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10040 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10041 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10042 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10043
10044 @item show print elements
10045 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10046 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10047
10048 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10049 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10050 @cindex printing frame argument values
10051 @cindex print all frame argument values
10052 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10053 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10054 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10055 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10056 values are:
10057
10058 @table @code
10059 @item all
10060 The values of all arguments are printed.
10061
10062 @item scalars
10063 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10064 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10065 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10066 only scalar arguments are shown:
10067
10068 @smallexample
10069 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10070 at frame-args.c:23
10071 @end smallexample
10072
10073 @item none
10074 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10075 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10079 at frame-args.c:23
10080 @end smallexample
10081 @end table
10082
10083 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10084 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10085 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10086 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10087 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10088 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10089 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10090 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10091 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10092 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10093
10094 @item show print frame-arguments
10095 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10096
10097 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10098 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10099
10100 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10101 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10102 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10103 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10104 This is the default.
10105
10106 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10107 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10108
10109 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10110 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10111 @kindex set print entry-values
10112 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10113 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10114 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10115 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10116 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10117
10118 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10119 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10120 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10121 @code{no} setting.
10122
10123 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10124 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10125 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10126 this information.
10127
10128 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10129
10130 @table @code
10131 @item no
10132 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10133 point.
10134 @smallexample
10135 #0 equal (val=5)
10136 #0 different (val=6)
10137 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10138 #0 born (val=10)
10139 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10140 @end smallexample
10141
10142 @item only
10143 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10144 values are never printed.
10145 @smallexample
10146 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10147 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10148 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10149 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10150 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10151 @end smallexample
10152
10153 @item preferred
10154 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10155 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10156 value for such parameter.
10157 @smallexample
10158 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10159 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10160 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10161 #0 born (val=10)
10162 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10163 @end smallexample
10164
10165 @item if-needed
10166 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10167 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10168 parameter.
10169 @smallexample
10170 #0 equal (val=5)
10171 #0 different (val=6)
10172 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10173 #0 born (val=10)
10174 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10175 @end smallexample
10176
10177 @item both
10178 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10179 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10180 optimizations.
10181 @smallexample
10182 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10183 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10184 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10185 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10186 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10187 @end smallexample
10188
10189 @item compact
10190 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10191 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10192 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10193 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10194 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10195 @smallexample
10196 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10197 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10198 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10199 #0 born (val=10)
10200 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10201 @end smallexample
10202
10203 @item default
10204 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10205 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10206 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10207 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10208 @smallexample
10209 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10210 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10211 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10212 #0 born (val=10)
10213 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10214 @end smallexample
10215 @end table
10216
10217 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10218 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10219
10220 @item show print entry-values
10221 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10222 entry.
10223
10224 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10225 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10226 @cindex repeated array elements
10227 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10228 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10229 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10230 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10231 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10232 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10233 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10234 is 10.
10235
10236 @item show print repeats
10237 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10238 elements.
10239
10240 @item set print null-stop
10241 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10242 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10243 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10244 contain only short strings.
10245 The default is off.
10246
10247 @item show print null-stop
10248 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10249 @sc{null} character.
10250
10251 @item set print pretty on
10252 @cindex print structures in indented form
10253 @cindex indentation in structure display
10254 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10255 per line, like this:
10256
10257 @smallexample
10258 @group
10259 $1 = @{
10260 next = 0x0,
10261 flags = @{
10262 sweet = 1,
10263 sour = 1
10264 @},
10265 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10266 @}
10267 @end group
10268 @end smallexample
10269
10270 @item set print pretty off
10271 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10272
10273 @smallexample
10274 @group
10275 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10276 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10277 @end group
10278 @end smallexample
10279
10280 @noindent
10281 This is the default format.
10282
10283 @item show print pretty
10284 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10285
10286 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10287 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10288 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10289 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10290 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10291 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10292 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10293 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10294
10295 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10296 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10297 international character sets, and is the default.
10298
10299 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10300 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10301
10302 @item set print union on
10303 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10304 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10305 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10306
10307 @item set print union off
10308 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10309 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10310 instead.
10311
10312 @item show print union
10313 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10314 structures and other unions.
10315
10316 For example, given the declarations
10317
10318 @smallexample
10319 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10320 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10321 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10322 Bug_forms;
10323
10324 struct thing @{
10325 Species it;
10326 union @{
10327 Tree_forms tree;
10328 Bug_forms bug;
10329 @} form;
10330 @};
10331
10332 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10333 @end smallexample
10334
10335 @noindent
10336 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10337
10338 @smallexample
10339 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10340 @end smallexample
10341
10342 @noindent
10343 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10344
10345 @smallexample
10346 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10347 @end smallexample
10348
10349 @noindent
10350 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10351 and in Pascal.
10352 @end table
10353
10354 @need 1000
10355 @noindent
10356 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10357
10358 @table @code
10359 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10360 @item set print demangle
10361 @itemx set print demangle on
10362 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10363 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10364 linkage. The default is on.
10365
10366 @item show print demangle
10367 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10368
10369 @item set print asm-demangle
10370 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10371 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10372 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10373 The default is off.
10374
10375 @item show print asm-demangle
10376 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10377 or demangled form.
10378
10379 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10380 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10381 @kindex set demangle-style
10382 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10383 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10384 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10385
10386 @table @code
10387 @item auto
10388 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10389 This is the default.
10390
10391 @item gnu
10392 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10393
10394 @item hp
10395 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10396
10397 @item lucid
10398 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10399
10400 @item arm
10401 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10402 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10403 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10404 require further enhancement to permit that.
10405
10406 @end table
10407 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10408
10409 @item show demangle-style
10410 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10411
10412 @item set print object
10413 @itemx set print object on
10414 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10415 @cindex display derived types
10416 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10417 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10418 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10419 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10420 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10421 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10422 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10423
10424 @item set print object off
10425 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10426 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10427
10428 @item show print object
10429 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10430
10431 @item set print static-members
10432 @itemx set print static-members on
10433 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10434 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10435
10436 @item set print static-members off
10437 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10438
10439 @item show print static-members
10440 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10441
10442 @item set print pascal_static-members
10443 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10444 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10445 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10446 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10447
10448 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10449 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10450
10451 @item show print pascal_static-members
10452 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10453
10454 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10455 @item set print vtbl
10456 @itemx set print vtbl on
10457 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10458 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10459 @cindex VTBL display
10460 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10461 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10462 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10463
10464 @item set print vtbl off
10465 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10466
10467 @item show print vtbl
10468 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10469 @end table
10470
10471 @node Pretty Printing
10472 @section Pretty Printing
10473
10474 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10475 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10476 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10477
10478 @menu
10479 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10480 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10481 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10482 @end menu
10483
10484 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10485 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10486
10487 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10488 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10489 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10490
10491 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10492 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10493 pretty-printers with their names.
10494 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10495 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10496 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10497 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10498
10499 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10500 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10501 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10502 do anything special.
10503
10504 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10505
10506 @itemize @bullet
10507 @item
10508 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10509 all inferiors.
10510
10511 @item
10512 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10513 when debugging that program.
10514 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10515
10516 @item
10517 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10518 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10519 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10520 @end itemize
10521
10522 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10523 pretty-printers are selected,
10524
10525 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10526 for new types.
10527
10528 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10529 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10530
10531 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10532
10533 @smallexample
10534 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10535 $1 = @{
10536 static npos = 4294967295,
10537 _M_dataplus = @{
10538 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10539 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10540 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10541 @},
10542 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10543 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10544 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10545 @}
10546 @}
10547 @end smallexample
10548
10549 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10550
10551 @smallexample
10552 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10553 $2 = "abcd"
10554 @end smallexample
10555
10556 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10557 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10558 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10559
10560 @table @code
10561 @kindex info pretty-printer
10562 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10563 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10564 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10565
10566 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10567 whose pretty-printers to list.
10568 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10569 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10570 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10571 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10572 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10573
10574 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10575 to list.
10576
10577 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10578 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10579 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10580 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10581
10582 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10583 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10584 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10585 @end table
10586
10587 Example:
10588
10589 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10590 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10591 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10592 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10593
10594 @smallexample
10595 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10596 library1.so:
10597 foo
10598 library2.so:
10599 bar
10600 bar1
10601 bar2
10602 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10603 library2.so:
10604 bar
10605 bar1
10606 bar2
10607 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10608 1 printer disabled
10609 2 of 3 printers enabled
10610 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10611 library1.so:
10612 foo [disabled]
10613 library2.so:
10614 bar
10615 bar1
10616 bar2
10617 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10618 1 printer disabled
10619 1 of 3 printers enabled
10620 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10621 library1.so:
10622 foo [disabled]
10623 library2.so:
10624 bar
10625 bar1 [disabled]
10626 bar2
10627 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10628 1 printer disabled
10629 0 of 3 printers enabled
10630 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10631 library1.so:
10632 foo [disabled]
10633 library2.so:
10634 bar [disabled]
10635 bar1 [disabled]
10636 bar2
10637 @end smallexample
10638
10639 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10640 as can each individual subprinter.
10641
10642 @node Value History
10643 @section Value History
10644
10645 @cindex value history
10646 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10647 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10648 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10649 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10650 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10651 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10652 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10653 symbol table.
10654
10655 @cindex @code{$}
10656 @cindex @code{$$}
10657 @cindex history number
10658 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10659 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10660 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10661 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10662 history number.
10663
10664 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10665 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10666 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10667 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10668 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10669 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10670 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10671
10672 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10673 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10674
10675 @smallexample
10676 p *$
10677 @end smallexample
10678
10679 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10680 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10681
10682 @smallexample
10683 p *$.next
10684 @end smallexample
10685
10686 @noindent
10687 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10688 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10689
10690 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10691 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10692
10693 @smallexample
10694 print x
10695 set x=5
10696 @end smallexample
10697
10698 @noindent
10699 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10700 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10701
10702 @table @code
10703 @kindex show values
10704 @item show values
10705 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10706 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10707 values} does not change the history.
10708
10709 @item show values @var{n}
10710 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10711
10712 @item show values +
10713 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10714 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10715 @end table
10716
10717 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10718 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10719
10720 @node Convenience Vars
10721 @section Convenience Variables
10722
10723 @cindex convenience variables
10724 @cindex user-defined variables
10725 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10726 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10727 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10728 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10729 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10730
10731 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10732 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10733 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10734 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10735 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10736
10737 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10738 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10739 For example:
10740
10741 @smallexample
10742 set $foo = *object_ptr
10743 @end smallexample
10744
10745 @noindent
10746 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10747 @code{object_ptr}.
10748
10749 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10750 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10751 value with another assignment at any time.
10752
10753 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10754 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10755 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10756 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10757
10758 @table @code
10759 @kindex show convenience
10760 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10761 @item show convenience
10762 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10763 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10764 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10765
10766 @kindex init-if-undefined
10767 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10768 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10769 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10770 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10771 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10772 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10773 override default values used in a command script.
10774
10775 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10776 any side-effects do not occur.
10777 @end table
10778
10779 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10780 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10781 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10782
10783 @smallexample
10784 set $i = 0
10785 print bar[$i++]->contents
10786 @end smallexample
10787
10788 @noindent
10789 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10790
10791 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10792 values likely to be useful.
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10796 @item $_
10797 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10798 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10799 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10800 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10801 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10802 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10803 to the type of @code{$__}.
10804
10805 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10806 @item $__
10807 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10808 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10809 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10810
10811 @item $_exitcode
10812 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10813 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10814 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10815 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10816
10817 @item $_exitsignal
10818 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10819 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10820 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10821 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10822
10823 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10824 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10825 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10826 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10827 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10828
10829 @smallexample
10830 #include <signal.h>
10831
10832 int
10833 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10834 @{
10835 raise (SIGALRM);
10836 return 0;
10837 @}
10838 @end smallexample
10839
10840 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10841 or signalled would be:
10842
10843 @smallexample
10844 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10845 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10846 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10847 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10848 >echo The program has exited\n
10849 >else
10850 >echo The program has signalled\n
10851 >end
10852 >end
10853 (@value{GDBP}) run
10854 Starting program:
10855
10856 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10857 The program no longer exists.
10858 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10859 The program has signalled
10860 @end smallexample
10861
10862 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10863 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10864 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10865 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10866
10867 @smallexample
10868 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10869 The program has exited
10870 @end smallexample
10871
10872 @item $_exception
10873 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10874 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10875
10876 @item $_probe_argc
10877 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10878 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10879
10880 @item $_sdata
10881 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10882 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10883 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10884 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10885 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10886
10887 @item $_siginfo
10888 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10889 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10890 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10891 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10892 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10893
10894 @item $_tlb
10895 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10896 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10897 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10898 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10899 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10900 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10901
10902 @item $_inferior
10903 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10904 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10905
10906 @item $_thread
10907 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10908
10909 @item $_gthread
10910 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10911
10912 @end table
10913
10914 @node Convenience Funs
10915 @section Convenience Functions
10916
10917 @cindex convenience functions
10918 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10919 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10920 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10921 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10922 @value{GDBN}.
10923
10924 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10925 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10926
10927 @table @code
10928
10929 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10930 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10931 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10932 returns zero.
10933
10934 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10935 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10936 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10937 it is @code{void}:
10938
10939 @smallexample
10940 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10941 $1 = void
10942 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10943 $2 = 1
10944 (@value{GDBP}) run
10945 Starting program: ./a.out
10946 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10947 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10948 $3 = 0
10949 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10950 $4 = 0
10951 @end smallexample
10952
10953 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10954 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10955 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10956 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10957 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10958 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10959 anymore.
10960
10961 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10962 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10963
10964 @smallexample
10965 void
10966 foo (void)
10967 @{
10968 @}
10969 @end smallexample
10970
10971 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10972
10973 @smallexample
10974 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10975 $1 = void
10976 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10977 $2 = 1
10978 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10979 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10980 $3 = void
10981 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10982 $4 = 1
10983 @end smallexample
10984
10985 @end table
10986
10987 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10988 @code{Python} support.
10989
10990 @table @code
10991
10992 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10993 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10994 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10995 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10996 Otherwise it returns zero.
10997
10998 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10999 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11000 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11001 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11002 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11003 regular expression support.
11004
11005 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11006 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11007 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11008 Otherwise it returns zero.
11009
11010 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11011 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11012 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11013
11014 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11015 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11016 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11017 Otherwise it returns zero.
11018
11019 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11020 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11021 The default is 1.
11022
11023 Example:
11024
11025 @smallexample
11026 (gdb) backtrace
11027 #0 bottom_func ()
11028 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11029 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11030 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11031 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11032 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11033 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11034 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11035 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11036 $1 = 1
11037 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11038 $1 = 1
11039 @end smallexample
11040
11041 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11042 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11043 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11044 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11045
11046 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11047 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11048 The default is 1.
11049
11050 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11051 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11052 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11053 Otherwise it returns zero.
11054
11055 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11056 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11057 The default is 1.
11058
11059 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11060 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11061 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11062 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11063
11064 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11065 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11066 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11067 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11068
11069 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11070 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11071 The default is 1.
11072
11073 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11074 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11075 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11076 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11077
11078 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11079 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11080 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11081
11082 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11083 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11084 an enumerated type:
11085
11086 @smallexample
11087 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11088 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11089 @end smallexample
11090
11091 @end table
11092
11093 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11094 convenience functions.
11095
11096 @table @code
11097 @item help function
11098 @kindex help function
11099 @cindex show all convenience functions
11100 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11101 @end table
11102
11103 @node Registers
11104 @section Registers
11105
11106 @cindex registers
11107 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11108 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11109 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11110 your machine.
11111
11112 @table @code
11113 @kindex info registers
11114 @item info registers
11115 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11116 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11117
11118 @kindex info all-registers
11119 @cindex floating point registers
11120 @item info all-registers
11121 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11122 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11123
11124 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11125 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11126 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11127 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11128
11129 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11130 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11131 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11132 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11133 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11134 @end table
11135
11136 @anchor{standard registers}
11137 @cindex stack pointer register
11138 @cindex program counter register
11139 @cindex process status register
11140 @cindex frame pointer register
11141 @cindex standard registers
11142 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11143 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11144 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11145 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11146 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11147 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11148 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11149 you could print the program counter in hex with
11150
11151 @smallexample
11152 p/x $pc
11153 @end smallexample
11154
11155 @noindent
11156 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11157
11158 @smallexample
11159 x/i $pc
11160 @end smallexample
11161
11162 @noindent
11163 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11164 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11165 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11166 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11167 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11168 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11169 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11170
11171 @smallexample
11172 set $sp += 4
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11176 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11177 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11178 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11179 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11180 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11181 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11182
11183 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11184 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11185 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11186 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11187 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11188 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11189 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11190
11191 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11192 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11193 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11194 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11195 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11196 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11197 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11198 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11199 prints the data in both formats.
11200
11201 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11202 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11203 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11204 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11205 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11206 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11207 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11208
11209 @smallexample
11210 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11211 $1 = @{
11212 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11213 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11214 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11215 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11216 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11217 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11218 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11219 @}
11220 @end smallexample
11221
11222 @noindent
11223 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11224 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11225 value to a @code{struct} member:
11226
11227 @smallexample
11228 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11229 @end smallexample
11230
11231 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11232 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11233 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11234 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11235 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11236 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11237
11238 @cindex caller-saved registers
11239 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11240 @cindex volatile registers
11241 @cindex <not saved> values
11242 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11243 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11244 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11245 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11246 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11247 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11248 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11249 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11250 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11251 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11252 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11253 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11254 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11255 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11256 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11257 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11258 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11259 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11260 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11261 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11262 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11263 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11264 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11265
11266 @node Floating Point Hardware
11267 @section Floating Point Hardware
11268 @cindex floating point
11269
11270 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11271 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11272
11273 @table @code
11274 @kindex info float
11275 @item info float
11276 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11277 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11278 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11279 the ARM and x86 machines.
11280 @end table
11281
11282 @node Vector Unit
11283 @section Vector Unit
11284 @cindex vector unit
11285
11286 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11287 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11288
11289 @table @code
11290 @kindex info vector
11291 @item info vector
11292 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11293 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11294 @end table
11295
11296 @node OS Information
11297 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11298 @cindex OS information
11299
11300 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11301 you debug your program.
11302
11303 @cindex auxiliary vector
11304 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11305 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11306 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11307 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11308 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11309 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11310 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11311 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11312 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11313 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11314 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11315 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11316
11317 @table @code
11318 @kindex info auxv
11319 @item info auxv
11320 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11321 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11322 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11323 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11324 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11325 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11326 an unrecognized tag.
11327 @end table
11328
11329 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11330 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11331 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11332 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11333 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11334 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11335 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11336
11337 @table @code
11338 @kindex info os
11339 @item info os @var{infotype}
11340
11341 Display OS information of the requested type.
11342
11343 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11344
11345 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11346 @table @code
11347 @kindex info os cpus
11348 @item cpus
11349 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11350 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11351 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11352 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11353 kernel initialization.
11354
11355 @kindex info os files
11356 @item files
11357 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11358 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11359 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11360 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11361
11362 @kindex info os modules
11363 @item modules
11364 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11365 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11366 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11367 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11368 in memory.
11369
11370 @kindex info os msg
11371 @item msg
11372 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11373 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11374 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11375 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11376 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11377 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11378 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11379 the message queue was last changed.
11380
11381 @kindex info os processes
11382 @item processes
11383 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11384 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11385 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11386 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11387 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11388 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11389
11390 @kindex info os procgroups
11391 @item procgroups
11392 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11393 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11394 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11395 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11396 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11397 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11398 and the process group leader is listed first.
11399
11400 @kindex info os semaphores
11401 @item semaphores
11402 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11403 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11404 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11405 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11406 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11407
11408 @kindex info os shm
11409 @item shm
11410 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11411 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11412 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11413 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11414 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11415 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11416 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11417
11418 @kindex info os sockets
11419 @item sockets
11420 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11421 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11422 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11423 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11424 connection.
11425
11426 @kindex info os threads
11427 @item threads
11428 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11429 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11430 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11431 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11432 process is not listed.
11433 @end table
11434
11435 @item info os
11436 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11437 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11438 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11439 types, this command will report an error.
11440 @end table
11441
11442 @node Memory Region Attributes
11443 @section Memory Region Attributes
11444 @cindex memory region attributes
11445
11446 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11447 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11448 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11449 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11450 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11451 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11452 user can override the fetched regions.
11453
11454 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11455 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11456 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11457 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11458 all memory.
11459
11460 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11461 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11462
11463 @table @code
11464 @kindex mem
11465 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11466 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11467 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11468 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11469 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11470 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11471
11472 @item mem auto
11473 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11474 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11475
11476 @kindex delete mem
11477 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11478 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11479 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11480
11481 @kindex disable mem
11482 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11483 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11484 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11485 It may be enabled again later.
11486
11487 @kindex enable mem
11488 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11489 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11490
11491 @kindex info mem
11492 @item info mem
11493 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11494 for each region:
11495
11496 @table @emph
11497 @item Memory Region Number
11498 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11499 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11500 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11501
11502 @item Lo Address
11503 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11504
11505 @item Hi Address
11506 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11507
11508 @item Attributes
11509 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11510 @end table
11511 @end table
11512
11513
11514 @subsection Attributes
11515
11516 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11517 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11518 write accesses to a memory region.
11519
11520 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11521 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11522 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11523
11524 @table @code
11525 @item ro
11526 Memory is read only.
11527 @item wo
11528 Memory is write only.
11529 @item rw
11530 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11531 @end table
11532
11533 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11534 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11535 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11536 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11537 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11538
11539 @table @code
11540 @item 8
11541 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11542 @item 16
11543 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11544 @item 32
11545 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11546 @item 64
11547 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11548 @end table
11549
11550 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11551 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11552 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11553 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11554 @c
11555 @c @table @code
11556 @c @item hwbreak
11557 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11558 @c @item swbreak (default)
11559 @c @end table
11560
11561 @subsubsection Data Cache
11562 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11563 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11564 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11565 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11566 registers.
11567
11568 @table @code
11569 @item cache
11570 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11571 @item nocache
11572 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11573 @end table
11574
11575 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11576 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11577 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11578 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11579 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11580
11581 @table @code
11582 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11583 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11584 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11585 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11586 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11587 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11588 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11589 The default value is @code{on}.
11590 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11591 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11592 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11593 @end table
11594
11595
11596 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11597 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11598 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11599 @c
11600 @c @table @code
11601 @c @item verify
11602 @c @item noverify (default)
11603 @c @end table
11604
11605 @node Dump/Restore Files
11606 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11607 @cindex dump/restore files
11608 @cindex append data to a file
11609 @cindex dump data to a file
11610 @cindex restore data from a file
11611
11612 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11613 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11614 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11615 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11616 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11617 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11618 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11619
11620 @table @code
11621
11622 @kindex dump
11623 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11624 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11625 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11626 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11627
11628 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11629 @table @code
11630 @item binary
11631 Raw binary form.
11632 @item ihex
11633 Intel hex format.
11634 @item srec
11635 Motorola S-record format.
11636 @item tekhex
11637 Tektronix Hex format.
11638 @item verilog
11639 Verilog Hex format.
11640 @end table
11641
11642 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11643 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11644 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11645 form.
11646
11647 @kindex append
11648 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11649 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11650 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11651 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11652 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11653
11654 @kindex restore
11655 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11656 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11657 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11658 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11659 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11660
11661 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11662 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11663 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11664 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11665 from that location.
11666
11667 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11668 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11669 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11670 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11671
11672 @end table
11673
11674 @node Core File Generation
11675 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11676 @cindex dump core from inferior
11677
11678 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11679 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11680 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11681 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11682 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11683 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11684 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11685
11686 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11687 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11688 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11689
11690 @table @code
11691 @kindex gcore
11692 @kindex generate-core-file
11693 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11694 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11695 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11696 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11697 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11698 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11699
11700 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11701 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11702
11703 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11704 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11705 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11706 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11707 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11708
11709 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11710 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11711 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11712 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11713 Enable or disable the use of the file
11714 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11715 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11716 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11717 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11718
11719 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11720 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11721 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11722 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11723 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11724 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11725 about the bits that can be set in the
11726 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11727 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11728
11729 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11730 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11731 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11732 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11733 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11734 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11735 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11736 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11737
11738 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11739 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11740 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11741 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11742 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11743 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11744 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11745
11746 The default value is @code{off}.
11747 @end table
11748
11749 @node Character Sets
11750 @section Character Sets
11751 @cindex character sets
11752 @cindex charset
11753 @cindex translating between character sets
11754 @cindex host character set
11755 @cindex target character set
11756
11757 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11758 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11759 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11760 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11761 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11762 @dfn{target character set}.
11763
11764 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11765 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11766 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11767 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11768 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11769 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11770 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11771 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11772 character and string literals in expressions.
11773
11774 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11775 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11776 target-charset} command, described below.
11777
11778 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11779 support:
11780
11781 @table @code
11782 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11783 @kindex set target-charset
11784 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11785 list of supported target character sets, type
11786 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11787
11788 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11789 @kindex set host-charset
11790 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11791
11792 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11793 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11794 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11795 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11796 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11797
11798 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11799 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11800 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11801
11802 @item set charset @var{charset}
11803 @kindex set charset
11804 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11805 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11806 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11807 for both host and target.
11808
11809 @item show charset
11810 @kindex show charset
11811 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11812
11813 @item show host-charset
11814 @kindex show host-charset
11815 Show the name of the current host character set.
11816
11817 @item show target-charset
11818 @kindex show target-charset
11819 Show the name of the current target character set.
11820
11821 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11822 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11823 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11824 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11825 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11826 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11827
11828 @item show target-wide-charset
11829 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11830 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11831 @end table
11832
11833 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11834 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11835 @file{charset-test.c}:
11836
11837 @smallexample
11838 #include <stdio.h>
11839
11840 char ascii_hello[]
11841 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11842 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11843 char ibm1047_hello[]
11844 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11845 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11846
11847 main ()
11848 @{
11849 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11850 @}
11851 @end smallexample
11852
11853 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11854 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11855 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11856
11857 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11858
11859 @smallexample
11860 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11861 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11862 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11863 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11864 @dots{}
11865 (@value{GDBP})
11866 @end smallexample
11867
11868 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11869 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11870 strings:
11871
11872 @smallexample
11873 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11874 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11875 (@value{GDBP})
11876 @end smallexample
11877
11878 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11879 initial character set:
11880 @smallexample
11881 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11882 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11883 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11884 (@value{GDBP})
11885 @end smallexample
11886
11887 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11888 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11889 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11890 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11891 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11892
11893 @smallexample
11894 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11895 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11896 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11897 $2 = 72 'H'
11898 (@value{GDBP})
11899 @end smallexample
11900
11901 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11902 literals you use in expressions:
11903
11904 @smallexample
11905 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11906 $3 = 43 '+'
11907 (@value{GDBP})
11908 @end smallexample
11909
11910 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11911 character.
11912
11913 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11914 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11915 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11916
11917 @smallexample
11918 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11919 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11920 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11921 $5 = 200 '\310'
11922 (@value{GDBP})
11923 @end smallexample
11924
11925 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11926 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11927
11928 @smallexample
11929 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11930 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11931 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11932 @end smallexample
11933
11934 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11935 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11936 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11937 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11938 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11939
11940 @smallexample
11941 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11942 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11943 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11944 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11945 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11946 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11947 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11948 $7 = 72 '\110'
11949 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11950 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11951 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11952 $9 = 200 'H'
11953 (@value{GDBP})
11954 @end smallexample
11955
11956 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11957 string literals you use in expressions:
11958
11959 @smallexample
11960 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11961 $10 = 78 '+'
11962 (@value{GDBP})
11963 @end smallexample
11964
11965 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11966 character.
11967
11968 @node Caching Target Data
11969 @section Caching Data of Targets
11970 @cindex caching data of targets
11971
11972 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11973 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11974 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11975 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11976 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11977 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11978 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11979 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11980 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11981 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11982 is executing.
11983 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11984 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11985 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11986 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11987 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11988 in the code segment.
11989 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11990 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11991
11992 @table @code
11993 @kindex set remotecache
11994 @item set remotecache on
11995 @itemx set remotecache off
11996 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11997 with old scripts.
11998
11999 @kindex show remotecache
12000 @item show remotecache
12001 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12002
12003 @kindex set stack-cache
12004 @item set stack-cache on
12005 @itemx set stack-cache off
12006 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12007 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12008
12009 @kindex show stack-cache
12010 @item show stack-cache
12011 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12012
12013 @kindex set code-cache
12014 @item set code-cache on
12015 @itemx set code-cache off
12016 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12017 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12018 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12019
12020 @kindex show code-cache
12021 @item show code-cache
12022 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12023 accesses.
12024
12025 @kindex info dcache
12026 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12027 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12028 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12029 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12030 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12031 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12032
12033 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12034 printed in hex.
12035
12036 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12037 @cindex dcache size
12038 @kindex set dcache size
12039 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12040
12041 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12042 @cindex dcache line-size
12043 @kindex set dcache line-size
12044 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12045 Must be a power of 2.
12046
12047 @item show dcache size
12048 @kindex show dcache size
12049 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12050
12051 @item show dcache line-size
12052 @kindex show dcache line-size
12053 Show default size of dcache lines.
12054
12055 @end table
12056
12057 @node Searching Memory
12058 @section Search Memory
12059 @cindex searching memory
12060
12061 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12062 @code{find} command.
12063
12064 @table @code
12065 @kindex find
12066 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12067 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12068 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12069 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12070 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12071 @end table
12072
12073 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12074 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12075
12076 @table @r
12077 @item @var{s}, search query size
12078 The size of each search query value.
12079
12080 @table @code
12081 @item b
12082 bytes
12083 @item h
12084 halfwords (two bytes)
12085 @item w
12086 words (four bytes)
12087 @item g
12088 giant words (eight bytes)
12089 @end table
12090
12091 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12092 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12093 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12094 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12095 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12096
12097 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12098 value's type in the current language.
12099 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12100 pattern as a mixture of types.
12101 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12102 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12103 which is typically four bytes.
12104
12105 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12106 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12107 @end table
12108
12109 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12110 (@code{"}).
12111 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12112 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12113
12114 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12115 number of matches found.
12116
12117 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12118 @samp{$_}.
12119 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12120
12121 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12122
12123 @smallexample
12124 void
12125 hello ()
12126 @{
12127 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12128 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12129 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12130 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12131 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12132 @}
12133 @end smallexample
12134
12135 @noindent
12136 you get during debugging:
12137
12138 @smallexample
12139 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12140 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12141 1 pattern found
12142 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12143 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12144 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12145 2 patterns found.
12146 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12147 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12148 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12149 2 patterns found.
12150 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12151 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12152 1 pattern found
12153 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12154 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12155 1 pattern found
12156 (gdb) print $numfound
12157 $1 = 1
12158 (gdb) print $_
12159 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12160 @end smallexample
12161
12162 @node Value Sizes
12163 @section Value Sizes
12164
12165 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12166 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12167 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12168 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12169 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12170
12171 @table @code
12172 @kindex set max-value-size
12173 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12174 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12175 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12176 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12177 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12178
12179 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12180 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12181
12182 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12183 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12184 currently 16 bytes.
12185
12186 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12187 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12188 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12189 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12190 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12191 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12192 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12193 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12194
12195 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12196
12197 @kindex show max-value-size
12198 @item show max-value-size
12199 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12200 allocate for the contents of a value.
12201 @end table
12202
12203 @node Optimized Code
12204 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12205 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12206 @cindex debugging optimized code
12207
12208 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12209 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12210 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12211 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12212 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12213 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12214 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12215
12216 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12217 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12218 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12219 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12220
12221 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12222 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12223 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12224 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12225 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12226 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12227
12228 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12229 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12230 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12231 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12232 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12233
12234 @menu
12235 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12236 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12237 @end menu
12238
12239 @node Inline Functions
12240 @section Inline Functions
12241 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12242
12243 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12244 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12245 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12246 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12247 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12248 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12249 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12250 @code{info frame} command.
12251
12252 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12253 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12254 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12255 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12256 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12257 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12258 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12259 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12260 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12261 local variables in the caller.
12262
12263 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12264 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12265 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12266 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12267 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12268 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12269 instructions are executed.
12270
12271 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12272 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12273 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12274 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12275
12276 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12277 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12278
12279 @itemize @bullet
12280 @item
12281 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12282 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12283 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12284 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12285 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12286 or inside the inlined function instead.
12287
12288 @item
12289 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12290 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12291 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12292 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12293
12294 @end itemize
12295
12296 @node Tail Call Frames
12297 @section Tail Call Frames
12298 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12299
12300 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12301 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12302 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12303 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12304 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12305
12306 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12307 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12308 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12309 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12310 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12311 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12312 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12313
12314 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12315 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12316 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12317 this information.
12318
12319 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12320 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12324 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12325 (gdb) info frame
12326 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12327 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12328 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12329 source language c++.
12330 Arglist at unknown address.
12331 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12332 @end smallexample
12333
12334 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12335 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12336 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12337 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12338 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12339 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12340
12341 @table @code
12342 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12343 @item set debug entry-values
12344 @kindex set debug entry-values
12345 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12346 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12347 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12348 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12349 result.
12350
12351 @item show debug entry-values
12352 @kindex show debug entry-values
12353 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12354 values at function entry and tail calls.
12355 @end table
12356
12357 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12358 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12359 reference by variable @code{x}):
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12363 void (*x) (void) = c;
12364 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12365 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12366 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12367
12368 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12369 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12370 a () at t.c:3
12371 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12372 (gdb) bt
12373 #0 a () at t.c:3
12374 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12375 @end smallexample
12376
12377 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12378
12379 @smallexample
12380 int i;
12381 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12382 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12383 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12384 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12385 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12386 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12387 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12388 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12389
12390 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12391 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12392 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12393 (gdb) bt
12394 #0 f () at t.c:2
12395 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12396 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12397 @end smallexample
12398
12399 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12400 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12401
12402 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12403 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12404 @set ARROW @click{}
12405 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12406 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12407 @end ifset
12408 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12409 @set ARROW ->
12410 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12411 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12412 @end ifclear
12413
12414 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12415 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12416 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12417
12418 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12419 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12420 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12421 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12422 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12423 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12424
12425 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12426 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12427 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12428 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12429 omitted.
12430
12431 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12432 entry may fail:
12433
12434 @smallexample
12435 int v;
12436 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12437 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12438 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12439 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12440 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12441 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12442
12443 (gdb) bt
12444 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12445 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12446 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12447 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12448 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12449 @end smallexample
12450
12451 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12452 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12453 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12454 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12455 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12456
12457 @node Macros
12458 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12459
12460 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12461 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12462 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12463 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12464 where it was defined.
12465
12466 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12467 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12468 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12469 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12470
12471 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12472 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12473 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12474 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12475 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12476 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12477 see @ref{List}.
12478
12479 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12480 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12481 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12482
12483 @table @code
12484
12485 @kindex macro expand
12486 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12487 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12488 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12489 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12490 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12491 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12492 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12493 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12494 it can be any string of tokens.
12495
12496 @kindex macro exp1
12497 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12498 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12499 @cindex expand macro once
12500 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12501 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12502 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12503 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12504 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12505 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12506 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12507 can be any string of tokens.
12508
12509 @kindex info macro
12510 @cindex macro definition, showing
12511 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12512 @cindex macros, from debug info
12513 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12514 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12515 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12516 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12517 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12518 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12519
12520 @kindex info macros
12521 @item info macros @var{location}
12522 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12523 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12524 command-line where those definitions were established.
12525
12526 @kindex macro define
12527 @cindex user-defined macros
12528 @cindex defining macros interactively
12529 @cindex macros, user-defined
12530 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12531 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12532 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12533 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12534 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12535 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12536 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12537 @var{arglist}.
12538
12539 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12540 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12541 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12542 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12543 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12544
12545 @kindex macro undef
12546 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12547 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12548 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12549 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12550 in the program being debugged.
12551
12552 @kindex macro list
12553 @item macro list
12554 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12555 @end table
12556
12557 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12558 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12559 show our source files:
12560
12561 @smallexample
12562 $ cat sample.c
12563 #include <stdio.h>
12564 #include "sample.h"
12565
12566 #define M 42
12567 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12568
12569 main ()
12570 @{
12571 #define N 28
12572 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12573 #undef N
12574 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12575 #define N 1729
12576 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12577 @}
12578 $ cat sample.h
12579 #define Q <
12580 $
12581 @end smallexample
12582
12583 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12584 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12585 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12586 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12587 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12588 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12589 information.
12590
12591 @smallexample
12592 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12593 $
12594 @end smallexample
12595
12596 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12597
12598 @smallexample
12599 $ gdb -nw sample
12600 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12601 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12602 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12603 (@value{GDBP})
12604 @end smallexample
12605
12606 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12607 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12608 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12609
12610 @smallexample
12611 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12612 3
12613 4 #define M 42
12614 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12615 6
12616 7 main ()
12617 8 @{
12618 9 #define N 28
12619 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12620 11 #undef N
12621 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12622 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12623 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12624 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12625 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12626 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12627 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12628 #define Q <
12629 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12630 expands to: (42 + 1)
12631 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12632 expands to: once (M + 1)
12633 (@value{GDBP})
12634 @end smallexample
12635
12636 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12637 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12638 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12639 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12640
12641 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12642 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12643
12644 @smallexample
12645 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12646 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12647 (@value{GDBP}) run
12648 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12649
12650 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12651 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12652 (@value{GDBP})
12653 @end smallexample
12654
12655 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12656
12657 @smallexample
12658 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12659 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12660 #define N 28
12661 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12662 expands to: 28 < 42
12663 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12664 $1 = 1
12665 (@value{GDBP})
12666 @end smallexample
12667
12668 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12669 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12670 thereof) in force at each point:
12671
12672 @smallexample
12673 (@value{GDBP}) next
12674 Hello, world!
12675 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12676 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12677 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12678 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12679 (@value{GDBP}) next
12680 We're so creative.
12681 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12682 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12683 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12684 #define N 1729
12685 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12686 expands to: 1729 < 42
12687 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12688 $2 = 0
12689 (@value{GDBP})
12690 @end smallexample
12691
12692 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12693 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12694 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12695 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12696
12697 @smallexample
12698 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12699 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12700 -D__STDC__=1
12701 (@value{GDBP})
12702 @end smallexample
12703
12704
12705 @node Tracepoints
12706 @chapter Tracepoints
12707 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12708 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12709
12710 @cindex tracepoints
12711 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12712 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12713 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12714 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12715 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12716 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12717 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12718
12719 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12720 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12721 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12722 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12723 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12724 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12725 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12726 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12727 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12728 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12729 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12730
12731 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12732 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12733 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12734 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12735 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12736 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12737 Packets}.
12738
12739 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12740 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12741 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12742
12743 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12744
12745 @menu
12746 * Set Tracepoints::
12747 * Analyze Collected Data::
12748 * Tracepoint Variables::
12749 * Trace Files::
12750 @end menu
12751
12752 @node Set Tracepoints
12753 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12754
12755 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12756 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12757 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12758 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12759 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12760 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12761 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12762
12763 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12764 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12765 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12766 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12767 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12768 tracepoint was hit.
12769
12770 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12771 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12772 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12773 either.
12774
12775 @cindex fast tracepoints
12776 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12777 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12778 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12779
12780 @cindex static tracepoints
12781 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12782 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12783 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12784 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12785 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12786 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12787 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12788 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12789 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12790 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12791 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12792 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12793 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12794 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12795 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12796 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12797 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12798 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12799 static tracepoint marker.
12800
12801 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12802 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12803
12804 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12805 conditions and actions.
12806
12807 @menu
12808 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12809 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12810 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12811 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12812 * Trace State Variables::
12813 * Tracepoint Actions::
12814 * Listing Tracepoints::
12815 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12816 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12817 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12818 @end menu
12819
12820 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12821 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12822
12823 @table @code
12824 @cindex set tracepoint
12825 @kindex trace
12826 @item trace @var{location}
12827 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12828 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12829 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12830 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12831 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12832 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12833 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12834 in tracing}).
12835 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12836 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12837 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12838 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12839 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12840 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12841 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12842 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12843 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12844 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12845 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12846 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12847
12848 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12849
12850 @smallexample
12851 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12852
12853 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12854
12855 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12856
12857 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12858
12859 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12860 @end smallexample
12861
12862 @noindent
12863 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12864
12865 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12866 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12867 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12868 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12869 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12870 information on tracepoint conditions.
12871
12872 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12873 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12874 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12875 @kindex ftrace
12876 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12877 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12878 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12879 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12880 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12881 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12882 message.
12883
12884 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12885 @code{trace}.
12886
12887 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12888 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12889 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12890 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12891 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12892 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12893 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12894 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12895
12896 @example
12897 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12898 @end example
12899
12900 @noindent
12901 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12902 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12903
12904 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12905 @cindex set static tracepoint
12906 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12907 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12908 @kindex strace
12909 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12910 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12911 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12912 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12913 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12914
12915 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12916 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12917 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12918 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12919 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12920 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12921 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12922 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12923 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12924 tracing engine:
12925
12926 @smallexample
12927 main ()
12928 @{
12929 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12930 @}
12931 @end smallexample
12932
12933 @noindent
12934 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12935 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12936
12937 @smallexample
12938 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12939 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12940 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12941 Data: "str %s"
12942 [etc...]
12943 @end smallexample
12944
12945 @noindent
12946 so you may probe the marker above with:
12947
12948 @smallexample
12949 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12950 @end smallexample
12951
12952 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12953 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12954 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12955 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12956 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12957 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12958 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12959 the @samp{Data:} field.
12960
12961 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12962 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12963 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12964
12965 @vindex $tpnum
12966 @cindex last tracepoint number
12967 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12968 @cindex tracepoint number
12969 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12970 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12971
12972 @kindex delete tracepoint
12973 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12974 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12975 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12976 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12977 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12978
12979 Examples:
12980
12981 @smallexample
12982 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12983
12984 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12985 @end smallexample
12986
12987 @noindent
12988 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12989 @end table
12990
12991 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12992 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12993
12994 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12995
12996 @table @code
12997 @kindex disable tracepoint
12998 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12999 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13000 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13001 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13002 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13003 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13004 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13005 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13006 next trace experiment.
13007
13008 @kindex enable tracepoint
13009 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13010 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13011 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13012 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13013 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13014 next time a trace experiment is run.
13015 @end table
13016
13017 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13018 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13019
13020 @table @code
13021 @kindex passcount
13022 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13023 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13024 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13025 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13026 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13027 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13028 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13029 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13030 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13031 user.
13032
13033 Examples:
13034
13035 @smallexample
13036 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13037 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13038
13039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13040 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13042 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13047 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13048 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13049 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13050 @end smallexample
13051 @end table
13052
13053 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13054 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13055 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13056 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13057
13058 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13059 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13060 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13061 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13062 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13063 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13064 is true.
13065
13066 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13067 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13068 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13069 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13070 just as with breakpoints.
13071
13072 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13073 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13074 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13075 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13076 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13077 accesses, and so forth.
13078
13079 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13080 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13081 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13082 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13083 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13084 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13085 search through.
13086
13087 @smallexample
13088 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13089 @end smallexample
13090
13091 @node Trace State Variables
13092 @subsection Trace State Variables
13093 @cindex trace state variables
13094
13095 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13096 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13097 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13098 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13099 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13100 integers.
13101
13102 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13103 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13104 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13105 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13106
13107 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13108 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13109 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13110 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13111 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13112 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13113 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13114 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13115 variable with the same name.
13116
13117 @table @code
13118
13119 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13120 @kindex tvariable
13121 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13122 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13123 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13124 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13125 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13126 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13127 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13128 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13129 value. The default initial value is 0.
13130
13131 @item info tvariables
13132 @kindex info tvariables
13133 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13134 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13135 currently running.
13136
13137 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13138 @kindex delete tvariable
13139 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13140 are specified.
13141
13142 @end table
13143
13144 @node Tracepoint Actions
13145 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13146
13147 @table @code
13148 @kindex actions
13149 @cindex tracepoint actions
13150 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13151 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13152 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13153 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13154 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13155 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13156 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13157 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13158 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13159 @code{while-stepping}.
13160
13161 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13162 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13163 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13164
13165 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13166 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13167 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13168
13169 @smallexample
13170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13171
13172 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13173
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13175 @end smallexample
13176
13177 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13178 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13179 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13180 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13181 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13182 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13183 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13184 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13185
13186 @smallexample
13187 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13188 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13189 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13190 > collect bar,baz
13191 > collect $regs
13192 > while-stepping 12
13193 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13194 > end
13195 end
13196 @end smallexample
13197
13198 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13199 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13200 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13201 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13202 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13203 special arguments are supported:
13204
13205 @table @code
13206 @item $regs
13207 Collect all registers.
13208
13209 @item $args
13210 Collect all function arguments.
13211
13212 @item $locals
13213 Collect all local variables.
13214
13215 @item $_ret
13216 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13217 of a backtrace.
13218
13219 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13220 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13221 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13222 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13223 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13224 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13225
13226 @item $_probe_argc
13227 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13228 tracepoint is located.
13229 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13230
13231 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13232 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13233 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13234 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13235
13236 @item $_sdata
13237 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13238 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13239 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13240 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13241 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13242 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13243 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13244 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13245 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13246
13247 @smallexample
13248 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13249 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13250 @end smallexample
13251
13252 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13253 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13254 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13255 @value{GDBN}.
13256 @end table
13257
13258 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13259 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13260 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13261
13262 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13263 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13264 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13265 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13266 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13267 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13268 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13269 @samp{mystr}.
13270
13271 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13272 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13273
13274 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13275 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13276 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13277 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13278 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13279 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13280 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13281 action were used.
13282
13283 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13284 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13285 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13286 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13287 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13288 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13289
13290 @smallexample
13291 > while-stepping 12
13292 > collect $regs, myglobal
13293 > end
13294 >
13295 @end smallexample
13296
13297 @noindent
13298 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13299 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13300 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13301 @code{stepping}.
13302
13303 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13304 @kindex set default-collect
13305 @cindex default collection action
13306 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13307 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13308 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13309 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13310 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13311 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13312
13313 @item show default-collect
13314 @kindex show default-collect
13315 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13316 tracepoint hit.
13317
13318 @end table
13319
13320 @node Listing Tracepoints
13321 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13322
13323 @table @code
13324 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13325 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13326 @cindex information about tracepoints
13327 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13328 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13329 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13330 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13331 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13332 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13333
13334 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13335 tracing:
13336
13337 @itemize @bullet
13338 @item
13339 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13340
13341 @item
13342 the state about installed on target of each location
13343 @end itemize
13344
13345 @smallexample
13346 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13347 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13348 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13349 while-stepping 20
13350 collect globfoo, $regs
13351 end
13352 collect globfoo2
13353 end
13354 pass count 1200
13355 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13356 collect $eip
13357 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13358 installed on target
13359 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13360 installed on target
13361 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13362 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13363 not installed on target
13364 (@value{GDBP})
13365 @end smallexample
13366
13367 @noindent
13368 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13369 @end table
13370
13371 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13372 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13373
13374 @table @code
13375 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13376 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13377 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13378 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13379 program.
13380
13381 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13382
13383 @table @emph
13384 @item Count
13385 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13386 stable identifier.
13387 @item ID
13388 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13389 @item Enabled or Disabled
13390 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13391 that are not enabled.
13392 @item Address
13393 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13394 @item What
13395 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13396 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13397 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13398 will be left blank.
13399 @end table
13400
13401 @noindent
13402 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13403
13404 @table @emph
13405 @item Data
13406 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13407 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13408 marker call.
13409 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13410 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13411 @end table
13412
13413 @smallexample
13414 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13415 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13416 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13417 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13418 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13419 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13420 Data: str %s
13421 (@value{GDBP})
13422 @end smallexample
13423 @end table
13424
13425 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13426 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13427
13428 @table @code
13429 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13430 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13431 @cindex collected data discarded
13432 @item tstart
13433 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13434 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13435 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13436 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13437 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13438 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13439 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13440 information, and so forth.
13441
13442 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13443 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13444 @item tstop
13445 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13446 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13447 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13448 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13449 needs to be stopped quickly.
13450
13451 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13452 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13453 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13454
13455 @kindex tstatus
13456 @cindex status of trace data collection
13457 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13458 @item tstatus
13459 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13460 collection.
13461 @end table
13462
13463 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13464
13465 @smallexample
13466 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13467 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13468 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13469 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13470 > while-stepping 11
13471 > collect $regs
13472 > end
13473 > end
13474 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13475 [time passes @dots{}]
13476 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13477 @end smallexample
13478
13479 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13480 @cindex disconnected tracing
13481 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13482 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13483 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13484 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13485 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13486 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13487 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13488 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13489
13490 @table @code
13491 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13492 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13493 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13494 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13495 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13496 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13497 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13498 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13499
13500 @item show disconnected-tracing
13501 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13502 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13503
13504 @end table
13505
13506 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13507 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13508 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13509 it will continue after reconnection.
13510
13511 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13512 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13513 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13514 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13515 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13516 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13517 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13518 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13519 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13520 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13521
13522 @cindex circular trace buffer
13523 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13524 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13525 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13526 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13527 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13528 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13529 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13530 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13531 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13532 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13533 the next run.
13534
13535 @table @code
13536 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13537 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13538 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13539 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13540 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13541 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13542 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13543
13544 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13545 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13546 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13547 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13548 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13549 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13550
13551 @end table
13552
13553 @table @code
13554 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13555 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13556 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13557 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13558 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13559 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13560 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13561 likes. This is also the default.
13562
13563 @item show trace-buffer-size
13564 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13565 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13566 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13567 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13568 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13569 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13570 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13571 @end table
13572
13573 @table @code
13574 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13575 @kindex set trace-user
13576
13577 @item show trace-user
13578 @kindex show trace-user
13579
13580 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13581 @kindex set trace-notes
13582 Set the trace run's notes.
13583
13584 @item show trace-notes
13585 @kindex show trace-notes
13586 Show the trace run's notes.
13587
13588 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13589 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13590 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13591 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13592 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13593
13594 @item show trace-stop-notes
13595 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13596 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13597
13598 @end table
13599
13600 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13601 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13602
13603 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13604 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13605 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13606 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13607 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13608 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13609 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13610 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13611 mentioned here.
13612
13613 @itemize @bullet
13614
13615 @item
13616 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13617 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13618 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13619 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13620 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13621 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13622 cannot be collected either.
13623
13624 @item
13625 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13626 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13627 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13628 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13629 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13630 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13631 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13632 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13633 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13634 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13635
13636 @item
13637 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13638 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13639 in a misleading way.
13640
13641 @item
13642 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13643 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13644 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13645 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13646 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13647 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13648 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13649 by @code{ptr}.
13650
13651 @item
13652 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13653 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13654 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13655 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13656 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13657 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13658 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13659 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13660 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13661 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13662 invalid address.
13663
13664 @item
13665 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13666 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13667 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13668 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13669 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13670 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13671 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13672 it to zero.
13673
13674 @end itemize
13675
13676 @node Analyze Collected Data
13677 @section Using the Collected Data
13678
13679 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13680 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13681 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13682 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13683 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13684 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13685 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13686 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13687 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13688 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13689 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13690 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13691 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13692 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13693 the buffer will fail.
13694
13695 @menu
13696 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13697 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13698 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13699 @end menu
13700
13701 @node tfind
13702 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13703
13704 @kindex tfind
13705 @cindex select trace snapshot
13706 @cindex find trace snapshot
13707 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13708 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13709 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13710 snapshot is selected.
13711
13712 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13713
13714 @table @code
13715 @item tfind start
13716 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13717 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13718
13719 @item tfind none
13720 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13721
13722 @item tfind end
13723 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13724
13725 @item tfind
13726 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13727 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13728
13729 @item tfind -
13730 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13731 retracing earlier steps.
13732
13733 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13734 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13735 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13736 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13737 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13738
13739 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13740 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13741 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13742 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13743 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13744
13745 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13746 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13747 addresses (exclusive).
13748
13749 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13750 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13751 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13752
13753 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13754 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13755 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13756 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13757 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13758 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13759 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13760 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13761 @end table
13762
13763 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13764 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13765 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13766 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13767 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13768 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13769 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13770 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13771 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13772 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13773 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13774 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13775 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13776 tracepoint as the current one.
13777
13778 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13779 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13780 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13781 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13782 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13783
13784 @smallexample
13785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13787 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13788 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13789 > tfind
13790 > end
13791
13792 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13793 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13794 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13795 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13796 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13797 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13798 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13799 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13800 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13801 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13802 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13803 @end smallexample
13804
13805 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13806 the buffer:
13807
13808 @smallexample
13809 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13810 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13811 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13812 > tfind line
13813 > end
13814
13815 Frame 0, X = 1
13816 Frame 7, X = 2
13817 Frame 13, X = 255
13818 @end smallexample
13819
13820 @node tdump
13821 @subsection @code{tdump}
13822 @kindex tdump
13823 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13824 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13825
13826 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13827 the current trace snapshot.
13828
13829 @smallexample
13830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13831 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13832 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13833 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13834 > end
13835
13836 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13837
13838 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13839 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13840 at gdb_test.c:444
13841 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13842
13843 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13844 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13845 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13846 d1 0x18 24
13847 d2 0x80 128
13848 d3 0x33 51
13849 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13850 d5 0x22 34
13851 d6 0xe0 224
13852 d7 0x380035 3670069
13853 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13854 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13855 a2 0x100 256
13856 a3 0x322000 3284992
13857 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13858 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13859 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13860 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13861 ps 0x0 0
13862 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13863 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13864 fpstatus 0x0 0
13865 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13866 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13867 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13868 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13869 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13870 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13871 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13872 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13873 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13874
13875 (@value{GDBP})
13876 @end smallexample
13877
13878 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13879 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13880 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13881 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13882
13883 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13884 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13885 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13886 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13887 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13888 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13889 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13890 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13891 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13892 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13893
13894 @node save tracepoints
13895 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13896 @kindex save tracepoints
13897 @kindex save-tracepoints
13898 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13899
13900 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13901 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13902 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13903 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13904 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13905 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13906
13907 @node Tracepoint Variables
13908 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13909 @cindex tracepoint variables
13910 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13911
13912 @table @code
13913 @vindex $trace_frame
13914 @item (int) $trace_frame
13915 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13916 snapshot is selected.
13917
13918 @vindex $tracepoint
13919 @item (int) $tracepoint
13920 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13921
13922 @vindex $trace_line
13923 @item (int) $trace_line
13924 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13925
13926 @vindex $trace_file
13927 @item (char []) $trace_file
13928 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13929
13930 @vindex $trace_func
13931 @item (char []) $trace_func
13932 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13933 @end table
13934
13935 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13936 use @code{output} instead.
13937
13938 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13939 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13940 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13941 which are managed by the target.
13942
13943 @smallexample
13944 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13945
13946 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13947 > output $trace_file
13948 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13949 > tfind
13950 > end
13951 @end smallexample
13952
13953 @node Trace Files
13954 @section Using Trace Files
13955 @cindex trace files
13956
13957 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13958 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13959 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13960 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13961 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13962
13963 @table @code
13964
13965 @kindex tsave
13966 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13967 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13968 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13969 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13970 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13971 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13972 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13973 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13974 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13975 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13976 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13977 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13978 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13979 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13980 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13981
13982 @kindex target tfile
13983 @kindex tfile
13984 @kindex target ctf
13985 @kindex ctf
13986 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13987 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13988 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13989 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13990 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13991 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13992 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13993 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13994 the host.
13995
13996 @smallexample
13997 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13998 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13999 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14000 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14001 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14002 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14003 i = 0
14004 a = 0
14005 b = 1 '\001'
14006 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14007 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14008 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14009 $1 = 1
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @end table
14013
14014 @node Overlays
14015 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14016 @cindex overlays
14017
14018 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14019 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14020 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14021 use overlays.
14022
14023 @menu
14024 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14025 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14026 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14027 mapped by asking the inferior.
14028 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14029 @end menu
14030
14031 @node How Overlays Work
14032 @section How Overlays Work
14033 @cindex mapped overlays
14034 @cindex unmapped overlays
14035 @cindex load address, overlay's
14036 @cindex mapped address
14037 @cindex overlay area
14038
14039 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14040 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14041 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14042 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14043 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14044
14045 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14046 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14047 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14048 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14049 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14050 largest overlay as well.
14051
14052 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14053 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14054 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14055 there.
14056
14057 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14058 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14059 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14060
14061 @smallexample
14062 @group
14063 Data Instruction Larger
14064 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14065 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14066 | | | | | |
14067 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14068 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14069 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14070 | and heap | | | | | |
14071 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14072 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14073 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14074 | | | | | |
14075 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14076 address | | | | | |
14077 | overlay | <-' | | |
14078 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14079 | | <---. | | load address
14080 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14081 | | | |
14082 +-----------+ | |
14083 +-----------+
14084 | |
14085 +-----------+
14086
14087 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14088 @end group
14089 @end smallexample
14090
14091 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14092 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14093 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14094 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14095 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14096 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14097 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14098 program and the overlay area.
14099
14100 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14101 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14102 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14103 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14104 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14105 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14106 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14107
14108 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14109 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14110 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14111
14112 @itemize @bullet
14113
14114 @item
14115 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14116 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14117 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14118 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14119
14120 @item
14121 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14122 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14123 your program's performance.
14124
14125 @item
14126 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14127 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14128 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14129 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14130 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14131 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14132 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14133
14134 @item
14135 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14136 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14137 instruction and data spaces.
14138
14139 @end itemize
14140
14141 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14142 improved in many ways:
14143
14144 @itemize @bullet
14145
14146 @item
14147 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14148 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14149 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14150 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14151 area in the usual way.
14152
14153 @item
14154 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14155 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14156
14157 @item
14158 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14159 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14160 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14161 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14162 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14163 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14164 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14165
14166 @end itemize
14167
14168
14169 @node Overlay Commands
14170 @section Overlay Commands
14171
14172 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14173 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14174 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14175 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14176 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14177 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14178
14179 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14180 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14181
14182 @table @code
14183 @item overlay off
14184 @kindex overlay
14185 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14186 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14187 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14188 overlay support is disabled.
14189
14190 @item overlay manual
14191 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14192 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14193 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14194 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14195 commands described below.
14196
14197 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14198 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14199 @cindex map an overlay
14200 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14201 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14202 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14203 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14204 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14205 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14206
14207 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14208 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14209 @cindex unmap an overlay
14210 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14211 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14212 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14213 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14214
14215 @item overlay auto
14216 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14217 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14218 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14219 Overlay Debugging}.
14220
14221 @item overlay load-target
14222 @itemx overlay load
14223 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14224 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14225 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14226 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14227 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14228 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14229
14230 @item overlay list-overlays
14231 @itemx overlay list
14232 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14233 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14234 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14235
14236 @end table
14237
14238 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14239 of the function the address falls in:
14240
14241 @smallexample
14242 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14243 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14244 @end smallexample
14245 @noindent
14246 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14247 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14248 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14249 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14250
14251 @smallexample
14252 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14253 No sections are mapped.
14254 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14255 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14256 @end smallexample
14257 @noindent
14258 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14259 name normally:
14260
14261 @smallexample
14262 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14263 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14264 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14265 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14266 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14267 @end smallexample
14268
14269 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14270 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14271 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14272 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14273 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14274
14275 @itemize @bullet
14276 @item
14277 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14278 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14279 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14280 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14281 @item
14282 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14283 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14284 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14285 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14286 breakpoints properly.
14287 @end itemize
14288
14289
14290 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14291 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14292 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14293
14294 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14295 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14296 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14297 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14298 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14299 current state of the overlays.
14300
14301 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14302 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14303
14304 @table @asis
14305
14306 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14307 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14308
14309 @smallexample
14310 struct
14311 @{
14312 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14313 unsigned long vma;
14314
14315 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14316 unsigned long size;
14317
14318 /* The overlay's load address. */
14319 unsigned long lma;
14320
14321 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14322 zero otherwise. */
14323 unsigned long mapped;
14324 @}
14325 @end smallexample
14326
14327 @item @code{_novlys}:
14328 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14329 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14330
14331 @end table
14332
14333 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14334 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14335 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14336 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14337 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14338 currently mapped.
14339
14340 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14341 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14342 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14343 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14344 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14345 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14346 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14347 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14348 are not being executed.
14349
14350 @node Overlay Sample Program
14351 @section Overlay Sample Program
14352 @cindex overlay example program
14353
14354 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14355 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14356 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14357 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14358 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14359 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14360 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14361
14362 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14363 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14364 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14365 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14366
14367 @table @file
14368 @item overlays.c
14369 The main program file.
14370 @item ovlymgr.c
14371 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14372 @item foo.c
14373 @itemx bar.c
14374 @itemx baz.c
14375 @itemx grbx.c
14376 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14377 @item d10v.ld
14378 @itemx m32r.ld
14379 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14380 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14381 @end table
14382
14383 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14384 cross-compiler like this:
14385
14386 @smallexample
14387 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14388 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14389 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14390 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14391 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14392 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14393 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14394 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14395 @end smallexample
14396
14397 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14398 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14399 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14400
14401
14402 @node Languages
14403 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14404 @cindex languages
14405
14406 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14407 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14408 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14409 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14410 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14411 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14412
14413 @cindex working language
14414 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14415 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14416 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14417 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14418 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14419 language}.
14420
14421 @menu
14422 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14423 * Show:: Displaying the language
14424 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14425 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14426 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14427 @end menu
14428
14429 @node Setting
14430 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14431
14432 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14433 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14434 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14435 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14436 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14437 are printed, etc.
14438
14439 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14440 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14441 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14442 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14443 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14444 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14445 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14446 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14447 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14448 Displaying the Language}.
14449
14450 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14451 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14452 another language. In that case, make the
14453 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14454 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14455 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14456
14457 @menu
14458 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14459 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14460 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14461 @end menu
14462
14463 @node Filenames
14464 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14465
14466 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14467 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14468
14469 @table @file
14470 @item .ada
14471 @itemx .ads
14472 @itemx .adb
14473 @itemx .a
14474 Ada source file.
14475
14476 @item .c
14477 C source file
14478
14479 @item .C
14480 @itemx .cc
14481 @itemx .cp
14482 @itemx .cpp
14483 @itemx .cxx
14484 @itemx .c++
14485 C@t{++} source file
14486
14487 @item .d
14488 D source file
14489
14490 @item .m
14491 Objective-C source file
14492
14493 @item .f
14494 @itemx .F
14495 Fortran source file
14496
14497 @item .mod
14498 Modula-2 source file
14499
14500 @item .s
14501 @itemx .S
14502 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14503 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14504 @end table
14505
14506 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14507 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14508
14509 @node Manually
14510 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14511
14512 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14513 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14514 your program.
14515
14516 @kindex set language
14517 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14518 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14519 a language, such as
14520 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14521 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14522
14523 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14524 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14525 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14526 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14527 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14528 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14529 command such as:
14530
14531 @smallexample
14532 print a = b + c
14533 @end smallexample
14534
14535 @noindent
14536 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14537 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14538 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14539 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14540
14541 @node Automatically
14542 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14543
14544 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14545 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14546 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14547 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14548 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14549 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14550 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14551 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14552 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14553
14554 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14555 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14556 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14557 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14558 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14559
14560 @node Show
14561 @section Displaying the Language
14562
14563 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14564 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14565
14566 @table @code
14567 @item show language
14568 @anchor{show language}
14569 @kindex show language
14570 Display the current working language. This is the
14571 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14572 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14573
14574 @item info frame
14575 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14576 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14577 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14578 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14579 information listed here.
14580
14581 @item info source
14582 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14583 Display the source language of this source file.
14584 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14585 information listed here.
14586 @end table
14587
14588 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14589 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14590 with a language explicitly:
14591
14592 @table @code
14593 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14594 @kindex set extension-language
14595 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14596 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14597
14598 @item info extensions
14599 @kindex info extensions
14600 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14601 @end table
14602
14603 @node Checks
14604 @section Type and Range Checking
14605
14606 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14607 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14608 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14609 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14610 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14611 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14612 errors when your program is running.
14613
14614 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14615 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14616 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14617 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14618
14619 @menu
14620 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14621 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14622 @end menu
14623
14624 @cindex type checking
14625 @cindex checks, type
14626 @node Type Checking
14627 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14628
14629 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14630 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14631 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14632 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14633
14634 @smallexample
14635 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14636
14637 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14638 $1 = 2
14639 @exdent but
14640 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14641 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14642 @end smallexample
14643
14644 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14645 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14646
14647 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14648 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14649 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14650 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14651 expressions like the second example above.
14652
14653 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14654 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14655 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14656 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14657 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14658 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14659
14660 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14661
14662 @kindex set check type
14663 @kindex show check type
14664 @table @code
14665 @item set check type on
14666 @itemx set check type off
14667 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14668 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14669 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14670
14671 @item show check type
14672 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14673 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14674 @end table
14675
14676 @cindex range checking
14677 @cindex checks, range
14678 @node Range Checking
14679 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14680
14681 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14682 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14683 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14684 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14685 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14686
14687 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14688 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14689 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14690 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14691
14692 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14693 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14694 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14695 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14696 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14697 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14698
14699 @smallexample
14700 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14701 @end smallexample
14702
14703 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14704 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14705 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14706
14707 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14708
14709 @kindex set check range
14710 @kindex show check range
14711 @table @code
14712 @item set check range auto
14713 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14714 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14715 each language.
14716
14717 @item set check range on
14718 @itemx set check range off
14719 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14720 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14721 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14722 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14723
14724 @item set check range warn
14725 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14726 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14727 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14728 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14729 systems).
14730
14731 @item show range
14732 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14733 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14734 @end table
14735
14736 @node Supported Languages
14737 @section Supported Languages
14738
14739 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14740 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14741 @c This is false ...
14742 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14743 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14744 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14745 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14746 language.
14747
14748 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14749 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14750 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14751 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14752 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14753 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14754 language reference or tutorial.
14755
14756 @menu
14757 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14758 * D:: D
14759 * Go:: Go
14760 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14761 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14762 * Fortran:: Fortran
14763 * Pascal:: Pascal
14764 * Rust:: Rust
14765 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14766 * Ada:: Ada
14767 @end menu
14768
14769 @node C
14770 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14771
14772 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14773 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14774
14775 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14776 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14777 together.
14778
14779 @cindex C@t{++}
14780 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14781 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14782 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14783 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14784 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14785 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14786 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14787
14788 @menu
14789 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14790 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14791 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14792 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14793 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14794 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14795 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14796 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14797 @end menu
14798
14799 @node C Operators
14800 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14801
14802 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14803
14804 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14805 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14806 often defined on groups of types.
14807
14808 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14809
14810 @itemize @bullet
14811
14812 @item
14813 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14814 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14815
14816 @item
14817 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14818 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14819
14820 @item
14821 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14822
14823 @item
14824 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14825
14826 @end itemize
14827
14828 @noindent
14829 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14830 in order of increasing precedence:
14831
14832 @table @code
14833 @item ,
14834 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14835 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14836 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14837
14838 @item =
14839 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14840 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14841
14842 @item @var{op}=
14843 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14844 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14845 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14846 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14847 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14848
14849 @item ?:
14850 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14851 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14852 should be of an integral type.
14853
14854 @item ||
14855 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14856
14857 @item &&
14858 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14859
14860 @item |
14861 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14862
14863 @item ^
14864 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14865
14866 @item &
14867 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14868
14869 @item ==@r{, }!=
14870 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14871 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14872
14873 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14874 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14875 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14876 and non-zero for true.
14877
14878 @item <<@r{, }>>
14879 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14880
14881 @item @@
14882 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14883
14884 @item +@r{, }-
14885 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14886 pointer types.
14887
14888 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14889 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14890 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14891 integral types.
14892
14893 @item ++@r{, }--
14894 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14895 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14896 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14897 operation takes place.
14898
14899 @item *
14900 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14901 @code{++}.
14902
14903 @item &
14904 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14905
14906 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14907 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14908 to examine the address
14909 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14910 stored.
14911
14912 @item -
14913 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14914 precedence as @code{++}.
14915
14916 @item !
14917 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14918 @code{++}.
14919
14920 @item ~
14921 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14922 @code{++}.
14923
14924
14925 @item .@r{, }->
14926 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14927 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14928 pointer based on the stored type information.
14929 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14930
14931 @item .*@r{, }->*
14932 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14933
14934 @item []
14935 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14936 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14937
14938 @item ()
14939 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14940
14941 @item ::
14942 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14943 and @code{class} types.
14944
14945 @item ::
14946 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14947 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14948 above.
14949 @end table
14950
14951 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14952 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14953 predefined meaning.
14954
14955 @node C Constants
14956 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14957
14958 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14959
14960 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14961 following ways:
14962
14963 @itemize @bullet
14964 @item
14965 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14966 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14967 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14968 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14969 @code{long} value.
14970
14971 @item
14972 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14973 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14974 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14975 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14976 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14977 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14978 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14979 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14980 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14981 constant.
14982
14983 @item
14984 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14985 integral equivalents.
14986
14987 @item
14988 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14989 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14990 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14991 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14992 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14993 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14994 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14995 @samp{\n} for newline.
14996
14997 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14998 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14999 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15000 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15001
15002 @item
15003 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15004 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15005 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15006 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15007 characters.
15008
15009 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15010 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15011 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15012
15013 @item
15014 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15015 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15016
15017 @item
15018 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15019 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15020 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15021 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15022 @end itemize
15023
15024 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15025 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15026
15027 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15028 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15029
15030 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15031 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15032 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15033 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15034 @quotation
15035 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15036 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15037 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15038 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15039 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15040 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15041 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15042 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15043 @end quotation
15044
15045 @enumerate
15046
15047 @cindex member functions
15048 @item
15049 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15050
15051 @smallexample
15052 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15053 @end smallexample
15054
15055 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15056 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15057 @item
15058 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15059 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15060 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15061 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15062 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15063
15064 @cindex call overloaded functions
15065 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15066 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15067 @item
15068 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15069 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15070 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15071 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15072 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15073 default arguments.
15074
15075 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15076 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15077 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15078 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15079 number of function arguments.
15080
15081 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15082 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15083 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15084
15085 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15086 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15087 @smallexample
15088 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15089 @end smallexample
15090
15091 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15092 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15093
15094 @cindex reference declarations
15095 @item
15096 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15097 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15098 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15099
15100 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15101 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15102 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15103 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15104 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15105
15106 @item
15107 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15108 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15109 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15110 necessary, for example in an expression like
15111 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15112 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15113 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15114
15115 @item
15116 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15117 specification.
15118 @end enumerate
15119
15120 @node C Defaults
15121 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15122
15123 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15124
15125 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15126 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15127 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15128 selects the working language.
15129
15130 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15131 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15132 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15133 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15134 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15135 for further details.
15136
15137 @node C Checks
15138 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15139
15140 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15141
15142 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15143 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15144 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15145 constants to pointers.
15146
15147 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15148 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15149 that is not itself an array.
15150
15151 @node Debugging C
15152 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15153
15154 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15155 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15156 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15157 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15158
15159 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15160 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15161 ,Expressions}.
15162
15163 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15164 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15165
15166 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15167
15168 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15169 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15170
15171 @table @code
15172 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15173 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15174 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15175 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15176 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15177 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15178
15179 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15180 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15181 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15182 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15183 classes.
15184 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15185
15186 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15187 @item catch throw
15188 @itemx catch rethrow
15189 @itemx catch catch
15190 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15191 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15192
15193 @cindex inheritance
15194 @item ptype @var{typename}
15195 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15196 @var{typename}.
15197 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15198
15199 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15200 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15201 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15202 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15203 multiple inheritance is in use.
15204
15205 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15206 @item demangle @var{name}
15207 Demangle @var{name}.
15208 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15209
15210 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15211 @item set print demangle
15212 @itemx show print demangle
15213 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15214 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15215 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15216 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15217 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15218
15219 @item set print object
15220 @itemx show print object
15221 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15222 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15223
15224 @item set print vtbl
15225 @itemx show print vtbl
15226 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15227 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15228 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15229 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15230
15231 @kindex set overload-resolution
15232 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15233 @item set overload-resolution on
15234 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15235 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15236 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15237 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15238 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15239 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15240
15241 @item set overload-resolution off
15242 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15243 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15244 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15245 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15246 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15247 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15248 argument types.
15249
15250 @kindex show overload-resolution
15251 @item show overload-resolution
15252 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15253
15254 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15255 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15256 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15257 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15258 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15259 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15260 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15261
15262 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15263
15264 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15265 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15266 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15267 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15268 for more detail.
15269
15270 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15271 function that returns a std::string:
15272
15273 @smallexample
15274 std::string function(int);
15275 @end smallexample
15276
15277 @noindent
15278 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15279 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15280
15281 @smallexample
15282 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15283 @end smallexample
15284
15285 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15286 tag. For example:
15287
15288 @smallexample
15289 (gdb) b function(int)
15290 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15291 (gdb) info breakpoints
15292 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15293 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15294 at main.cc:10
15295 @end smallexample
15296
15297 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15298 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15299 name, like:
15300
15301 @smallexample
15302 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15303 @end smallexample
15304 @end table
15305
15306 @node Decimal Floating Point
15307 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15308 @cindex decimal floating point format
15309
15310 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15311 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15312 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15313 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15314
15315 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15316 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15317 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15318 configured target.
15319
15320 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15321 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15322 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15323
15324 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15325 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15326 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15327
15328 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15329 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15330 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15331
15332 @node D
15333 @subsection D
15334
15335 @cindex D
15336 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15337 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15338 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15339
15340 @node Go
15341 @subsection Go
15342
15343 @cindex Go (programming language)
15344 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15345 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15346
15347 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15348
15349 @table @code
15350 @cindex current Go package
15351 @item The current Go package
15352 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15353 specifying global variables and functions.
15354
15355 For example, given the program:
15356
15357 @example
15358 package main
15359 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15360 func main () @{
15361 // ...
15362 @}
15363 @end example
15364
15365 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15366
15367 @example
15368 (gdb) p myglob
15369 (gdb) p main.myglob
15370 @end example
15371
15372 @cindex builtin Go types
15373 @item Builtin Go types
15374 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15375 as a string.
15376
15377 @cindex builtin Go functions
15378 @item Builtin Go functions
15379 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15380 function and handles it internally.
15381
15382 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15383 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15384 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15385 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15386 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15387 @end table
15388
15389 @node Objective-C
15390 @subsection Objective-C
15391
15392 @cindex Objective-C
15393 This section provides information about some commands and command
15394 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15395 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15396 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15397
15398 @menu
15399 * Method Names in Commands::
15400 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15401 @end menu
15402
15403 @node Method Names in Commands
15404 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15405
15406 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15407 names as line specifications:
15408
15409 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15410 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15411 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15412 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15413 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15414 @itemize
15415 @item @code{clear}
15416 @item @code{break}
15417 @item @code{info line}
15418 @item @code{jump}
15419 @item @code{list}
15420 @end itemize
15421
15422 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15423
15424 @smallexample
15425 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15426 @end smallexample
15427
15428 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15429 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15430 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15431 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15432 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15433 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15434 debugged, enter:
15435
15436 @smallexample
15437 break -[Fruit create]
15438 @end smallexample
15439
15440 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15441 enter:
15442
15443 @smallexample
15444 list +[NSText initialize]
15445 @end smallexample
15446
15447 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15448 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15449 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15450 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15451
15452 @smallexample
15453 break create
15454 @end smallexample
15455
15456 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15457 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15458 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15459 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15460 none apply.
15461
15462 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15463 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15470 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15471 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15472 @kindex print-object
15473 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15474
15475 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15476
15477 @smallexample
15478 print -[@var{object} hash]
15479 @end smallexample
15480
15481 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15482 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15483 @noindent
15484 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15485 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15486 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15487 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15488 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15489 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15490
15491 @node OpenCL C
15492 @subsection OpenCL C
15493
15494 @cindex OpenCL C
15495 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15496
15497 @menu
15498 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15499 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15500 * OpenCL C Operators::
15501 @end menu
15502
15503 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15504 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15505
15506 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15507 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15508 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15509 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15510 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15511
15512 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15513 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15514
15515 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15516 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15517 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15518 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15519
15520 @node OpenCL C Operators
15521 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15522
15523 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15524 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15525 vector data types.
15526
15527 @node Fortran
15528 @subsection Fortran
15529 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15530
15531 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15532 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15533
15534 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15535 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15536 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15537 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15538 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15539 underscore.
15540
15541 @menu
15542 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15543 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15544 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15545 @end menu
15546
15547 @node Fortran Operators
15548 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15549
15550 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15551
15552 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15553 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15554 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15555
15556 @table @code
15557 @item **
15558 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15559 of the second one.
15560
15561 @item :
15562 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15563 represent a section of array.
15564
15565 @item %
15566 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15567 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15568 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15569 union type.
15570 @end table
15571
15572 @node Fortran Defaults
15573 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15574
15575 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15576
15577 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15578 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15579 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15580 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15581
15582 @node Special Fortran Commands
15583 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15584
15585 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15586
15587 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15588 such as displaying common blocks.
15589
15590 @table @code
15591 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15592 @kindex info common
15593 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15594 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15595 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15596 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15597 printed.
15598 @end table
15599
15600 @node Pascal
15601 @subsection Pascal
15602
15603 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15604 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15605 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15606 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15607 syntax.
15608
15609 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15610 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15611 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15612
15613 @node Rust
15614 @subsection Rust
15615
15616 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15617 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15618 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15619 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15620
15621 @itemize @bullet
15622 @item
15623 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15624 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15625 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15626
15627 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15628 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15629 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15630 @samp{B}.
15631
15632 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15633 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15634
15635 @item
15636 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15637 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15638 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15639 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15640 @samp{K::x::y}.
15641
15642 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15643 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15644 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15645 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15646 scope.
15647
15648 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15649 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15650
15651 @item
15652 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15653 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15654
15655 @item
15656 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15657
15658 @item
15659 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15660 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15661 never be destroyed.
15662
15663 @item
15664 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15665 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15666 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15667
15668 @item
15669 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15670 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15671 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15672 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15673 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15674 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15675 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15676 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15677
15678 @item
15679 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15680 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15681 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15682 @itemize @bullet
15683
15684 @item
15685 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15686
15687 @item
15688 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15689
15690 @item
15691 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15692 type names.
15693
15694 @item
15695 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15696
15697 @item
15698 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15699 available in the crate.
15700 @end itemize
15701 @end itemize
15702
15703 @node Modula-2
15704 @subsection Modula-2
15705
15706 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15707
15708 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15709 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15710 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15711 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15712 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15713 table.
15714
15715 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15716 @menu
15717 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15718 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15719 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15720 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15721 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15722 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15723 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15724 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15725 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15726 @end menu
15727
15728 @node M2 Operators
15729 @subsubsection Operators
15730 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15731
15732 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15733 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15734 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15735 following definitions hold:
15736
15737 @itemize @bullet
15738
15739 @item
15740 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15741 their subranges.
15742
15743 @item
15744 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15745
15746 @item
15747 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15748
15749 @item
15750 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15751 @var{type}}.
15752
15753 @item
15754 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15755
15756 @item
15757 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15758
15759 @item
15760 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15761 @end itemize
15762
15763 @noindent
15764 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15765 increasing precedence:
15766
15767 @table @code
15768 @item ,
15769 Function argument or array index separator.
15770
15771 @item :=
15772 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15773 @var{value}.
15774
15775 @item <@r{, }>
15776 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15777 types.
15778
15779 @item <=@r{, }>=
15780 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15781 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15782 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15783
15784 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15785 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15786 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15787 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15788 comment character.
15789
15790 @item IN
15791 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15792 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15793
15794 @item OR
15795 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15796
15797 @item AND@r{, }&
15798 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15799
15800 @item @@
15801 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15802
15803 @item +@r{, }-
15804 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15805 and difference on set types.
15806
15807 @item *
15808 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15809 on set types.
15810
15811 @item /
15812 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15813 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15814
15815 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15816 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15817 precedence as @code{*}.
15818
15819 @item -
15820 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15821
15822 @item ^
15823 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15824
15825 @item NOT
15826 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15827 @code{^}.
15828
15829 @item .
15830 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15831 precedence as @code{^}.
15832
15833 @item []
15834 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15835
15836 @item ()
15837 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15838 as @code{^}.
15839
15840 @item ::@r{, }.
15841 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15842 @end table
15843
15844 @quotation
15845 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15846 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15847 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15848 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15849 @end quotation
15850
15851
15852 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15853 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15854 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15855
15856 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15857 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15858
15859 @table @var
15860
15861 @item a
15862 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15863
15864 @item c
15865 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15866
15867 @item i
15868 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15869
15870 @item m
15871 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15872 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15873 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15874
15875 @item n
15876 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15877
15878 @item r
15879 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15880
15881 @item t
15882 represents a type.
15883
15884 @item v
15885 represents a variable.
15886
15887 @item x
15888 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15889 explanation of the function for details.
15890 @end table
15891
15892 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15893
15894 @table @code
15895 @item ABS(@var{n})
15896 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15897
15898 @item CAP(@var{c})
15899 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15900 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15901
15902 @item CHR(@var{i})
15903 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15904
15905 @item DEC(@var{v})
15906 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15907
15908 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15909 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15910 new value.
15911
15912 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15913 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15914 set.
15915
15916 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15917 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15918
15919 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15920 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15921
15922 @item INC(@var{v})
15923 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15924
15925 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15926 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15927 new value.
15928
15929 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15930 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15931 there. Returns the new set.
15932
15933 @item MAX(@var{t})
15934 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15935
15936 @item MIN(@var{t})
15937 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15938
15939 @item ODD(@var{i})
15940 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15941
15942 @item ORD(@var{x})
15943 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15944 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15945 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15946 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15947
15948 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15949 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15950 variable or a type.
15951
15952 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15953 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15954
15955 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15956 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15957 variable or a type.
15958
15959 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15960 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15961 @end table
15962
15963 @quotation
15964 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15965 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15966 an error.
15967 @end quotation
15968
15969 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15970 @node M2 Constants
15971 @subsubsection Constants
15972
15973 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15974 ways:
15975
15976 @itemize @bullet
15977
15978 @item
15979 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15980 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15981 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15982 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15983
15984 @item
15985 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15986 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15987 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15988 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15989 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15990 digits.
15991
15992 @item
15993 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15994 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15995 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15996 followed by a @samp{C}.
15997
15998 @item
15999 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16000 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16001 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16002 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16003 sequences.
16004
16005 @item
16006 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16007
16008 @item
16009 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16010 @code{FALSE}.
16011
16012 @item
16013 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16014
16015 @item
16016 Set constants are not yet supported.
16017 @end itemize
16018
16019 @node M2 Types
16020 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16021 @cindex Modula-2 types
16022
16023 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16024 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16025 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16026 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16027 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16028 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16029
16030 The first example contains the following section of code:
16031
16032 @smallexample
16033 VAR
16034 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16035 r: [20..40] ;
16036 @end smallexample
16037
16038 @noindent
16039 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16040 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16041
16042 @smallexample
16043 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16044 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16045 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16046 SET OF CHAR
16047 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16048 21
16049 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16050 [20..40]
16051 @end smallexample
16052
16053 @noindent
16054 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16055
16056 @smallexample
16057 VAR
16058 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16059 @end smallexample
16060
16061 @noindent
16062 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16063
16064 @smallexample
16065 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16066 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16067 @end smallexample
16068
16069 @noindent
16070 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16071 expressions using the debugger.
16072
16073 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16074 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16075
16076 @smallexample
16077 VAR
16078 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16079 @end smallexample
16080
16081 @smallexample
16082 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16083 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16084 @end smallexample
16085
16086 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16087 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16088 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16089 above.
16090
16091 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16092
16093 @smallexample
16094 TYPE
16095 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16096 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16097 VAR
16098 s: t ;
16099 BEGIN
16100 s := blue ;
16101 @end smallexample
16102
16103 @noindent
16104 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16105 and value of a variable.
16106
16107 @smallexample
16108 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16109 $1 = blue
16110 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16111 type = [blue..yellow]
16112 @end smallexample
16113
16114 @noindent
16115 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16116 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16117 their @code{C} counterparts.
16118
16119 @smallexample
16120 VAR
16121 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16122 BEGIN
16123 s[1] := 1 ;
16124 @end smallexample
16125
16126 @smallexample
16127 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16128 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16129 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16130 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16131 @end smallexample
16132
16133 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16134 pointer types as shown in this example:
16135
16136 @smallexample
16137 VAR
16138 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16139 BEGIN
16140 NEW(s) ;
16141 s^[1] := 1 ;
16142 @end smallexample
16143
16144 @noindent
16145 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16146
16147 @smallexample
16148 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16149 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16150 @end smallexample
16151
16152 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16153 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16154 types:
16155
16156 @smallexample
16157 TYPE
16158 foo = RECORD
16159 f1: CARDINAL ;
16160 f2: CHAR ;
16161 f3: myarray ;
16162 END ;
16163
16164 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16165 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16166 VAR
16167 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16168 @end smallexample
16169
16170 @noindent
16171 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16172 below.
16173
16174 @smallexample
16175 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16176 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16177 f1 : CARDINAL;
16178 f2 : CHAR;
16179 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16180 END
16181 @end smallexample
16182
16183 @node M2 Defaults
16184 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16185 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16186
16187 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16188 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16189 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16190 selected the working language.
16191
16192 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16193 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16194 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16195 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16196
16197 @node Deviations
16198 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16199 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16200
16201 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16202 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16203
16204 @itemize @bullet
16205 @item
16206 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16207 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16208 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16209 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16210 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16211 returned a pointer.)
16212
16213 @item
16214 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16215 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16216 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16217 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16218
16219 @item
16220 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16221 argument.
16222
16223 @item
16224 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16225 @end itemize
16226
16227 @node M2 Checks
16228 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16229 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16230
16231 @quotation
16232 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16233 range checking.
16234 @end quotation
16235 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16236
16237 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16238
16239 @itemize @bullet
16240 @item
16241 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16242 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16243
16244 @item
16245 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16246 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16247 @end itemize
16248
16249 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16250 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16251
16252 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16253 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16254
16255 @node M2 Scope
16256 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16257 @cindex scope
16258 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16259 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16260 @ifinfo
16261 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16262 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16263 @end ifinfo
16264 @ifnotinfo
16265 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16266 @end ifnotinfo
16267
16268 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16269 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16270 similar syntax:
16271
16272 @smallexample
16273
16274 @var{module} . @var{id}
16275 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16276 @end smallexample
16277
16278 @noindent
16279 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16280 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16281 identifier within your program, except another module.
16282
16283 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16284 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16285 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16286 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16287
16288 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16289 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16290 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16291 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16292 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16293 @var{module}.
16294
16295 @node GDB/M2
16296 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16297
16298 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16299 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16300 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16301 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16302 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16303 analogue in Modula-2.
16304
16305 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16306 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16307 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16308 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16309 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16310 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16311
16312 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16313 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16314 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16315
16316 @node Ada
16317 @subsection Ada
16318 @cindex Ada
16319
16320 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16321 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16322 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16323 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16324 to be difficult.
16325
16326
16327 @cindex expressions in Ada
16328 @menu
16329 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16330 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16331 in @value{GDBN}.
16332 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16333 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16334 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16335 subprograms.
16336 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16337 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16338 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16339 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16340 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16341 Profile
16342 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16343 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16344 @end menu
16345
16346 @node Ada Mode Intro
16347 @subsubsection Introduction
16348 @cindex Ada mode, general
16349
16350 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16351 syntax, with some extensions.
16352 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16353
16354 @itemize @bullet
16355 @item
16356 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16357 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16358 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16359 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16360
16361 @item
16362 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16363 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16364
16365 @item
16366 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16367 @end itemize
16368
16369 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16370 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16371 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16372 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16373 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16374
16375 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16376 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16377 was translated from an Ada source file.
16378
16379 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16380 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16381 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16382 middle (to allow based literals).
16383
16384 @node Omissions from Ada
16385 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16386 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16387
16388 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16389
16390 @itemize @bullet
16391 @item
16392 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16393
16394 @itemize @minus
16395 @item
16396 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16397 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16398
16399 @item
16400 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16401
16402 @item
16403 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16404
16405 @item
16406 @t{'Tag}.
16407
16408 @item
16409 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16410 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16411
16412 @item
16413 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16414 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16415
16416 @item
16417 @t{'Address}.
16418 @end itemize
16419
16420 @item
16421 The names in
16422 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16423 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16424 not currently available.
16425
16426 @item
16427 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16428 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16429 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16430 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16431 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16432 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16433 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16434 indeterminate values.
16435
16436 @item
16437 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16438 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16439 are not implemented.
16440
16441 @item
16442 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16443 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16444 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16445 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16446 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16447
16448 @smallexample
16449 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16450 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16451 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16452 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16453 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16454 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 Changing a
16458 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16459 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16460 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16461 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16462 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16463 declared to have a type such as:
16464
16465 @smallexample
16466 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16467 Id : Integer;
16468 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16469 end record;
16470 @end smallexample
16471
16472 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16473 assignments:
16474
16475 @smallexample
16476 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16477 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16478 @end smallexample
16479
16480 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16481 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16482 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16483 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16484 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16485 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16486 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16487 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16488
16489 @item
16490 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16491
16492 @item
16493 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16494 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16495 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16496 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16497 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16498 the proper resolution.
16499
16500 @item
16501 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16502
16503 @item
16504 Entry calls are not implemented.
16505
16506 @item
16507 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16508 formats are not supported.
16509
16510 @item
16511 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16512
16513 @item
16514 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16515 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16516 context.
16517 Should your program
16518 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16519 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16520 @end itemize
16521
16522 @node Additions to Ada
16523 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16524 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16525
16526 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16527 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16528
16529 @itemize @bullet
16530 @item
16531 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16532 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16533 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16534 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16535 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16536 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16537 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16538 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16539
16540 @item
16541 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16542 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16543 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16544
16545 @item
16546 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16547 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16548
16549 @item
16550 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16551 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16552 @end itemize
16553
16554 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16555 additions specific to Ada:
16556
16557 @itemize @bullet
16558 @item
16559 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16560 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16561
16562 @smallexample
16563 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16564 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16565 @end smallexample
16566
16567 @item
16568 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16569 the value of its right-hand operand.
16570 This allows, for example,
16571 complex conditional breaks:
16572
16573 @smallexample
16574 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16575 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16576 @end smallexample
16577
16578 @item
16579 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16580 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16581 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16582 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16583 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16584 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16585 in strings. For example,
16586 @smallexample
16587 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16588 @end smallexample
16589 @noindent
16590 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16591 after each period.
16592
16593 @item
16594 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16595 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16596 to write
16597
16598 @smallexample
16599 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16600 @end smallexample
16601
16602 @item
16603 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16604 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16605 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16606 of 3 might print as
16607
16608 @smallexample
16609 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16610 @end smallexample
16611
16612 @noindent
16613 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16614 clause.
16615
16616 @item
16617 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16618 multi-character subsequence of
16619 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16620 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16621 in place of @t{a'length}.
16622
16623 @item
16624 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16625 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16626 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16627 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16628 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16629 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16630 For example,
16631 @smallexample
16632 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16633 @end smallexample
16634
16635 @item
16636 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16637 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16638 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16639 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16640 object.
16641
16642 @end itemize
16643
16644 @node Overloading support for Ada
16645 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16646 @cindex overloading, Ada
16647
16648 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16649 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16650 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16651 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16652 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16653 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16654
16655 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16656 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16657 use, for instance:
16658
16659 @smallexample
16660 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16661 Multiple matches for f
16662 [0] cancel
16663 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16664 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16665 >
16666 @end smallexample
16667
16668 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16669 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16670 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16671
16672 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16673 case:
16674
16675 @table @code
16676
16677 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16678 @item set ada print-signatures
16679 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16680 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16681 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16682
16683 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16684 @item show ada print-signatures
16685 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16686 overloads selection menu.
16687 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16688
16689 @end table
16690
16691 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16692 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16693
16694 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16695 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16696 before reaching the main procedure.
16697 As defined in the Ada Reference
16698 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16699 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16700 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16701 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16702
16703 @node Ada Exceptions
16704 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16705
16706 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16707
16708 @table @code
16709 @kindex info exceptions
16710 @item info exceptions
16711 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16712 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16713 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16714 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16715 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16716 @end table
16717
16718 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16719 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16720 argument.
16721
16722 @smallexample
16723 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16724 All defined Ada exceptions:
16725 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16726 program_error: 0x613d20
16727 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16728 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16729 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16730 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16731 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16732 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16733 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16734 @end smallexample
16735
16736 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16737 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16738
16739 @node Ada Tasks
16740 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16741 @cindex Ada, tasking
16742
16743 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16744 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16745
16746 @table @code
16747 @kindex info tasks
16748 @item info tasks
16749 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16750
16751
16752 @smallexample
16753 @iftex
16754 @leftskip=0.5cm
16755 @end iftex
16756 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16757 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16758 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16759 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16760 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16761 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16762
16763 @end smallexample
16764
16765 @noindent
16766 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16767 task currently being inspected.
16768
16769 @table @asis
16770 @item ID
16771 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16772
16773 @item TID
16774 The Ada task ID.
16775
16776 @item P-ID
16777 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16778
16779 @item Pri
16780 The base priority of the task.
16781
16782 @item State
16783 Current state of the task.
16784
16785 @table @code
16786 @item Unactivated
16787 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16788 executing.
16789
16790 @item Runnable
16791 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16792 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16793
16794 @item Terminated
16795 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16796 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16797 terminated themselves.
16798
16799 @item Child Activation Wait
16800 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16801
16802 @item Accept Statement
16803 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16804
16805 @item Waiting on entry call
16806 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16807
16808 @item Async Select Wait
16809 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16810 select statement.
16811
16812 @item Delay Sleep
16813 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16814 alternative open.
16815
16816 @item Child Termination Wait
16817 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16818 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16819 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16820
16821 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16822 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16823 finish terminating.
16824
16825 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16826 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16827 @end table
16828
16829 @item Name
16830 Name of the task in the program.
16831
16832 @end table
16833
16834 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16835 @item info task @var{taskno}
16836 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16837 the following example:
16838 @smallexample
16839 @iftex
16840 @leftskip=0.5cm
16841 @end iftex
16842 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16843 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16844 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16845 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16846 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16847 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16848 Name: task_1
16849 Thread: 0x807f378
16850 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16851 Base Priority: 15
16852 State: Runnable
16853 @end smallexample
16854
16855 @item task
16856 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16857 @cindex current Ada task ID
16858 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16859
16860 @smallexample
16861 @iftex
16862 @leftskip=0.5cm
16863 @end iftex
16864 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16865 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16866 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16867 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16868 (@value{GDBP}) task
16869 [Current task is 2]
16870 @end smallexample
16871
16872 @item task @var{taskno}
16873 @cindex Ada task switching
16874 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16875 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16876 from the current task to the given task.
16877
16878 @smallexample
16879 @iftex
16880 @leftskip=0.5cm
16881 @end iftex
16882 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16883 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16884 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16885 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16886 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16887 [Switching to task 1]
16888 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16889 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16890 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16891 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16892 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16893 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16894 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16895 @end smallexample
16896
16897 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16898 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16899 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16900 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16901 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16902 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16903 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16904 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16905 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16906
16907 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16908 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16909 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16910 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16911 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16912
16913 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16914 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16915 program.
16916
16917 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16918 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16919 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16920
16921 For example,
16922
16923 @smallexample
16924 @iftex
16925 @leftskip=0.5cm
16926 @end iftex
16927 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16928 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16929 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16930 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16931 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16932 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16933 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16934 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16935 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16936 Continuing.
16937 task # 1 running
16938 task # 2 running
16939
16940 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16941 15 flush;
16942 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16943 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16944 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16945 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16946 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16947 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16948 @end smallexample
16949 @end table
16950
16951 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16952 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16953 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16954
16955 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16956 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16957 the platform being used.
16958 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16959 switching is not supported.
16960
16961 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16962 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16963 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16964 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16965 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16966 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16967
16968 @node Ravenscar Profile
16969 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16970 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16971
16972 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16973 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16974 requirements.
16975
16976 @table @code
16977 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16978 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16979 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16980 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16981 Profile. This is the default.
16982
16983 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16984 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16985 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16986 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16987 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16988 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16989 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16990
16991 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16992 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16993 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16994 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16995
16996 @end table
16997
16998 @node Ada Settings
16999 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17000 @cindex Ada settings
17001
17002 @table @code
17003 @kindex set varsize-limit
17004 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17005 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17006 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17007 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17008 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17009 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17010 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17011
17012 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17013 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17014 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17015 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17016 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17017 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17018 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17019 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17020 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17021 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17022 size is less than @var{size}.
17023
17024 @kindex show varsize-limit
17025 @item show varsize-limit
17026 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17027 @end table
17028
17029 @node Ada Glitches
17030 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17031 @cindex Ada, problems
17032
17033 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17034 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17035 @value{GDBN},
17036 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17037 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17038
17039 @itemize @bullet
17040 @item
17041 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17042 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17043
17044 @item
17045 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17046 argument lists are treated as positional).
17047
17048 @item
17049 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17050
17051 @item
17052 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17053 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17054 the host machine.
17055
17056 @item
17057 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17058 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17059 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17060 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17061 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17062 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17063 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17064 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17065 you can usually resolve the confusion
17066 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17067 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17068 @end itemize
17069
17070 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17071 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17072 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17073 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17074 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17075 enabled.
17076
17077 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17078 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17079 @table @code
17080
17081 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17082 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17083 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17084 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17085 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17086 This is the default.
17087
17088 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17089 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17090 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17091 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17092 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17093 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17094 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17095
17096 @end table
17097
17098 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17099 @cindex GNAT encoding
17100 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17101 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17102 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17103 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17104 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17105 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17106
17107 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17108 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17109 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17110 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17111 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17112 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17113 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17114 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17115
17116 @table @code
17117
17118 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17119 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17120 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17121 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17122
17123 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17124 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17125 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17126
17127 @end table
17128
17129 @node Unsupported Languages
17130 @section Unsupported Languages
17131
17132 @cindex unsupported languages
17133 @cindex minimal language
17134 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17135 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17136 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17137 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17138 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17139 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17140
17141 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17142 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17143 language.
17144
17145 @node Symbols
17146 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17147
17148 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17149 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17150 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17151 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17152 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17153 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17154 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17155
17156 @cindex symbol names
17157 @cindex names of symbols
17158 @cindex quoting names
17159 @anchor{quoting names}
17160 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17161 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17162 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17163 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17164 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17165 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17166 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17167 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17168
17169 @smallexample
17170 p 'foo.c'::x
17171 @end smallexample
17172
17173 @noindent
17174 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17175
17176 @table @code
17177 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17178 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17179 @kindex set case-sensitive
17180 @item set case-sensitive on
17181 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17182 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17183 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17184 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17185 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17186 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17187 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17188 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17189 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17190 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17191 case-insensitive matches.
17192
17193 @kindex show case-sensitive
17194 @item show case-sensitive
17195 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17196 lookups.
17197
17198 @kindex set print type methods
17199 @item set print type methods
17200 @itemx set print type methods on
17201 @itemx set print type methods off
17202 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17203 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17204 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17205 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17206 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17207 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17208
17209 @kindex show print type methods
17210 @item show print type methods
17211 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17212 classes.
17213
17214 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17215 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17216 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17217 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17218 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17219 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17220 types defined in classes.
17221
17222 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17223 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17224 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17225 printing classes.
17226
17227 @kindex set print type typedefs
17228 @item set print type typedefs
17229 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17230 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17231
17232 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17233 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17234 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17235 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17236 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17237 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17238 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17239 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17240 types.
17241
17242 @kindex show print type typedefs
17243 @item show print type typedefs
17244 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17245 printing classes.
17246
17247 @kindex info address
17248 @cindex address of a symbol
17249 @item info address @var{symbol}
17250 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17251 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17252 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17253 is always stored.
17254
17255 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17256 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17257 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17258
17259 @kindex info symbol
17260 @cindex symbol from address
17261 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17262 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17263 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17264 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17265 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17266
17267 @smallexample
17268 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17269 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17270 @end smallexample
17271
17272 @noindent
17273 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17274 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17275
17276 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17277 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17278
17279 @smallexample
17280 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17281 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17282 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17283 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17284 @end smallexample
17285
17286 @kindex demangle
17287 @cindex demangle
17288 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17289 Demangle @var{name}.
17290 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17291 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17292
17293 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17294 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17295
17296 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17297 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17298
17299 @kindex whatis
17300 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17301 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17302 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17303 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17304
17305 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17306 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17307 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17308
17309 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17310 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17311 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17312 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17313 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17314 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17315 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17316 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17317 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17318
17319 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17320 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17321 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17322 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17323 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17324 unroll it.
17325
17326 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17327 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17328 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17329
17330 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17331 Available flags are:
17332
17333 @table @code
17334 @item r
17335 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17336 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17337 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17338
17339 @item m
17340 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17341
17342 @item M
17343 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17344 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17345
17346 @item t
17347 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17348 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17349 names are substituted when printing other types.
17350
17351 @item T
17352 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17353 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17354
17355 @item o
17356 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17357 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17358
17359 For example, given the following declarations:
17360
17361 @smallexample
17362 struct tuv
17363 @{
17364 int a1;
17365 char *a2;
17366 int a3;
17367 @};
17368
17369 struct xyz
17370 @{
17371 int f1;
17372 char f2;
17373 void *f3;
17374 struct tuv f4;
17375 @};
17376
17377 union qwe
17378 @{
17379 struct tuv fff1;
17380 struct xyz fff2;
17381 @};
17382
17383 struct tyu
17384 @{
17385 int a1 : 1;
17386 int a2 : 3;
17387 int a3 : 23;
17388 char a4 : 2;
17389 int64_t a5;
17390 int a6 : 5;
17391 int64_t a7 : 3;
17392 @};
17393 @end smallexample
17394
17395 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17396
17397 @smallexample
17398 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17399 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17400 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17401 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17402 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17403 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17404
17405 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17406 @}
17407 @end smallexample
17408
17409 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17410 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17411 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17412 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17413 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17414 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17415 its fields.
17416
17417 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17418
17419 @smallexample
17420 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17421 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17422 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17423 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17424 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17425 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17426 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17427
17428 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17429 @} fff1;
17430 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17431 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17432 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17433 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17434 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17435 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17436 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17437 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17438 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17439 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17440
17441 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17442 @} f4;
17443
17444 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17445 @} fff2;
17446
17447 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17448 @}
17449 @end smallexample
17450
17451 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17452 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17453 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17454 of these structures' fields.
17455
17456 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17457 bitfields:
17458
17459 @smallexample
17460 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17461 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17462 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17463 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17464 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17465 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17466 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17467 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17468 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17469 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17470 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17471
17472 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17473 @}
17474 @end smallexample
17475
17476 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17477 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17478 @end table
17479
17480 @kindex ptype
17481 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17482 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17483 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17484 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17485
17486 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17487 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17488 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17489 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17490 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17491 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17492 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17493 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17494
17495 For example, for this variable declaration:
17496
17497 @smallexample
17498 typedef double real_t;
17499 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17500 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17501 complex_t var;
17502 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17503 @end smallexample
17504
17505 @noindent
17506 the two commands give this output:
17507
17508 @smallexample
17509 @group
17510 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17511 type = complex_t
17512 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17513 type = struct complex @{
17514 real_t real;
17515 double imag;
17516 @}
17517 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17518 type = struct complex
17519 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17520 type = struct complex
17521 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17522 type = struct complex @{
17523 real_t real;
17524 double imag;
17525 @}
17526 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17527 type = real_t *
17528 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17529 type = double *
17530 @end group
17531 @end smallexample
17532
17533 @noindent
17534 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17535 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17536
17537 @cindex incomplete type
17538 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17539 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17540 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17541 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17542 given these declarations:
17543
17544 @smallexample
17545 struct foo;
17546 struct foo *fooptr;
17547 @end smallexample
17548
17549 @noindent
17550 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17551
17552 @smallexample
17553 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17554 $1 = <incomplete type>
17555 @end smallexample
17556
17557 @noindent
17558 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17559 completely specified.
17560
17561 @cindex unknown type
17562 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17563 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17564 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17565 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17566 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17567 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17568 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17569 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17570
17571 @smallexample
17572 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17573 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17574 @end smallexample
17575
17576 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17577 of such variables.
17578
17579 @kindex info types
17580 @item info types @var{regexp}
17581 @itemx info types
17582 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17583 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17584 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17585 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17586 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17587 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17588 name is @code{value}.
17589
17590 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17591 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17592 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17593
17594 @kindex info type-printers
17595 @item info type-printers
17596 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17597 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17598 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17599 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17600 type printers.
17601
17602 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17603
17604 @kindex enable type-printer
17605 @kindex disable type-printer
17606 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17607 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17608 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17609
17610 @kindex info scope
17611 @cindex local variables
17612 @item info scope @var{location}
17613 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17614 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17615 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17616 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17617 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17618
17619 @smallexample
17620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17621 Scope for command_line_handler:
17622 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17623 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17624 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17625 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17626 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17627 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17628 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17629 @end smallexample
17630
17631 @noindent
17632 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17633 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17634 collect}.
17635
17636 @kindex info source
17637 @item info source
17638 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17639 the function containing the current point of execution:
17640 @itemize @bullet
17641 @item
17642 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17643 @item
17644 the directory it was compiled in,
17645 @item
17646 its length, in lines,
17647 @item
17648 which programming language it is written in,
17649 @item
17650 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17651 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17652 @item
17653 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17654 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17655 @item
17656 whether the debugging information includes information about
17657 preprocessor macros.
17658 @end itemize
17659
17660
17661 @kindex info sources
17662 @item info sources
17663 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17664 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17665 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17666
17667 @kindex info functions
17668 @item info functions
17669 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17670 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17671 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17672 number.
17673
17674 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17675 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17676 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17677 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17678 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17679 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17680 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17681 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17682
17683 @kindex info variables
17684 @item info variables
17685 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17686 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17687 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17688 their respective source line numbers.
17689
17690 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17691 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17692 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17693 @var{regexp}.
17694
17695 @kindex info classes
17696 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17697 @item info classes
17698 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17699 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17700 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17701 expression.
17702
17703 @kindex info selectors
17704 @item info selectors
17705 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17706 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17707 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17708 expression.
17709
17710 @ignore
17711 This was never implemented.
17712 @kindex info methods
17713 @item info methods
17714 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17715 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17716 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17717 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17718 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17719 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17720 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17721 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17722 @end ignore
17723
17724 @cindex opaque data types
17725 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17726 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17727 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17728 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17729 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17730 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17731 another source file. The default is on.
17732
17733 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17734 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17735
17736 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17737 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17738 is printed as follows:
17739 @smallexample
17740 @{<no data fields>@}
17741 @end smallexample
17742
17743 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17744 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17745 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17746
17747 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17748 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17749 @item set print symbol-loading
17750 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17751 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17752 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17753 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17754 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17755 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17756 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17757 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17758 can be annoying.
17759 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17760 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17761 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17762 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17763
17764 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17765 @item show print symbol-loading
17766 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17767 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17768
17769 @kindex maint print symbols
17770 @cindex symbol dump
17771 @kindex maint print psymbols
17772 @cindex partial symbol dump
17773 @kindex maint print msymbols
17774 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17775 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17776 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17777 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17778 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17779 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17780 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17781 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17782 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17783 that objfile.
17784 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17785 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17786 @code{main}.
17787 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17788 source file.
17789
17790 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17791 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17792 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17793 tables.
17794 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17795 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17796 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17797 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17798 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17799 ``ELF symbols''.
17800
17801 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17802 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17803
17804 @kindex maint info symtabs
17805 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17806 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17807 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17808 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17809 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17810 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17811 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17812
17813 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17814 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17815 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17816 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17817 structure in more detail. For example:
17818
17819 @smallexample
17820 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17821 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17822 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17823 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17824 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17825 readin no
17826 fullname (null)
17827 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17828 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17829 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17830 dependencies (none)
17831 @}
17832 @}
17833 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17834 (@value{GDBP})
17835 @end smallexample
17836 @noindent
17837 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17838 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17839 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17840 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17841 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17842
17843 @smallexample
17844 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17845 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17846 line 1574.
17847 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17848 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17849 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17850 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17851 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17852 dirname (null)
17853 fullname (null)
17854 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17855 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17856 debugformat DWARF 2
17857 @}
17858 @}
17859 (@value{GDBP})
17860 @end smallexample
17861
17862 @kindex maint info line-table
17863 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17864 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17865 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17866
17867 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17868 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17869 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17870
17871 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17872 @cindex symbol cache size
17873 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17874 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17875 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17876 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17877 with different sizes.
17878
17879 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17880 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17881 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17882
17883 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17884 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17885 @item maint print symbol-cache
17886 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17887 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17888
17889 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17890 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17891 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17892 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17893 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17894
17895 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17896 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17897 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17898 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17899 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17900 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17901
17902 @end table
17903
17904 @node Altering
17905 @chapter Altering Execution
17906
17907 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17908 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17909 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17910 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17911 program.
17912
17913 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17914 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17915 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17916
17917 @menu
17918 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17919 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17920 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17921 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17922 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17923 * Patching:: Patching your program
17924 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17925 @end menu
17926
17927 @node Assignment
17928 @section Assignment to Variables
17929
17930 @cindex assignment
17931 @cindex setting variables
17932 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17933 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17934
17935 @smallexample
17936 print x=4
17937 @end smallexample
17938
17939 @noindent
17940 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17941 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17942 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17943 information on operators in supported languages.
17944
17945 @kindex set variable
17946 @cindex variables, setting
17947 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17948 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17949 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17950 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17951 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17952
17953 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17954 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17955 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17956 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17957 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17958 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17959 command @code{set width}:
17960
17961 @smallexample
17962 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17963 type = double
17964 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17965 $4 = 13
17966 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17967 Invalid syntax in expression.
17968 @end smallexample
17969
17970 @noindent
17971 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17972 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17973
17974 @smallexample
17975 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17976 @end smallexample
17977
17978 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17979 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17980 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17981 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17982 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17983 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17984
17985 @smallexample
17986 @group
17987 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17988 type = double
17989 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17990 $1 = 1
17991 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17992 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17993 $2 = 1
17994 (@value{GDBP}) r
17995 The program being debugged has been started already.
17996 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17997 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17998 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17999 Invalid bfd target.
18000 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18001 The current BFD target is "=4".
18002 @end group
18003 @end smallexample
18004
18005 @noindent
18006 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18007 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18008 @code{g}, use
18009
18010 @smallexample
18011 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18012 @end smallexample
18013
18014 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18015 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18016 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18017 same length or shorter.
18018 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18019 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18020
18021 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18022 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18023 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18024 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18025 and representation in memory), and
18026
18027 @smallexample
18028 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18029 @end smallexample
18030
18031 @noindent
18032 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18033
18034 @node Jumping
18035 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18036
18037 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18038 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18039 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18040
18041 @table @code
18042 @kindex jump
18043 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18044 @item jump @var{location}
18045 @itemx j @var{location}
18046 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18047 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18048 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18049 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18050 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18051
18052 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18053 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18054 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18055 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18056 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18057 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18058 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18059 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18060 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18061 @end table
18062
18063 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18064 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18065 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18066 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18067 example,
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 set $pc = 0x485
18071 @end smallexample
18072
18073 @noindent
18074 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18075 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18076 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18077
18078 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18079 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18080 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18081 detail.
18082
18083 @c @group
18084 @node Signaling
18085 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18086 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18087
18088 @table @code
18089 @kindex signal
18090 @item signal @var{signal}
18091 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18092 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18093 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18094 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18095
18096 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18097 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18098 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18099 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18100 signal.
18101
18102 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18103 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18104 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18105 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18106 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18107 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18108 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18109 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18110
18111 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18112 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18113 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18114 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18115 passes the signal directly to your program.
18116
18117 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18118 after executing the command.
18119
18120 @kindex queue-signal
18121 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18122 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18123 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18124 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18125 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18126 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18127 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18128 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18129 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18130
18131 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18132 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18133 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18134 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18135 @code{continue} command.
18136
18137 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18138 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18139 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18140 (@pxref{Signals}).
18141 @end table
18142 @c @end group
18143
18144 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18145 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18146
18147 @node Returning
18148 @section Returning from a Function
18149
18150 @table @code
18151 @cindex returning from a function
18152 @kindex return
18153 @item return
18154 @itemx return @var{expression}
18155 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18156 command. If you give an
18157 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18158 value.
18159 @end table
18160
18161 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18162 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18163 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18164 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18165
18166 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18167 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18168 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18169 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18170 of functions.
18171
18172 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18173 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18174 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18175 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18176 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18177
18178 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18179 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18180 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18181 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18182 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18183 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18184 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18185 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18186 assignment into the right register(s).
18187
18188 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18189 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18190 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18191 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18192 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18193 into a @code{long long int}:
18194
18195 @smallexample
18196 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18197 29 return 31;
18198 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18199 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18200 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18201 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18202 (@value{GDBP})
18203 @end smallexample
18204
18205 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18206 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18207 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18208 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18209 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18210 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18211 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18212 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18213
18214 @smallexample
18215 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18216 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18217 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18218 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18219 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18220 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18221 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18222 (@value{GDBP})
18223 @end smallexample
18224
18225 @node Calling
18226 @section Calling Program Functions
18227
18228 @table @code
18229 @cindex calling functions
18230 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18231 @item print @var{expr}
18232 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18233 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18234 debugged.
18235
18236 @kindex call
18237 @item call @var{expr}
18238 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18239 returned values.
18240
18241 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18242 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18243 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18244 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18245 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18246 value history.
18247 @end table
18248
18249 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18250 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18251 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18252 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18253
18254 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18255 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18256 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18257 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18258 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18259 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18260 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18261 in that case is controlled by the
18262 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18263
18264 @table @code
18265 @item set unwindonsignal
18266 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18267 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18268 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18269 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18270 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18271 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18272 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18273 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18274 received.
18275
18276 @item show unwindonsignal
18277 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18278 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18279 @value{GDBN}.
18280
18281 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18282 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18283 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18284 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18285 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18286 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18287 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18288 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18289 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18290 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18291
18292 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18293 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18294 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18295 @value{GDBN}.
18296
18297 @end table
18298
18299 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18300
18301 @cindex no debug info functions
18302 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18303 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18304 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18305 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18306 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18307 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18308
18309 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18310 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18311 declared return type. For example:
18312
18313 @smallexample
18314 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18315 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18316 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18317 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18318 @end smallexample
18319
18320 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18321 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18322 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18323 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18324
18325 @smallexample
18326 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18327 @end smallexample
18328
18329 @noindent
18330 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18331
18332 @smallexample
18333 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18334 @end smallexample
18335
18336 @noindent
18337 these calls are equivalent:
18338
18339 @smallexample
18340 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18341 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18342 @end smallexample
18343
18344 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18345 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18346 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18347 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18348 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18349 float parameters, and no debug info:
18350
18351 @smallexample
18352 float
18353 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18354 float v1, v2;
18355 @{
18356 return v1 * v2;
18357 @}
18358 @end smallexample
18359
18360 @noindent
18361 you call it like this:
18362
18363 @smallexample
18364 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18365 @end smallexample
18366
18367 @node Patching
18368 @section Patching Programs
18369
18370 @cindex patching binaries
18371 @cindex writing into executables
18372 @cindex writing into corefiles
18373
18374 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18375 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18376 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18377 patching your program's binary.
18378
18379 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18380 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18381 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18382 repairs.
18383
18384 @table @code
18385 @kindex set write
18386 @item set write on
18387 @itemx set write off
18388 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18389 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18390 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18391
18392 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18393 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18394 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18395
18396 @item show write
18397 @kindex show write
18398 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18399 as well as reading.
18400 @end table
18401
18402 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18403 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18404 @cindex injecting code
18405 @cindex writing into executables
18406 @cindex compiling code
18407
18408 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18409 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18410 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18411 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18412
18413 @table @code
18414 @kindex compile code
18415 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18416 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18417 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18418 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18419 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18420 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18421 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18422 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18423 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18424 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18425 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18426 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18427
18428 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18429 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18430 E.g.:
18431
18432 @smallexample
18433 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18434 @end smallexample
18435
18436 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18437 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18438 from actual source code. E.g.:
18439
18440 @smallexample
18441 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18442 @end smallexample
18443
18444 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18445 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18446 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18447 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18448 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18449 editor.
18450
18451 @smallexample
18452 compile code
18453 >printf ("hello\n");
18454 >printf ("world\n");
18455 >end
18456 @end smallexample
18457
18458 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18459 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18460 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18461 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18462 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18463 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18464 inferior symbols otherwise.
18465
18466 @kindex compile file
18467 @item compile file @var{filename}
18468 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18469 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18470
18471 @smallexample
18472 compile file /home/user/example.c
18473 @end smallexample
18474 @end table
18475
18476 @table @code
18477 @item compile print @var{expr}
18478 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18479 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18480 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18481 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18482 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18483 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18484 Formats}.
18485
18486 @item compile print
18487 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18488 @cindex reprint the last value
18489 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18490 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18491 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18492 multiple-line editor.
18493 @end table
18494
18495 @noindent
18496 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18497
18498 @table @code
18499 @anchor{set debug compile}
18500 @item set debug compile
18501 @cindex compile command debugging info
18502 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18503 injecting the code. The default is off.
18504
18505 @item show debug compile
18506 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18507 compiling and injecting the code.
18508 @end table
18509
18510 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18511
18512 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18513 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18514 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18515 injecting process.
18516
18517 @noindent
18518 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18519
18520 @table @asis
18521 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18522 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18523 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18524 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18525
18526 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18527 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18528 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18529 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18530 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18531 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18532 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18533 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18534
18535 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18536 @end table
18537
18538 @noindent
18539 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18540
18541 @table @code
18542 @item set compile-args
18543 @cindex compile command options override
18544 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18545 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18546 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18547 compilation.
18548
18549 @item show compile-args
18550 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18551 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18552 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18553 @end table
18554
18555 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18556
18557 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18558 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18559 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18560
18561 @table @asis
18562 @item C code examples and caveats
18563 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18564 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18565 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18566 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18567 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18568
18569 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18570 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18571 much like any other normal debugging session.
18572
18573 @smallexample
18574 void function1 (void)
18575 @{
18576 int i = 42;
18577 printf ("function 1\n");
18578 @}
18579
18580 void function2 (void)
18581 @{
18582 int j = 12;
18583 function1 ();
18584 @}
18585
18586 int main(void)
18587 @{
18588 int k = 6;
18589 int *p;
18590 function2 ();
18591 return 0;
18592 @}
18593 @end smallexample
18594
18595 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18596 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18597 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18598
18599 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18600 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18601 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18602 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18603 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18604
18605 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18606 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18607 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18608 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18609 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18610 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18611 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18612 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18613 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18614 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18615
18616 @smallexample
18617 compile code k = 3;
18618 @end smallexample
18619
18620 @noindent
18621 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18622 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18623 @code{compile} command changes it.
18624
18625 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18626 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18627 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18628 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18629 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18630
18631 @smallexample
18632 compile code j = 3;
18633 @end smallexample
18634
18635 @noindent
18636 will result in a compilation error message.
18637
18638 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18639 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18640 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18641
18642 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18643 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18644 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18645 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18646
18647 @smallexample
18648 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18649 @end smallexample
18650
18651 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18652 command has completed:
18653
18654 @smallexample
18655 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18656 @end smallexample
18657
18658 @noindent
18659 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18660 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18661 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18662 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18663 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18664
18665 @smallexample
18666 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18667 @end smallexample
18668
18669 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18670 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18671 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18672 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18673 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18674 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18675 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18676 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18677
18678 @smallexample
18679 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18680 @end smallexample
18681
18682 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18683 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18684 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18685 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18686 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18687 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18688 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18689
18690 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18691 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18692 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18693 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18694 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18695 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18696
18697 @smallexample
18698 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18699 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18700 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18701 Compilation failed.
18702 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18703 42
18704 @end smallexample
18705
18706 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18707 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18708 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18709 will print to the console.
18710 @end table
18711
18712 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18713
18714 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18715 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18716 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18717 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18718 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18719 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18720 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18721 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18722
18723
18724 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18725 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18726 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18727 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18728 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18729 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18730 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18731
18732 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18733 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18734 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18735 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18736 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18737 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18738 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18739
18740 @table @code
18741 @item set compile-gcc
18742 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18743 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18744 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18745 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18746 default.
18747
18748 @item show compile-gcc
18749 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18750 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18751 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18752 @end table
18753
18754 @node GDB Files
18755 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18756
18757 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18758 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18759 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18760 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18761
18762 @menu
18763 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18764 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18765 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18766 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18767 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18768 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18769 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18770 @end menu
18771
18772 @node Files
18773 @section Commands to Specify Files
18774
18775 @cindex symbol table
18776 @cindex core dump file
18777
18778 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18779 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18780 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18781 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18782
18783 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18784 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18785 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18786 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18787 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18788 new files are useful.
18789
18790 @table @code
18791 @cindex executable file
18792 @kindex file
18793 @item file @var{filename}
18794 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18795 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18796 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18797 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18798 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18799 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18800 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18801 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18802
18803 @cindex unlinked object files
18804 @cindex patching object files
18805 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18806 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18807 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18808 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18809 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18810 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18811 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18812 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18813
18814 @item file
18815 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18816 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18817
18818 @kindex exec-file
18819 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18820 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18821 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18822 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18823 discard information on the executable file.
18824
18825 @kindex symbol-file
18826 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18827 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18828 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18829 table and program to run from the same file.
18830
18831 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18832 program's symbol table.
18833
18834 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18835 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18836 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18837 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18838 @value{GDBN}.
18839
18840 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18841 executing it once.
18842
18843 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18844 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18845 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18846 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18847 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18848 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18849 optimized code.
18850
18851 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18852 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18853 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18854 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18855 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18856
18857 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18858 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18859 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18860 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18861 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18862 Warnings and Messages}.)
18863
18864 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18865 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18866 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18867 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18868 in stabs format.
18869
18870 @kindex readnow
18871 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18872 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18873 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18874 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18875 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18876 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18877 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18878 entire symbol table available.
18879
18880 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
18881 @cindex never read symbols
18882 @cindex symbols, never read
18883 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18884 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18885 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
18886 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
18887 @xref{--readnever}.
18888
18889 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18890 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18891 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18892 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18893 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18894 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18895 @c files.
18896
18897 @kindex core-file
18898 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18899 @itemx core
18900 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18901 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18902 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18903 executable file itself for other parts.
18904
18905 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18906 to be used.
18907
18908 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18909 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18910 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18911 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18912 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18913
18914 @kindex add-symbol-file
18915 @cindex dynamic linking
18916 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18917 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]}
18918 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18919 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18920 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18921 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18922 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18923 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18924 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18925 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18926 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18927 @var{address} as an expression.
18928
18929 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18930 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18931 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18932 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18933
18934 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18935
18936 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18937 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18938 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18939 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18940 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18941 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18942 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18943 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18944 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18945
18946 @itemize @bullet
18947 @item
18948 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18949 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18950 @item
18951 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18952 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18953 @item
18954 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18955 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18956 @end itemize
18957
18958 @noindent
18959 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18960 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18961 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18962 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18963 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18964 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18965 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18966 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18967 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18968 way.
18969
18970 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18971
18972 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18973 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18974 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18975 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18976 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18977 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18978
18979 @smallexample
18980 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18981 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18982 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18983 (y or n) y
18984 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18985 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18986 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18987 (gdb)
18988 @end smallexample
18989
18990
18991 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18992
18993 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18994 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18995 @cindex load symbols from memory
18996 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18997 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18998 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18999 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19000 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19001 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19002 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19003 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19004 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19005
19006 @kindex section
19007 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19008 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19009 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19010 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19011 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19012 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19013 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19014 their addresses.
19015
19016 @kindex info files
19017 @kindex info target
19018 @item info files
19019 @itemx info target
19020 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19021 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19022 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19023 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19024 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19025 current ones.
19026
19027 @kindex maint info sections
19028 @item maint info sections
19029 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19030 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19031 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19032 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19033 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19034 may be arbitrarily combined):
19035
19036 @table @code
19037 @item ALLOBJ
19038 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19039 @item @var{sections}
19040 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19041 @item @var{section-flags}
19042 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19043 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19044 @table @code
19045 @item ALLOC
19046 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19047 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19048 @item LOAD
19049 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19050 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19051 @item RELOC
19052 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19053 @item READONLY
19054 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19055 @item CODE
19056 Section contains executable code only.
19057 @item DATA
19058 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19059 @item ROM
19060 Section will reside in ROM.
19061 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19062 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19063 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19064 Section is not empty.
19065 @item NEVER_LOAD
19066 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19067 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19068 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19069 COFF shared library information.
19070 @item IS_COMMON
19071 Section contains common symbols.
19072 @end table
19073 @end table
19074 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19075 @cindex read-only sections
19076 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19077 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19078 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19079 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19080 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19081 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19082 enhancement to debugging performance.
19083
19084 The default is off.
19085
19086 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19087 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19088 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19089 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19090
19091 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19092 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19093 @end table
19094
19095 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19096 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19097 name and remembers it that way.
19098
19099 @cindex shared libraries
19100 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19101 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19102 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19103 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19104
19105 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19106 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19107
19108 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19109 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19110 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19111 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19112 debugging a core file).
19113
19114 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19115 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19116 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19117
19118 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19119 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19120 particularly large or there are many of them.
19121
19122 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19123 commands:
19124
19125 @table @code
19126 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19127 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19128 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19129 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19130 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19131 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19132 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19133 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19134
19135 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19136 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19137 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19138 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19139 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19140 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19141 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19142 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19143 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19144
19145 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19146 @item show auto-solib-add
19147 Display the current autoloading mode.
19148 @end table
19149
19150 @cindex load shared library
19151 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19152 command:
19153
19154 @table @code
19155 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19156 @kindex info share
19157 @item info share @var{regex}
19158 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19159 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19160 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19161 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19162
19163 @kindex info dll
19164 @item info dll @var{regex}
19165 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19166
19167 @kindex sharedlibrary
19168 @kindex share
19169 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19170 @itemx share @var{regex}
19171 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19172 Unix regular expression.
19173 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19174 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19175 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19176 loaded.
19177
19178 @item nosharedlibrary
19179 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19180 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19181 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19182 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19183 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19184 discarded.
19185 @end table
19186
19187 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19188 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19189 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19190 Catchpoints}).
19191
19192 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19193 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19194 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19195 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19196
19197 @table @code
19198 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19199 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19200 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19201 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19202 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19203 shared library.
19204
19205 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19206 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19207 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19208 library events happen.
19209 @end table
19210
19211 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19212 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19213 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19214 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19215 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19216 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19217 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19218 not.
19219
19220 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19221 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19222 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19223 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19224 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19225
19226 @table @code
19227 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19228 @cindex system root, alternate
19229 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19230 @kindex set sysroot
19231 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19232 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19233 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19234 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19235 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19236 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19237 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19238 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19239 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19240 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19241 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19242 @var{path}.
19243
19244 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19245 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19246 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19247 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19248 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19249 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19250 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19251 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19252 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19253 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19254 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19255 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19256 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19257 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19258
19259 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19260 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19261 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19262 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19263 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19264
19265 @smallexample
19266 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19267 @end smallexample
19268
19269 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19270 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19271 system:
19272
19273 @smallexample
19274 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19275 @end smallexample
19276
19277 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19278 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19279 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19280 colons:
19281
19282 @smallexample
19283 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19284 @end smallexample
19285
19286 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19287 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19288 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19289 @samp{z}):
19290
19291 @smallexample
19292 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19293 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19294 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 @noindent
19298 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19299 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19300 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19301
19302 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19303 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19304
19305 @smallexample
19306 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19307 @end smallexample
19308
19309 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19310 if you don't want or need to.
19311
19312 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19313 sysroot}.
19314
19315 @cindex default system root
19316 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19317 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19318 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19319 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19320 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19321 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19322 location.
19323
19324 @kindex show sysroot
19325 @item show sysroot
19326 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19327
19328 @kindex set solib-search-path
19329 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19330 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19331 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19332 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19333 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19334 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19335 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19336 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19337 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19338 of shared library symbols.
19339
19340 @kindex show solib-search-path
19341 @item show solib-search-path
19342 Display the current shared library search path.
19343
19344 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19345 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19346 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19347 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19348 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19349
19350 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19351 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19352 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19353 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19354 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19355 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19356 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19357 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19358 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19359 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19360 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19361 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19362 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19363 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19364 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19365 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19366 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19367 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19368 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19369 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19370 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19371 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19372
19373 @table @code
19374 @item unix
19375 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19376 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19377 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19378 the forward slash.
19379
19380 @item dos-based
19381 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19382 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19383 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19384 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19385 considered directory separators.
19386
19387 @item auto
19388 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19389 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19390 This is the default.
19391 @end table
19392 @end table
19393
19394 @cindex file name canonicalization
19395 @cindex base name differences
19396 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19397 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19398 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19399 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19400 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19401 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19402 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19403 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19404 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19405 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19406 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19407 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19408 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19409 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19410 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19411
19412 @table @code
19413 @item set basenames-may-differ
19414 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19415 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19416
19417 @item show basenames-may-differ
19418 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19419 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19420 @end table
19421
19422 @node File Caching
19423 @section File Caching
19424 @cindex caching of opened files
19425 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19426
19427 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19428 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19429 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19430 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19431
19432 @table @code
19433 @kindex maint info bfds
19434 @item maint info bfds
19435 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19436 @value{GDBN}.
19437
19438 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19439 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19440 @kindex bfd caching
19441 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19442 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19443 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19444 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19445 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19446 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19447 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19448 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19449 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19450
19451 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19452 @kindex bfd caching
19453 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19454 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19455
19456 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19457 @kindex bfd caching
19458 @item show debug bfd-cache
19459 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19460 @end table
19461
19462 @node Separate Debug Files
19463 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19464 @cindex separate debugging information files
19465 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19466 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19467 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19468 @cindex global debugging information directories
19469 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19470 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19471
19472 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19473 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19474 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19475 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19476 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19477 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19478 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19479
19480 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19481 file:
19482
19483 @itemize @bullet
19484 @item
19485 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19486 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19487 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19488 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19489 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19490 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19491 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19492 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19493
19494 @item
19495 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19496 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19497 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19498 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19499 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19500 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19501 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19502 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19503 below.
19504 @end itemize
19505
19506 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19507 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19508
19509 @itemize @bullet
19510 @item
19511 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19512 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19513 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19514 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19515 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19516
19517 @item
19518 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19519 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19520 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19521 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19522 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19523 hex characters, not 10.)
19524 @end itemize
19525
19526 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19527 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19528 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19529 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19530 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19531 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19532
19533 @itemize @minus
19534 @item
19535 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19536 @item
19537 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19538 @item
19539 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19540 @item
19541 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19542 @end itemize
19543
19544 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19545 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19546 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19547 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19548 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19549
19550 @table @code
19551
19552 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19553 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19554 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19555 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19556 concatenating them by a path separator.
19557
19558 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19559 @item show debug-file-directory
19560 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19561 information files.
19562
19563 @end table
19564
19565 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19566 @cindex debug link sections
19567 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19568 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19569
19570 @itemize
19571 @item
19572 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19573 a zero byte,
19574 @item
19575 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19576 boundary within the section, and
19577 @item
19578 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19579 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19580 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19581 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19582 @end itemize
19583
19584 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19585 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19586 described above.
19587
19588 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19589 @cindex build ID sections
19590 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19591 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19592 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19593 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19594 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19595 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19596 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19597 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19598 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19599
19600 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19601 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19602 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19603 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19604 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19605 in an ordinary executable.
19606
19607 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19608 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19609 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19610 following commands:
19611
19612 @smallexample
19613 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19614 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19615 @end smallexample
19616
19617 @noindent
19618 These commands remove the debugging
19619 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19620 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19621 two files:
19622
19623 @itemize @bullet
19624 @item
19625 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19626 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19627
19628 @smallexample
19629 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19630 @end smallexample
19631
19632 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19633 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19634 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19635 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19636
19637 @item
19638 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19639 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19640 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19641 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19642 @end itemize
19643
19644 @noindent
19645
19646 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19647 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19648 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19649
19650 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19651 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19652 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19653 @c different ways!
19654 @ifhtml
19655 @display
19656 @html
19657 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19658 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19659 @end html
19660 @end display
19661 @end ifhtml
19662 @ifnothtml
19663 @display
19664 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19665 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19666 @end display
19667 @end ifnothtml
19668
19669 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19670 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19671 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19672 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19673 CRC.
19674
19675 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19676 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19677 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19678 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19679 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19680
19681 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19682 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19683 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19684 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19685 @code{0xffffffff}.
19686
19687 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19688 @smallexample
19689 unsigned long
19690 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19691 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19692 @{
19693 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19694 @{
19695 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19696 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19697 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19698 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19699 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19700 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19701 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19702 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19703 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19704 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19705 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19706 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19707 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19708 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19709 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19710 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19711 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19712 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19713 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19714 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19715 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19716 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19717 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19718 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19719 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19720 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19721 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19722 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19723 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19724 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19725 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19726 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19727 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19728 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19729 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19730 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19731 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19732 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19733 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19734 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19735 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19736 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19737 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19738 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19739 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19740 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19741 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19742 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19743 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19744 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19745 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19746 0x2d02ef8d
19747 @};
19748 unsigned char *end;
19749
19750 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19751 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19752 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19753 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19754 @}
19755 @end smallexample
19756
19757 @noindent
19758 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19759
19760 @node MiniDebugInfo
19761 @section Debugging information in a special section
19762 @cindex separate debug sections
19763 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19764
19765 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19766 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19767 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19768 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19769
19770 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19771 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19772 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19773 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19774 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19775 debugging information might be included in the section.
19776
19777 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19778 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19779 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19780
19781 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19782 standard utilities:
19783
19784 @smallexample
19785 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19786 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19787 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19788 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19789
19790 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19791 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19792 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19793 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19794 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19795 | sort > funcsyms
19796
19797 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19798 # table.
19799 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19800
19801 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19802 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19803
19804 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19805 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19806 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19807 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19808
19809 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19810 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19811
19812 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19813 # original binary.
19814 xz mini_debuginfo
19815 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19816 @end smallexample
19817
19818 @node Index Files
19819 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19820 @cindex index files
19821 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19822
19823 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19824 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19825 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19826 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19827 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19828 startup.
19829
19830 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
19831 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
19832 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
19833
19834 @smallexample
19835 $ gdb-add-index symfile
19836 @end smallexample
19837
19838 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
19839
19840 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
19841 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
19842
19843 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19844 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19845 using @command{objcopy}.
19846
19847 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19848
19849 @table @code
19850 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
19851 @kindex save gdb-index
19852 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
19853 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
19854 default creates it produces a single file
19855 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
19856 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
19857 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
19858 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
19859 given @var{directory}.
19860 @end table
19861
19862 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19863 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19864
19865 @smallexample
19866 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19867 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19868 @end smallexample
19869
19870 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
19871
19872 @smallexample
19873 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
19874 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
19875 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
19876 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
19877 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
19878 @end smallexample
19879
19880 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19881 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19882 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19883 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19884 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19885 The default is @code{off}.
19886 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19887 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19888
19889 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19890 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19891
19892 @smallexample
19893 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19894 @end smallexample
19895
19896 Instead you must do, for example,
19897
19898 @smallexample
19899 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19900 @end smallexample
19901
19902 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19903 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19904 currently work for programs using Ada.
19905
19906 @node Symbol Errors
19907 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19908
19909 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19910 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19911 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19912 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19913 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19914 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19915 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19916 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19917 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19918 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19919 Messages}).
19920
19921 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19922
19923 @table @code
19924 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19925
19926 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19927 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19928 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19929 in its outer scope blocks.
19930
19931 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19932 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19933 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19934 function.
19935
19936 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19937
19938 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19939 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19940 do so.
19941
19942 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19943 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19944 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19945 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19946 Messages}.)
19947
19948 @item bad block start address patched
19949
19950 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19951 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19952 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19953
19954 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19955 starting on the previous source line.
19956
19957 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19958
19959 @cindex foo
19960 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19961 larger than the size of the string table.
19962
19963 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19964 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19965 with this name.
19966
19967 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19968
19969 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19970 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19971 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19972
19973 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19974 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19975 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19976 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19977 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19978 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19979
19980 @item stub type has NULL name
19981
19982 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19983
19984 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19985 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19986 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19987 it.
19988
19989 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19990
19991 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19992
19993 @end table
19994
19995 @node Data Files
19996 @section GDB Data Files
19997
19998 @cindex prefix for data files
19999 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20000 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20001
20002 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20003 is currently using.
20004
20005 @table @code
20006 @kindex set data-directory
20007 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20008 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20009 to @var{directory}.
20010
20011 @kindex show data-directory
20012 @item show data-directory
20013 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20014 @end table
20015
20016 @cindex default data directory
20017 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20018 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20019 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20020 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20021 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20022 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20023 location.
20024
20025 The data directory may also be specified with the
20026 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20027 @xref{Mode Options}.
20028
20029 @node Targets
20030 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20031
20032 @cindex debugging target
20033 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20034
20035 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20036 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20037 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20038 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20039 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20040 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20041 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20042 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20043
20044 @cindex target architecture
20045 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20046 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20047 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20048 command.
20049
20050 @table @code
20051 @kindex set architecture
20052 @kindex show architecture
20053 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20054 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20055 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20056 supported architectures.
20057
20058 @item show architecture
20059 Show the current target architecture.
20060
20061 @item set processor
20062 @itemx processor
20063 @kindex set processor
20064 @kindex show processor
20065 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20066 and @code{show architecture}.
20067 @end table
20068
20069 @menu
20070 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20071 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20072 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20073 @end menu
20074
20075 @node Active Targets
20076 @section Active Targets
20077
20078 @cindex stacking targets
20079 @cindex active targets
20080 @cindex multiple targets
20081
20082 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20083 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20084 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20085 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20086 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20087 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20088 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20089 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20090 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20091
20092 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20093 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20094 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20095 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20096
20097 @node Target Commands
20098 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20099
20100 @table @code
20101 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20102 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20103 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20104 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20105 protocol of the target machine.
20106
20107 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20108 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20109 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20110
20111 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20112 after executing the command.
20113
20114 @kindex help target
20115 @item help target
20116 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20117 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20118 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20119
20120 @item help target @var{name}
20121 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20122 select it.
20123
20124 @kindex set gnutarget
20125 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20126 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20127 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20128 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20129 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20130 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20131
20132 @quotation
20133 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20134 you must know the actual BFD name.
20135 @end quotation
20136
20137 @noindent
20138 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20139
20140 @kindex show gnutarget
20141 @item show gnutarget
20142 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20143 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20144 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20145 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20146 @end table
20147
20148 @cindex common targets
20149 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20150 configuration):
20151
20152 @table @code
20153 @kindex target
20154 @item target exec @var{program}
20155 @cindex executable file target
20156 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20157 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20158
20159 @item target core @var{filename}
20160 @cindex core dump file target
20161 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20162 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20163
20164 @item target remote @var{medium}
20165 @cindex remote target
20166 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20167 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20168 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20169
20170 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20171 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20172
20173 @smallexample
20174 target remote /dev/ttya
20175 @end smallexample
20176
20177 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20178 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20179 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20180 clobbered by the download.
20181
20182 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20183 @cindex built-in simulator target
20184 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20185 In general,
20186 @smallexample
20187 target sim
20188 load
20189 run
20190 @end smallexample
20191 @noindent
20192 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20193 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20194 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20195 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20196 Processors}.
20197
20198 @item target native
20199 @cindex native target
20200 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20201 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20202 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20203 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20204
20205 @end table
20206
20207 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20208 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20209
20210 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20211 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20212 various aspects of this process.
20213
20214 @table @code
20215
20216 @item set hash
20217 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20218 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20219 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20220 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20221 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20222 monitor.
20223
20224 @item show hash
20225 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20226 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20227
20228 @item set debug monitor
20229 @kindex set debug monitor
20230 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20231 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20232 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20233
20234 @item show debug monitor
20235 @kindex show debug monitor
20236 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20237 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20238 @end table
20239
20240 @table @code
20241
20242 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20243 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20244 @anchor{load}
20245 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20246 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20247 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20248 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20249 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20250 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20251
20252 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20253 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20254 target is @dots{}}''
20255
20256 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20257 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20258 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20259 specifies a fixed address.
20260 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20261
20262 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20263 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20264 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20265
20266 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20267 load programs into flash memory.
20268
20269 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20270 @end table
20271
20272 @table @code
20273
20274 @kindex flash-erase
20275 @item flash-erase
20276 @anchor{flash-erase}
20277
20278 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20279
20280 @end table
20281
20282 @node Byte Order
20283 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20284
20285 @cindex choosing target byte order
20286 @cindex target byte order
20287
20288 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20289 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20290 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20291 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20292 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20293 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20294
20295 @table @code
20296 @kindex set endian
20297 @item set endian big
20298 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20299
20300 @item set endian little
20301 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20302
20303 @item set endian auto
20304 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20305 executable.
20306
20307 @item show endian
20308 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20309
20310 @end table
20311
20312 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20313 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20314 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20315 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20316 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20317 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20318 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20319 and @code{big} otherwise.
20320
20321 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20322 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20323 target system.
20324
20325
20326 @node Remote Debugging
20327 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20328 @cindex remote debugging
20329
20330 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20331 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20332 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20333 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20334 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20335
20336 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20337 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20338 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20339 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20340 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20341 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20342
20343 Other remote targets may be available in your
20344 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20345
20346 @menu
20347 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20348 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20349 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20350 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20351 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20352 @end menu
20353
20354 @node Connecting
20355 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20356 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20357 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20358 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20359 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20360 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20361 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20362
20363 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20364 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20365 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20366 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20367
20368 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20369
20370 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20371 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20372 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20373 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20374
20375 @table @asis
20376
20377 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20378 @item Result of detach or program exit
20379 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20380 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20381 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20382
20383 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20384 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20385 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20386 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20387
20388 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20389 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20390 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20391 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20392
20393 @item Specifying the program to debug
20394 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20395 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20396 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20397 target.
20398
20399 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20400 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20401 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20402
20403 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20404 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20405 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20406 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20407
20408 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20409 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20410 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20411 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20412 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20413 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20414 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20415 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20416 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20417
20418 @item The @code{run} command
20419 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20420 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20421 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20422 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20423 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20424
20425 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20426 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20427 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20428 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20429 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20430
20431 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20432 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20433 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20434 @code{target remote} mode.
20435
20436 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20437 @item Attaching
20438 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20439 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20440 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20441
20442 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20443 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20444 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20445 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20446 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20447
20448 @end table
20449
20450 @anchor{Host and target files}
20451 @subsection Host and Target Files
20452 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20453 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20454
20455 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20456 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20457 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20458 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20459 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20460
20461 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20462 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20463 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20464 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20465 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20466
20467 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20468 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20469 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20470 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20471 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20472 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20473 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20474 target libraries.
20475
20476 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20477 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20478 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20479 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20480 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20481 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20482 programs.
20483
20484 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20485 @cindex remote connection commands
20486 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20487 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20488 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20489 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20490 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20491 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20492 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20493
20494 @table @code
20495
20496 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20497 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20498 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20499 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20500 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20501
20502 @smallexample
20503 target remote /dev/ttyb
20504 @end smallexample
20505
20506 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20507 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20508 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20509 @code{target} command.
20510
20511 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20512 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20513 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20514 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20515 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20516 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20517 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20518 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20519 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20520 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20521 target.
20522
20523 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20524 @code{manyfarms}:
20525
20526 @smallexample
20527 target remote manyfarms:2828
20528 @end smallexample
20529
20530 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20531 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20532 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20533 port 1234 on your local machine:
20534
20535 @smallexample
20536 target remote :1234
20537 @end smallexample
20538 @noindent
20539
20540 Note that the colon is still required here.
20541
20542 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20543 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20544 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20545 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20546 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20547
20548 @smallexample
20549 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20550 @end smallexample
20551
20552 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20553 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20554 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20555 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20556
20557 @item target remote | @var{command}
20558 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20559 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20560 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20561 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20562 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20563 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20564 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20565 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20566 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20567
20568 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20569 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20570 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20571
20572 @end table
20573
20574 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20575 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20576 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20577 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20578 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20579 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20580 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20581
20582 @smallexample
20583 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20584 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20585 @end smallexample
20586
20587 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20588 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20589 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20590 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20591
20592 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20593 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20594
20595 @table @code
20596 @kindex detach (remote)
20597 @item detach
20598 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20599 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20600 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20601 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20602 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20603 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20604 still connected to the target.
20605
20606 @kindex disconnect
20607 @item disconnect
20608 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20609 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20610 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20611 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20612 another target.
20613
20614 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20615 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20616 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20617 @kindex monitor
20618 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20619 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20620 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20621 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20622 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20623 and implement.
20624 @end table
20625
20626 @node File Transfer
20627 @section Sending files to a remote system
20628 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20629 @cindex file transfer
20630 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20631
20632 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20633 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20634 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20635 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20636 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20637 the only way to upload or download files.
20638
20639 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20640
20641 @table @code
20642 @kindex remote put
20643 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20644 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20645 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20646
20647 @kindex remote get
20648 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20649 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20650 on the host system.
20651
20652 @kindex remote delete
20653 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20654 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20655
20656 @end table
20657
20658 @node Server
20659 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20660
20661 @kindex gdbserver
20662 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20663 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20664 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20665 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20666 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20667
20668 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20669 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20670 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20671 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20672 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20673 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20674 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20675 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20676 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20677 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20678 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20679 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20680 choice for debugging.
20681
20682 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20683 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20684 protocol.
20685
20686 @quotation
20687 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20688 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20689 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20690 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20691 @code{gdbserver}.
20692 @end quotation
20693
20694 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20695 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20696 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20697 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20698
20699 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20700 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20701 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20702 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20703 system does all the symbol handling.
20704
20705 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20706 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20707 syntax is:
20708
20709 @smallexample
20710 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20711 @end smallexample
20712
20713 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20714 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20715 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20716 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20717 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20718 @file{/dev/com1}:
20719
20720 @smallexample
20721 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20722 @end smallexample
20723
20724 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20725 with it.
20726
20727 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20728
20729 @smallexample
20730 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20731 @end smallexample
20732
20733 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20734 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20735 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20736 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20737 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20738 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20739 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20740 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20741 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20742 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20743 @code{target remote} command.
20744
20745 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20746 with ssh:
20747
20748 @smallexample
20749 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20750 @end smallexample
20751
20752 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20753 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20754 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20755 You could elide it if you want to.
20756
20757 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20758 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20759 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20760 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20761
20762 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20763 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20764 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20765 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20766
20767 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20768 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20769
20770 @smallexample
20771 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20772 @end smallexample
20773
20774 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20775 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20776
20777 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20778 @value{GDBN} attach command
20779 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20780
20781 @pindex pidof
20782 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20783 @code{pidof} utility:
20784
20785 @smallexample
20786 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20790 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20791 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20792
20793 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20794
20795 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20796 port.
20797
20798 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20799 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20800 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20801 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20802 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20803 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20804 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20805 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20806
20807 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20808 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20809 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20810
20811 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20812 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20813 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20814 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20815 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20816 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20817 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20818 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20819 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20820 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20821 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20822 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20823
20824 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20825 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20826
20827 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20828 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20829 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20830 program. For more information,
20831 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20832
20833 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20834 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20835 status information about the debugging process.
20836 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20837 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20838 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20839 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20840
20841 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20842 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20843 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20844 Possible options are:
20845
20846 @table @code
20847 @item none
20848 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20849 @item all
20850 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20851 @item timestamps
20852 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20853 @end table
20854
20855 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20856 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20857
20858 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20859 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20860 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20861 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20862 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20863
20864 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20865 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20866 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20867 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20868
20869 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20870 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20871 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20872 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20873
20874 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20875 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20876 environment:
20877
20878 @smallexample
20879 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20880 @end smallexample
20881
20882 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20883 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20884
20885 @smallexample
20886 $ gdbserver --selftest
20887 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20888 @end smallexample
20889
20890 These tests are disabled in release.
20891 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20892
20893 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20894 @itemize
20895
20896 @item
20897 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20898
20899 @item
20900 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20901 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20902 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20903 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20904 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20905 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20906
20907 @item
20908 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20909 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20910 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20911 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20912 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20913 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20914 program is already on the target.
20915
20916 @end itemize
20917
20918 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20919 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20920 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20921
20922 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20923 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20924 Here are the available commands.
20925
20926 @table @code
20927 @item monitor help
20928 List the available monitor commands.
20929
20930 @item monitor set debug 0
20931 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20932 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20933
20934 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20935 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20936 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20937 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20938
20939 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20940 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20941 Possible options are:
20942
20943 @table @code
20944 @item none
20945 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20946 @item all
20947 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20948 @item timestamps
20949 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20950 @end table
20951
20952 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20953 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20954
20955 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20956 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20957 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20958 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20959 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20960 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20961
20962 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20963 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20964
20965 @item monitor exit
20966 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20967 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20968 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20969 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20970 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20971
20972 @end table
20973
20974 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20975 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20976
20977 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20978 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20979
20980 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20981 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20982 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20983 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20984 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20985 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20986 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20987 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20988 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20989 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20990 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20991 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20992
20993 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20994
20995 @table @code
20996 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20997
20998 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20999 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21000 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21001
21002 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21003
21004 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21005 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21006 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21007 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21008 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21009 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21010
21011 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21012
21013 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21014 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21015 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21016 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21017 command for that. For example:
21018
21019 @smallexample
21020 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21021 @end smallexample
21022
21023 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21024 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21025 @end table
21026
21027 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21028 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21029 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21030 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21031 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21032 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21033 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21034 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21035 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21036 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21037
21038 @smallexample
21039 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21040 @end smallexample
21041
21042 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21043
21044 @smallexample
21045 $ gdb myprogram
21046 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21047 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21048 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21049 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21050 @end smallexample
21051
21052 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21053 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21054 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21055 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21056 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21057 tracing.
21058
21059 @node Remote Configuration
21060 @section Remote Configuration
21061
21062 @kindex set remote
21063 @kindex show remote
21064 This section documents the configuration options available when
21065 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21066 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21067 system-call-allowed}.
21068
21069 @table @code
21070 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21071 @cindex address size for remote targets
21072 @cindex bits in remote address
21073 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21074 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21075 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21076 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21077
21078 @item show remoteaddresssize
21079 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21080
21081 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21082 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21083 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21084 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21085 remote targets.
21086
21087 @item show serial baud
21088 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21089
21090 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21091 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21092 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21093
21094 @item show serial parity
21095 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21096
21097 @item set remotebreak
21098 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21099 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21100 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21101 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21102 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21103 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21104 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21105 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21106
21107 @item show remotebreak
21108 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21109 interrupt the remote program.
21110
21111 @item set remoteflow on
21112 @itemx set remoteflow off
21113 @kindex set remoteflow
21114 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21115 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21116
21117 @item show remoteflow
21118 @kindex show remoteflow
21119 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21120
21121 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21122 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21123 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21124 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21125 @code{ascii}.
21126
21127 @item show remotelogbase
21128 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21129 protocol.
21130
21131 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21132 @cindex record serial communications on file
21133 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21134 default is not to record at all.
21135
21136 @item show remotelogfile.
21137 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21138 serial communications.
21139
21140 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21141 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21142 @cindex remote timeout
21143 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21144 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21145
21146 @item show remotetimeout
21147 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21148 responses.
21149
21150 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21151 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21152 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21153 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21154 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21155 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21156 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
21157 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
21158
21159 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21160 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21161 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21162 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21163 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
21164 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
21165 as unlimited.
21166
21167 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21168 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21169 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21170
21171 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21172 @itemx show remote exec-file
21173 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21174 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21175 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21176 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21177 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21178 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21179
21180 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21181 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21182 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21183 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21184 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21185 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21186 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21187 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21188 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21189 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21190
21191 @item show interrupt-sequence
21192 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21193 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21194 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21195 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21196
21197 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21198 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21199 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21200 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21201 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21202 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21203
21204 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21205 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21206 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21207
21208 @kindex set tcp
21209 @kindex show tcp
21210 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21211 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21212 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21213 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21214 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21215 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21216 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21217 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21218 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21219
21220 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21221 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21222
21223 @item show tcp auto-retry
21224 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21225
21226 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21227 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21228 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21229 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21230 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21231 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21232 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21233 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21234 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21235 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21236 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21237
21238 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21239 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21240 @end table
21241
21242 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21243 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21244 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21245 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21246 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21247 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21248 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21249 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21250 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21251
21252 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21253 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21254 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21255 @value{GDBN} developers.
21256
21257 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21258 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21259 are:
21260
21261 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21262 @item Command Name
21263 @tab Remote Packet
21264 @tab Related Features
21265
21266 @item @code{fetch-register}
21267 @tab @code{p}
21268 @tab @code{info registers}
21269
21270 @item @code{set-register}
21271 @tab @code{P}
21272 @tab @code{set}
21273
21274 @item @code{binary-download}
21275 @tab @code{X}
21276 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21277
21278 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21279 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21280 @tab @code{info auxv}
21281
21282 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21283 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21284 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21285
21286 @item @code{attach}
21287 @tab @code{vAttach}
21288 @tab @code{attach}
21289
21290 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21291 @tab @code{vCont}
21292 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21293
21294 @item @code{run}
21295 @tab @code{vRun}
21296 @tab @code{run}
21297
21298 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21299 @tab @code{Z0}
21300 @tab @code{break}
21301
21302 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21303 @tab @code{Z1}
21304 @tab @code{hbreak}
21305
21306 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21307 @tab @code{Z2}
21308 @tab @code{watch}
21309
21310 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21311 @tab @code{Z3}
21312 @tab @code{rwatch}
21313
21314 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21315 @tab @code{Z4}
21316 @tab @code{awatch}
21317
21318 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21319 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21320 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21321
21322 @item @code{target-features}
21323 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21324 @tab @code{set architecture}
21325
21326 @item @code{library-info}
21327 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21328 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21329
21330 @item @code{memory-map}
21331 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21332 @tab @code{info mem}
21333
21334 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21335 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21336 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21337
21338 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21339 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21340 @tab @code{info spu}
21341
21342 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21343 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21344 @tab @code{info spu}
21345
21346 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21347 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21348 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21349
21350 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21351 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21352 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21353
21354 @item @code{threads}
21355 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21356 @tab @code{info threads}
21357
21358 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21359 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21360 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21361
21362 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21363 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21364 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21365
21366 @item @code{search-memory}
21367 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21368 @tab @code{find}
21369
21370 @item @code{supported-packets}
21371 @tab @code{qSupported}
21372 @tab Remote communications parameters
21373
21374 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21375 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21376 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21377
21378 @item @code{pass-signals}
21379 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21380 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21381
21382 @item @code{program-signals}
21383 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21384 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21385
21386 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21387 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21388 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21389
21390 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21391 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21392 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21393
21394 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21395 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21396 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21397
21398 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21399 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21400 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21401
21402 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21403 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21404 @tab @code{remote delete}
21405
21406 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21407 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21408 @tab Host I/O
21409
21410 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21411 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21412 @tab Host I/O
21413
21414 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21415 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21416 @tab Host I/O
21417
21418 @item @code{noack-packet}
21419 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21420 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21421
21422 @item @code{osdata}
21423 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21424 @tab @code{info os}
21425
21426 @item @code{query-attached}
21427 @tab @code{qAttached}
21428 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21429
21430 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21431 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21432 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21433
21434 @item @code{trace-status}
21435 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21436 @tab @code{tstatus}
21437
21438 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21439 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21440 @tab Traceframe info
21441
21442 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21443 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21444 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21445
21446 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21447 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21448 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21449
21450 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21451 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21452 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21453
21454 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21455 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21456 @tab @code{set environment}
21457
21458 @item @code{environment-unset}
21459 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21460 @tab @code{unset environment}
21461
21462 @item @code{environment-reset}
21463 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21464 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21465
21466 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21467 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21468 @tab @code{set cwd}
21469
21470 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21471 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21472 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21473
21474 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21475 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21476 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21477
21478 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21479 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21480 @tab @code{break}
21481
21482 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21483 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21484 @tab @code{hbreak}
21485
21486 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21487 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21488 @tab @code{fork}
21489
21490 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21491 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21492 @tab @code{vfork}
21493
21494 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21495 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21496 @tab @code{exec}
21497
21498 @item @code{thread-events}
21499 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21500 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21501
21502 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21503 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21504 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21505
21506 @end multitable
21507
21508 @node Remote Stub
21509 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21510
21511 @cindex debugging stub, example
21512 @cindex remote stub, example
21513 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21514 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21515 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21516 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21517 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21518 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21519 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21520 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21521
21522 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21523 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21524 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21525 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21526 program, you need:
21527
21528 @enumerate
21529 @item
21530 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21531 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21532 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21533
21534 @item
21535 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21536 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21537
21538 @item
21539 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21540 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21541 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21542 documentation.
21543 @end enumerate
21544
21545 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21546 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21547 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21548
21549 @table @emph
21550 @item On the host,
21551 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21552 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21553 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21554
21555 @item On the target,
21556 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21557 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21558 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21559
21560 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21561 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21562 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21563 @end table
21564
21565 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21566 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21567 @sc{sparc} boards.
21568
21569 @cindex remote serial stub list
21570 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21571
21572 @table @code
21573
21574 @item i386-stub.c
21575 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21576 @cindex Intel
21577 @cindex i386
21578 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21579
21580 @item m68k-stub.c
21581 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21582 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21583 @cindex m680x0
21584 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21585
21586 @item sh-stub.c
21587 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21588 @cindex Renesas
21589 @cindex SH
21590 For Renesas SH architectures.
21591
21592 @item sparc-stub.c
21593 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21594 @cindex Sparc
21595 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21596
21597 @item sparcl-stub.c
21598 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21599 @cindex Fujitsu
21600 @cindex SparcLite
21601 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21602
21603 @end table
21604
21605 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21606 recently added stubs.
21607
21608 @menu
21609 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21610 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21611 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21612 @end menu
21613
21614 @node Stub Contents
21615 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21616
21617 @cindex remote serial stub
21618 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21619 subroutines:
21620
21621 @table @code
21622 @item set_debug_traps
21623 @findex set_debug_traps
21624 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21625 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21626 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21627 program's startup code.
21628
21629 @item handle_exception
21630 @findex handle_exception
21631 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21632 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21633 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21634 run when a trap is triggered.
21635
21636 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21637 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21638 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21639 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21640 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21641 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21642 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21643 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21644 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21645 machine.
21646
21647 @item breakpoint
21648 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21649 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21650 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21651 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21652 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21653 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21654 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21655 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21656 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21657 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21658 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21659
21660 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21661 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21662 start of your debugging session.
21663 @end table
21664
21665 @node Bootstrapping
21666 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21667
21668 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21669 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21670 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21671 debugging target machine.
21672
21673 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21674 serial port.
21675
21676 @table @code
21677 @item int getDebugChar()
21678 @findex getDebugChar
21679 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21680 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21681 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21682
21683 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21684 @findex putDebugChar
21685 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21686 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21687 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21688 @end table
21689
21690 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21691 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21692 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21693 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21694 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21695 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21696 remote system to stop.
21697
21698 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21699 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21700 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21701 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21702
21703 Other routines you need to supply are:
21704
21705 @table @code
21706 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21707 @findex exceptionHandler
21708 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21709 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21710 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21711 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21712 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21713 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21714 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21715 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21716 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21717 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21718 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21719 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21720 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21721
21722 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21723 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21724 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21725 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21726 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21727
21728 @item void flush_i_cache()
21729 @findex flush_i_cache
21730 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21731 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21732 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21733
21734 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21735 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21736 @end table
21737
21738 @noindent
21739 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21740
21741 @table @code
21742 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21743 @findex memset
21744 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21745 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21746 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21747 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21748 @end table
21749
21750 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21751 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21752 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21753 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21754
21755
21756 @node Debug Session
21757 @subsection Putting it All Together
21758
21759 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21760 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21761 steps.
21762
21763 @enumerate
21764 @item
21765 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21766 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21767 @display
21768 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21769 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21770 @end display
21771
21772 @item
21773 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21774 procedure is called:
21775
21776 @smallexample
21777 set_debug_traps();
21778 breakpoint();
21779 @end smallexample
21780
21781 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21782 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21783 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21784 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21785 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21786 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21787 progress.
21788
21789 @item
21790 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21791 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21792
21793 @smallexample
21794 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21795 @end smallexample
21796
21797 @noindent
21798 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21799 function in your program, that function is called when
21800 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21801 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21802 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21803
21804 @item
21805 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21806 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21807
21808 @item
21809 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21810 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21811
21812 @item
21813 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21814 @c document that. FIXME.
21815 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21816 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21817
21818 @item
21819 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21820 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21821
21822 @end enumerate
21823
21824 @node Configurations
21825 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21826
21827 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21828 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21829 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21830
21831 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21832 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21833 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21834 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21835 are quite different from each other.
21836
21837 @menu
21838 * Native::
21839 * Embedded OS::
21840 * Embedded Processors::
21841 * Architectures::
21842 @end menu
21843
21844 @node Native
21845 @section Native
21846
21847 This section describes details specific to particular native
21848 configurations.
21849
21850 @menu
21851 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21852 * Process Information:: Process information
21853 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21854 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21855 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21856 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21857 @end menu
21858
21859 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21860 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21861
21862 @cindex libkvm
21863 @cindex kernel memory image
21864 @cindex kernel crash dump
21865
21866 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21867 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21868 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21869 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21870 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21871 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21872 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21873 @code{kvm} target:
21874
21875 @smallexample
21876 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21877 @end smallexample
21878
21879 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21880 argument:
21881
21882 @smallexample
21883 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21884 @end smallexample
21885
21886 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21887 available:
21888
21889 @table @code
21890 @kindex kvm
21891 @item kvm pcb
21892 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21893
21894 @item kvm proc
21895 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21896 modern FreeBSD systems.
21897 @end table
21898
21899 @node Process Information
21900 @subsection Process Information
21901 @cindex /proc
21902 @cindex examine process image
21903 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21904
21905 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
21906 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
21907 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
21908 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
21909 to report information about the process running your program, or about
21910 any process running on your system.
21911
21912 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
21913 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
21914 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
21915 systems.
21916
21917 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
21918 information.
21919
21920 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
21921 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
21922 information available from a live process. Process information is
21923 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
21924 systems.
21925
21926 @table @code
21927 @kindex info proc
21928 @cindex process ID
21929 @item info proc
21930 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21931 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21932 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21933 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21934 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21935 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21936 executable file's absolute file name.
21937
21938 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21939 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21940 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21941 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21942 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21943 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21944
21945 @item info proc cmdline
21946 @cindex info proc cmdline
21947 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21948 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21949
21950 @item info proc cwd
21951 @cindex info proc cwd
21952 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21953 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21954
21955 @item info proc exe
21956 @cindex info proc exe
21957 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
21958 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21959
21960 @item info proc mappings
21961 @cindex memory address space mappings
21962 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
21963 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
21964 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
21965 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
21966 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
21967
21968 @item info proc stat
21969 @itemx info proc status
21970 @cindex process detailed status information
21971 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
21972 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
21973 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
21974 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
21975 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21976
21977 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
21978 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21979
21980 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
21981 proc status}.
21982
21983 @item info proc all
21984 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21985 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21986
21987 @ignore
21988 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21989 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21990 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21991 @kindex info proc times
21992 @item info proc times
21993 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21994 its children.
21995
21996 @kindex info proc id
21997 @item info proc id
21998 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21999 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22000 @end ignore
22001
22002 @item set procfs-trace
22003 @kindex set procfs-trace
22004 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22005 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22006
22007 @item show procfs-trace
22008 @kindex show procfs-trace
22009 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22010
22011 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22012 @kindex set procfs-file
22013 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22014 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22015 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22016 standard output.
22017
22018 @item show procfs-file
22019 @kindex show procfs-file
22020 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22021
22022 @item proc-trace-entry
22023 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22024 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22025 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22026 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22027 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22028 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22029 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22030 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22031 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22032
22033 @item info pidlist
22034 @kindex info pidlist
22035 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22036 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22037 processes and all the threads within each process.
22038
22039 @item info meminfo
22040 @kindex info meminfo
22041 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22042 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22043 @end table
22044
22045 @node DJGPP Native
22046 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22047 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22048 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22049 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22050
22051 @cindex DPMI
22052 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22053 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22054 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22055 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22056
22057 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22058 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22059 subsection describes those commands.
22060
22061 @table @code
22062 @kindex info dos
22063 @item info dos
22064 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22065 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22066
22067 @kindex sysinfo
22068 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22069 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22070 @item info dos sysinfo
22071 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22072 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22073 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22074
22075 @cindex GDT
22076 @cindex LDT
22077 @cindex IDT
22078 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22079 @cindex descriptor tables display
22080 @item info dos gdt
22081 @itemx info dos ldt
22082 @itemx info dos idt
22083 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22084 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22085 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22086 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22087 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22088 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22089 rights.
22090
22091 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22092 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22093 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22094 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22095 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22096
22097 @cindex garbled pointers
22098 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22099 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22100 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22101 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22102 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22103 debugged program's data segment:
22104
22105 @smallexample
22106 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22107 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22108 @end smallexample
22109
22110 @noindent
22111 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22112 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22113
22114 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22115 @item info dos pde
22116 @itemx info dos pte
22117 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22118 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22119 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22120 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22121 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22122 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22123 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22124 that is currently in use.
22125
22126 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22127 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22128 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22129 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22130 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22131 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22132 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22133
22134 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22135 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22136 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22137 controller.
22138
22139 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22140
22141 @cindex physical address from linear address
22142 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22143 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22144 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22145 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22146 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22147 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22148 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22149
22150 @smallexample
22151 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22152 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22153 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22154 @end smallexample
22155
22156 @noindent
22157 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22158 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22159 attributes of that page.
22160
22161 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22162 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22163 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22164 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22165 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22166 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22167
22168 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22169 transfer buffer:
22170
22171 @smallexample
22172 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22173 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22174 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22175 @end smallexample
22176
22177 @noindent
22178 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22179 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22180 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22181 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22182 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22183
22184 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22185 @end table
22186
22187 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22188 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22189 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22190 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22191
22192 @table @code
22193 @kindex set com1base
22194 @kindex set com1irq
22195 @kindex set com2base
22196 @kindex set com2irq
22197 @kindex set com3base
22198 @kindex set com3irq
22199 @kindex set com4base
22200 @kindex set com4irq
22201 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22202 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22203 port.
22204
22205 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22206 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22207 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22208
22209 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22210 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22211 other 3 COM ports.
22212
22213 @kindex show com1base
22214 @kindex show com1irq
22215 @kindex show com2base
22216 @kindex show com2irq
22217 @kindex show com3base
22218 @kindex show com3irq
22219 @kindex show com4base
22220 @kindex show com4irq
22221 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22222 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22223 lines used by the COM ports.
22224
22225 @item info serial
22226 @kindex info serial
22227 @cindex DOS serial port status
22228 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22229 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22230 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22231 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22232 @end table
22233
22234
22235 @node Cygwin Native
22236 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22237 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22238 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22239 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22240
22241 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22242 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22243
22244 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22245 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22246 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22247 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22248 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22249 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22250 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22251 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22252
22253 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22254 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22255 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22256
22257 @table @code
22258 @kindex info w32
22259 @item info w32
22260 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22261 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22262
22263 @item info w32 selector
22264 This command displays information returned by
22265 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22266 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22267 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22268 Without argument, this command displays information
22269 about the six segment registers.
22270
22271 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22272 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22273 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22274 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22275
22276 @kindex signal-event
22277 @item signal-event @var{id}
22278 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22279 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22280
22281 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22282 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22283 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22284 (for x86_64 versions):
22285
22286 @itemize @minus
22287 @item
22288 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22289 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22290 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22291
22292 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22293 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22294 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22295 to attach.
22296
22297 @item
22298 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22299 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22300 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22301 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22302 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22303 @end itemize
22304
22305 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22306 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22307 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22308 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22309 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22310 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22311 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22312 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22313 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22314 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22315 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22316
22317 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22318 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22319 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22320 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22321
22322 @kindex set new-console
22323 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22324 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22325 be started in a new console on next start.
22326 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22327 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22328
22329 @kindex show new-console
22330 @item show new-console
22331 Displays whether a new console is used
22332 when the debuggee is started.
22333
22334 @kindex set new-group
22335 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22336 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22337 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22338 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22339 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22340
22341 @kindex show new-group
22342 @item show new-group
22343 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22344
22345 @kindex set debugevents
22346 @item set debugevents
22347 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22348 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22349 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22350 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22351 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22352
22353 @kindex set debugexec
22354 @item set debugexec
22355 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22356 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22357
22358 @kindex set debugexceptions
22359 @item set debugexceptions
22360 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22361 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22362
22363 @kindex set debugmemory
22364 @item set debugmemory
22365 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22366 and writes by the debugger.
22367
22368 @kindex set shell
22369 @item set shell
22370 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22371 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22372
22373 @kindex show shell
22374 @item show shell
22375 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22376
22377 @end table
22378
22379 @menu
22380 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22381 @end menu
22382
22383 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22384 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22385 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22386 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22387
22388 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22389 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22390 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22391 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22392 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22393 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22394 ``minimal symbols''.
22395
22396 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22397 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22398 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22399 program run once to completion.
22400
22401 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22402
22403 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22404 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22405 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22406 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22407 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22408 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22409 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22410 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22411 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22412
22413 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22414 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22415 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22416 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22417 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22418 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22419
22420 @smallexample
22421 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22422 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22423
22424 Non-debugging symbols:
22425 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22426 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22427 @end smallexample
22428
22429 @smallexample
22430 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22431 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22432
22433 Non-debugging symbols:
22434 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22435 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22436 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22437 [etc...]
22438 @end smallexample
22439
22440 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22441
22442 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22443 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22444 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22445 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22446 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22447 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22448 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22449
22450 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22451 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22452 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22453 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22454 problem:
22455
22456 @smallexample
22457 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22458 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22459 @end smallexample
22460
22461 @smallexample
22462 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22463 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22464 @end smallexample
22465
22466 And two possible solutions:
22467
22468 @smallexample
22469 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22470 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22471 @end smallexample
22472
22473 @smallexample
22474 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22475 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22476 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22477 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22478 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22479 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22480 @end smallexample
22481
22482 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22483 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22484 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22485 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22486 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22487
22488 @smallexample
22489 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22490 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22491 @end smallexample
22492
22493 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22494 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22495 safe.
22496
22497 @node Hurd Native
22498 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22499 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22500
22501 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22502 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22503
22504 @table @code
22505 @item set signals
22506 @itemx set sigs
22507 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22508 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22509 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22510 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22511 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22512 @code{signals}.
22513
22514 @item show signals
22515 @itemx show sigs
22516 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22517 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22518 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22519
22520 @item set signal-thread
22521 @itemx set sigthread
22522 @kindex set signal-thread
22523 @kindex set sigthread
22524 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22525 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22526 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22527 signal-thread}.
22528
22529 @item show signal-thread
22530 @itemx show sigthread
22531 @kindex show signal-thread
22532 @kindex show sigthread
22533 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22534 delivered a signal.
22535
22536 @item set stopped
22537 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22538 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22539 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22540 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22541
22542 @item show stopped
22543 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22544 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22545 stopped.
22546
22547 @item set exceptions
22548 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22549 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22550 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22551 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22552 trapping on.
22553
22554 @item show exceptions
22555 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22556 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22557
22558 @item set task pause
22559 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22560 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22561 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22562 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22563 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22564 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22565 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22566 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22567 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22568
22569 @item show task pause
22570 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22571 Show the current state of task suspension.
22572
22573 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22574 @cindex task suspend count
22575 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22576 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22577 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22578
22579 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22580 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22581
22582 @item set task exception-port
22583 @itemx set task excp
22584 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22585 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22586 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22587 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22588
22589 @item set noninvasive
22590 @cindex noninvasive task options
22591 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22592 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22593 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22594 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22595
22596 @item info send-rights
22597 @itemx info receive-rights
22598 @itemx info port-rights
22599 @itemx info port-sets
22600 @itemx info dead-names
22601 @itemx info ports
22602 @itemx info psets
22603 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22604 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22605 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22606 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22607 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22608 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22609 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22610 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22611 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22612
22613 @item set thread pause
22614 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22615 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22616 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22617 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22618 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22619 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22620 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22621 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22622 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22623 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22624 only the current thread.
22625
22626 @item show thread pause
22627 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22628 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22629
22630 @item set thread run
22631 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22632
22633 @item show thread run
22634 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22635
22636 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22637 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22638 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22639 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22640 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22641 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22642 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22643
22644 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22645 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22646 detaching.
22647
22648 @item set thread exception-port
22649 @itemx set thread excp
22650 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22651 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22652 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22653
22654 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22655 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22656 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22657 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22658
22659 @item set thread default
22660 @itemx show thread default
22661 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22662 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22663 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22664 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22665 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22666 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22667 the non-default commands.
22668 @end table
22669
22670 @node Darwin
22671 @subsection Darwin
22672 @cindex Darwin
22673
22674 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22675
22676 @table @code
22677 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22678 @kindex set debug darwin
22679 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22680 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22681
22682 @item show debug darwin
22683 @kindex show debug darwin
22684 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22685
22686 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22687 @kindex set debug mach-o
22688 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22689 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22690 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22691 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22692 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22693 usage.
22694
22695 @item show debug mach-o
22696 @kindex show debug mach-o
22697 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22698
22699 @item set mach-exceptions on
22700 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22701 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22702 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22703 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22704 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22705 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22706
22707 @item show mach-exceptions
22708 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22709 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22710 @end table
22711
22712
22713 @node Embedded OS
22714 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22715
22716 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22717 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22718 architectures.
22719
22720 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22721 various real-time operating systems.
22722
22723 @node Embedded Processors
22724 @section Embedded Processors
22725
22726 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22727 configurations.
22728
22729 @cindex send command to simulator
22730 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22731 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22732
22733 @table @code
22734 @item sim @var{command}
22735 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22736 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22737 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22738 acceptable commands.
22739 @end table
22740
22741
22742 @menu
22743 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22744 * ARM:: ARM
22745 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22746 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22747 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22748 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
22749 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22750 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22751 * CRIS:: CRIS
22752 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22753 @end menu
22754
22755 @node ARC
22756 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22757 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22758 @cindex ARC specific commands
22759 @cindex ARC600
22760 @cindex ARC700
22761 @cindex ARC EM
22762 @cindex ARC HS
22763
22764 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22765
22766 @table @code
22767 @item set debug arc
22768 @kindex set debug arc
22769 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22770 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22771
22772 @item show debug arc
22773 @kindex show debug arc
22774 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22775
22776 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22777 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22778 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22779
22780 @end table
22781
22782 @node ARM
22783 @subsection ARM
22784
22785 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22786
22787 @table @code
22788 @item set arm disassembler
22789 @kindex set arm
22790 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22791 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22792
22793 @item show arm disassembler
22794 @kindex show arm
22795 Show the current disassembly style.
22796
22797 @item set arm apcs32
22798 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22799 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22800
22801 @item show arm apcs32
22802 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22803
22804 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22805 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22806 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22807
22808 @table @code
22809 @item auto
22810 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22811 @item softfpa
22812 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22813 processors.
22814 @item fpa
22815 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22816 @item softvfp
22817 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22818 @item vfp
22819 VFP co-processor.
22820 @end table
22821
22822 @item show arm fpu
22823 Show the current type of the FPU.
22824
22825 @item set arm abi
22826 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22827
22828 @item show arm abi
22829 Show the currently used ABI.
22830
22831 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22832 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22833 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22834 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22835 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22836 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22837 register).
22838
22839 @item show arm fallback-mode
22840 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22841
22842 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22843 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22844 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22845 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22846 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22847
22848 @item show arm force-mode
22849 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22850
22851 @item set debug arm
22852 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22853 target support subsystem.
22854
22855 @item show debug arm
22856 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22857 @end table
22858
22859 @table @code
22860 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22861 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22862
22863 @table @code
22864 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22865 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22866 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22867 The default value is @code{all}.
22868
22869 @table @code
22870 @item none
22871 @item demon
22872 @item angel
22873 @item redboot
22874 @item all
22875 @end table
22876 @end table
22877 @end table
22878
22879 @node M68K
22880 @subsection M68k
22881
22882 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22883
22884 @node MicroBlaze
22885 @subsection MicroBlaze
22886 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22887 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22888
22889 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22890 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22891 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22892 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22893 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22894 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22895 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22896 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22897 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22898 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22899 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22900
22901 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22902
22903 @table @code
22904 @item target remote :1234
22905 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22906 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22907
22908 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22909 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22910 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22911
22912 @item load
22913 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22914
22915 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22916 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22917
22918 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22919 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22920 @end table
22921
22922 @node MIPS Embedded
22923 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22924
22925 @noindent
22926 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22927
22928 @table @code
22929 @item set mipsfpu double
22930 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22931 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22932 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22933 @itemx show mipsfpu
22934 @kindex set mipsfpu
22935 @kindex show mipsfpu
22936 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22937 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22938 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22939 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22940 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22941 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22942 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22943 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22944 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22945 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22946 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22947 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22948 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22949
22950 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22951 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22952 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22953
22954 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22955 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22956 @end table
22957
22958 @node OpenRISC 1000
22959 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
22960 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
22961
22962 @noindent
22963 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
22964 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
22965 FPGA's.
22966
22967 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
22968 a target:
22969
22970 @table @code
22971
22972 @kindex target sim
22973 @item target sim
22974
22975 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
22976 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
22977 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
22978 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
22979
22980 Example: @code{target sim}
22981
22982 @item set debug or1k
22983 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
22984 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
22985
22986 @item show debug or1k
22987 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22988 @end table
22989
22990 @node PowerPC Embedded
22991 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22992
22993 @cindex DVC register
22994 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22995 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22996
22997 @smallexample
22998 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22999 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23000 @end smallexample
23001
23002 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23003 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23004 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23005 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23006 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23007 or newer.
23008
23009 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23010 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23011 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23012 watching variables of scalar types.
23013
23014 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23015 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23016
23017 @smallexample
23018 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23019 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23020 @end smallexample
23021
23022 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23023 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23024
23025 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23026 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23027 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23028 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23029 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23030 use the @code{break-range} command.
23031
23032 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23033
23034 @table @code
23035 @kindex break-range
23036 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23037 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23038 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23039 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23040 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23041 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23042 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23043 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23044 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23045
23046 @kindex set powerpc
23047 @item set powerpc soft-float
23048 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23049 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23050 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23051 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23052
23053 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23054 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23055 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23056 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23057 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23058 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23059 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23060 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23061
23062 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23063 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23064 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23065 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23066 address of its first byte.
23067
23068 @end table
23069
23070 @node AVR
23071 @subsection Atmel AVR
23072 @cindex AVR
23073
23074 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23075 following AVR-specific commands:
23076
23077 @table @code
23078 @item info io_registers
23079 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23080 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23081 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23082 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23083 @end table
23084
23085 @node CRIS
23086 @subsection CRIS
23087 @cindex CRIS
23088
23089 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23090 following CRIS-specific commands:
23091
23092 @table @code
23093 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23094 @cindex CRIS version
23095 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23096 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23097 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23098
23099 @item show cris-version
23100 Show the current CRIS version.
23101
23102 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23103 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23104 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23105 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23106 @code{R59}.
23107
23108 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23109 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23110
23111 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23112 @cindex CRIS mode
23113 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23114 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23115 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23116
23117 @item show cris-mode
23118 Show the current CRIS mode.
23119 @end table
23120
23121 @node Super-H
23122 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23123 @cindex Super-H
23124
23125 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23126 commands:
23127
23128 @table @code
23129 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23130 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23131 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23132 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23133 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23134 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23135 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23136 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23137 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23138 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23139 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23140 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23141
23142 @item show sh calling-convention
23143 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23144 Show the current calling convention setting.
23145
23146 @end table
23147
23148
23149 @node Architectures
23150 @section Architectures
23151
23152 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23153 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23154
23155 @menu
23156 * AArch64::
23157 * i386::
23158 * Alpha::
23159 * MIPS::
23160 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23161 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23162 * PowerPC::
23163 * Nios II::
23164 * Sparc64::
23165 @end menu
23166
23167 @node AArch64
23168 @subsection AArch64
23169 @cindex AArch64 support
23170
23171 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23172 following special commands:
23173
23174 @table @code
23175 @item set debug aarch64
23176 @kindex set debug aarch64
23177 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23178 messages are to be displayed.
23179
23180 @item show debug aarch64
23181 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23182
23183 @end table
23184
23185 @node i386
23186 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23187
23188 @table @code
23189 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23190 @kindex set struct-convention
23191 @cindex struct return convention
23192 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23193 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23194 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23195 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23196 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23197 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23198 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23199 be returned in a register.
23200
23201 @item show struct-convention
23202 @kindex show struct-convention
23203 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23204 from functions.
23205 @end table
23206
23207
23208 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23209 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23210
23211 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23212 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23213 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23214 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23215 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23216 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23217 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23218
23219 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23220 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23221 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23222 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23223 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23224 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23225
23226 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23227 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23228 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23229
23230 @smallexample
23231 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23232 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23233 @end smallexample
23234
23235 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23236 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23237 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23238 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23239 the pointer.
23240
23241 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23242 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23243 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23244 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23245 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23246
23247 @table @code
23248 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23249 @kindex show mpx bound
23250 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23251
23252 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23253 @kindex set mpx bound
23254 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23255 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23256 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23257 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23258 @end table
23259
23260 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23261 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23262 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23263 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23264
23265 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23266 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23267 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23268 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23269 function.
23270
23271 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23272 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23273 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23274 continuing the execution. For example:
23275
23276 @smallexample
23277 $ break *upper
23278 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23279 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23280 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23281 $ print $bnd0
23282 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23283 @end smallexample
23284
23285 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23286 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23287 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23288
23289 @node Alpha
23290 @subsection Alpha
23291
23292 See the following section.
23293
23294 @node MIPS
23295 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23296
23297 @cindex stack on Alpha
23298 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23299 @cindex Alpha stack
23300 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23301 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23302 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23303 find the beginning of a function.
23304
23305 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23306 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23307 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23308 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23309 commands:
23310
23311 @table @code
23312 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23313 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23314 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23315 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23316 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23317 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23318 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23319 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23320
23321 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23322 Display the current limit.
23323 @end table
23324
23325 @noindent
23326 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23327 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23328
23329 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23330 programs:
23331
23332 @table @code
23333 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23334 @kindex set mips abi
23335 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23336 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23337 values of @var{arg} are:
23338
23339 @table @samp
23340 @item auto
23341 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23342 default).
23343 @item o32
23344 @item o64
23345 @item n32
23346 @item n64
23347 @item eabi32
23348 @item eabi64
23349 @end table
23350
23351 @item show mips abi
23352 @kindex show mips abi
23353 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23354
23355 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23356 @kindex set mips compression
23357 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23358 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23359 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23360 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23361 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23362 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23363 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23364 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23365 provided by the executable.
23366
23367 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23368 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23369 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23370 identified as such.
23371
23372 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23373 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23374 implicitly from an executable.
23375
23376 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23377 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23378 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23379 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23380 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23381
23382 @item show mips compression
23383 @kindex show mips compression
23384 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23385 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23386
23387 @item set mipsfpu
23388 @itemx show mipsfpu
23389 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23390
23391 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23392 @kindex set mips mask-address
23393 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23394 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23395 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23396 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23397 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23398
23399 @item show mips mask-address
23400 @kindex show mips mask-address
23401 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23402 not.
23403
23404 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23405 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23406 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23407 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23408 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23409 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23410
23411 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23412 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23413 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23414
23415 @item set debug mips
23416 @kindex set debug mips
23417 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23418 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23419
23420 @item show debug mips
23421 @kindex show debug mips
23422 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23423 @end table
23424
23425
23426 @node HPPA
23427 @subsection HPPA
23428 @cindex HPPA support
23429
23430 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23431 following special commands:
23432
23433 @table @code
23434 @item set debug hppa
23435 @kindex set debug hppa
23436 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23437 messages are to be displayed.
23438
23439 @item show debug hppa
23440 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23441
23442 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23443 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23444 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23445 given @var{address}.
23446
23447 @end table
23448
23449
23450 @node SPU
23451 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23452 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23453 @cindex SPU
23454
23455 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23456 it provides the following special commands:
23457
23458 @table @code
23459 @item info spu event
23460 @kindex info spu
23461 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23462 and pending event status.
23463
23464 @item info spu signal
23465 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23466 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23467 notification channels.
23468
23469 @item info spu mailbox
23470 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23471 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23472 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23473
23474 @item info spu dma
23475 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23476 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23477 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23478
23479 @item info spu proxydma
23480 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23481 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23482 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23483
23484 @end table
23485
23486 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23487 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23488 special commands:
23489
23490 @table @code
23491 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23492 @kindex set spu
23493 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23494 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23495 function. The default is @code{off}.
23496
23497 @item show spu stop-on-load
23498 @kindex show spu
23499 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23500
23501 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23502 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23503 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23504 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23505 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23506 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23507
23508 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23509 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23510
23511 @end table
23512
23513 @node PowerPC
23514 @subsection PowerPC
23515 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23516
23517 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23518 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23519 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23520 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23521 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23522
23523 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23524 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23525 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23526
23527 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23528 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23529
23530 @node Nios II
23531 @subsection Nios II
23532 @cindex Nios II architecture
23533
23534 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23535 it provides the following special commands:
23536
23537 @table @code
23538
23539 @item set debug nios2
23540 @kindex set debug nios2
23541 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23542 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23543
23544 @item show debug nios2
23545 @kindex show debug nios2
23546 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23547 @end table
23548
23549 @node Sparc64
23550 @subsection Sparc64
23551 @cindex Sparc64 support
23552 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23553 @subsubsection ADI Support
23554
23555 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23556 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23557 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23558 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23559 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23560 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23561 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23562 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23563 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23564 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23565 signal.
23566
23567 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23568 ADI-enabled.
23569
23570 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23571 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23572
23573
23574 @table @code
23575 @kindex adi examine
23576 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23577
23578 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23579 cacheline.
23580
23581 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23582 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23583 block size, to display.
23584
23585 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23586 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23587
23588 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23589
23590 @smallexample
23591 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23592 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23593 @end smallexample
23594
23595 @kindex adi assign
23596 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23597
23598 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23599 to an address.
23600
23601 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23602 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23603 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23604
23605 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23606 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23607
23608 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23609
23610 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23611 variable "shmaddr":
23612
23613 @smallexample
23614 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23615 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23616 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23617 @end smallexample
23618
23619 @end table
23620
23621 @node Controlling GDB
23622 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23623
23624 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23625 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23626 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23627 described here.
23628
23629 @menu
23630 * Prompt:: Prompt
23631 * Editing:: Command editing
23632 * Command History:: Command history
23633 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23634 * Numbers:: Numbers
23635 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23636 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23637 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23638 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23639 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23640 @end menu
23641
23642 @node Prompt
23643 @section Prompt
23644
23645 @cindex prompt
23646
23647 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23648 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23649 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23650 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23651 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23652 which one you are talking to.
23653
23654 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23655 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23656 or a prompt that does not.
23657
23658 @table @code
23659 @kindex set prompt
23660 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23661 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23662
23663 @kindex show prompt
23664 @item show prompt
23665 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23666 @end table
23667
23668 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23669 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23670 are:
23671
23672 @table @code
23673 @kindex set extended-prompt
23674 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23675 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23676 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23677 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23678 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23679 is displayed.
23680
23681 For example:
23682
23683 @smallexample
23684 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23685 @end smallexample
23686
23687 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23688 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23689
23690 @kindex show extended-prompt
23691 @item show extended-prompt
23692 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23693 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23694 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23695 @end table
23696
23697 @node Editing
23698 @section Command Editing
23699 @cindex readline
23700 @cindex command line editing
23701
23702 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23703 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23704 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23705 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23706 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23707 debugging sessions.
23708
23709 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23710 command @code{set}.
23711
23712 @table @code
23713 @kindex set editing
23714 @cindex editing
23715 @item set editing
23716 @itemx set editing on
23717 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23718
23719 @item set editing off
23720 Disable command line editing.
23721
23722 @kindex show editing
23723 @item show editing
23724 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23725 @end table
23726
23727 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23728 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23729 @end ifset
23730 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23731 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23732 @end ifclear
23733 for more details about the Readline
23734 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23735 encouraged to read that chapter.
23736
23737 @node Command History
23738 @section Command History
23739 @cindex command history
23740
23741 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23742 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23743 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23744 history facility.
23745
23746 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23747 package, to provide the history facility.
23748 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23749 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23750 @end ifset
23751 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23752 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23753 @end ifclear
23754 for the detailed description of the History library.
23755
23756 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23757 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23758 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23759 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23760 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23761 pressed on a line by itself.
23762
23763 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23764 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23765 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23766 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23767
23768 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23769 history.
23770
23771 @table @code
23772 @cindex history substitution
23773 @cindex history file
23774 @kindex set history filename
23775 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23776 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23777 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23778 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23779 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23780 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23781 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23782 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23783 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23784 is not set.
23785
23786 @cindex save command history
23787 @kindex set history save
23788 @item set history save
23789 @itemx set history save on
23790 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23791 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23792
23793 @item set history save off
23794 Stop recording command history in a file.
23795
23796 @cindex history size
23797 @kindex set history size
23798 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23799 @item set history size @var{size}
23800 @itemx set history size unlimited
23801 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23802 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23803 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23804 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23805 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23806 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23807
23808 @cindex remove duplicate history
23809 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23810 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23811 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23812 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23813 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23814 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23815 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23816 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23817 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23818
23819 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23820 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23821
23822 @end table
23823
23824 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23825 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23826 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23827 @end ifset
23828 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23829 @xref{Event Designators},
23830 @end ifclear
23831 for more details.
23832
23833 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23834 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23835 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23836 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23837 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23838 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23839 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23840 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23841
23842 The commands to control history expansion are:
23843
23844 @table @code
23845 @item set history expansion on
23846 @itemx set history expansion
23847 @kindex set history expansion
23848 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23849
23850 @item set history expansion off
23851 Disable history expansion.
23852
23853 @c @group
23854 @kindex show history
23855 @item show history
23856 @itemx show history filename
23857 @itemx show history save
23858 @itemx show history size
23859 @itemx show history expansion
23860 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23861 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23862 @c @end group
23863 @end table
23864
23865 @table @code
23866 @kindex show commands
23867 @cindex show last commands
23868 @cindex display command history
23869 @item show commands
23870 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23871
23872 @item show commands @var{n}
23873 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23874
23875 @item show commands +
23876 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23877 @end table
23878
23879 @node Screen Size
23880 @section Screen Size
23881 @cindex size of screen
23882 @cindex screen size
23883 @cindex pagination
23884 @cindex page size
23885 @cindex pauses in output
23886
23887 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23888 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23889 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23890 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
23891 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
23892 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
23893 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
23894 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
23895 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
23896 following line.
23897
23898 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23899 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23900 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23901 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23902 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23903 width} commands:
23904
23905 @table @code
23906 @kindex set height
23907 @kindex set width
23908 @kindex show width
23909 @kindex show height
23910 @item set height @var{lpp}
23911 @itemx set height unlimited
23912 @itemx show height
23913 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23914 @itemx set width unlimited
23915 @itemx show width
23916 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23917 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23918 commands display the current settings.
23919
23920 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23921 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23922 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23923 buffer.
23924
23925 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23926 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23927
23928 @item set pagination on
23929 @itemx set pagination off
23930 @kindex set pagination
23931 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23932 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23933 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23934 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23935
23936 @item show pagination
23937 @kindex show pagination
23938 Show the current pagination mode.
23939 @end table
23940
23941 @node Numbers
23942 @section Numbers
23943 @cindex number representation
23944 @cindex entering numbers
23945
23946 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23947 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23948 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23949 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23950 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23951 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23952 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23953 both input and output with the commands described below.
23954
23955 @table @code
23956 @kindex set input-radix
23957 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23958 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23959 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23960 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23961 example, any of
23962
23963 @smallexample
23964 set input-radix 012
23965 set input-radix 10.
23966 set input-radix 0xa
23967 @end smallexample
23968
23969 @noindent
23970 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23971 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23972 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23973 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23974 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23975 change the radix.
23976
23977 @kindex set output-radix
23978 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23979 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23980 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23981 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23982
23983 @kindex show input-radix
23984 @item show input-radix
23985 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23986
23987 @kindex show output-radix
23988 @item show output-radix
23989 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23990
23991 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23992 @itemx show radix
23993 @kindex set radix
23994 @kindex show radix
23995 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23996 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23997 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23998 default value of 10.
23999
24000 @end table
24001
24002 @node ABI
24003 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24004
24005 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24006 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24007 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24008 current ABI.
24009
24010 @cindex OS ABI
24011 @kindex set osabi
24012 @kindex show osabi
24013 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24014
24015 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24016 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24017 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24018 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24019 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24020 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24021 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24022 platform provides.
24023
24024 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24025 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24026 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24027 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24028
24029 @table @code
24030 @item show osabi
24031 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24032
24033 @item set osabi
24034 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24035
24036 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24037 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24038 @end table
24039
24040 @cindex float promotion
24041
24042 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24043 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24044 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24045 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24046 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24047 @code{double} and then passed.
24048
24049 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24050 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24051 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24052
24053 @table @code
24054 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24055 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24056 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24057 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24058 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24059
24060 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24061 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24062 functions.
24063
24064 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24065 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24066 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24067 @end table
24068
24069 @kindex set cp-abi
24070 @kindex show cp-abi
24071 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24072 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24073 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24074 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24075 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24076 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24077 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24078 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24079 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24080 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24081 ``auto''.
24082
24083 @table @code
24084 @item show cp-abi
24085 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24086
24087 @item set cp-abi
24088 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24089
24090 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24091 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24092 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24093 @end table
24094
24095 @node Auto-loading
24096 @section Automatically loading associated files
24097 @cindex auto-loading
24098
24099 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24100 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24101 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24102 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24103 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24104 sources).
24105
24106 @menu
24107 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24108 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24109
24110 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24111 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24112 @end menu
24113
24114 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24115 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24116 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24117
24118 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24119 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24120 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24121
24122 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24123 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24124
24125 @table @code
24126 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24127 @kindex set auto-load off
24128 @item set auto-load off
24129 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24130 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24131 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24132 @smallexample
24133 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24134 @end smallexample
24135
24136 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24137 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24138 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24139 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24140 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24141 @code{set auto-load no}.
24142
24143 @anchor{show auto-load}
24144 @kindex show auto-load
24145 @item show auto-load
24146 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24147 or disabled.
24148
24149 @smallexample
24150 (gdb) show auto-load
24151 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24152 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24153 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24154 is on.
24155 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24156 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24157 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24158 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24159 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24160 @end smallexample
24161
24162 @anchor{info auto-load}
24163 @kindex info auto-load
24164 @item info auto-load
24165 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24166 not.
24167
24168 @smallexample
24169 (gdb) info auto-load
24170 gdb-scripts:
24171 Loaded Script
24172 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24173 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24174 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24175 loaded.
24176 python-scripts:
24177 Loaded Script
24178 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24179 @end smallexample
24180 @end table
24181
24182 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24183
24184 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24185 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24186 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24187 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24188 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24189 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24190 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24191 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24192 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24193 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24194 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24195 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24196 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24197 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24198 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24199 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24200 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24201 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24202 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24203 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24204 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24205 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24206 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24207 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24208 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24209 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24210 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24211 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24212 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24213 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24214 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24215 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24216 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24217 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24218 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24219 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24220 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24221 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24222 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24223 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24224 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24225 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24226 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24227 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24228 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24229 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24230 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24231 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24232 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24233 @end multitable
24234
24235 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24236 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24237 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24238
24239 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24240 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24241 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24242
24243 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24244 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24245
24246 @table @code
24247 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24248 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24249 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24250 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24251 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24252
24253 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24254 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24255 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24256 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24257 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24258
24259 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24260 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24261 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24262 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24263 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24264 @end table
24265
24266 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24267 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24268 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24269
24270 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24271
24272 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24273 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24274
24275 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24276 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24277 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24278 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24279 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24280 library.
24281
24282 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24283 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24284
24285 @table @code
24286 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24287 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24288 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24289 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24290
24291 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24292 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24293 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24294 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24295 enabled or disabled.
24296
24297 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24298 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24299 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24300 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24301 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24302 @end table
24303
24304 @node Auto-loading safe path
24305 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24306 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24307
24308 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24309 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24310 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24311 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24312 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24313
24314 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24315 get loaded:
24316
24317 @smallexample
24318 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24319 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24320 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24321 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24322 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24323 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24324 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24325 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24326 @end smallexample
24327
24328 @noindent
24329 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24330 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24331
24332 @smallexample
24333 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24334 @end smallexample
24335
24336 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24337
24338 @table @code
24339 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24340 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24341 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24342 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24343 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24344 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24345 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24346 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24347 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24348 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24349
24350 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24351 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24352 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24353
24354 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24355 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24356 @item show auto-load safe-path
24357 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24358 scripts.
24359
24360 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24361 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24362 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24363 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24364 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24365 by the host platform path separator in use.
24366 @end table
24367
24368 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24369 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24370 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24371 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24372 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24373
24374 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24375 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24376 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24377 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24378 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24379 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24380 init file in the current directory
24381 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24382
24383 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24384 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24385
24386 @table @asis
24387 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24388 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24389 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24390 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24391
24392 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24393 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24394 @value{GDBN} session.
24395
24396 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24397 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24398 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24399 from trusted sources.
24400
24401 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24402 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24403 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24404 trusted sources.
24405 @end table
24406
24407 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24408 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24409
24410 @table @asis
24411 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24412 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24413
24414 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24415 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24416 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24417 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24418 @end table
24419
24420 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24421 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24422 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24423 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24424 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24425 recommended to be entered.
24426
24427 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24428 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24429 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24430
24431 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24432 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24433 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24434 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24435 be printed.
24436
24437 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24438 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24439 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24440
24441 @smallexample
24442 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24443 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24444 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24445 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24446 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24447 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24448 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24449 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24450 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24451 @end smallexample
24452
24453 @table @code
24454 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24455 @kindex set debug auto-load
24456 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24457 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24458
24459 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24460 @kindex show debug auto-load
24461 @item show debug auto-load
24462 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24463 on or off.
24464 @end table
24465
24466 @node Messages/Warnings
24467 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24468
24469 @cindex verbose operation
24470 @cindex optional warnings
24471 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24472 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24473 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24474 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24475
24476 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24477 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24478 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24479
24480 @table @code
24481 @kindex set verbose
24482 @item set verbose on
24483 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24484
24485 @item set verbose off
24486 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24487
24488 @kindex show verbose
24489 @item show verbose
24490 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24491 @end table
24492
24493 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24494 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24495 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24496 Symbol Files}).
24497
24498 @table @code
24499
24500 @kindex set complaints
24501 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24502 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24503 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24504 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24505 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24506
24507 @kindex show complaints
24508 @item show complaints
24509 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24510
24511 @end table
24512
24513 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24514 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24515 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24516 you try to run a program which is already running:
24517
24518 @smallexample
24519 (@value{GDBP}) run
24520 The program being debugged has been started already.
24521 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24522 @end smallexample
24523
24524 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24525 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24526
24527 @table @code
24528
24529 @kindex set confirm
24530 @cindex flinching
24531 @cindex confirmation
24532 @cindex stupid questions
24533 @item set confirm off
24534 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24535 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24536 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24537
24538 @item set confirm on
24539 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24540
24541 @kindex show confirm
24542 @item show confirm
24543 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24544
24545 @end table
24546
24547 @cindex command tracing
24548 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24549 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24550 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24551 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24552
24553 @table @code
24554 @kindex set trace-commands
24555 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24556 @item set trace-commands on
24557 Enable command tracing.
24558 @item set trace-commands off
24559 Disable command tracing.
24560 @item show trace-commands
24561 Display the current state of command tracing.
24562 @end table
24563
24564 @node Debugging Output
24565 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24566 @cindex optional debugging messages
24567
24568 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24569 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24570 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24571 section documents those commands.
24572
24573 @table @code
24574 @kindex set exec-done-display
24575 @item set exec-done-display
24576 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24577 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24578 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24579 @kindex show exec-done-display
24580 @item show exec-done-display
24581 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24582 notification.
24583 @kindex set debug
24584 @cindex ARM AArch64
24585 @item set debug aarch64
24586 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24587 The default is off.
24588 @kindex show debug
24589 @item show debug aarch64
24590 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24591 ARM AArch64.
24592 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24593 @cindex architecture debugging info
24594 @item set debug arch
24595 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24596 @item show debug arch
24597 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24598 @item set debug aix-solib
24599 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24600 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24601 support module. The default is off.
24602 @item show debug aix-thread
24603 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24604 @item set debug aix-thread
24605 @cindex AIX threads
24606 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24607 module.
24608 @item show debug aix-thread
24609 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24610 @item set debug check-physname
24611 @cindex physname
24612 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24613 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24614 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24615 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24616 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24617 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24618 @item show debug check-physname
24619 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24620 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24621 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24622 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24623 exported symbols. The default is off.
24624 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24625 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24626 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24627 @item set debug dwarf-die
24628 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24629 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24630 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24631 A value of zero turns off the display.
24632 @item show debug dwarf-die
24633 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24634 @item set debug dwarf-line
24635 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24636 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24637 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24638 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24639 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24640 @item show debug dwarf-line
24641 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24642 @item set debug dwarf-read
24643 @cindex DWARF Reading
24644 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24645 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24646 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24647 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24648 @item show debug dwarf-read
24649 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24650 @item set debug displaced
24651 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24652 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24653 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24654 @item show debug displaced
24655 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24656 related to displaced stepping.
24657 @item set debug event
24658 @cindex event debugging info
24659 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24660 default is off.
24661 @item show debug event
24662 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24663 info.
24664 @item set debug expression
24665 @cindex expression debugging info
24666 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24667 expression parsing. The default is off.
24668 @item show debug expression
24669 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24670 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24671 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24672 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24673 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24674 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24675 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24676 @item set debug fbsd-nat
24677 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
24678 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
24679 @item show debug fbsd-nat
24680 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
24681 @item set debug frame
24682 @cindex frame debugging info
24683 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24684 default is off.
24685 @item show debug frame
24686 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24687 info.
24688 @item set debug gnu-nat
24689 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24690 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24691 @item show debug gnu-nat
24692 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24693 @item set debug infrun
24694 @cindex inferior debugging info
24695 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24696 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24697 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24698 @item show debug infrun
24699 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24700 @item set debug jit
24701 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24702 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24703 @item show debug jit
24704 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24705 @item set debug lin-lwp
24706 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24707 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24708 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24709 @item show debug lin-lwp
24710 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24711 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24712 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24713 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24714 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24715 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24716 @item set debug mach-o
24717 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24718 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24719 processing. The default is off.
24720 @item show debug mach-o
24721 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24722 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24723 @item set debug notification
24724 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24725 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24726 The default is off.
24727 @item show debug notification
24728 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24729 @item set debug observer
24730 @cindex observer debugging info
24731 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24732 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24733 @item show debug observer
24734 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24735 @item set debug overload
24736 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24737 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24738 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24739 is off.
24740 @item show debug overload
24741 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24742 debugging info.
24743 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24744 @cindex debug expression parser
24745 @item set debug parser
24746 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24747 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24748 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24749 details. The default is off.
24750 @item show debug parser
24751 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24752 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24753 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24754 @cindex debug remote protocol
24755 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24756 @cindex display remote packets
24757 @item set debug remote
24758 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24759 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24760 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24761 @item show debug remote
24762 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24763
24764 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24765 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24766 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24767 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24768
24769 @item set debug serial
24770 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24771 default is off.
24772 @item show debug serial
24773 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24774 info.
24775 @item set debug solib-frv
24776 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24777 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24778 @item show debug solib-frv
24779 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24780 messages.
24781 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24782 @cindex symbol lookup
24783 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24784 The default is 0 (off).
24785 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24786 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24787 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24788 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24789 @item set debug symfile
24790 @cindex symbol file functions
24791 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24792 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24793 @item show debug symfile
24794 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24795 @item set debug symtab-create
24796 @cindex symbol table creation
24797 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24798 The default is 0 (off).
24799 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24800 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24801 @item show debug symtab-create
24802 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24803 @item set debug target
24804 @cindex target debugging info
24805 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24806 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24807 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24808 value of large memory transfers.
24809 @item show debug target
24810 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24811 info.
24812 @item set debug timestamp
24813 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24814 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24815 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24816 message.
24817 @item show debug timestamp
24818 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24819 debugging info.
24820 @item set debug varobj
24821 @cindex variable object debugging info
24822 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24823 info. The default is off.
24824 @item show debug varobj
24825 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24826 debugging info.
24827 @item set debug xml
24828 @cindex XML parser debugging
24829 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24830 @item show debug xml
24831 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24832 @end table
24833
24834 @node Other Misc Settings
24835 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24836 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24837
24838 @table @code
24839 @kindex set interactive-mode
24840 @item set interactive-mode
24841 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24842 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24843 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24844 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24845 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24846 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24847 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24848 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24849
24850 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24851 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24852 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24853 inside a cygwin window.
24854
24855 @kindex show interactive-mode
24856 @item show interactive-mode
24857 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24858 @end table
24859
24860 @node Extending GDB
24861 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24862 @cindex extending GDB
24863
24864 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24865 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24866 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24867 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24868 being debugged.
24869
24870 @menu
24871 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24872 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24873 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24874 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24875 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24876 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24877 @end menu
24878
24879 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24880 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24881 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24882 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24883 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24884 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24885
24886 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24887 setting:
24888
24889 @table @code
24890 @kindex set script-extension
24891 @kindex show script-extension
24892 @item set script-extension off
24893 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24894
24895 @item set script-extension soft
24896 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24897 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24898 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24899 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24900
24901 @item set script-extension strict
24902 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24903 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24904 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24905
24906 @item show script-extension
24907 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24908
24909 @end table
24910
24911 @node Sequences
24912 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24913
24914 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24915 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24916 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24917 files.
24918
24919 @menu
24920 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24921 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24922 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24923 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24924 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24925 @end menu
24926
24927 @node Define
24928 @subsection User-defined Commands
24929
24930 @cindex user-defined command
24931 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24932 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24933 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24934 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24935 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24936 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24937
24938 @smallexample
24939 define adder
24940 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24941 end
24942 @end smallexample
24943
24944 @noindent
24945 To execute the command use:
24946
24947 @smallexample
24948 adder 1 2 3
24949 @end smallexample
24950
24951 @noindent
24952 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24953 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24954 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24955 functions calls.
24956
24957 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24958 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24959 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24960 been passed.
24961
24962 @smallexample
24963 define adder
24964 if $argc == 2
24965 print $arg0 + $arg1
24966 end
24967 if $argc == 3
24968 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24969 end
24970 end
24971 @end smallexample
24972
24973 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24974 to process a variable number of arguments:
24975
24976 @smallexample
24977 define adder
24978 set $i = 0
24979 set $sum = 0
24980 while $i < $argc
24981 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24982 set $i = $i + 1
24983 end
24984 print $sum
24985 end
24986 @end smallexample
24987
24988 @table @code
24989
24990 @kindex define
24991 @item define @var{commandname}
24992 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24993 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24994 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24995 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24996 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24997 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24998
24999 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25000 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25001 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25002
25003 @kindex document
25004 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25005 @item document @var{commandname}
25006 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25007 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25008 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25009 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25010 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25011 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25012
25013 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25014 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25015 does not change the documentation.
25016
25017 @kindex dont-repeat
25018 @cindex don't repeat command
25019 @item dont-repeat
25020 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25021 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25022 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25023
25024 @kindex help user-defined
25025 @item help user-defined
25026 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25027 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25028 included (if any).
25029
25030 @kindex show user
25031 @item show user
25032 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25033 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25034 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25035 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25036 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25037
25038 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25039 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25040 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25041 @item show max-user-call-depth
25042 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25043 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25044 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25045 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25046 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25047 @end table
25048
25049 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25050 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25051
25052 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25053 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25054 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25055
25056 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25057 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25058 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25059 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25060
25061 @node Hooks
25062 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25063 @cindex command hooks
25064 @cindex hooks, for commands
25065 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25066
25067 @kindex hook
25068 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25069 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25070 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25071 before that command.
25072
25073 @cindex hooks, post-command
25074 @kindex hookpost
25075 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25076 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25077 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25078 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25079 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25080
25081 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25082 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25083
25084 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25085 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25086
25087 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25088 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25089 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25090 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25091 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25092
25093 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25094 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25095 you could define:
25096
25097 @smallexample
25098 define hook-stop
25099 handle SIGALRM nopass
25100 end
25101
25102 define hook-run
25103 handle SIGALRM pass
25104 end
25105
25106 define hook-continue
25107 handle SIGALRM pass
25108 end
25109 @end smallexample
25110
25111 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25112 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25113 you could define:
25114
25115 @smallexample
25116 define hook-echo
25117 echo <<<---
25118 end
25119
25120 define hookpost-echo
25121 echo --->>>\n
25122 end
25123
25124 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25125 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25126 (@value{GDBP})
25127
25128 @end smallexample
25129
25130 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25131 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25132 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25133 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25134 @c or not?
25135 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25136 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25137 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25138
25139 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25140 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25141 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25142
25143 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25144 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25145
25146 @node Command Files
25147 @subsection Command Files
25148
25149 @cindex command files
25150 @cindex scripting commands
25151 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25152 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25153 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25154 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25155 terminal.
25156
25157 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25158 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25159 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25160 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25161 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25162
25163 @table @code
25164 @kindex source
25165 @cindex execute commands from a file
25166 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25167 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25168 @end table
25169
25170 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25171 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25172 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25173 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25174 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25175
25176 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25177 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25178 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25179 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25180 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25181 is not relevant to scripts.
25182
25183 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25184 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25185 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25186 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25187 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25188 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25189 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25190 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25191 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25192 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25193 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25194 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25195 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25196 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25197
25198 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25199 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25200 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25201
25202 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25203 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25204 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25205 when called from command files.
25206
25207 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25208 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25209 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25210 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25211 the next command.
25212
25213 @smallexample
25214 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25215 @end smallexample
25216
25217 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25218 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25219 would be directed to @file{log}.
25220
25221 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25222 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25223 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25224 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25225 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25226 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25227 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25228 conditionally, etc.
25229
25230 @table @code
25231 @kindex if
25232 @kindex else
25233 @item if
25234 @itemx else
25235 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25236 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25237 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25238 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25239 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25240 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25241 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25242
25243 @kindex while
25244 @item while
25245 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25246 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25247 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25248 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25249 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25250 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25251
25252 @kindex loop_break
25253 @item loop_break
25254 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25255 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25256 line.
25257
25258 @kindex loop_continue
25259 @item loop_continue
25260 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25261 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25262 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25263 the controlling expression.
25264
25265 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25266 @item end
25267 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25268 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25269 @end table
25270
25271
25272 @node Output
25273 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25274
25275 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25276 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25277 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25278 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25279 want.
25280
25281 @table @code
25282 @kindex echo
25283 @item echo @var{text}
25284 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25285 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25286 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25287 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25288 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25289 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25290 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25291 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25292 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25293 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25294 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25295
25296 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25297 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25298
25299 @smallexample
25300 echo This is some text\n\
25301 which is continued\n\
25302 onto several lines.\n
25303 @end smallexample
25304
25305 produces the same output as
25306
25307 @smallexample
25308 echo This is some text\n
25309 echo which is continued\n
25310 echo onto several lines.\n
25311 @end smallexample
25312
25313 @kindex output
25314 @item output @var{expression}
25315 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25316 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25317 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25318 on expressions.
25319
25320 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25321 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25322 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25323 Formats}, for more information.
25324
25325 @kindex printf
25326 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25327 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25328 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25329 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25330 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25331 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25332 executing the code below:
25333
25334 @smallexample
25335 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25336 @end smallexample
25337
25338 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25339 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25340 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25341 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25342 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25343 printed.
25344
25345 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25346
25347 @smallexample
25348 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25349 @end smallexample
25350
25351 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25352 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25353 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25354
25355 @itemize @bullet
25356 @item
25357 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25358
25359 @item
25360 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25361 width.
25362
25363 @item
25364 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25365 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25366
25367 @item
25368 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25369 supported.
25370
25371 @item
25372 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25373
25374 @item
25375 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25376 @end itemize
25377
25378 @noindent
25379 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25380 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25381 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25382 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25383
25384 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25385 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25386 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25387 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25388 supported.
25389
25390 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25391 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25392 together with a floating point specifier.
25393 letters:
25394
25395 @itemize @bullet
25396 @item
25397 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25398
25399 @item
25400 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25401
25402 @item
25403 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25404 @end itemize
25405
25406 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25407 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25408 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25409
25410 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25411 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25412
25413 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25414 @smallexample
25415 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25416 @end smallexample
25417
25418 @anchor{eval}
25419 @kindex eval
25420 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25421 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25422 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25423
25424 @end table
25425
25426 @node Auto-loading sequences
25427 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25428 @cindex native script auto-loading
25429
25430 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25431 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25432 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25433 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25434
25435 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25436 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25437
25438 @table @code
25439 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25440 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25441 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25442 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25443
25444 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25445 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25446 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25447 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25448 disabled.
25449
25450 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25451 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25452 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25453 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25454 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25455 auto-loaded.
25456 @end table
25457
25458 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25459 matching names are printed.
25460
25461 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25462 @include python.texi
25463
25464 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25465 @include guile.texi
25466
25467 @node Auto-loading extensions
25468 @section Auto-loading extensions
25469 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25470
25471 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25472 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25473 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25474 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25475 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25476
25477 @menu
25478 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25479 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25480 * Which flavor to choose?::
25481 @end menu
25482
25483 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25484 debugging commands and features.
25485
25486 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25487 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25488 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25489 for more information.
25490 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25491 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25492
25493 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25494 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25495
25496 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25497 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25498 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25499 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25500 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25501
25502 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25503 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25504 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25505 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25506
25507 @table @code
25508 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25509 GDB's own command language
25510 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25511 Python
25512 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25513 Guile
25514 @end table
25515
25516 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25517 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25518 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25519 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25520 script in the specified extension language.
25521
25522 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25523 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25524
25525 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25526 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25527
25528 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25529 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25530 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25531 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25532 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25533 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25534
25535 @table @code
25536 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25537 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25538 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25539 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25540 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25541 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25542
25543 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25544 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25545
25546 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25547 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25548 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25549 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25550
25551 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25552 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25553 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25554 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25555 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25556 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25557 platform.
25558
25559 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25560 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25561 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25562
25563 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25564 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25565 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25566 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25567
25568 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25569 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25570 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25571 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25572 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25573 @end table
25574
25575 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25576 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25577 @var{objfile} is opened.
25578 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25579 is evaluated more than once.
25580
25581 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25582 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25583 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25584
25585 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25586 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25587 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25588 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25589 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25590 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25591 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25592
25593 The following entries are supported:
25594
25595 @table @code
25596 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25597 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25598 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25599 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25600 @end table
25601
25602 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25603
25604 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25605 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25606 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25607 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25608 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25609
25610 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25611 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25612
25613 @example
25614 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25615 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25616 asm("\
25617 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25618 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25619 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25620 .popsection \n\
25621 ");
25622 @end example
25623
25624 @noindent
25625 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25626 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25627
25628 @example
25629 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25630 @end example
25631
25632 The script name may include directories if desired.
25633
25634 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25635 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25636
25637 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25638 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25639 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25640 will remove duplicates.
25641
25642 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25643
25644 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25645 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25646 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25647 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25648 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25649 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25650 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25651 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25652 on its name.
25653
25654 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25655 testsuite.
25656
25657 @example
25658 #include "symcat.h"
25659 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25660 asm(
25661 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25662 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25663 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25664 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25665 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25666 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25667 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25668 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25669 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25670 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25671 ".byte 0\n"
25672 ".popsection\n"
25673 );
25674 @end example
25675
25676 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25677 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25678 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25679 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25680
25681 @node Which flavor to choose?
25682 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25683
25684 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25685 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25686
25687 @noindent
25688 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25689
25690 @itemize @bullet
25691 @item
25692 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25693
25694 @item
25695 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25696
25697 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25698 in the source search path.
25699 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25700 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25701
25702 @item
25703 Doesn't require source code additions.
25704 @end itemize
25705
25706 @noindent
25707 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25708
25709 @itemize @bullet
25710 @item
25711 Works with static linking.
25712
25713 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25714 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25715 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25716 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25717 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25718
25719 @item
25720 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25721
25722 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25723 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25724
25725 @item
25726 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25727
25728 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25729 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25730 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25731 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25732 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25733 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25734 @end itemize
25735
25736 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25737 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25738
25739 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25740 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25741 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25742
25743 @subsection Python comes first
25744
25745 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25746 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25747 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25748 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25749 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25750 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25751 pretty-printed form of a value).
25752 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25753 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25754 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25755
25756 @node Aliases
25757 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25758 @cindex aliases for commands
25759
25760 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25761 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25762 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25763 that involves less typing.
25764
25765 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25766 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25767 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25768
25769 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25770 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25771 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25772
25773 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25774
25775 @table @code
25776
25777 @kindex alias
25778 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25779
25780 @end table
25781
25782 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25783 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25784 underscores.
25785
25786 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25787 that is being aliased.
25788
25789 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25790 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25791 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25792
25793 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25794 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25795
25796 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25797 of a command so that there is less to type.
25798 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25799 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25800 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25801 The following will accomplish this.
25802
25803 @smallexample
25804 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25805 @end smallexample
25806
25807 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25808 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25809 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25810 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25811
25812 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25813 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25814 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25815 of a command.
25816
25817 @smallexample
25818 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25819 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25820 (gdb) set p elms 20
25821 (gdb) show p elms
25822 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25823 @end smallexample
25824
25825 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25826 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25827 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25828
25829 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25830 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25831
25832 @smallexample
25833 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25834 @end smallexample
25835
25836 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25837 alias for a more complex command.
25838 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25839
25840 @smallexample
25841 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25842 (gdb) spe 20
25843 @end smallexample
25844
25845 @node Interpreters
25846 @chapter Command Interpreters
25847 @cindex command interpreters
25848
25849 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25850 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25851 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25852
25853 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25854 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25855 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25856 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25857
25858 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25859 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25860 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25861 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25862
25863 @table @code
25864 @item console
25865 @cindex console interpreter
25866 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25867 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25868 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25869
25870 @item mi
25871 @cindex mi interpreter
25872 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25873 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25874 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25875 Interface}.
25876
25877 @item mi2
25878 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25879 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25880
25881 @item mi1
25882 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25883 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25884
25885 @end table
25886
25887 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25888
25889 @kindex interpreter-exec
25890 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25891 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25892 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25893
25894 @smallexample
25895 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25896 @end smallexample
25897
25898 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25899 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25900
25901 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25902 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25903 permanently.
25904
25905 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25906
25907 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25908 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25909 device (usually a tty).
25910
25911 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25912 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25913 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25914 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25915 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25916 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25917 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25918 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25919 the separate MI interpreter.
25920
25921 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25922 @code{new-ui} command:
25923
25924 @kindex new-ui
25925 @cindex new user interface
25926 @smallexample
25927 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25928 @end smallexample
25929
25930 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25931 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25932 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25933 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25934 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25935 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25936
25937 @smallexample
25938 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25939 @end smallexample
25940
25941 @noindent
25942 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25943
25944 @node TUI
25945 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25946 @cindex TUI
25947 @cindex Text User Interface
25948
25949 @menu
25950 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25951 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25952 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25953 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25954 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25955 @end menu
25956
25957 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25958 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25959 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25960 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25961 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25962 is available.
25963
25964 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25965 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25966 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25967 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25968 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25969 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25970
25971 @node TUI Overview
25972 @section TUI Overview
25973
25974 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25975
25976 @table @emph
25977 @item command
25978 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25979 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25980 managed using readline.
25981
25982 @item source
25983 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25984 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25985
25986 @item assembly
25987 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25988
25989 @item register
25990 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25991 when their values change.
25992 @end table
25993
25994 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25995 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25996 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25997 indicates the breakpoint type:
25998
25999 @table @code
26000 @item B
26001 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26002
26003 @item b
26004 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26005
26006 @item H
26007 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26008
26009 @item h
26010 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26011 @end table
26012
26013 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26014
26015 @table @code
26016 @item +
26017 Breakpoint is enabled.
26018
26019 @item -
26020 Breakpoint is disabled.
26021 @end table
26022
26023 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26024 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26025 changes.
26026
26027 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26028 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26029 layouts:
26030
26031 @itemize @bullet
26032 @item
26033 source only,
26034
26035 @item
26036 assembly only,
26037
26038 @item
26039 source and assembly,
26040
26041 @item
26042 source and registers, or
26043
26044 @item
26045 assembly and registers.
26046 @end itemize
26047
26048 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26049
26050 @table @emph
26051 @item target
26052 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26053 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26054
26055 @item process
26056 Gives the current process or thread number.
26057 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26058
26059 @item function
26060 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26061 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26062 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26063 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26064
26065 @item line
26066 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26067 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26068
26069 @item pc
26070 Indicates the current program counter address.
26071 @end table
26072
26073 @node TUI Keys
26074 @section TUI Key Bindings
26075 @cindex TUI key bindings
26076
26077 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26078 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26079 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26080 @end ifset
26081 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26082 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26083 @end ifclear
26084 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26085 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26086
26087 @table @kbd
26088 @kindex C-x C-a
26089 @item C-x C-a
26090 @kindex C-x a
26091 @itemx C-x a
26092 @kindex C-x A
26093 @itemx C-x A
26094 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26095 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26096 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26097 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26098 The screen is then refreshed.
26099
26100 @kindex C-x 1
26101 @item C-x 1
26102 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26103 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26104 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26105
26106 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26107
26108 @kindex C-x 2
26109 @item C-x 2
26110 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26111 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26112 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26113 previous layout and the new one.
26114
26115 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26116
26117 @kindex C-x o
26118 @item C-x o
26119 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26120 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26121 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26122
26123 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26124
26125 @kindex C-x s
26126 @item C-x s
26127 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26128 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26129 @end table
26130
26131 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26132
26133 @table @asis
26134 @kindex PgUp
26135 @item @key{PgUp}
26136 Scroll the active window one page up.
26137
26138 @kindex PgDn
26139 @item @key{PgDn}
26140 Scroll the active window one page down.
26141
26142 @kindex Up
26143 @item @key{Up}
26144 Scroll the active window one line up.
26145
26146 @kindex Down
26147 @item @key{Down}
26148 Scroll the active window one line down.
26149
26150 @kindex Left
26151 @item @key{Left}
26152 Scroll the active window one column left.
26153
26154 @kindex Right
26155 @item @key{Right}
26156 Scroll the active window one column right.
26157
26158 @kindex C-L
26159 @item @kbd{C-L}
26160 Refresh the screen.
26161 @end table
26162
26163 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26164 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26165 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26166 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26167 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26168
26169 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26170 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26171 @cindex TUI single key mode
26172
26173 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26174 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26175 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26176
26177 @table @kbd
26178 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26179 @item c
26180 continue
26181
26182 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26183 @item d
26184 down
26185
26186 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26187 @item f
26188 finish
26189
26190 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26191 @item n
26192 next
26193
26194 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26195 @item o
26196 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26197
26198 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26199 @item q
26200 exit the SingleKey mode.
26201
26202 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26203 @item r
26204 run
26205
26206 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26207 @item s
26208 step
26209
26210 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26211 @item i
26212 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26213
26214 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26215 @item u
26216 up
26217
26218 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26219 @item v
26220 info locals
26221
26222 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26223 @item w
26224 where
26225 @end table
26226
26227 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26228 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26229 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26230 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26231 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26232 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26233
26234
26235 @node TUI Commands
26236 @section TUI-specific Commands
26237 @cindex TUI commands
26238
26239 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26240 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26241 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26242 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26243
26244 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26245 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26246 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26247 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26248 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26249
26250 @table @code
26251 @item tui enable
26252 @kindex tui enable
26253 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26254 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26255 otherwise a default layout is used.
26256
26257 @item tui disable
26258 @kindex tui disable
26259 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26260
26261 @item info win
26262 @kindex info win
26263 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26264
26265 @item layout @var{name}
26266 @kindex layout
26267 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26268 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26269 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26270
26271 @table @code
26272 @item next
26273 Display the next layout.
26274
26275 @item prev
26276 Display the previous layout.
26277
26278 @item src
26279 Display the source and command windows.
26280
26281 @item asm
26282 Display the assembly and command windows.
26283
26284 @item split
26285 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26286
26287 @item regs
26288 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26289 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26290 register, assembler, and command windows.
26291 @end table
26292
26293 @item focus @var{name}
26294 @kindex focus
26295 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26296 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26297
26298 @table @code
26299 @item next
26300 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26301
26302 @item prev
26303 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26304
26305 @item src
26306 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26307
26308 @item asm
26309 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26310
26311 @item regs
26312 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26313
26314 @item cmd
26315 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26316 @end table
26317
26318 @item refresh
26319 @kindex refresh
26320 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26321
26322 @item tui reg @var{group}
26323 @kindex tui reg
26324 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26325 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26326 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26327 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26328 following groups are available on most targets:
26329 @table @code
26330 @item next
26331 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26332 through all of the available register groups.
26333
26334 @item prev
26335 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26336 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26337 @var{next}.
26338
26339 @item general
26340 Display the general registers.
26341 @item float
26342 Display the floating point registers.
26343 @item system
26344 Display the system registers.
26345 @item vector
26346 Display the vector registers.
26347 @item all
26348 Display all registers.
26349 @end table
26350
26351 @item update
26352 @kindex update
26353 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26354
26355 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26356 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26357 @kindex winheight
26358 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26359 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26360 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26361 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26362 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26363
26364 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26365 @kindex tabset
26366 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26367 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26368 assembly windows.
26369 @end table
26370
26371 @node TUI Configuration
26372 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26373 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26374
26375 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26376
26377 @table @code
26378 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26379 @kindex set tui border-kind
26380 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26381 The possible values are the following:
26382 @table @code
26383 @item space
26384 Use a space character to draw the border.
26385
26386 @item ascii
26387 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26388
26389 @item acs
26390 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26391 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26392 @end table
26393
26394 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26395 @kindex set tui border-mode
26396 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26397 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26398 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26399 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26400 @table @code
26401 @item normal
26402 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26403
26404 @item standout
26405 Use standout mode.
26406
26407 @item reverse
26408 Use reverse video mode.
26409
26410 @item half
26411 Use half bright mode.
26412
26413 @item half-standout
26414 Use half bright and standout mode.
26415
26416 @item bold
26417 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26418
26419 @item bold-standout
26420 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26421 @end table
26422 @end table
26423
26424 @node Emacs
26425 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26426
26427 @cindex Emacs
26428 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26429 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26430 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26431 @value{GDBN}.
26432
26433 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26434 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26435 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26436 created Emacs buffer.
26437 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26438
26439 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26440 things:
26441
26442 @itemize @bullet
26443 @item
26444 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26445 the GUD buffer.
26446
26447 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26448 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26449
26450 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26451 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26452 in this way.
26453
26454 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26455 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26456 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26457 stop.
26458
26459 @item
26460 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26461
26462 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26463 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26464 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26465 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26466 and the source.
26467
26468 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26469 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26470 @end itemize
26471
26472 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26473 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26474 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26475 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26476
26477 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26478 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26479 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26480 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26481 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26482 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26483 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26484 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26485 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26486
26487 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26488 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26489 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26490 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26491
26492 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26493 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26494 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26495 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26496 one you want.
26497
26498 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26499 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26500
26501 @table @kbd
26502 @item C-h m
26503 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26504
26505 @item C-c C-s
26506 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26507 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26508
26509 @item C-c C-n
26510 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26511 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26512 to show the current file and location.
26513
26514 @item C-c C-i
26515 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26516 display window accordingly.
26517
26518 @item C-c C-f
26519 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26520 @code{finish} command.
26521
26522 @item C-c C-r
26523 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26524 command.
26525
26526 @item C-c <
26527 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26528 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26529 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26530
26531 @item C-c >
26532 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26533 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26534 @end table
26535
26536 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26537 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26538
26539 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26540 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26541 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26542 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26543 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26544 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26545 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26546
26547 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26548 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26549 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26550 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26551 frame.
26552
26553 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26554 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26555 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26556 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26557 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26558 to correspond properly with the code.
26559
26560 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26561 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26562 Emacs Manual}).
26563
26564 @node GDB/MI
26565 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26566
26567 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26568
26569 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26570 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26571 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26572 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26573 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26574 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26575
26576 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26577 in the form of a reference manual.
26578
26579 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26580 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26581 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26582
26583 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26584
26585 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26586 This chapter uses the following notation:
26587
26588 @itemize @bullet
26589 @item
26590 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26591
26592 @item
26593 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26594 it may or may not be given.
26595
26596 @item
26597 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26598 may repeat zero or more times.
26599
26600 @item
26601 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26602 may repeat one or more times.
26603
26604 @item
26605 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26606 @end itemize
26607
26608 @ignore
26609 @heading Dependencies
26610 @end ignore
26611
26612 @menu
26613 * GDB/MI General Design::
26614 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26615 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26616 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26617 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26618 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26619 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26620 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26621 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26622 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26623 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26624 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26625 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26626 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26627 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26628 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26629 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26630 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26631 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26632 @ignore
26633 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26634 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26635 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26636 @end ignore
26637 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26638 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26639 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26640 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26641 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26642 @end menu
26643
26644 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26645 @node GDB/MI General Design
26646 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26647 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26648
26649 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26650 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26651 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26652 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26653 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26654 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26655 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26656 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26657 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26658 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26659
26660 The important examples of notifications are:
26661 @itemize @bullet
26662
26663 @item
26664 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26665 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26666 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26667 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26668 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26669 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26670 command itself was successfully executed.
26671
26672 @item
26673 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26674 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26675 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26676 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26677 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26678 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26679
26680 @item
26681 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26682 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26683 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26684 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26685 orthogonal frontend design.
26686
26687 @end itemize
26688
26689 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26690 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26691 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26692 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26693 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26694 the user interface.
26695
26696
26697 @menu
26698 * Context management::
26699 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26700 * Thread groups::
26701 @end menu
26702
26703 @node Context management
26704 @subsection Context management
26705
26706 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26707
26708 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26709 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26710 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26711 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26712 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26713 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26714 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26715 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26716 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26717
26718 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26719 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26720 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26721 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26722 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26723 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26724 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26725 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26726 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26727 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26728 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26729
26730 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26731 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26732 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26733 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26734 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26735 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26736 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26737 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26738 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26739 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26740
26741 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26742 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26743 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26744 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26745 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26746 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26747 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26748 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26749 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26750 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26751 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26752 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26753 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26754 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26755 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26756 @samp{--frame} options.
26757
26758 @subsubsection Language
26759
26760 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26761 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26762 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26763 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26764 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26765 For instance:
26766
26767 @smallexample
26768 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26769 ^done,value="4"
26770 (gdb)
26771 @end smallexample
26772
26773 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26774 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26775 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26776
26777 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26778 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26779
26780 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26781 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26782 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26783 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26784 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26785 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26786 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26787 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26788 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26789
26790 @table @code
26791 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26792 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26793 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26794
26795 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26796 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26797 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26798
26799 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26800 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26801 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26802 MI commands even while the target is running.
26803
26804 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26805 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26806 @end table
26807
26808 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26809 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26810 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26811 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26812 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26813 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26814
26815 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26816 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26817 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26818 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26819 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26820 are running.
26821
26822 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26823 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26824 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26825 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26826 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26827 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26828 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26829 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26830 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26831 @samp{--thread} option).
26832
26833 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26834 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26835 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26836 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26837
26838 @node Thread groups
26839 @subsection Thread groups
26840 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26841 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26842 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26843 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26844 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26845
26846 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26847 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26848 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26849 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26850 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26851 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26852 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26853 into processes.
26854
26855 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26856 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26857 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26858 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26859 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26860 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26861 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26862 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26863 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26864 the members of specific thread group.
26865
26866 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26867 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26868 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26869 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26870 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26871 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26872 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26873 after attaching to that thread group.
26874
26875 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26876 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26877 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26878 such thread groups.
26879
26880 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26881 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26882 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26883
26884 @menu
26885 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26886 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26887 @end menu
26888
26889 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26890 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26891
26892 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26893 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26894 @table @code
26895 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26896 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26897
26898 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26899 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26900 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26901
26902 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26903 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26904 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26905
26906 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26907 "any sequence of digits"
26908
26909 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26910 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26911
26912 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26913 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26914
26915 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26916 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26917
26918 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26919 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26920 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26921
26922 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26923 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26924
26925 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26926 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26927 @end table
26928
26929 @noindent
26930 Notes:
26931
26932 @itemize @bullet
26933 @item
26934 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26935 output is described below.
26936
26937 @item
26938 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26939 finishes.
26940
26941 @item
26942 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26943 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26944 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26945 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26946 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26947 @end itemize
26948
26949 Pragmatics:
26950
26951 @itemize @bullet
26952 @item
26953 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26954
26955 @item
26956 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26957 @end itemize
26958
26959 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26960 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26961
26962 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26963 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26964 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26965 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26966 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26967 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26968
26969 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26970 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26971 @var{token}.
26972
26973 @table @code
26974 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26975 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26976
26977 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26978 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26979
26980 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26981 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26982
26983 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26984 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26985
26986 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26987 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26988
26989 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26990 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26991
26992 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26993 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26994
26995 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26996 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26997
26998 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26999 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27000
27001 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27002 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27003 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27004
27005 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27006 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27007
27008 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27009 @code{ @var{string} }
27010
27011 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27012 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27013
27014 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27015 @code{@var{c-string}}
27016
27017 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27018 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27019
27020 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27021 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27022 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27023
27024 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27025 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27026
27027 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27028 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27029
27030 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27031 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27032
27033 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27034 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27035
27036 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27037 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27038
27039 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27040 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27041 @end table
27042
27043 @noindent
27044 Notes:
27045
27046 @itemize @bullet
27047 @item
27048 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27049
27050 @item
27051 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27052 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27053 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27054 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27055 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27056 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27057 prior command.
27058
27059 @item
27060 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27061 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27062 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27063 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27064
27065 @item
27066 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27067 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27068 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27069 @samp{*}.
27070
27071 @item
27072 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27073 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27074 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27075 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27076
27077 @item
27078 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27079 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27080 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27081 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27082
27083 @item
27084 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27085 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27086 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27087
27088 @item
27089 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27090 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27091 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27092 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27093
27094 @item
27095 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27096 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27097 @var{values}.
27098
27099
27100 @end itemize
27101
27102 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27103 details about the various output records.
27104
27105 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27106 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27107 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27108
27109 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27110 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27111
27112 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27113 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27114 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27115 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27116 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27117 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27118
27119 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27120 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27121 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27122
27123 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27124 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27125 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27126 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27127
27128 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27129 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27130
27131 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27132 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27133 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27134 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27135 might change.
27136
27137 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27138 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27139 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27140 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27141
27142 @itemize @bullet
27143 @item
27144 New MI commands may be added.
27145
27146 @item
27147 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27148
27149 @item
27150 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27151 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27152
27153 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27154 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27155
27156 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27157 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27158 @end itemize
27159
27160 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27161 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27162 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27163 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27164 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27165
27166 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27167 @c version?
27168
27169 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27170 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27171 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27172 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27173 @cindex mailing lists
27174
27175 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27176 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27177 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27178
27179 @menu
27180 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27181 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27182 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27183 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27184 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27185 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27186 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27187 @end menu
27188
27189 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27190 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27191
27192 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27193 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27194 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27195 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27196
27197 @table @code
27198 @findex ^done
27199 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27200 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27201 values.
27202
27203 @item "^running"
27204 @findex ^running
27205 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27206 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27207 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27208 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27209 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27210 which threads are resumed.
27211
27212 @item "^connected"
27213 @findex ^connected
27214 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27215
27216 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27217 @findex ^error
27218 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27219 the corresponding error message.
27220
27221 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27222 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27223 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27224
27225 @table @samp
27226 @item "undefined-command"
27227 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27228 @end table
27229
27230 @item "^exit"
27231 @findex ^exit
27232 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27233
27234 @end table
27235
27236 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27237 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27238
27239 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27240 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27241 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27242 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27243 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27244
27245 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27246 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27247 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27248 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27249 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27250
27251 @table @code
27252 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27253 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27254 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27255
27256 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27257 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27258 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27259 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27260
27261 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27262 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27263 internals.
27264 @end table
27265
27266 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27267 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27268
27269 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27270 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27271 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27272 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27273 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27274 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27275
27276 The following is the list of possible async records:
27277
27278 @table @code
27279
27280 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27281 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27282 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27283 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27284 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27285 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27286 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27287 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27288 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27289 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27290 it run freely.
27291
27292 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27293 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27294 following values:
27295
27296 @table @code
27297 @item breakpoint-hit
27298 A breakpoint was reached.
27299 @item watchpoint-trigger
27300 A watchpoint was triggered.
27301 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27302 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27303 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27304 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27305 @item function-finished
27306 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27307 @item location-reached
27308 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27309 @item watchpoint-scope
27310 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27311 @item end-stepping-range
27312 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27313 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27314 @item exited-signalled
27315 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27316 @item exited
27317 The inferior exited.
27318 @item exited-normally
27319 The inferior exited normally.
27320 @item signal-received
27321 A signal was received by the inferior.
27322 @item solib-event
27323 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27324 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27325 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27326 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27327 @item fork
27328 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27329 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27330 @item vfork
27331 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27332 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27333 @item syscall-entry
27334 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27335 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27336 @item syscall-return
27337 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27338 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27339 @item exec
27340 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27341 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27342 @end table
27343
27344 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27345 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27346 Depending on whether all-stop
27347 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27348 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27349 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27350 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27351 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27352 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27353 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27354 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27355 if such information is not available.
27356
27357 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27358 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27359 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27360 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27361 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27362 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27363 cannot be used in any way.
27364
27365 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27366 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27367 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27368 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27369 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27370 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27371
27372 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27373 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27374 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27375 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27376 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27377 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27378
27379 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27380 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27381 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27382 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27383 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27384
27385 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27386 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27387 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27388 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27389 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27390 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27391 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27392 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27393 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27394
27395 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27396 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27397
27398 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27399 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27400 that thread.
27401
27402 @item =library-loaded,...
27403 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27404 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27405 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27406 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27407 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27408 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27409 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27410 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27411 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27412 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27413 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27414 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27415 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27416 to this library.
27417
27418 @item =library-unloaded,...
27419 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27420 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27421 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27422 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27423 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27424 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27425 thread groups.
27426
27427 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27428 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27429 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27430 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27431 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27432
27433 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27434 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27435 initial value @var{initial}.
27436
27437 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27438 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27439 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27440 trace state variables are deleted.
27441
27442 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27443 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27444 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27445 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27446 value of trace state variable is known.
27447
27448 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27449 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27450 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27451 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27452 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27453 user.
27454
27455 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27456 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27457 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27458
27459 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27460 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27461
27462 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27463 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27464 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27465 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27466 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27467
27468 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27469 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27470 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27471 for existing method and format values.
27472
27473 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27474 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27475 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27476 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27477 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27478 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27479
27480 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27481 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27482 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27483 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27484 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27485 executable code.
27486 @end table
27487
27488 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27489 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27490
27491 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27492 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27493 following fields:
27494
27495 @table @code
27496 @item number
27497 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27498 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27499 @samp{1.2}.
27500
27501 @item type
27502 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27503 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27504
27505 @item catch-type
27506 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27507 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27508
27509 @item disp
27510 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27511 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27512 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27513
27514 @item enabled
27515 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27516 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27517 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27518
27519 @item addr
27520 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27521 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27522 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27523 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27524 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27525
27526 @item func
27527 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27528 If not known, this field is not present.
27529
27530 @item filename
27531 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27532 If not known, this field is not present.
27533
27534 @item fullname
27535 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27536 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27537
27538 @item line
27539 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27540 If not known, this field is not present.
27541
27542 @item at
27543 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27544 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27545 by a symbol name.
27546
27547 @item pending
27548 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27549 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27550
27551 @item evaluated-by
27552 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27553 @samp{target}.
27554
27555 @item thread
27556 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27557 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27558
27559 @item task
27560 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27561 field will hold the task identifier.
27562
27563 @item cond
27564 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27565
27566 @item ignore
27567 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27568
27569 @item enable
27570 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27571
27572 @item traceframe-usage
27573 FIXME.
27574
27575 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27576 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27577
27578 @item mask
27579 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27580
27581 @item pass
27582 A tracepoint's pass count.
27583
27584 @item original-location
27585 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27586 This field is optional.
27587
27588 @item times
27589 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27590
27591 @item installed
27592 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27593 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27594 is not.
27595
27596 @item what
27597 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27598
27599 @end table
27600
27601 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27602 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27603
27604 @smallexample
27605 -> -break-insert main
27606 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27607 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27608 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27609 times="0"@}
27610 <- (gdb)
27611 @end smallexample
27612
27613 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27614 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27615
27616 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27617 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27618 fields:
27619
27620 @table @code
27621 @item level
27622 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27623 zero. This field is always present.
27624
27625 @item func
27626 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27627 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27628
27629 @item addr
27630 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27631
27632 @item file
27633 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27634 address. This field may be absent.
27635
27636 @item line
27637 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27638 may be absent.
27639
27640 @item from
27641 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27642 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27643
27644 @end table
27645
27646 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27647 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27648
27649 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27650 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27651 stated otherwise.
27652
27653 @table @code
27654 @item id
27655 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27656
27657 @item target-id
27658 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27659
27660 @item details
27661 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27662 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27663 frontend. This field is optional.
27664
27665 @item name
27666 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27667 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27668 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27669 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27670 field is omitted.
27671
27672 @item state
27673 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27674 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27675
27676 @item frame
27677 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27678 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27679 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27680
27681 @item core
27682 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27683 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27684 @end table
27685
27686 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27687 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27688
27689 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27690 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27691 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27692 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27693 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27694 the @code{exception-message} field.
27695
27696 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27697 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27698 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27699 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27700
27701 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27702 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27703 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27704 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27705
27706 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27707 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27708
27709 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27710
27711 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27712 information of the breakpoint.
27713
27714 @smallexample
27715 -> -break-insert main
27716 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27717 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27718 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27719 times="0"@}
27720 <- (gdb)
27721 @end smallexample
27722
27723 @subheading Program Execution
27724
27725 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27726 reason that execution stopped.
27727
27728 @smallexample
27729 -> -exec-run
27730 <- ^running
27731 <- (gdb)
27732 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27733 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27734 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27735 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27736 <- (gdb)
27737 -> -exec-continue
27738 <- ^running
27739 <- (gdb)
27740 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27741 <- (gdb)
27742 @end smallexample
27743
27744 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27745
27746 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27747
27748 @smallexample
27749 -> (gdb)
27750 <- -gdb-exit
27751 <- ^exit
27752 @end smallexample
27753
27754 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27755 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27756 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27757 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27758 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27759 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27760
27761 @subheading A Bad Command
27762
27763 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27764
27765 @smallexample
27766 -> -rubbish
27767 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27768 <- (gdb)
27769 @end smallexample
27770
27771
27772 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27773 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27774 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27775
27776 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27777 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27778
27779 @subheading Motivation
27780
27781 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27782
27783 @subheading Introduction
27784
27785 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27786
27787 @subheading Commands
27788
27789 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27790
27791 @subsubheading Synopsis
27792
27793 @smallexample
27794 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27795 @end smallexample
27796
27797 @subsubheading Result
27798
27799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27800
27801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27802
27803 @subsubheading Example
27804
27805 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27806 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27807
27808
27809 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27810 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27811 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27812
27813 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27814 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27815 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27816 breakpoints.
27817
27818 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27819 @findex -break-after
27820
27821 @subsubheading Synopsis
27822
27823 @smallexample
27824 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27825 @end smallexample
27826
27827 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27828 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27829 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27830 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27831
27832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27833
27834 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27835
27836 @subsubheading Example
27837
27838 @smallexample
27839 (gdb)
27840 -break-insert main
27841 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27842 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27843 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27844 times="0"@}
27845 (gdb)
27846 -break-after 1 3
27847 ~
27848 ^done
27849 (gdb)
27850 -break-list
27851 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27852 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27853 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27854 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27855 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27856 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27857 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27858 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27859 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27860 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27861 (gdb)
27862 @end smallexample
27863
27864 @ignore
27865 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27866 @findex -break-catch
27867 @end ignore
27868
27869 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27870 @findex -break-commands
27871
27872 @subsubheading Synopsis
27873
27874 @smallexample
27875 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27876 @end smallexample
27877
27878 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27879 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27880 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27881 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27882 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27883 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27884
27885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27886
27887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27888
27889 @subsubheading Example
27890
27891 @smallexample
27892 (gdb)
27893 -break-insert main
27894 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27895 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27896 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27897 times="0"@}
27898 (gdb)
27899 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27900 ^done
27901 (gdb)
27902 @end smallexample
27903
27904 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27905 @findex -break-condition
27906
27907 @subsubheading Synopsis
27908
27909 @smallexample
27910 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27911 @end smallexample
27912
27913 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27914 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27915 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27916 command below).
27917
27918 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27919
27920 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27921
27922 @subsubheading Example
27923
27924 @smallexample
27925 (gdb)
27926 -break-condition 1 1
27927 ^done
27928 (gdb)
27929 -break-list
27930 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27931 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27932 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27933 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27934 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27935 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27936 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27937 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27938 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27939 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27940 (gdb)
27941 @end smallexample
27942
27943 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27944 @findex -break-delete
27945
27946 @subsubheading Synopsis
27947
27948 @smallexample
27949 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27950 @end smallexample
27951
27952 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27953 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27954
27955 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27956
27957 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27958
27959 @subsubheading Example
27960
27961 @smallexample
27962 (gdb)
27963 -break-delete 1
27964 ^done
27965 (gdb)
27966 -break-list
27967 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27968 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27969 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27970 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27971 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27972 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27973 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27974 body=[]@}
27975 (gdb)
27976 @end smallexample
27977
27978 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27979 @findex -break-disable
27980
27981 @subsubheading Synopsis
27982
27983 @smallexample
27984 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27985 @end smallexample
27986
27987 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27988 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27989
27990 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27991
27992 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27993
27994 @subsubheading Example
27995
27996 @smallexample
27997 (gdb)
27998 -break-disable 2
27999 ^done
28000 (gdb)
28001 -break-list
28002 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28003 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28004 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28005 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28006 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28007 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28008 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28009 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28010 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28011 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28012 (gdb)
28013 @end smallexample
28014
28015 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28016 @findex -break-enable
28017
28018 @subsubheading Synopsis
28019
28020 @smallexample
28021 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28022 @end smallexample
28023
28024 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28025
28026 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28027
28028 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28029
28030 @subsubheading Example
28031
28032 @smallexample
28033 (gdb)
28034 -break-enable 2
28035 ^done
28036 (gdb)
28037 -break-list
28038 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28039 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28040 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28041 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28042 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28043 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28044 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28045 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28046 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28047 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28048 (gdb)
28049 @end smallexample
28050
28051 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28052 @findex -break-info
28053
28054 @subsubheading Synopsis
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28058 @end smallexample
28059
28060 @c REDUNDANT???
28061 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28062
28063 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28064 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28065 table.
28066
28067 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28068
28069 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28070
28071 @subsubheading Example
28072 N.A.
28073
28074 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28075 @findex -break-insert
28076 @anchor{-break-insert}
28077
28078 @subsubheading Synopsis
28079
28080 @smallexample
28081 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28082 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28083 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28084 @end smallexample
28085
28086 @noindent
28087 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28088
28089 @table @var
28090 @item linespec location
28091 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28092
28093 @item explicit location
28094 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28095 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28096 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28097
28098 @table @samp
28099 @item --source @var{filename}
28100 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28101 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28102
28103 @item --function @var{function}
28104 The name of a function or method.
28105
28106 @item --label @var{label}
28107 The name of a label.
28108
28109 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28110 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28111 @end table
28112
28113 @item address location
28114 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28115 @end table
28116
28117 @noindent
28118 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28119
28120 @table @samp
28121 @item -t
28122 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28123 @item -h
28124 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28125 @item -f
28126 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28127 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28128 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28129 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28130 cannot be parsed.
28131 @item -d
28132 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28133 @item -a
28134 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28135 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28136 @item -c @var{condition}
28137 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28138 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28139 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28140 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28141 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28142 @var{thread-id}.
28143 @end table
28144
28145 @subsubheading Result
28146
28147 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28148 resulting breakpoint.
28149
28150 Note: this format is open to change.
28151 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28152
28153 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28154
28155 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28156 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28157
28158 @subsubheading Example
28159
28160 @smallexample
28161 (gdb)
28162 -break-insert main
28163 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28164 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28165 times="0"@}
28166 (gdb)
28167 -break-insert -t foo
28168 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28169 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28170 times="0"@}
28171 (gdb)
28172 -break-list
28173 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28174 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28175 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28176 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28177 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28178 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28179 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28180 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28181 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28182 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28183 times="0"@},
28184 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28185 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28186 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28187 times="0"@}]@}
28188 (gdb)
28189 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28190 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28191 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28192 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28193 @c times="0"@}
28194 @c (gdb)
28195 @end smallexample
28196
28197 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28198 @findex -dprintf-insert
28199
28200 @subsubheading Synopsis
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28204 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28205 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28206 [ @var{argument} ]
28207 @end smallexample
28208
28209 @noindent
28210 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28211 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28212
28213 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28214
28215 @table @samp
28216 @item -t
28217 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28218 @item -f
28219 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28220 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28221 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28222 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28223 cannot be parsed.
28224 @item -d
28225 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28226 @item -c @var{condition}
28227 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28228 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28229 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28230 to @var{ignore-count}.
28231 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28232 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28233 @var{thread-id}.
28234 @end table
28235
28236 @subsubheading Result
28237
28238 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28239 resulting breakpoint.
28240
28241 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28242
28243 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28244
28245 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28246
28247 @subsubheading Example
28248
28249 @smallexample
28250 (gdb)
28251 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28252 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28253 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28254 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28255 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28256 original-location="foo"@}
28257 (gdb)
28258 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28259 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28260 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28261 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28262 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28263 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28264 (gdb)
28265 @end smallexample
28266
28267 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28268 @findex -break-list
28269
28270 @subsubheading Synopsis
28271
28272 @smallexample
28273 -break-list
28274 @end smallexample
28275
28276 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28277
28278 @table @samp
28279 @item Number
28280 number of the breakpoint
28281 @item Type
28282 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28283 @item Disposition
28284 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28285 or @samp{nokeep}
28286 @item Enabled
28287 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28288 @item Address
28289 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28290 @item What
28291 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28292 name, line number
28293 @item Thread-groups
28294 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28295 @item Times
28296 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28297 @end table
28298
28299 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28300 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28301
28302 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28303
28304 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28305
28306 @subsubheading Example
28307
28308 @smallexample
28309 (gdb)
28310 -break-list
28311 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28312 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28313 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28314 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28315 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28316 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28317 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28318 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28319 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28320 times="0"@},
28321 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28322 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28323 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28324 (gdb)
28325 @end smallexample
28326
28327 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28328
28329 @smallexample
28330 (gdb)
28331 -break-list
28332 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28333 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28334 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28335 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28336 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28337 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28338 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28339 body=[]@}
28340 (gdb)
28341 @end smallexample
28342
28343 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28344 @findex -break-passcount
28345
28346 @subsubheading Synopsis
28347
28348 @smallexample
28349 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28350 @end smallexample
28351
28352 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28353 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28354 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28355 command @samp{passcount}.
28356
28357 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28358 @findex -break-watch
28359
28360 @subsubheading Synopsis
28361
28362 @smallexample
28363 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28364 @end smallexample
28365
28366 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28367 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28368 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28369 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28370 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28371 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28372 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28373 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28374
28375 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28376 breakpoints inserted.
28377
28378 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28379
28380 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28381 @samp{rwatch}.
28382
28383 @subsubheading Example
28384
28385 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28386
28387 @smallexample
28388 (gdb)
28389 -break-watch x
28390 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28391 (gdb)
28392 -exec-continue
28393 ^running
28394 (gdb)
28395 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28396 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28397 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28398 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
28399 (gdb)
28400 @end smallexample
28401
28402 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28403 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28404 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28405
28406 @smallexample
28407 (gdb)
28408 -break-watch C
28409 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28410 (gdb)
28411 -exec-continue
28412 ^running
28413 (gdb)
28414 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28415 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28416 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28417 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28418 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28419 (gdb)
28420 -exec-continue
28421 ^running
28422 (gdb)
28423 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28424 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28425 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28426 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28427 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28428 (gdb)
28429 @end smallexample
28430
28431 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28432 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28433 deleted.
28434
28435 @smallexample
28436 (gdb)
28437 -break-watch C
28438 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28439 (gdb)
28440 -break-list
28441 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28442 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28443 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28444 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28445 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28446 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28447 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28448 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28449 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28450 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28451 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28452 times="1"@},
28453 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28454 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28455 (gdb)
28456 -exec-continue
28457 ^running
28458 (gdb)
28459 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28460 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28461 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28462 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28463 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28464 (gdb)
28465 -break-list
28466 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28467 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28468 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28469 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28470 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28471 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28472 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28473 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28474 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28475 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28476 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28477 times="1"@},
28478 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28479 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28480 (gdb)
28481 -exec-continue
28482 ^running
28483 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28484 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28485 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28486 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28487 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28488 (gdb)
28489 -break-list
28490 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28491 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28492 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28493 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28494 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28495 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28496 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28497 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28498 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28499 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28500 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28501 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28502 (gdb)
28503 @end smallexample
28504
28505
28506 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28507 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28508 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28509
28510 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28511 catchpoints.
28512
28513 @menu
28514 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28515 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28516 @end menu
28517
28518 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28519 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28520
28521 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28522 @findex -catch-load
28523
28524 @subsubheading Synopsis
28525
28526 @smallexample
28527 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28528 @end smallexample
28529
28530 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28531 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28532 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28533 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28534 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28535
28536
28537 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28538
28539 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28540
28541 @subsubheading Example
28542
28543 @smallexample
28544 -catch-load -t foo.so
28545 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28546 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28547 (gdb)
28548 @end smallexample
28549
28550
28551 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28552 @findex -catch-unload
28553
28554 @subsubheading Synopsis
28555
28556 @smallexample
28557 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28561 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28562 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28563 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28564 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28565
28566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28567
28568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28569
28570 @subsubheading Example
28571
28572 @smallexample
28573 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28574 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28575 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28576 (gdb)
28577 @end smallexample
28578
28579 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28580 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28581
28582 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28583 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28584
28585 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28586 @findex -catch-assert
28587
28588 @subsubheading Synopsis
28589
28590 @smallexample
28591 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28592 @end smallexample
28593
28594 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28595
28596 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28597
28598 @table @samp
28599 @item -c @var{condition}
28600 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28601 @item -d
28602 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28603 @item -t
28604 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28605 @end table
28606
28607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28608
28609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28610
28611 @subsubheading Example
28612
28613 @smallexample
28614 -catch-assert
28615 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28616 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28617 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28618 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28619 (gdb)
28620 @end smallexample
28621
28622 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28623 @findex -catch-exception
28624
28625 @subsubheading Synopsis
28626
28627 @smallexample
28628 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28629 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28630 @end smallexample
28631
28632 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28633 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28634 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28635 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28636 catchpoints.
28637
28638 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28639
28640 @table @samp
28641 @item -c @var{condition}
28642 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28643 @item -d
28644 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28645 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28646 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28647 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28648 @item -t
28649 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28650 @item -u
28651 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28652 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28653 @end table
28654
28655 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28656
28657 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28658 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28659
28660 @subsubheading Example
28661
28662 @smallexample
28663 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28664 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28665 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28666 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28667 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28668 (gdb)
28669 @end smallexample
28670
28671 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
28672 @findex -catch-handlers
28673
28674 @subsubheading Synopsis
28675
28676 @smallexample
28677 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28678 [ -t ]
28679 @end smallexample
28680
28681 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
28682 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28683 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28684 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28685 catchpoints.
28686
28687 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28688
28689 @table @samp
28690 @item -c @var{condition}
28691 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28692 @item -d
28693 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28694 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28695 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
28696 @item -t
28697 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28698 @end table
28699
28700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28701
28702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
28703
28704 @subsubheading Example
28705
28706 @smallexample
28707 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
28708 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28709 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
28710 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
28711 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
28712 (gdb)
28713 @end smallexample
28714
28715 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28716 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28717 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28718
28719 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28720 @findex -exec-arguments
28721
28722
28723 @subsubheading Synopsis
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28730 @samp{-exec-run}.
28731
28732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28733
28734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28735
28736 @subsubheading Example
28737
28738 @smallexample
28739 (gdb)
28740 -exec-arguments -v word
28741 ^done
28742 (gdb)
28743 @end smallexample
28744
28745
28746 @ignore
28747 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28748 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28749
28750 @subsubheading Synopsis
28751
28752 @smallexample
28753 -exec-show-arguments
28754 @end smallexample
28755
28756 Print the arguments of the program.
28757
28758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28759
28760 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28761
28762 @subsubheading Example
28763 N.A.
28764 @end ignore
28765
28766
28767 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28768 @findex -environment-cd
28769
28770 @subsubheading Synopsis
28771
28772 @smallexample
28773 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28774 @end smallexample
28775
28776 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28777
28778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28779
28780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28781
28782 @subsubheading Example
28783
28784 @smallexample
28785 (gdb)
28786 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28787 ^done
28788 (gdb)
28789 @end smallexample
28790
28791
28792 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28793 @findex -environment-directory
28794
28795 @subsubheading Synopsis
28796
28797 @smallexample
28798 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28799 @end smallexample
28800
28801 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28802 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28803 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28804 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28805 occurs as normal.
28806 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28807 multiple directories in a single command
28808 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28809 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28810 If blanks are needed as
28811 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28812 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28813 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28814 character must not be used
28815 in any directory name.
28816 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28817
28818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28819
28820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28821
28822 @subsubheading Example
28823
28824 @smallexample
28825 (gdb)
28826 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28827 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28828 (gdb)
28829 -environment-directory ""
28830 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28831 (gdb)
28832 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28833 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28834 (gdb)
28835 -environment-directory -r
28836 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28837 (gdb)
28838 @end smallexample
28839
28840
28841 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28842 @findex -environment-path
28843
28844 @subsubheading Synopsis
28845
28846 @smallexample
28847 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28848 @end smallexample
28849
28850 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28851 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28852 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28853 supplied in addition to the
28854 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28855 occurs as normal.
28856 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28857 multiple directories in a single command
28858 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28859 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28860 If blanks are needed as
28861 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28862 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28863 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28864 character must not be used
28865 in any directory name.
28866 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28867
28868
28869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28870
28871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28872
28873 @subsubheading Example
28874
28875 @smallexample
28876 (gdb)
28877 -environment-path
28878 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28879 (gdb)
28880 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28881 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28882 (gdb)
28883 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28884 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28885 (gdb)
28886 @end smallexample
28887
28888
28889 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28890 @findex -environment-pwd
28891
28892 @subsubheading Synopsis
28893
28894 @smallexample
28895 -environment-pwd
28896 @end smallexample
28897
28898 Show the current working directory.
28899
28900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28901
28902 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28903
28904 @subsubheading Example
28905
28906 @smallexample
28907 (gdb)
28908 -environment-pwd
28909 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28910 (gdb)
28911 @end smallexample
28912
28913 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28914 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28915 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28916
28917
28918 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28919 @findex -thread-info
28920
28921 @subsubheading Synopsis
28922
28923 @smallexample
28924 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28925 @end smallexample
28926
28927 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28928 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28929 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28930 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28931 current thread.
28932
28933 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28934
28935 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28936 about all threads.
28937
28938 @subsubheading Result
28939
28940 The result contains the following attributes:
28941
28942 @table @samp
28943 @item threads
28944 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28945 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28946
28947 @item current-thread-id
28948 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28949 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28950 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28951 the command.
28952
28953 @end table
28954
28955 @subsubheading Example
28956
28957 @smallexample
28958 -thread-info
28959 ^done,threads=[
28960 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28961 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28962 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28963 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28964 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28965 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28966 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28967 state="running"@}],
28968 current-thread-id="1"
28969 (gdb)
28970 @end smallexample
28971
28972 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28973 @findex -thread-list-ids
28974
28975 @subsubheading Synopsis
28976
28977 @smallexample
28978 -thread-list-ids
28979 @end smallexample
28980
28981 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28982 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28983 threads.
28984
28985 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28986 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28987
28988 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28989
28990 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28991
28992 @subsubheading Example
28993
28994 @smallexample
28995 (gdb)
28996 -thread-list-ids
28997 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28998 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28999 (gdb)
29000 @end smallexample
29001
29002
29003 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29004 @findex -thread-select
29005
29006 @subsubheading Synopsis
29007
29008 @smallexample
29009 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29010 @end smallexample
29011
29012 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29013 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29014 topmost frame for that thread.
29015
29016 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29017 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29018
29019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29020
29021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29022
29023 @subsubheading Example
29024
29025 @smallexample
29026 (gdb)
29027 -exec-next
29028 ^running
29029 (gdb)
29030 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29031 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29032 (gdb)
29033 -thread-list-ids
29034 ^done,
29035 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29036 number-of-threads="3"
29037 (gdb)
29038 -thread-select 3
29039 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29040 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29041 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29042 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
29043 (gdb)
29044 @end smallexample
29045
29046 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29047 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29048 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29049
29050 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29051 @findex -ada-task-info
29052
29053 @subsubheading Synopsis
29054
29055 @smallexample
29056 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29057 @end smallexample
29058
29059 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29060 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29061
29062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29063
29064 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29065 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29066
29067 @subsubheading Result
29068
29069 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29070 defined for each Ada task:
29071
29072 @table @samp
29073 @item current
29074 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29075
29076 @item id
29077 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29078
29079 @item task-id
29080 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29081
29082 @item thread-id
29083 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29084 task.
29085
29086 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29087 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29088 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29089
29090 @item parent-id
29091 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29092 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29093
29094 @item priority
29095 The base priority of the task.
29096
29097 @item state
29098 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29099 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29100
29101 @item name
29102 The name of the task.
29103
29104 @end table
29105
29106 @subsubheading Example
29107
29108 @smallexample
29109 -ada-task-info
29110 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29111 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29112 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29113 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29114 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29115 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29116 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29117 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29118 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29119 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29120 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29121 (gdb)
29122 @end smallexample
29123
29124 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29125 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29126 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29127
29128 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29129 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29130 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29131 other cases.
29132
29133 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29134 @findex -exec-continue
29135
29136 @subsubheading Synopsis
29137
29138 @smallexample
29139 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29140 @end smallexample
29141
29142 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29143 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29144 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29145 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29146 @itemize @bullet
29147 @item
29148 breakpoints or watchpoints
29149 @item
29150 signals or exceptions
29151 @item
29152 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29153 @item
29154 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29155 @end itemize
29156 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29157 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29158 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29159 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29160 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29161 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29162
29163 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29164
29165 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29166
29167 @subsubheading Example
29168
29169 @smallexample
29170 -exec-continue
29171 ^running
29172 (gdb)
29173 @@Hello world
29174 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29175 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29176 line="13"@}
29177 (gdb)
29178 @end smallexample
29179
29180
29181 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29182 @findex -exec-finish
29183
29184 @subsubheading Synopsis
29185
29186 @smallexample
29187 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29191 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29192 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29193 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29194 function was called.
29195
29196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29197
29198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29199
29200 @subsubheading Example
29201
29202 Function returning @code{void}.
29203
29204 @smallexample
29205 -exec-finish
29206 ^running
29207 (gdb)
29208 @@hello from foo
29209 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29210 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
29211 (gdb)
29212 @end smallexample
29213
29214 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29215 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29216 value itself.
29217
29218 @smallexample
29219 -exec-finish
29220 ^running
29221 (gdb)
29222 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29223 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29224 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29225 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29226 (gdb)
29227 @end smallexample
29228
29229
29230 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29231 @findex -exec-interrupt
29232
29233 @subsubheading Synopsis
29234
29235 @smallexample
29236 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29237 @end smallexample
29238
29239 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29240 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29241 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29242 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29243 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29244
29245 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29246 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29247 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29248 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29249
29250 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29251 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29252 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29253 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29254
29255 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29256
29257 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29258
29259 @subsubheading Example
29260
29261 @smallexample
29262 (gdb)
29263 111-exec-continue
29264 111^running
29265
29266 (gdb)
29267 222-exec-interrupt
29268 222^done
29269 (gdb)
29270 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29271 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29272 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
29273 (gdb)
29274
29275 (gdb)
29276 -exec-interrupt
29277 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29278 (gdb)
29279 @end smallexample
29280
29281 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29282 @findex -exec-jump
29283
29284 @subsubheading Synopsis
29285
29286 @smallexample
29287 -exec-jump @var{location}
29288 @end smallexample
29289
29290 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29291 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29292 different forms of @var{location}.
29293
29294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29295
29296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29297
29298 @subsubheading Example
29299
29300 @smallexample
29301 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29302 *running,thread-id="all"
29303 ^running
29304 @end smallexample
29305
29306
29307 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29308 @findex -exec-next
29309
29310 @subsubheading Synopsis
29311
29312 @smallexample
29313 -exec-next [--reverse]
29314 @end smallexample
29315
29316 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29317 of the next source line is reached.
29318
29319 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29320 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29321 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29322 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29323 source line where the function was called.
29324
29325
29326 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29327
29328 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29329
29330 @subsubheading Example
29331
29332 @smallexample
29333 -exec-next
29334 ^running
29335 (gdb)
29336 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29337 (gdb)
29338 @end smallexample
29339
29340
29341 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29342 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29343
29344 @subsubheading Synopsis
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29348 @end smallexample
29349
29350 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29351 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29352 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29353 printed as well.
29354
29355 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29356 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29357 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29358 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29359 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29360
29361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29362
29363 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29364
29365 @subsubheading Example
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 (gdb)
29369 -exec-next-instruction
29370 ^running
29371
29372 (gdb)
29373 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29374 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29375 (gdb)
29376 @end smallexample
29377
29378
29379 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29380 @findex -exec-return
29381
29382 @subsubheading Synopsis
29383
29384 @smallexample
29385 -exec-return
29386 @end smallexample
29387
29388 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29389 Displays the new current frame.
29390
29391 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29392
29393 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29394
29395 @subsubheading Example
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 (gdb)
29399 200-break-insert callee4
29400 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29401 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29402 (gdb)
29403 000-exec-run
29404 000^running
29405 (gdb)
29406 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29407 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29408 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29409 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29410 (gdb)
29411 205-break-delete
29412 205^done
29413 (gdb)
29414 111-exec-return
29415 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29416 args=[@{name="strarg",
29417 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29418 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29419 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
29420 (gdb)
29421 @end smallexample
29422
29423
29424 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29425 @findex -exec-run
29426
29427 @subsubheading Synopsis
29428
29429 @smallexample
29430 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29431 @end smallexample
29432
29433 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29434 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29435 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29436 the program has exited exceptionally.
29437
29438 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29439 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29440 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29441 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29442 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29443
29444 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29445 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29446 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29447 (@pxref{Starting}).
29448
29449 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29450
29451 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29452
29453 @subsubheading Examples
29454
29455 @smallexample
29456 (gdb)
29457 -break-insert main
29458 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29459 (gdb)
29460 -exec-run
29461 ^running
29462 (gdb)
29463 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29464 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29465 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29466 (gdb)
29467 @end smallexample
29468
29469 @noindent
29470 Program exited normally:
29471
29472 @smallexample
29473 (gdb)
29474 -exec-run
29475 ^running
29476 (gdb)
29477 x = 55
29478 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29479 (gdb)
29480 @end smallexample
29481
29482 @noindent
29483 Program exited exceptionally:
29484
29485 @smallexample
29486 (gdb)
29487 -exec-run
29488 ^running
29489 (gdb)
29490 x = 55
29491 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29492 (gdb)
29493 @end smallexample
29494
29495 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29496 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29497
29498 @smallexample
29499 (gdb)
29500 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29501 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29502 @end smallexample
29503
29504
29505 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29506
29507
29508 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29509 @findex -exec-step
29510
29511 @subsubheading Synopsis
29512
29513 @smallexample
29514 -exec-step [--reverse]
29515 @end smallexample
29516
29517 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29518 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29519 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29520 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29521 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29522 previously executed source line.
29523
29524 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29525
29526 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29527
29528 @subsubheading Example
29529
29530 Stepping into a function:
29531
29532 @smallexample
29533 -exec-step
29534 ^running
29535 (gdb)
29536 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29537 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29538 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29539 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29540 (gdb)
29541 @end smallexample
29542
29543 Regular stepping:
29544
29545 @smallexample
29546 -exec-step
29547 ^running
29548 (gdb)
29549 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29550 (gdb)
29551 @end smallexample
29552
29553
29554 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29555 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29556
29557 @subsubheading Synopsis
29558
29559 @smallexample
29560 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29561 @end smallexample
29562
29563 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29564 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29565 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29566 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29567 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29568 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29569 as well.
29570
29571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29572
29573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29574
29575 @subsubheading Example
29576
29577 @smallexample
29578 (gdb)
29579 -exec-step-instruction
29580 ^running
29581
29582 (gdb)
29583 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29584 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29585 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29586 (gdb)
29587 -exec-step-instruction
29588 ^running
29589
29590 (gdb)
29591 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29592 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29593 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29594 (gdb)
29595 @end smallexample
29596
29597
29598 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29599 @findex -exec-until
29600
29601 @subsubheading Synopsis
29602
29603 @smallexample
29604 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29605 @end smallexample
29606
29607 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29608 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29609 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29610 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29611
29612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29613
29614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29615
29616 @subsubheading Example
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 (gdb)
29620 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29621 ^running
29622 (gdb)
29623 x = 55
29624 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29625 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29626 (gdb)
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629 @ignore
29630 @subheading -file-clear
29631 Is this going away????
29632 @end ignore
29633
29634 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29635 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29636 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29637
29638 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29639 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29640
29641 @smallexample
29642 -enable-frame-filters
29643 @end smallexample
29644
29645 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29646 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29647 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29648 request that this functionality be enabled.
29649
29650 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29651
29652 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29653 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29654
29655 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29656 @findex -stack-info-frame
29657
29658 @subsubheading Synopsis
29659
29660 @smallexample
29661 -stack-info-frame
29662 @end smallexample
29663
29664 Get info on the selected frame.
29665
29666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29667
29668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29669 (without arguments).
29670
29671 @subsubheading Example
29672
29673 @smallexample
29674 (gdb)
29675 -stack-info-frame
29676 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29677 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29678 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29679 (gdb)
29680 @end smallexample
29681
29682 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29683 @findex -stack-info-depth
29684
29685 @subsubheading Synopsis
29686
29687 @smallexample
29688 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29689 @end smallexample
29690
29691 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29692 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29693
29694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29695
29696 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29697
29698 @subsubheading Example
29699
29700 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29701
29702 @smallexample
29703 (gdb)
29704 -stack-info-depth
29705 ^done,depth="12"
29706 (gdb)
29707 -stack-info-depth 4
29708 ^done,depth="4"
29709 (gdb)
29710 -stack-info-depth 12
29711 ^done,depth="12"
29712 (gdb)
29713 -stack-info-depth 11
29714 ^done,depth="11"
29715 (gdb)
29716 -stack-info-depth 13
29717 ^done,depth="12"
29718 (gdb)
29719 @end smallexample
29720
29721 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29722 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29723 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29724
29725 @subsubheading Synopsis
29726
29727 @smallexample
29728 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29729 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29730 @end smallexample
29731
29732 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29733 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29734 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29735 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29736 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29737 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29738 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29739 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29740
29741 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29742 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29743 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29744 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29745 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29746 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29747
29748 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29749 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29750 are still displayed, however.
29751
29752 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29753 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29754
29755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29756
29757 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29758 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29759 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29760
29761 @subsubheading Example
29762
29763 @smallexample
29764 (gdb)
29765 -stack-list-frames
29766 ^done,
29767 stack=[
29768 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29769 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29770 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29771 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29772 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29773 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29774 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29775 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29776 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29777 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29778 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29779 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29780 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29781 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29782 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29783 (gdb)
29784 -stack-list-arguments 0
29785 ^done,
29786 stack-args=[
29787 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29788 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29789 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29790 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29791 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29792 (gdb)
29793 -stack-list-arguments 1
29794 ^done,
29795 stack-args=[
29796 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29797 frame=@{level="1",
29798 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29799 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29800 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29801 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29802 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29803 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29804 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29805 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29806 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29807 (gdb)
29808 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29809 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29810 (gdb)
29811 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29812 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29813 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29814 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29815 (gdb)
29816 @end smallexample
29817
29818 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29819
29820
29821 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29822 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29823 @findex -stack-list-frames
29824
29825 @subsubheading Synopsis
29826
29827 @smallexample
29828 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29829 @end smallexample
29830
29831 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29832 following info:
29833
29834 @table @samp
29835 @item @var{level}
29836 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29837 @item @var{addr}
29838 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29839 @item @var{func}
29840 Function name.
29841 @item @var{file}
29842 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29843 @item @var{fullname}
29844 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29845 @item @var{line}
29846 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29847 @item @var{from}
29848 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29849 if the frame's function is not known.
29850 @end table
29851
29852 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29853 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29854 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29855 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29856 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29857 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29858 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29859 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29860 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29861
29862 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29863
29864 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29865
29866 @subsubheading Example
29867
29868 Full stack backtrace:
29869
29870 @smallexample
29871 (gdb)
29872 -stack-list-frames
29873 ^done,stack=
29874 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29875 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29876 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29877 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29878 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29879 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29880 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29881 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29882 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29883 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29884 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29885 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29886 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29887 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29888 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29889 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29890 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29891 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29892 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29893 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29894 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29895 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29896 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29897 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29898 (gdb)
29899 @end smallexample
29900
29901 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29902
29903 @smallexample
29904 (gdb)
29905 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29906 ^done,stack=
29907 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29908 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29909 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29910 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29911 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29912 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29913 (gdb)
29914 @end smallexample
29915
29916 Show a single frame:
29917
29918 @smallexample
29919 (gdb)
29920 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29921 ^done,stack=
29922 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29923 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29924 (gdb)
29925 @end smallexample
29926
29927
29928 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29929 @findex -stack-list-locals
29930 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29931
29932 @subsubheading Synopsis
29933
29934 @smallexample
29935 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29936 @end smallexample
29937
29938 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29939 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29940 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29941 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29942 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29943 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29944 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29945 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29946 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29947 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29948
29949 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29950 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29951 variables are still displayed, however.
29952
29953 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29954 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29955
29956 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29957
29958 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29959
29960 @subsubheading Example
29961
29962 @smallexample
29963 (gdb)
29964 -stack-list-locals 0
29965 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29966 (gdb)
29967 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29968 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29969 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29970 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29971 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29972 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29973 (gdb)
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29977 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29978 @findex -stack-list-variables
29979
29980 @subsubheading Synopsis
29981
29982 @smallexample
29983 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29984 @end smallexample
29985
29986 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29987 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29988 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29989 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29990 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29991 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29992 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29993
29994 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29995 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29996 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29997
29998 @subsubheading Example
29999
30000 @smallexample
30001 (gdb)
30002 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30003 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30004 (gdb)
30005 @end smallexample
30006
30007
30008 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30009 @findex -stack-select-frame
30010
30011 @subsubheading Synopsis
30012
30013 @smallexample
30014 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30015 @end smallexample
30016
30017 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30018 the stack.
30019
30020 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30021 option to every command.
30022
30023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30024
30025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30026 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30027
30028 @subsubheading Example
30029
30030 @smallexample
30031 (gdb)
30032 -stack-select-frame 2
30033 ^done
30034 (gdb)
30035 @end smallexample
30036
30037 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30038 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30039 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30040
30041 @ignore
30042
30043 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30044
30045 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30046 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30047 used by @code{Insight}.
30048
30049 The two main reasons for that are:
30050
30051 @enumerate 1
30052 @item
30053 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30054
30055 @item
30056 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30057 now).
30058 @end enumerate
30059
30060 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30061 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30062 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30063 hints about their use.
30064
30065 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30066 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30067 least, the following operations:
30068
30069 @itemize @bullet
30070 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30071 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30072 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30073 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30074 @end itemize
30075
30076 @end ignore
30077
30078 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30079
30080 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30081
30082 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30083 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30084 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30085 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30086 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30087 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30088 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30089 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30090 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30091 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30092 object, or to change display format.
30093
30094 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30095 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30096 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30097 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30098 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30099 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30100 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30101 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30102 child will be created.
30103
30104 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30105 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30106 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30107 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30108 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30109
30110 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30111 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30112 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30113 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30114 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30115 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30116 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30117 variables that frontend has created.
30118
30119 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30120 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30121 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30122 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30123 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30124 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30125 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30126 implicitly updated.
30127
30128 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30129 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30130 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30131 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30132 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30133 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30134 frame. Consider this example:
30135
30136 @smallexample
30137 void do_work(...)
30138 @{
30139 struct work_state state;
30140
30141 if (...)
30142 do_work(...);
30143 @}
30144 @end smallexample
30145
30146 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30147 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30148 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30149 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30150 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30151
30152 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30153 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30154 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30155 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30156 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30157 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30158
30159 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30160 access this functionality:
30161
30162 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30163 @item @strong{Operation}
30164 @tab @strong{Description}
30165
30166 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30167 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30168 @item @code{-var-create}
30169 @tab create a variable object
30170 @item @code{-var-delete}
30171 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30172 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30173 @tab set the display format of this variable
30174 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30175 @tab show the display format of this variable
30176 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30177 @tab tells how many children this object has
30178 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30179 @tab return a list of the object's children
30180 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30181 @tab show the type of this variable object
30182 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30183 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30184 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30185 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30186 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30187 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30188 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30189 @tab get the value of this variable
30190 @item @code{-var-assign}
30191 @tab set the value of this variable
30192 @item @code{-var-update}
30193 @tab update the variable and its children
30194 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30195 @tab set frozeness attribute
30196 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30197 @tab set range of children to display on update
30198 @end multitable
30199
30200 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30201 how it can be used.
30202
30203 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30204
30205 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30206 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30207
30208 @smallexample
30209 -enable-pretty-printing
30210 @end smallexample
30211
30212 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30213 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30214 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30215 request that this functionality be enabled.
30216
30217 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30218
30219 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30220 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30221
30222 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30223 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30224
30225 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30226 @findex -var-create
30227
30228 @subsubheading Synopsis
30229
30230 @smallexample
30231 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30232 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30233 @end smallexample
30234
30235 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30236 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30237 register.
30238
30239 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30240 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30241 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30242 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30243 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30244
30245 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30246 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30247 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30248 object must be created.
30249
30250 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30251 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30252
30253 @itemize @bullet
30254 @item
30255 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30256
30257 @item
30258 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30259
30260 @item
30261 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30262 @end itemize
30263
30264 @cindex dynamic varobj
30265 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30266 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30267 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30268 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30269 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30270 compatibility for existing clients.
30271
30272 @subsubheading Result
30273
30274 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30275 are:
30276
30277 @table @samp
30278 @item name
30279 The name of the varobj.
30280
30281 @item numchild
30282 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30283 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30284 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30285
30286 @item value
30287 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30288 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30289 will not be interesting.
30290
30291 @item type
30292 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30293 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30294 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30295 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30296 @emph{declared} one.
30297
30298 @item thread-id
30299 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30300 thread's global identifier.
30301
30302 @item has_more
30303 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30304 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30305
30306 @item dynamic
30307 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30308 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30309 then this attribute will not be present.
30310
30311 @item displayhint
30312 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30313 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30314 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30315 @end table
30316
30317 Typical output will look like this:
30318
30319 @smallexample
30320 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30321 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30322 @end smallexample
30323
30324
30325 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30326 @findex -var-delete
30327
30328 @subsubheading Synopsis
30329
30330 @smallexample
30331 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30332 @end smallexample
30333
30334 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30335 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30336
30337 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30338
30339
30340 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30341 @findex -var-set-format
30342
30343 @subsubheading Synopsis
30344
30345 @smallexample
30346 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30347 @end smallexample
30348
30349 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30350 @var{format-spec}.
30351
30352 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30353 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30354
30355 @smallexample
30356 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30357 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30358 @end smallexample
30359
30360 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30361 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30362 for pointers, etc.).
30363
30364 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30365 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30366 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30367 zero-hexadecimal format.
30368
30369 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30370 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30371
30372 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30373 @findex -var-show-format
30374
30375 @subsubheading Synopsis
30376
30377 @smallexample
30378 -var-show-format @var{name}
30379 @end smallexample
30380
30381 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30382
30383 @smallexample
30384 @var{format} @expansion{}
30385 @var{format-spec}
30386 @end smallexample
30387
30388
30389 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30390 @findex -var-info-num-children
30391
30392 @subsubheading Synopsis
30393
30394 @smallexample
30395 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30396 @end smallexample
30397
30398 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30399
30400 @smallexample
30401 numchild=@var{n}
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30405 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30406 be available.
30407
30408
30409 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30410 @findex -var-list-children
30411
30412 @subsubheading Synopsis
30413
30414 @smallexample
30415 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30416 @end smallexample
30417 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30418
30419 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30420 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30421 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30422 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30423 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30424 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30425 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30426 and unions.
30427
30428 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30429 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30430 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30431 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30432 reported.
30433
30434 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30435 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30436 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30437 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30438 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30439 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30440 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30441 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30442 the visible items.
30443
30444 For each child the following results are returned:
30445
30446 @table @var
30447
30448 @item name
30449 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30450
30451 @item exp
30452 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30453 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30454
30455 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30456 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30457
30458 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30459 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30460 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30461 type and value are not present.
30462
30463 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30464 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30465 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30466
30467 @item numchild
30468 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30469 0.
30470
30471 @item type
30472 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30473 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30474 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30475 @emph{declared} one.
30476
30477 @item value
30478 If values were requested, this is the value.
30479
30480 @item thread-id
30481 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30482 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30483
30484 @item frozen
30485 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30486
30487 @item displayhint
30488 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30489 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30490 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30491
30492 @item dynamic
30493 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30494 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30495 then this attribute will not be present.
30496
30497 @end table
30498
30499 The result may have its own attributes:
30500
30501 @table @samp
30502 @item displayhint
30503 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30504 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30505 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30506
30507 @item has_more
30508 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30509 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30510 @end table
30511
30512 @subsubheading Example
30513
30514 @smallexample
30515 (gdb)
30516 -var-list-children n
30517 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30518 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30519 (gdb)
30520 -var-list-children --all-values n
30521 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30522 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30523 @end smallexample
30524
30525
30526 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30527 @findex -var-info-type
30528
30529 @subsubheading Synopsis
30530
30531 @smallexample
30532 -var-info-type @var{name}
30533 @end smallexample
30534
30535 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30536 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30537 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 type=@var{typename}
30541 @end smallexample
30542
30543
30544 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30545 @findex -var-info-expression
30546
30547 @subsubheading Synopsis
30548
30549 @smallexample
30550 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30551 @end smallexample
30552
30553 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30554 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30555 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30556
30557 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30558 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30559
30560 @smallexample
30561 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30562 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30563 @end smallexample
30564
30565 @noindent
30566 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30567 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30568
30569 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30570 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30571 is of limited use.
30572
30573 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30574 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30575
30576 @subsubheading Synopsis
30577
30578 @smallexample
30579 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30580 @end smallexample
30581
30582 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30583 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30584 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30585 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30586 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30587 watchpoint from a variable object.
30588
30589 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30590 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30591
30592 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30593 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30594 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30595 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30596 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30597 @smallexample
30598 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30599 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30600 @end smallexample
30601
30602 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30603 @findex -var-show-attributes
30604
30605 @subsubheading Synopsis
30606
30607 @smallexample
30608 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30609 @end smallexample
30610
30611 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30612
30613 @smallexample
30614 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30615 @end smallexample
30616
30617 @noindent
30618 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30619
30620 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30621 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30622
30623 @subsubheading Synopsis
30624
30625 @smallexample
30626 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30627 @end smallexample
30628
30629 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30630 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30631 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30632 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30633 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30634 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30635 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30636
30637 @smallexample
30638 value=@var{value}
30639 @end smallexample
30640
30641 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30642 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30643
30644 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30645 @findex -var-assign
30646
30647 @subsubheading Synopsis
30648
30649 @smallexample
30650 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30651 @end smallexample
30652
30653 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30654 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30655 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30656 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30657
30658 @subsubheading Example
30659
30660 @smallexample
30661 (gdb)
30662 -var-assign var1 3
30663 ^done,value="3"
30664 (gdb)
30665 -var-update *
30666 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30667 (gdb)
30668 @end smallexample
30669
30670 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30671 @findex -var-update
30672
30673 @subsubheading Synopsis
30674
30675 @smallexample
30676 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30677 @end smallexample
30678
30679 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30680 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30681 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30682 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30683 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30684 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30685 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30686 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30687 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30688 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30689 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30690 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30691 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30692
30693 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30694 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30695 diagnostic.
30696
30697 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30698 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30699
30700 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30701 @samp{changelist}.
30702
30703 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30704
30705 @table @samp
30706 @item name
30707 The name of the varobj.
30708
30709 @item value
30710 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30711 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30712
30713 @item in_scope
30714 @anchor{-var-update}
30715 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30716
30717 @table @code
30718 @item "true"
30719 The variable object's current value is valid.
30720
30721 @item "false"
30722 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30723 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30724 scope.
30725
30726 @item "invalid"
30727 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30728 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30729 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30730 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30731 objects.
30732 @end table
30733
30734 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30735 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30736
30737 @item type_changed
30738 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30739 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30740 be @samp{false}.
30741
30742 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30743 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30744 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30745 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30746 unset.
30747
30748 @item new_type
30749 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30750 hold the new type.
30751
30752 @item new_num_children
30753 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30754 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30755
30756 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30757 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30758 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30759 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30760 children which may be available.
30761
30762 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30763 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30764 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30765 only happen at the end of the update range).
30766
30767 @item displayhint
30768 The display hint, if any.
30769
30770 @item has_more
30771 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30772 available outside the varobj's update range.
30773
30774 @item dynamic
30775 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30776 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30777 then this attribute will not be present.
30778
30779 @item new_children
30780 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30781 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30782 be listed in this attribute.
30783 @end table
30784
30785 @subsubheading Example
30786
30787 @smallexample
30788 (gdb)
30789 -var-assign var1 3
30790 ^done,value="3"
30791 (gdb)
30792 -var-update --all-values var1
30793 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30794 type_changed="false"@}]
30795 (gdb)
30796 @end smallexample
30797
30798 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30799 @findex -var-set-frozen
30800 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30801
30802 @subsubheading Synopsis
30803
30804 @smallexample
30805 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30806 @end smallexample
30807
30808 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30809 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30810 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30811 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30812 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30813 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30814 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30815 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30816 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30817 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30818 @code{-var-update} does.
30819
30820 @subsubheading Example
30821
30822 @smallexample
30823 (gdb)
30824 -var-set-frozen V 1
30825 ^done
30826 (gdb)
30827 @end smallexample
30828
30829 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30830 @findex -var-set-update-range
30831 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30832
30833 @subsubheading Synopsis
30834
30835 @smallexample
30836 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30837 @end smallexample
30838
30839 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30840 @code{-var-update}.
30841
30842 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30843 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30844 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30845 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30846
30847 @subsubheading Example
30848
30849 @smallexample
30850 (gdb)
30851 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30852 ^done
30853 @end smallexample
30854
30855 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30856 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30857 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30858
30859 @subsubheading Synopsis
30860
30861 @smallexample
30862 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30863 @end smallexample
30864
30865 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30866
30867 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30868 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30869
30870 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30871 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30872 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30873 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30874 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30875 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30876 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30877
30878 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30879 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30880 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30881 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30882
30883 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30884 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30885 can be used to check this.
30886
30887 @subsubheading Example
30888
30889 Resetting the visualizer:
30890
30891 @smallexample
30892 (gdb)
30893 -var-set-visualizer V None
30894 ^done
30895 @end smallexample
30896
30897 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30898
30899 @smallexample
30900 (gdb)
30901 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30902 ^done
30903 @end smallexample
30904
30905 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30906 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30907
30908 @smallexample
30909 (gdb)
30910 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30911 ^done
30912 @end smallexample
30913
30914 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30915 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30916 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30917
30918 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30919 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30920 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30921 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30922
30923 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30924 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30925
30926 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30927 @c @subheading -data-assign
30928 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30929 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30930 @c set variable
30931 @c @subsubheading Example
30932 @c N.A.
30933
30934 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30935 @findex -data-disassemble
30936
30937 @subsubheading Synopsis
30938
30939 @smallexample
30940 -data-disassemble
30941 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30942 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30943 -- @var{mode}
30944 @end smallexample
30945
30946 @noindent
30947 Where:
30948
30949 @table @samp
30950 @item @var{start-addr}
30951 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30952 @item @var{end-addr}
30953 is the end address
30954 @item @var{filename}
30955 is the name of the file to disassemble
30956 @item @var{linenum}
30957 is the line number to disassemble around
30958 @item @var{lines}
30959 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30960 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30961 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30962 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30963 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30964 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30965 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30966 are displayed.
30967 @item @var{mode}
30968 is one of:
30969 @itemize @bullet
30970 @item 0 disassembly only
30971 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30972 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30973 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30974 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30975 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30976 @end itemize
30977
30978 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30979 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30980 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30981 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30982 @end table
30983
30984 @subsubheading Result
30985
30986 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30987 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30988 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30989
30990 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30991 following fields:
30992
30993 @table @code
30994 @item address
30995 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30996
30997 @item func-name
30998 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30999
31000 @item offset
31001 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31002
31003 @item inst
31004 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31005
31006 @item opcodes
31007 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31008 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31009
31010 @end table
31011
31012 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31013 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31014
31015 @table @code
31016 @item line
31017 The line number within @samp{file}.
31018
31019 @item file
31020 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31021 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31022 used.
31023
31024 @item fullname
31025 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31026 using the source file search path
31027 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31028 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31029
31030 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31031 present in the debug information.
31032
31033 @item line_asm_insn
31034 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31035 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31036 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31037 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31038 @samp{opcodes}.
31039
31040 @end table
31041
31042 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31043 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31044 adjust its format.
31045
31046 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31047
31048 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31049
31050 @subsubheading Example
31051
31052 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31053
31054 @smallexample
31055 (gdb)
31056 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31057 ^done,
31058 asm_insns=[
31059 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31060 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31061 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31062 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31063 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31064 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31065 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31066 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31067 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31068 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31069 (gdb)
31070 @end smallexample
31071
31072 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31073 @code{main}.
31074
31075 @smallexample
31076 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31077 ^done,asm_insns=[
31078 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31079 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31080 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31081 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31082 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31083 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31084 [@dots{}]
31085 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31086 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31087 (gdb)
31088 @end smallexample
31089
31090 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31091
31092 @smallexample
31093 (gdb)
31094 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31095 ^done,asm_insns=[
31096 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31097 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31098 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31099 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31100 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31101 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31102 (gdb)
31103 @end smallexample
31104
31105 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31106
31107 @smallexample
31108 (gdb)
31109 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31110 ^done,asm_insns=[
31111 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31112 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31113 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31114 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31115 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31116 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31117 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31118 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31119 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31120 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31121 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31122 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31123 (gdb)
31124 @end smallexample
31125
31126
31127 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31128 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31134 @end smallexample
31135
31136 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31137 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31138 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31139
31140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31141
31142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31143 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31144 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31145
31146 @subsubheading Example
31147
31148 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31149 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31150 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31151 output.
31152
31153 @smallexample
31154 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31155 211^done,value="1"
31156 (gdb)
31157 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31158 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31159 (gdb)
31160 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31161 411^done,value="4"
31162 (gdb)
31163 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31164 511^done,value="4"
31165 (gdb)
31166 @end smallexample
31167
31168
31169 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31170 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31171
31172 @subsubheading Synopsis
31173
31174 @smallexample
31175 -data-list-changed-registers
31176 @end smallexample
31177
31178 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31179
31180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31181
31182 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31183 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31184
31185 @subsubheading Example
31186
31187 On a PPC MBX board:
31188
31189 @smallexample
31190 (gdb)
31191 -exec-continue
31192 ^running
31193
31194 (gdb)
31195 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31196 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31197 line="5"@}
31198 (gdb)
31199 -data-list-changed-registers
31200 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31201 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31202 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31203 (gdb)
31204 @end smallexample
31205
31206
31207 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31208 @findex -data-list-register-names
31209
31210 @subsubheading Synopsis
31211
31212 @smallexample
31213 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31214 @end smallexample
31215
31216 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31217 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31218 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31219 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31220 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31221 include empty register names.
31222
31223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31224
31225 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31226 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31227 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31228
31229 @subsubheading Example
31230
31231 For the PPC MBX board:
31232 @smallexample
31233 (gdb)
31234 -data-list-register-names
31235 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31236 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31237 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31238 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31239 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31240 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31241 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31242 (gdb)
31243 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31244 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31245 (gdb)
31246 @end smallexample
31247
31248 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31249 @findex -data-list-register-values
31250
31251 @subsubheading Synopsis
31252
31253 @smallexample
31254 -data-list-register-values
31255 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31256 @end smallexample
31257
31258 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31259 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31260 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31261 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31262 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31263 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31264
31265 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31266
31267 @table @code
31268 @item x
31269 Hexadecimal
31270 @item o
31271 Octal
31272 @item t
31273 Binary
31274 @item d
31275 Decimal
31276 @item r
31277 Raw
31278 @item N
31279 Natural
31280 @end table
31281
31282 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31283
31284 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31285 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31286
31287 @subsubheading Example
31288
31289 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31290 don't appear in the actual output):
31291
31292 @smallexample
31293 (gdb)
31294 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31295 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31296 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31297 (gdb)
31298 -data-list-register-values x
31299 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31300 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31301 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31302 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31303 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31304 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31305 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31306 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31307 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31308 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31309 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31310 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31311 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31312 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31313 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31314 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31315 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31316 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31317 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31318 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31319 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31320 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31321 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31322 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31323 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31324 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31325 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31326 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31327 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31328 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31329 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31330 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31331 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31332 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31333 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31334 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31335 (gdb)
31336 @end smallexample
31337
31338
31339 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31340 @findex -data-read-memory
31341
31342 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31343
31344 @subsubheading Synopsis
31345
31346 @smallexample
31347 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31348 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31349 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31350 @end smallexample
31351
31352 @noindent
31353 where:
31354
31355 @table @samp
31356 @item @var{address}
31357 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31358 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31359 quoted using the C convention.
31360
31361 @item @var{word-format}
31362 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31363 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31364 ,Output Formats}).
31365
31366 @item @var{word-size}
31367 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31368
31369 @item @var{nr-rows}
31370 The number of rows in the output table.
31371
31372 @item @var{nr-cols}
31373 The number of columns in the output table.
31374
31375 @item @var{aschar}
31376 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31377 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31378 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31379 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31380
31381 @item @var{byte-offset}
31382 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31383 @end table
31384
31385 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31386 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31387 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31388 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31389 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31390 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31391 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31392 @samp{addr}.
31393
31394 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31395 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31396 @samp{prev-page}.
31397
31398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31399
31400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31401 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31402
31403 @subsubheading Example
31404
31405 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31406 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31407 word. Display each word in hex.
31408
31409 @smallexample
31410 (gdb)
31411 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31412 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31413 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31414 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31415 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31416 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31417 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31418 (gdb)
31419 @end smallexample
31420
31421 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31422 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31423
31424 @smallexample
31425 (gdb)
31426 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31427 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31428 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31429 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31430 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31431 (gdb)
31432 @end smallexample
31433
31434 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31435 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31436 used as the non-printable character.
31437
31438 @smallexample
31439 (gdb)
31440 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31441 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31442 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31443 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31444 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31445 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31446 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31447 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31448 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31449 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31450 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31451 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31452 (gdb)
31453 @end smallexample
31454
31455 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31456 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31457
31458 @subsubheading Synopsis
31459
31460 @smallexample
31461 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31462 @var{address} @var{count}
31463 @end smallexample
31464
31465 @noindent
31466 where:
31467
31468 @table @samp
31469 @item @var{address}
31470 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31471 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31472 quoted using the C convention.
31473
31474 @item @var{count}
31475 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31476 literal.
31477
31478 @item @var{offset}
31479 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31480 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31481 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31482 arithmetics itself.
31483
31484 @end table
31485
31486 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31487 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31488 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31489 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31490 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31491 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31492
31493 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31494 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31495 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31496 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31497 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31498 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31499 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31500 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31501
31502 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31503 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31504 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31505 and has the following fields:
31506
31507 @table @code
31508 @item begin
31509 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31510
31511 @item end
31512 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31513
31514 @item offset
31515 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31516 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31517
31518 @item contents
31519 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31520
31521 @end table
31522
31523
31524
31525 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31526
31527 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31528
31529 @subsubheading Example
31530
31531 @smallexample
31532 (gdb)
31533 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31534 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31535 end="0xbffff15e",
31536 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31537 (gdb)
31538 @end smallexample
31539
31540
31541 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31542 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31543
31544 @subsubheading Synopsis
31545
31546 @smallexample
31547 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31548 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31549 @end smallexample
31550
31551 @noindent
31552 where:
31553
31554 @table @samp
31555 @item @var{address}
31556 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31557 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31558 be quoted using the C convention.
31559
31560 @item @var{contents}
31561 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31562 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31563
31564 @item @var{count}
31565 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31566 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31567 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31568 @var{count} memory units.
31569
31570 @end table
31571
31572 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31573
31574 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31575
31576 @subsubheading Example
31577
31578 @smallexample
31579 (gdb)
31580 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31581 ^done
31582 (gdb)
31583 @end smallexample
31584
31585 @smallexample
31586 (gdb)
31587 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31588 ^done
31589 (gdb)
31590 @end smallexample
31591
31592 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31593 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31594 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31595
31596 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31597 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31598
31599 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31600 @findex -trace-find
31601
31602 @subsubheading Synopsis
31603
31604 @smallexample
31605 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31606 @end smallexample
31607
31608 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31609 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31610 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31611
31612 @table @samp
31613
31614 @item none
31615 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31616
31617 @item frame-number
31618 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31619 that index.
31620
31621 @item tracepoint-number
31622 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31623 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31624
31625 @item pc
31626 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31627 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31628 address.
31629
31630 @item pc-inside-range
31631 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31632 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31633 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31634
31635 @item pc-outside-range
31636 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31637 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31638 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31639
31640 @item line
31641 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31642 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31643 the specified location.
31644
31645 @end table
31646
31647 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31648 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31649
31650 @table @samp
31651 @item found
31652 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31653 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31654
31655 @item traceframe
31656 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31657 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31658
31659 @item tracepoint
31660 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31661 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31662
31663 @item frame
31664 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31665 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31666 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31667
31668 @end table
31669
31670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31671
31672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31673
31674 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31675 @findex -trace-define-variable
31676
31677 @subsubheading Synopsis
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31681 @end smallexample
31682
31683 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31684 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31685 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31686 with the @samp{$} character.
31687
31688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31689
31690 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31691
31692 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31693 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31694
31695 @subsubheading Synopsis
31696
31697 @smallexample
31698 -trace-frame-collected
31699 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31700 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31701 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31702 [--memory-contents]
31703 @end smallexample
31704
31705 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31706 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31707 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31708 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31709 See the output description table below for more details.
31710
31711 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31712 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31713 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31714 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31715 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31716
31717 For instance, if the actions were
31718 @smallexample
31719 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31720 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31721 @end smallexample
31722
31723 @noindent
31724 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31725 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31726 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31727 objects would be computed expressions.
31728
31729 An example output would be:
31730
31731 @smallexample
31732 (gdb)
31733 -trace-frame-collected
31734 ^done,
31735 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31736 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31737 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31738 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31739 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31740 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31741 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31742 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31743 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31744 ...
31745 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31746 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31747 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31748 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31749 (gdb)
31750 @end smallexample
31751
31752 Where:
31753
31754 @table @code
31755 @item explicit-variables
31756 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31757 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31758 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31759 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31760 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31761 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31762 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31763 arrays, structures and unions.
31764
31765 @item computed-expressions
31766 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31767 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31768 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31769 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31770
31771 @item registers
31772 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31773 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31774 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31775 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31776 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31777
31778 @item tvars
31779 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31780 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31781 current value are returned.
31782
31783 @item memory
31784 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31785 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31786 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31787
31788 @table @code
31789 @item address
31790 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31791
31792 @item length
31793 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31794
31795 @item contents
31796 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31797 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31798
31799 @end table
31800
31801 @end table
31802
31803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31804
31805 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31806
31807 @subsubheading Example
31808
31809 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31810 @findex -trace-list-variables
31811
31812 @subsubheading Synopsis
31813
31814 @smallexample
31815 -trace-list-variables
31816 @end smallexample
31817
31818 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31819 table has the following fields:
31820
31821 @table @samp
31822 @item name
31823 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31824
31825 @item initial
31826 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31827 field is always present.
31828
31829 @item current
31830 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31831 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31832 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31833 presently running.
31834
31835 @end table
31836
31837 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31838
31839 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31840
31841 @subsubheading Example
31842
31843 @smallexample
31844 (gdb)
31845 -trace-list-variables
31846 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31847 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31848 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31849 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31850 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31851 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31852 (gdb)
31853 @end smallexample
31854
31855 @subheading -trace-save
31856 @findex -trace-save
31857
31858 @subsubheading Synopsis
31859
31860 @smallexample
31861 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31862 @end smallexample
31863
31864 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31865 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31866 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31867 to perform the save.
31868
31869 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31870 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31871 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31872
31873 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31874
31875 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31876
31877
31878 @subheading -trace-start
31879 @findex -trace-start
31880
31881 @subsubheading Synopsis
31882
31883 @smallexample
31884 -trace-start
31885 @end smallexample
31886
31887 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31888 have any fields.
31889
31890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31891
31892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31893
31894 @subheading -trace-status
31895 @findex -trace-status
31896
31897 @subsubheading Synopsis
31898
31899 @smallexample
31900 -trace-status
31901 @end smallexample
31902
31903 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31904 the following fields:
31905
31906 @table @samp
31907
31908 @item supported
31909 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31910 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31911 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31912 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31913 started. This field is always present.
31914
31915 @item running
31916 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31917 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31918 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31919
31920 @item stop-reason
31921 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31922 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31923 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31924 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31925 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31926 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31927 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31928 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31929 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31930
31931 @item stopping-tracepoint
31932 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31933 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31934 @samp{passcount}.
31935
31936 @item frames
31937 @itemx frames-created
31938 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31939 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31940 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31941 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31942
31943 @item buffer-size
31944 @itemx buffer-free
31945 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31946 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31947
31948 @item circular
31949 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31950 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31951 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31952 and may fill up.
31953
31954 @item disconnected
31955 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31956 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31957 that the trace run will stop.
31958
31959 @item trace-file
31960 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31961 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31962
31963 @end table
31964
31965 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31966
31967 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31968
31969 @subheading -trace-stop
31970 @findex -trace-stop
31971
31972 @subsubheading Synopsis
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -trace-stop
31976 @end smallexample
31977
31978 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31979 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31980 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31981
31982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31983
31984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31985
31986
31987 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31988 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31989 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31990
31991
31992 @ignore
31993 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31994 @findex -symbol-info-address
31995
31996 @subsubheading Synopsis
31997
31998 @smallexample
31999 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32000 @end smallexample
32001
32002 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32003
32004 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32005
32006 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32007
32008 @subsubheading Example
32009 N.A.
32010
32011
32012 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32013 @findex -symbol-info-file
32014
32015 @subsubheading Synopsis
32016
32017 @smallexample
32018 -symbol-info-file
32019 @end smallexample
32020
32021 Show the file for the symbol.
32022
32023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32024
32025 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32026 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32027
32028 @subsubheading Example
32029 N.A.
32030
32031
32032 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32033 @findex -symbol-info-function
32034
32035 @subsubheading Synopsis
32036
32037 @smallexample
32038 -symbol-info-function
32039 @end smallexample
32040
32041 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32042
32043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32044
32045 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32046
32047 @subsubheading Example
32048 N.A.
32049
32050
32051 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32052 @findex -symbol-info-line
32053
32054 @subsubheading Synopsis
32055
32056 @smallexample
32057 -symbol-info-line
32058 @end smallexample
32059
32060 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32061
32062 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32063
32064 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32065 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32066
32067 @subsubheading Example
32068 N.A.
32069
32070
32071 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32072 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32073
32074 @subsubheading Synopsis
32075
32076 @smallexample
32077 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32078 @end smallexample
32079
32080 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32081
32082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32083
32084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32085
32086 @subsubheading Example
32087 N.A.
32088
32089
32090 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32091 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32092
32093 @subsubheading Synopsis
32094
32095 @smallexample
32096 -symbol-list-functions
32097 @end smallexample
32098
32099 List the functions in the executable.
32100
32101 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32102
32103 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32104 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32105
32106 @subsubheading Example
32107 N.A.
32108 @end ignore
32109
32110
32111 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32112 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32113
32114 @subsubheading Synopsis
32115
32116 @smallexample
32117 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32118 @end smallexample
32119
32120 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32121 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32122 ascending PC order.
32123
32124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32125
32126 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32127
32128 @subsubheading Example
32129 @smallexample
32130 (gdb)
32131 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32132 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32133 (gdb)
32134 @end smallexample
32135
32136
32137 @ignore
32138 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32139 @findex -symbol-list-types
32140
32141 @subsubheading Synopsis
32142
32143 @smallexample
32144 -symbol-list-types
32145 @end smallexample
32146
32147 List all the type names.
32148
32149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32150
32151 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32152 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32153
32154 @subsubheading Example
32155 N.A.
32156
32157
32158 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32159 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32160
32161 @subsubheading Synopsis
32162
32163 @smallexample
32164 -symbol-list-variables
32165 @end smallexample
32166
32167 List all the global and static variable names.
32168
32169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32170
32171 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32172
32173 @subsubheading Example
32174 N.A.
32175
32176
32177 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32178 @findex -symbol-locate
32179
32180 @subsubheading Synopsis
32181
32182 @smallexample
32183 -symbol-locate
32184 @end smallexample
32185
32186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32187
32188 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32189
32190 @subsubheading Example
32191 N.A.
32192
32193
32194 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32195 @findex -symbol-type
32196
32197 @subsubheading Synopsis
32198
32199 @smallexample
32200 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32201 @end smallexample
32202
32203 Show type of @var{variable}.
32204
32205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32206
32207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32208 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32209
32210 @subsubheading Example
32211 N.A.
32212 @end ignore
32213
32214
32215 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32216 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32217 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32218
32219 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32220 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32221
32222 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32223 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32224
32225 @subsubheading Synopsis
32226
32227 @smallexample
32228 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32229 @end smallexample
32230
32231 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32232 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32233 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32234 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32235 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32236 notification.
32237
32238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32239
32240 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32241
32242 @subsubheading Example
32243
32244 @smallexample
32245 (gdb)
32246 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32247 ^done
32248 (gdb)
32249 @end smallexample
32250
32251
32252 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32253 @findex -file-exec-file
32254
32255 @subsubheading Synopsis
32256
32257 @smallexample
32258 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32259 @end smallexample
32260
32261 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32262 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32263 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32264 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32265 notification.
32266
32267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32268
32269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32270
32271 @subsubheading Example
32272
32273 @smallexample
32274 (gdb)
32275 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32276 ^done
32277 (gdb)
32278 @end smallexample
32279
32280
32281 @ignore
32282 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32283 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32284
32285 @subsubheading Synopsis
32286
32287 @smallexample
32288 -file-list-exec-sections
32289 @end smallexample
32290
32291 List the sections of the current executable file.
32292
32293 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32294
32295 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32296 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32297 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32298
32299 @subsubheading Example
32300 N.A.
32301 @end ignore
32302
32303
32304 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32305 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32306
32307 @subsubheading Synopsis
32308
32309 @smallexample
32310 -file-list-exec-source-file
32311 @end smallexample
32312
32313 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32314 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32315 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32316 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32317
32318 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32319
32320 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32321
32322 @subsubheading Example
32323
32324 @smallexample
32325 (gdb)
32326 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32327 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32328 (gdb)
32329 @end smallexample
32330
32331
32332 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32333 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32334
32335 @subsubheading Synopsis
32336
32337 @smallexample
32338 -file-list-exec-source-files
32339 @end smallexample
32340
32341 List the source files for the current executable.
32342
32343 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32344 name) of a source file.
32345
32346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32347
32348 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32349 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32350
32351 @subsubheading Example
32352 @smallexample
32353 (gdb)
32354 -file-list-exec-source-files
32355 ^done,files=[
32356 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32357 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32358 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32359 (gdb)
32360 @end smallexample
32361
32362 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32363 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32364
32365 @subsubheading Synopsis
32366
32367 @smallexample
32368 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32369 @end smallexample
32370
32371 List the shared libraries in the program.
32372 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32373 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32374
32375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32376
32377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32378 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32379 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32380 library. Each range has the following fields:
32381
32382 @table @samp
32383 @item from
32384 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32385 @item to
32386 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32387 @end table
32388
32389 @subsubheading Example
32390 @smallexample
32391 (gdb)
32392 -file-list-exec-source-files
32393 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32394 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32395 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32396 (gdb)
32397 @end smallexample
32398
32399
32400 @ignore
32401 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32402 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32403
32404 @subsubheading Synopsis
32405
32406 @smallexample
32407 -file-list-symbol-files
32408 @end smallexample
32409
32410 List symbol files.
32411
32412 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32413
32414 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32415
32416 @subsubheading Example
32417 N.A.
32418 @end ignore
32419
32420
32421 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32422 @findex -file-symbol-file
32423
32424 @subsubheading Synopsis
32425
32426 @smallexample
32427 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32428 @end smallexample
32429
32430 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32431 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32432 produced, except for a completion notification.
32433
32434 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32435
32436 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32437
32438 @subsubheading Example
32439
32440 @smallexample
32441 (gdb)
32442 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32443 ^done
32444 (gdb)
32445 @end smallexample
32446
32447 @ignore
32448 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32449 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32450 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32451
32452 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32453
32454 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32455
32456 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32457
32458 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32459
32460 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32461
32462 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32463
32464 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32465
32466 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32467
32468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32469 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32470 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32471
32472 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32473
32474 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32475
32476 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32477
32478 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32479 @end ignore
32480
32481
32482 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32483 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32484 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32485
32486
32487 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32488 @findex -target-attach
32489
32490 @subsubheading Synopsis
32491
32492 @smallexample
32493 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32494 @end smallexample
32495
32496 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32497 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32498 group, the id previously returned by
32499 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32500
32501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32502
32503 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32504
32505 @subsubheading Example
32506 @smallexample
32507 (gdb)
32508 -target-attach 34
32509 =thread-created,id="1"
32510 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32511 ^done
32512 (gdb)
32513 @end smallexample
32514
32515 @ignore
32516 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32517 @findex -target-compare-sections
32518
32519 @subsubheading Synopsis
32520
32521 @smallexample
32522 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32523 @end smallexample
32524
32525 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32526 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32527
32528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32529
32530 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32531
32532 @subsubheading Example
32533 N.A.
32534 @end ignore
32535
32536
32537 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32538 @findex -target-detach
32539
32540 @subsubheading Synopsis
32541
32542 @smallexample
32543 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32544 @end smallexample
32545
32546 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32547 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32548 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32549
32550 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32551
32552 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32553
32554 @subsubheading Example
32555
32556 @smallexample
32557 (gdb)
32558 -target-detach
32559 ^done
32560 (gdb)
32561 @end smallexample
32562
32563
32564 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32565 @findex -target-disconnect
32566
32567 @subsubheading Synopsis
32568
32569 @smallexample
32570 -target-disconnect
32571 @end smallexample
32572
32573 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32574 generally not resumed.
32575
32576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32577
32578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32579
32580 @subsubheading Example
32581
32582 @smallexample
32583 (gdb)
32584 -target-disconnect
32585 ^done
32586 (gdb)
32587 @end smallexample
32588
32589
32590 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32591 @findex -target-download
32592
32593 @subsubheading Synopsis
32594
32595 @smallexample
32596 -target-download
32597 @end smallexample
32598
32599 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32600 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32601
32602 @table @samp
32603 @item section
32604 The name of the section.
32605 @item section-sent
32606 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32607 @item section-size
32608 The size of the section.
32609 @item total-sent
32610 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32611 @item total-size
32612 The size of the overall executable to download.
32613 @end table
32614
32615 @noindent
32616 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32617 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32618
32619 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32620 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32621
32622 @table @samp
32623 @item section
32624 The name of the section.
32625 @item section-size
32626 The size of the section.
32627 @item total-size
32628 The size of the overall executable to download.
32629 @end table
32630
32631 @noindent
32632 At the end, a summary is printed.
32633
32634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32635
32636 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32637
32638 @subsubheading Example
32639
32640 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32641 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32642
32643 @smallexample
32644 (gdb)
32645 -target-download
32646 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32647 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32648 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32649 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32650 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32651 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32652 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32653 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32654 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32655 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32656 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32657 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32658 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32659 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32660 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32661 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32662 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32663 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32664 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32665 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32666 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32667 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32668 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32669 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32670 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32671 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32672 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32673 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32674 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32675 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32676 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32677 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32678 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32679 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32680 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32681 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32682 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32683 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32684 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32685 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32686 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32687 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32688 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32689 write-rate="429"
32690 (gdb)
32691 @end smallexample
32692
32693
32694 @ignore
32695 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32696 @findex -target-exec-status
32697
32698 @subsubheading Synopsis
32699
32700 @smallexample
32701 -target-exec-status
32702 @end smallexample
32703
32704 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32705 not, for instance).
32706
32707 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32708
32709 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32710
32711 @subsubheading Example
32712 N.A.
32713
32714
32715 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32716 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32717
32718 @subsubheading Synopsis
32719
32720 @smallexample
32721 -target-list-available-targets
32722 @end smallexample
32723
32724 List the possible targets to connect to.
32725
32726 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32727
32728 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32729
32730 @subsubheading Example
32731 N.A.
32732
32733
32734 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32735 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32736
32737 @subsubheading Synopsis
32738
32739 @smallexample
32740 -target-list-current-targets
32741 @end smallexample
32742
32743 Describe the current target.
32744
32745 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32746
32747 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32748 other things).
32749
32750 @subsubheading Example
32751 N.A.
32752
32753
32754 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32755 @findex -target-list-parameters
32756
32757 @subsubheading Synopsis
32758
32759 @smallexample
32760 -target-list-parameters
32761 @end smallexample
32762
32763 @c ????
32764 @end ignore
32765
32766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32767
32768 No equivalent.
32769
32770 @subsubheading Example
32771 N.A.
32772
32773 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32774 @findex -target-flash-erase
32775
32776 @subsubheading Synopsis
32777
32778 @smallexample
32779 -target-flash-erase
32780 @end smallexample
32781
32782 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32783
32784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32785
32786 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32787 addresses and memory region sizes.
32788
32789 @smallexample
32790 (gdb)
32791 -target-flash-erase
32792 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32793 (gdb)
32794 @end smallexample
32795
32796 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32797 @findex -target-select
32798
32799 @subsubheading Synopsis
32800
32801 @smallexample
32802 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32803 @end smallexample
32804
32805 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32806
32807 @table @samp
32808 @item @var{type}
32809 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32810 @item @var{parameters}
32811 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32812 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32813 @end table
32814
32815 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32816 which the target program is, in the following form:
32817
32818 @smallexample
32819 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32820 args=[@var{arg list}]
32821 @end smallexample
32822
32823 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32824
32825 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32826
32827 @subsubheading Example
32828
32829 @smallexample
32830 (gdb)
32831 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32832 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32833 (gdb)
32834 @end smallexample
32835
32836 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32837 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32838 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32839
32840
32841 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32842 @findex -target-file-put
32843
32844 @subsubheading Synopsis
32845
32846 @smallexample
32847 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32848 @end smallexample
32849
32850 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32851 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32852
32853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32854
32855 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32856
32857 @subsubheading Example
32858
32859 @smallexample
32860 (gdb)
32861 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32862 ^done
32863 (gdb)
32864 @end smallexample
32865
32866
32867 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32868 @findex -target-file-get
32869
32870 @subsubheading Synopsis
32871
32872 @smallexample
32873 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32874 @end smallexample
32875
32876 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32877 on the host system.
32878
32879 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32880
32881 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32882
32883 @subsubheading Example
32884
32885 @smallexample
32886 (gdb)
32887 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32888 ^done
32889 (gdb)
32890 @end smallexample
32891
32892
32893 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32894 @findex -target-file-delete
32895
32896 @subsubheading Synopsis
32897
32898 @smallexample
32899 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32900 @end smallexample
32901
32902 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32903
32904 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32905
32906 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32907
32908 @subsubheading Example
32909
32910 @smallexample
32911 (gdb)
32912 -target-file-delete remotefile
32913 ^done
32914 (gdb)
32915 @end smallexample
32916
32917
32918 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32919 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32920 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32921
32922 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32923 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32924
32925 @subsubheading Synopsis
32926
32927 @smallexample
32928 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32929 @end smallexample
32930
32931 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32932 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32933 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32934
32935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32936
32937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32938
32939 @subsubheading Result
32940
32941 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32942 defined for each exception:
32943
32944 @table @samp
32945 @item name
32946 The name of the exception.
32947
32948 @item address
32949 The address of the exception.
32950
32951 @end table
32952
32953 @subsubheading Example
32954
32955 @smallexample
32956 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32957 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32958 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32959 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32960 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32961 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32962 @end smallexample
32963
32964 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32965
32966 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32967 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32968 Catchpoint Commands}.
32969
32970
32971 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32972 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32973 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32974
32975 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32976 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32977 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32978 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32979
32980 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32981 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32982 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32983
32984 @subsubheading Synopsis
32985
32986 @smallexample
32987 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32988 @end smallexample
32989
32990 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32991
32992 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32993 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32994 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32995 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32996 dash.
32997
32998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32999
33000 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33001
33002 @subsubheading Result
33003
33004 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33005
33006 @table @samp
33007 @item exists
33008 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33009 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33010
33011 @end table
33012
33013 @subsubheading Example
33014
33015 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33016
33017 @smallexample
33018 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33019 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33020 @end smallexample
33021
33022 @noindent
33023 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33024 to the debugger:
33025
33026 @smallexample
33027 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33028 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33029 @end smallexample
33030
33031 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33032 @findex -list-features
33033 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33034
33035 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33036 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33037 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33038 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33039 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33040 startup.
33041
33042 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33043 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33044 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33045 is given below.
33046
33047 Example output:
33048
33049 @smallexample
33050 (gdb) -list-features
33051 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33052 @end smallexample
33053
33054 The current list of features is:
33055
33056 @ftable @samp
33057 @item frozen-varobjs
33058 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33059 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33060 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33061 @item pending-breakpoints
33062 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33063 command.
33064 @item python
33065 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33066 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33067 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33068 @item thread-info
33069 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33070 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33071 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33072 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33073 @item breakpoint-notifications
33074 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33075 CLI will be announced via async records.
33076 @item ada-task-info
33077 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33078 @item language-option
33079 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33080 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33081 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33082 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33083 @item undefined-command-error-code
33084 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33085 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33086 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33087 @item exec-run-start-option
33088 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33089 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33090 @end ftable
33091
33092 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33093 @findex -list-target-features
33094
33095 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33096 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33097 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33098 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33099 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33100 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33101 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33102 Example output:
33103
33104 @smallexample
33105 (gdb) -list-target-features
33106 ^done,result=["async"]
33107 @end smallexample
33108
33109 The current list of features is:
33110
33111 @table @samp
33112 @item async
33113 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33114 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33115 while the target is running.
33116
33117 @item reverse
33118 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33119 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33120
33121 @end table
33122
33123 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33124 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33125 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33126
33127 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33128
33129 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33130 @findex -gdb-exit
33131
33132 @subsubheading Synopsis
33133
33134 @smallexample
33135 -gdb-exit
33136 @end smallexample
33137
33138 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33139
33140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33141
33142 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33143
33144 @subsubheading Example
33145
33146 @smallexample
33147 (gdb)
33148 -gdb-exit
33149 ^exit
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152
33153 @ignore
33154 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33155 @findex -exec-abort
33156
33157 @subsubheading Synopsis
33158
33159 @smallexample
33160 -exec-abort
33161 @end smallexample
33162
33163 Kill the inferior running program.
33164
33165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33166
33167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33168
33169 @subsubheading Example
33170 N.A.
33171 @end ignore
33172
33173
33174 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33175 @findex -gdb-set
33176
33177 @subsubheading Synopsis
33178
33179 @smallexample
33180 -gdb-set
33181 @end smallexample
33182
33183 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33184 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33185
33186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33187
33188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33189
33190 @subsubheading Example
33191
33192 @smallexample
33193 (gdb)
33194 -gdb-set $foo=3
33195 ^done
33196 (gdb)
33197 @end smallexample
33198
33199
33200 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33201 @findex -gdb-show
33202
33203 @subsubheading Synopsis
33204
33205 @smallexample
33206 -gdb-show
33207 @end smallexample
33208
33209 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33210
33211 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33212
33213 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33214
33215 @subsubheading Example
33216
33217 @smallexample
33218 (gdb)
33219 -gdb-show annotate
33220 ^done,value="0"
33221 (gdb)
33222 @end smallexample
33223
33224 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33225
33226
33227 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33228 @findex -gdb-version
33229
33230 @subsubheading Synopsis
33231
33232 @smallexample
33233 -gdb-version
33234 @end smallexample
33235
33236 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33237
33238 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33239
33240 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33241 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33242
33243 @subsubheading Example
33244
33245 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33246 @c box in TeX.
33247 @smallexample
33248 (gdb)
33249 -gdb-version
33250 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33251 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33252 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33253 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33254 ~ certain conditions.
33255 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33256 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33257 ~ details.
33258 ~This GDB was configured as
33259 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33260 ^done
33261 (gdb)
33262 @end smallexample
33263
33264 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33265 @findex -list-thread-groups
33266
33267 @subheading Synopsis
33268
33269 @smallexample
33270 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33271 @end smallexample
33272
33273 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33274 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33275 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33276 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33277 top-level thread groups.
33278
33279 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33280 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33281 available on the target.
33282
33283 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33284 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33285 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33286 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33287 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33288 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33289 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33290 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33291
33292 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33293 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33294 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33295 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33296 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33297 @samp{threads} field.
33298
33299 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33300 the following caveats:
33301
33302 @itemize @bullet
33303 @item
33304 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33305 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33306 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33307
33308 @item
33309 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33310 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33311 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33312 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33313 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33314 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33315
33316 @end itemize
33317
33318 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33319 have the following fields:
33320
33321 @table @code
33322 @item id
33323 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33324 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33325 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33326
33327 @item type
33328 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33329 valid type.
33330
33331 @item pid
33332 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33333 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33334
33335 @item exit-code
33336 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33337 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33338 only if the process is not running.
33339
33340 @item num_children
33341 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33342 absent for an available thread group.
33343
33344 @item threads
33345 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33346 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33347 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33348
33349 @item cores
33350 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33351 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33352 such information is not available.
33353
33354 @item executable
33355 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33356 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33357 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33358
33359 @end table
33360
33361 @subheading Example
33362
33363 @smallexample
33364 @value{GDBP}
33365 -list-thread-groups
33366 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33367 -list-thread-groups 17
33368 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33369 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33370 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33371 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33372 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
33373 -list-thread-groups --available
33374 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33375 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33376 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33377 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33378 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33379 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33380 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33381 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33382 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33383 @end smallexample
33384
33385 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33386 @findex -info-os
33387
33388 @subsubheading Synopsis
33389
33390 @smallexample
33391 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33392 @end smallexample
33393
33394 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33395 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33396 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33397 of data of that type.
33398
33399 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33400 system.
33401
33402 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33403
33404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33405
33406 @subsubheading Example
33407
33408 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33409 like this:
33410
33411 @smallexample
33412 @value{GDBP}
33413 -info-os
33414 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33415 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33416 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33417 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33418 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33419 col2="CPUs"@},
33420 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33421 col2="File descriptors"@},
33422 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33423 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33424 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33425 col2="Message queues"@},
33426 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33427 col2="Processes"@},
33428 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33429 col2="Process groups"@},
33430 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33431 col2="Semaphores"@},
33432 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33433 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33434 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33435 col2="Sockets"@},
33436 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33437 col2="Threads"@}]
33438 @value{GDBP}
33439 -info-os processes
33440 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33441 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33442 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33443 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33444 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33445 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33446 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33447 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33448 ...
33449 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33450 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33451 (gdb)
33452 @end smallexample
33453
33454 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33455 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33456 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33457 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33458 @code{info os} omits it.)
33459
33460 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33461 @findex -add-inferior
33462
33463 @subheading Synopsis
33464
33465 @smallexample
33466 -add-inferior
33467 @end smallexample
33468
33469 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33470 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33471 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33472 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33473 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33474 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33475
33476 @subheading Example
33477
33478 @smallexample
33479 @value{GDBP}
33480 -add-inferior
33481 ^done,inferior="i3"
33482 @end smallexample
33483
33484 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33485 @findex -interpreter-exec
33486
33487 @subheading Synopsis
33488
33489 @smallexample
33490 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33491 @end smallexample
33492 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33493
33494 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33495
33496 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33497
33498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33499
33500 @subheading Example
33501
33502 @smallexample
33503 (gdb)
33504 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33505 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33506 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33507 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33508 ^done
33509 (gdb)
33510 @end smallexample
33511
33512 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33513 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33514
33515 @subheading Synopsis
33516
33517 @smallexample
33518 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33519 @end smallexample
33520
33521 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33522
33523 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33524
33525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33526
33527 @subheading Example
33528
33529 @smallexample
33530 (gdb)
33531 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33532 ^done
33533 (gdb)
33534 @end smallexample
33535
33536 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33537 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33538
33539 @subheading Synopsis
33540
33541 @smallexample
33542 -inferior-tty-show
33543 @end smallexample
33544
33545 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33546
33547 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33548
33549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33550
33551 @subheading Example
33552
33553 @smallexample
33554 (gdb)
33555 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33556 ^done
33557 (gdb)
33558 -inferior-tty-show
33559 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33560 (gdb)
33561 @end smallexample
33562
33563 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33564 @findex -enable-timings
33565
33566 @subheading Synopsis
33567
33568 @smallexample
33569 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33570 @end smallexample
33571
33572 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33573 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33574 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33575 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33576
33577 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33578
33579 No equivalent.
33580
33581 @subheading Example
33582
33583 @smallexample
33584 (gdb)
33585 -enable-timings
33586 ^done
33587 (gdb)
33588 -break-insert main
33589 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33590 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33591 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33592 times="0"@},
33593 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33594 (gdb)
33595 -enable-timings no
33596 ^done
33597 (gdb)
33598 -exec-run
33599 ^running
33600 (gdb)
33601 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33602 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33603 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33604 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33605 (gdb)
33606 @end smallexample
33607
33608 @node Annotations
33609 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33610
33611 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33612 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33613 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33614 relatively high level.
33615
33616 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33617 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33618
33619 @ignore
33620 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33621 @end ignore
33622
33623 @menu
33624 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33625 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33626 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33627 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33628 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33629 * Annotations for Running::
33630 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33631 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33632 @end menu
33633
33634 @node Annotations Overview
33635 @section What is an Annotation?
33636 @cindex annotations
33637
33638 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33639 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33640 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33641 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33642 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33643 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33644 cannot contain newline characters.
33645
33646 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33647 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33648 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33649 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33650 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33651 means those three characters as output.
33652
33653 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33654 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33655 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33656 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33657 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33658 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33659 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33660 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33661 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33662
33663 @table @code
33664 @kindex set annotate
33665 @item set annotate @var{level}
33666 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33667 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33668
33669 @item show annotate
33670 @kindex show annotate
33671 Show the current annotation level.
33672 @end table
33673
33674 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33675
33676 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33677
33678 @smallexample
33679 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33680 GNU gdb 6.0
33681 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33682 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33683 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33684 under certain conditions.
33685 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33686 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33687 for details.
33688 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33689
33690 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33691 (@value{GDBP})
33692 ^Z^Zprompt
33693 @kbd{quit}
33694
33695 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33696 $
33697 @end smallexample
33698
33699 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33700 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33701 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33702 output from @value{GDBN}.
33703
33704 @node Server Prefix
33705 @section The Server Prefix
33706 @cindex server prefix
33707
33708 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33709 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33710 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33711 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33712 a transparent manner.
33713
33714 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33715 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33716 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33717 @code{print} command.
33718
33719 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33720 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33721
33722 @node Prompting
33723 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33724
33725 @cindex annotations for prompts
33726 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33727 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33728 over, etc.
33729
33730 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33731 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33732 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33733 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33734 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33735 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33736 features the following annotations:
33737
33738 @smallexample
33739 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33740 ^Z^Zprompt
33741 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33742 @end smallexample
33743
33744 The input types are
33745
33746 @table @code
33747 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33748 @findex prompt annotation
33749 @findex post-prompt annotation
33750 @item prompt
33751 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33752
33753 @findex pre-commands annotation
33754 @findex commands annotation
33755 @findex post-commands annotation
33756 @item commands
33757 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33758 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33759
33760 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33761 @findex overload-choice annotation
33762 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33763 @item overload-choice
33764 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33765
33766 @findex pre-query annotation
33767 @findex query annotation
33768 @findex post-query annotation
33769 @item query
33770 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33771
33772 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33773 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33774 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33775 @item prompt-for-continue
33776 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33777 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33778 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33779 presence of annotations.
33780 @end table
33781
33782 @node Errors
33783 @section Errors
33784 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33785
33786 @findex quit annotation
33787 @smallexample
33788 ^Z^Zquit
33789 @end smallexample
33790
33791 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33792
33793 @findex error annotation
33794 @smallexample
33795 ^Z^Zerror
33796 @end smallexample
33797
33798 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33799
33800 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33801 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33802 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33803 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33804 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33805 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33806 to the top level.
33807
33808 @findex error-begin annotation
33809 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33810
33811 @smallexample
33812 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33813 @end smallexample
33814
33815 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33816 message.
33817
33818 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33819 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33820 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33821
33822 @node Invalidation
33823 @section Invalidation Notices
33824
33825 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33826 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33827 changed.
33828
33829 @table @code
33830 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33831 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33832
33833 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33834 have changed.
33835
33836 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33837 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33838
33839 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33840 deleted a breakpoint.
33841 @end table
33842
33843 @node Annotations for Running
33844 @section Running the Program
33845 @cindex annotations for running programs
33846
33847 @findex starting annotation
33848 @findex stopping annotation
33849 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33850 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33851
33852 @smallexample
33853 ^Z^Zstarting
33854 @end smallexample
33855
33856 is output. When the program stops,
33857
33858 @smallexample
33859 ^Z^Zstopped
33860 @end smallexample
33861
33862 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33863 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33864
33865 @table @code
33866 @findex exited annotation
33867 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33868 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33869 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33870
33871 @findex signalled annotation
33872 @findex signal-name annotation
33873 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33874 @findex signal-string annotation
33875 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33876 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33877 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33878 annotation continues:
33879
33880 @smallexample
33881 @var{intro-text}
33882 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33883 @var{name}
33884 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33885 @var{middle-text}
33886 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33887 @var{string}
33888 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33889 @var{end-text}
33890 @end smallexample
33891
33892 @noindent
33893 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33894 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33895 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33896 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33897 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33898
33899 @findex signal annotation
33900 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33901 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33902 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33903 terminated with it.
33904
33905 @findex breakpoint annotation
33906 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33907 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33908
33909 @findex watchpoint annotation
33910 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33911 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33912 @end table
33913
33914 @node Source Annotations
33915 @section Displaying Source
33916 @cindex annotations for source display
33917
33918 @findex source annotation
33919 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33920
33921 @smallexample
33922 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33923 @end smallexample
33924
33925 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33926 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33927 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33928 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33929 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33930 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33931 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33932 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33933 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33934 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33935 depend on the language).
33936
33937 @node JIT Interface
33938 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33939 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33940 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33941
33942 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33943 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33944 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33945 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33946
33947 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33948 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33949 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33950 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33951 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33952 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33953
33954 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33955 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33956 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33957 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33958 LLVM JIT.
33959
33960 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33961 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33962 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33963 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33964 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33965 out about additional code.
33966
33967 @menu
33968 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33969 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33970 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33971 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33972 @end menu
33973
33974 @node Declarations
33975 @section JIT Declarations
33976
33977 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33978 implement the interface:
33979
33980 @smallexample
33981 typedef enum
33982 @{
33983 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33984 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33985 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33986 @} jit_actions_t;
33987
33988 struct jit_code_entry
33989 @{
33990 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33991 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33992 const char *symfile_addr;
33993 uint64_t symfile_size;
33994 @};
33995
33996 struct jit_descriptor
33997 @{
33998 uint32_t version;
33999 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34000 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34001 uint32_t action_flag;
34002 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34003 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34004 @};
34005
34006 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34007 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34008
34009 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34010 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34011 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34012 @end smallexample
34013
34014 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34015 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34016 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34017
34018 @node Registering Code
34019 @section Registering Code
34020
34021 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34022
34023 @itemize @bullet
34024 @item
34025 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34026 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34027
34028 @item
34029 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34030 file.
34031
34032 @item
34033 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34034
34035 @item
34036 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34037
34038 @item
34039 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34040 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34041 @end itemize
34042
34043 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34044 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34045 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34046 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34047
34048 @node Unregistering Code
34049 @section Unregistering Code
34050
34051 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34052
34053 @itemize @bullet
34054 @item
34055 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34056
34057 @item
34058 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34059
34060 @item
34061 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34062 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34063 @end itemize
34064
34065 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34066 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34067
34068 @node Custom Debug Info
34069 @section Custom Debug Info
34070 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34071 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34072
34073 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34074 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34075 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34076 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34077 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34078 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34079 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34080 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34081 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34082
34083 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34084 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34085 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34086 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34087 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34088 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34089 compiler.
34090
34091 @menu
34092 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34093 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34094 @end menu
34095
34096 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34097 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34098 @kindex jit-reader-load
34099 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34100
34101 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34102 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34103
34104 @table @code
34105 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34106 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34107 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34108 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34109 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34110 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34111 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34112
34113 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34114 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34115 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34116 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34117 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34118
34119 @item jit-reader-unload
34120 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34121
34122 @end table
34123
34124 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34125 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34126 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34127
34128 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34129 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34130
34131 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34132 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34133 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34134 the system include directory.
34135
34136 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34137 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34138 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34139
34140 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34141 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34142
34143 @findex gdb_init_reader
34144 @smallexample
34145 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34146 @end smallexample
34147
34148 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34149
34150 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34151 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34152 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34153 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34154 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34155 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34156
34157 @smallexample
34158 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34159 @{
34160 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34161 int reader_version;
34162
34163 /* For use by the reader. */
34164 void *priv_data;
34165
34166 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34167 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34168 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34169 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34170 @};
34171 @end smallexample
34172
34173 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34174 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34175
34176 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34177 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34178 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34179 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34180 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34181 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34182 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34183 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34184 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34185 target's address space.
34186
34187 @node In-Process Agent
34188 @chapter In-Process Agent
34189 @cindex debugging agent
34190 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34191 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34192 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34193 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34194 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34195 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34196 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34197 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34198 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34199 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34200 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34201 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34202 behavior without interrupting it.
34203
34204 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34205 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34206 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34207 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34208 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34209 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34210 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34211 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34212 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34213
34214 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34215 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34216 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34217 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34218
34219 @anchor{Control Agent}
34220 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34221 debugging with the following commands:
34222
34223 @table @code
34224 @kindex set agent on
34225 @item set agent on
34226 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34227 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34228 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34229 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34230 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34231 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34232
34233 @kindex set agent off
34234 @item set agent off
34235 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34236 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34237
34238 @kindex show agent
34239 @item show agent
34240 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34241 the in-process agent.
34242 @end table
34243
34244 @menu
34245 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34246 @end menu
34247
34248 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34249 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34250 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34251
34252 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34253 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34254 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34255 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34256 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34257 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34258 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34259 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34260 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34261
34262 @menu
34263 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34264 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34265 @end menu
34266
34267 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34268 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34269 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34270
34271 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34272 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34273
34274 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34275 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34276 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34277 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34278
34279 @enumerate
34280 @item
34281 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34282 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34283 @item
34284 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34285 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34286 the other one.
34287 @end enumerate
34288
34289 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34290
34291 @enumerate
34292 @item
34293 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34294 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34295 @anchor{agent expression object}
34296 @item
34297 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34298 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34299 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34300 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34301 @item
34302 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34303 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34304
34305 @end enumerate
34306
34307 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34308 object:
34309
34310 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34311 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34312 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34313 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34314 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34315 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34316 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34317 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34318 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34319 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34320 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34321 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34322 memory address for collecting.
34323 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34324 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34325 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34326 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34327 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34328 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34329 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34330 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34331 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34332 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34333 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34334 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34335 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34336 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34337 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34338 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34339 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34340 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34341 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34342 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34343 @ref{agent expression object}
34344 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34345 @ref{agent expression object}
34346 @item actions @tab variable
34347 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34348 @end multitable
34349
34350 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34351 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34352 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34353
34354 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34355 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34356
34357 @table @samp
34358
34359 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34360 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34361 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34362 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34363 in IPA finally.
34364
34365 Replies:
34366 @table @samp
34367 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34368 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34369 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34370 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34371 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34372 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34373 @item E @var{NN}
34374 for an error
34375
34376 @end table
34377
34378 @item close
34379 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34380 is about to kill inferiors.
34381
34382 @item qTfSTM
34383 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34384 @item qTsSTM
34385 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34386 @item qTSTMat
34387 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34388 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34389 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34390
34391 Replies:
34392 @table @samp
34393 @item E @var{NN}
34394 for an error
34395 @end table
34396 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34397 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34398 @end table
34399
34400 @node GDB Bugs
34401 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34402 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34403 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34404
34405 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34406
34407 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34408 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34409 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34410 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34411
34412 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34413 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34414
34415 @menu
34416 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34417 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34418 @end menu
34419
34420 @node Bug Criteria
34421 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34422 @cindex bug criteria
34423
34424 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34425
34426 @itemize @bullet
34427 @cindex fatal signal
34428 @cindex debugger crash
34429 @cindex crash of debugger
34430 @item
34431 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34432 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34433
34434 @cindex error on valid input
34435 @item
34436 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34437 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34438 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34439
34440 @cindex invalid input
34441 @item
34442 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34443 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34444 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34445 for traditional practice''.
34446
34447 @item
34448 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34449 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34450 @end itemize
34451
34452 @node Bug Reporting
34453 @section How to Report Bugs
34454 @cindex bug reports
34455 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34456
34457 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34458 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34459 contact that organization first.
34460
34461 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34462 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34463 distribution.
34464 @c should add a web page ref...
34465
34466 @ifset BUGURL
34467 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34468 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34469 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34470 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34471 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34472 be used.
34473
34474 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34475 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34476 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34477 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34478
34479 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34480 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34481 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34482 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34483 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34484 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34485 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34486 bug reports to the mailing list.
34487 @end ifset
34488 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34489 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34490 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34491 @end ifclear
34492 @end ifset
34493
34494 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34495 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34496 fact or leave it out, state it!
34497
34498 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34499 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34500 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34501 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34502 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34503 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34504 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34505 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34506 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34507
34508 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34509 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34510 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34511 self-contained.
34512
34513 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34514 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34515 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34516 bugs properly.
34517
34518 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34519
34520 @itemize @bullet
34521 @item
34522 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34523 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34524 version}.
34525
34526 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34527 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34528
34529 @item
34530 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34531 version number.
34532
34533 @item
34534 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34535 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34536 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34537 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34538
34539 @item
34540 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34541 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34542
34543 @item
34544 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34545 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34546 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34547 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34548 those compilers.
34549
34550 @item
34551 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34552 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34553 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34554 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34555
34556 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34557 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34558
34559 @item
34560 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34561 reproduce the bug.
34562
34563 @item
34564 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34565 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34566
34567 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34568 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34569 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34570 a chance to make a mistake.
34571
34572 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34573 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34574 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34575 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34576 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34577 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34578 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34579 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34580
34581 @pindex script
34582 @cindex recording a session script
34583 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34584 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34585 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34586 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34587
34588 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34589 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34590
34591 @item
34592 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34593 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34594 it by context, not by line number.
34595
34596 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34597 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34598
34599 @end itemize
34600
34601 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34602
34603 @itemize @bullet
34604 @item
34605 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34606
34607 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34608 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34609 changes will not affect it.
34610
34611 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34612 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34613 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34614 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34615
34616 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34617 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34618 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34619 less time, and so on.
34620
34621 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34622 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34623
34624 @item
34625 A patch for the bug.
34626
34627 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34628 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34629 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34630 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34631
34632 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34633 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34634 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34635 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34636
34637 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34638 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34639 help us to understand.
34640
34641 @item
34642 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34643
34644 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34645 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34646 @end itemize
34647
34648 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34649 @c and consists of the two following files:
34650 @c rluser.texi
34651 @c hsuser.texi
34652 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34653 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34654 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34655 @include rluser.texi
34656 @include hsuser.texi
34657 @end ifclear
34658
34659 @node In Memoriam
34660 @appendix In Memoriam
34661
34662 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34663 contributors:
34664
34665 @table @code
34666 @item Fred Fish
34667 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34668 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34669 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34670
34671 @item Michael Snyder
34672 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34673 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34674 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34675 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34676 @end table
34677
34678 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34679 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34680
34681 @node Formatting Documentation
34682 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34683
34684 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34685 @cindex reference card
34686 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34687 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34688 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34689 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34690 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34691 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34692
34693 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34694 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34695
34696 @smallexample
34697 make refcard.dvi
34698 @end smallexample
34699
34700 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34701 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34702 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34703 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34704 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34705
34706 @cindex documentation
34707
34708 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34709 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34710 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34711 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34712 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34713 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34714
34715 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34716 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34717 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34718 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34719 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34720 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34721 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34722 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34723
34724 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34725 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34726 @code{makeinfo}.
34727
34728 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34729 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34730 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34731
34732 @smallexample
34733 cd gdb
34734 make gdb.info
34735 @end smallexample
34736
34737 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34738 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34739 Texinfo definitions file.
34740
34741 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34742 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34743 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34744 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34745 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34746 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34747 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34748
34749 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34750 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34751 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34752 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34753 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34754 directory.
34755
34756 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34757 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34758 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34759 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34760
34761 @smallexample
34762 make gdb.dvi
34763 @end smallexample
34764
34765 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34766
34767 @node Installing GDB
34768 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34769 @cindex installation
34770
34771 @menu
34772 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34773 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34774 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34775 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34776 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34777 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34778 @end menu
34779
34780 @node Requirements
34781 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34782 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34783
34784 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34785 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34786
34787 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34788 @table @asis
34789 @item ISO C90 compiler
34790 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34791 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34792
34793 @end table
34794
34795 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34796 @table @asis
34797 @item Expat
34798 @anchor{Expat}
34799 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34800 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34801 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34802 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34803 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34804 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34805
34806 Expat is used for:
34807
34808 @itemize @bullet
34809 @item
34810 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34811 @item
34812 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34813 @item
34814 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34815 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34816 @item
34817 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34818 @item
34819 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34820 @item
34821 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34822 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34823 @end itemize
34824
34825 @item MPFR
34826 @anchor{MPFR}
34827 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34828 library. This library may be included with your operating system
34829 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34830 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34831 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34832 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34833 option to specify its location.
34834
34835 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34836 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34837 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34838 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34839
34840 @item zlib
34841 @cindex compressed debug sections
34842 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34843 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34844 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34845 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34846 information in such binaries.
34847
34848 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34849 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34850 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34851
34852 @item iconv
34853 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34854 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34855 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34856 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34857
34858 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34859 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34860 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34861 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34862
34863 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34864 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34865 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34866
34867 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34868 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34869 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34870 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34871 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34872 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34873 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34874 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34875 @end table
34876
34877 @node Running Configure
34878 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34879 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34880 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34881 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34882 build the @code{gdb} program.
34883 @iftex
34884 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34885 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34886 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34887 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34888 @end iftex
34889
34890 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34891 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34892 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34893
34894 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34895 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34896
34897 @table @code
34898 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34899 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34900
34901 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34902 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34903
34904 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34905 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34906
34907 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34908 @sc{gnu} include files
34909
34910 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34911 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34912
34913 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34914 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34915
34916 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34917 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34918
34919 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34920 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34921
34922 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34923 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34924 @end table
34925
34926 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34927 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34928 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34929
34930 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34931 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34932 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34933 argument.
34934
34935 For example:
34936
34937 @smallexample
34938 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34939 ./configure @var{host}
34940 make
34941 @end smallexample
34942
34943 @noindent
34944 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34945 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34946 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34947 correct value by examining your system.)
34948
34949 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34950 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34951 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34952 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34953
34954 @need 750
34955 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34956 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34957 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34958
34959 @smallexample
34960 sh configure @var{host}
34961 @end smallexample
34962
34963 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34964 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34965 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34966 @file{configure}
34967 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34968 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34969
34970 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34971 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34972 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34973 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34974 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34975 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34976 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34977 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34978 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34979
34980 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34981 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34982 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34983 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34984 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34985
34986 @node Separate Objdir
34987 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34988
34989 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34990 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34991 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34992 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34993 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34994 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34995 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34996 program specified there.
34997
34998 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34999 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35000 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35001 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35002 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35003 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35004
35005 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35006 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35007
35008 @smallexample
35009 @group
35010 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35011 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35012 cd ../gdb-sun4
35013 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
35014 make
35015 @end group
35016 @end smallexample
35017
35018 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35019 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35020 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35021 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35022 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35023 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35024
35025 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35026 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35027 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35028 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35029 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35030
35031 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35032 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35033 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35034 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35035 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35036 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35037
35038 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35039 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35040 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35041
35042 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35043 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35044 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35045 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35046 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35047
35048 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35049 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35050 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35051 with each other.
35052
35053 @node Config Names
35054 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35055
35056 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35057 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35058 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35059 of information in the following pattern:
35060
35061 @smallexample
35062 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35063 @end smallexample
35064
35065 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35066 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35067 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35068
35069 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35070 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35071 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35072 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35073 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35074 abbreviations---for example:
35075
35076 @smallexample
35077 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35078 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35079 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35080 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35081 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35082 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35083 % sh config.sub sun4
35084 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35085 % sh config.sub sun3
35086 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35087 % sh config.sub i986v
35088 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35089 @end smallexample
35090
35091 @noindent
35092 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35093 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35094
35095 @node Configure Options
35096 @section @file{configure} Options
35097
35098 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35099 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
35100 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
35101 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
35102
35103 @smallexample
35104 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35105 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35106 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35107 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35108 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
35109 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35110 @var{host}
35111 @end smallexample
35112
35113 @noindent
35114 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35115 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35116 @samp{--}.
35117
35118 @table @code
35119 @item --help
35120 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35121
35122 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35123 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35124 @file{@var{dir}}.
35125
35126 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35127 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35128 @file{@var{dir}}.
35129
35130 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35131 @need 2000
35132 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35133 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35134 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35135 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35136 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35137 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35138 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35139 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35140 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35141 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35142 @var{dirname}.
35143
35144 @item --norecursion
35145 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35146 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35147
35148 @item --target=@var{target}
35149 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35150 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35151 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35152
35153 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35154
35155 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35156 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35157
35158 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35159 @end table
35160
35161 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35162 needed for special purposes only.
35163
35164 @node System-wide configuration
35165 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35166 @cindex system-wide init file
35167
35168 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35169 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35170 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35171
35172 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35173
35174 @table @code
35175 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35176 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35177 @var{file}.
35178 @end table
35179
35180 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35181 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35182
35183 @itemize @bullet
35184 @item
35185 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35186 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35187 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35188 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35189 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35190 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35191
35192 @item
35193 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35194 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35195 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35196 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35197 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35198 @end itemize
35199
35200 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35201 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35202 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35203 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35204 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35205 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35206 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35207 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35208 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35209 reread.
35210
35211 @menu
35212 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35213 @end menu
35214
35215 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35216 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35217 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35218
35219 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35220 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35221 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35222 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35223 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35224 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35225
35226 The following scripts are currently available:
35227 @itemize @bullet
35228
35229 @item @file{elinos.py}
35230 @pindex elinos.py
35231 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35232 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35233 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35234 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35235 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35236 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35237
35238 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35239 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35240 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35241 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35242 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35243 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35244
35245 @end itemize
35246
35247 @node Maintenance Commands
35248 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35249 @cindex maintenance commands
35250 @cindex internal commands
35251
35252 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35253 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35254 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35255 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35256 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35257
35258 @table @code
35259 @kindex maint agent
35260 @kindex maint agent-eval
35261 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35262 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35263 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35264 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35265 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35266 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35267 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35268 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35269 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35270 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35271 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35272 addition and return the sum.
35273 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35274 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35275
35276 @kindex maint agent-printf
35277 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35278 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35279 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35280 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35281 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35282
35283 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35284 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35285 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35286 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35287 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35288 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35289 is shown:
35290
35291 @table @code
35292 @item breakpoint
35293 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35294
35295 @item watchpoint
35296 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35297
35298 @item longjmp
35299 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35300 @code{longjmp} calls.
35301
35302 @item longjmp resume
35303 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35304
35305 @item until
35306 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35307
35308 @item finish
35309 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35310
35311 @item shlib events
35312 Shared library events.
35313
35314 @end table
35315
35316 @kindex maint info btrace
35317 @item maint info btrace
35318 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35319
35320 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35321 @item maint btrace packet-history
35322 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35323 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35324 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35325 recording format.
35326
35327 @table @code
35328 @item bts
35329 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35330 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35331
35332 @table @asis
35333 @item Block number
35334 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35335 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35336 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35337 @end table
35338
35339 @item pt
35340 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35341 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35342 information is printed:
35343
35344 @table @asis
35345 @item Packet number
35346 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35347 @item Trace offset
35348 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35349 @item Packet opcode and payload
35350 @end table
35351 @end table
35352
35353 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35354 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35355 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35356 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35357 needed.
35358
35359 @kindex maint btrace clear
35360 @item maint btrace clear
35361 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35362 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35363
35364 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35365 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35366 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35367 buffer.
35368
35369 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35370 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35371 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35372 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35373 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35374 packet history.
35375
35376 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35377 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35378 @cindex displaced stepping support
35379 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35380 @item set displaced-stepping
35381 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35382 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35383 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35384 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35385 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35386 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35387
35388 @table @code
35389 @item set displaced-stepping on
35390 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35391 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35392
35393 @item set displaced-stepping off
35394 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35395 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35396
35397 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35398 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35399 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35400 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35401 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35402 @end table
35403
35404 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35405 @item maint check-psymtabs
35406 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35407 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35408
35409 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35410 @item maint check-symtabs
35411 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35412
35413 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35414 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35415 Expand symbol tables.
35416 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35417 names matching @var{regexp}.
35418
35419 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35420 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35421 @cindex demangler crashes
35422 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35423 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35424 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35425 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35426 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35427 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35428 option to terminate the current session.
35429
35430 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35431 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35432 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35433
35434 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35435 @item maint cplus namespace
35436 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35437
35438 @kindex maint deprecate
35439 @kindex maint undeprecate
35440 @cindex deprecated commands
35441 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35442 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35443 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35444 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35445 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35446 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35447 the replacement as part of the warning.
35448
35449 @kindex maint dump-me
35450 @item maint dump-me
35451 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35452 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35453 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35454 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35455
35456 @kindex maint internal-error
35457 @kindex maint internal-warning
35458 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35459 @cindex demangler crashes
35460 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35461 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35462 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35463
35464 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35465 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35466 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35467 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35468 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35469 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35470 @value{GDBN} session.
35471
35472 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35473 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35474
35475 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35476
35477 @smallexample
35478 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35479 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35480 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35481 debugging may prove unreliable.
35482 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35483 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35484 (@value{GDBP})
35485 @end smallexample
35486
35487 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35488 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35489 @cindex demangler crashes
35490
35491 @kindex maint set internal-error
35492 @kindex maint show internal-error
35493 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35494 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35495 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35496 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35497 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35498 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35499 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35500 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35501 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35502 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35503 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35504 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35505 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35506 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35507 described in the table below.
35508
35509 @table @samp
35510 @item quit
35511 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35512 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35513
35514 @item corefile
35515 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35516 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35517 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35518 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35519 disabled.
35520 @end table
35521
35522 @kindex maint packet
35523 @item maint packet @var{text}
35524 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35525 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35526 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35527 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35528 checksum.
35529
35530 @kindex maint print architecture
35531 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35532 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35533 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35534
35535 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35536 @item maint print c-tdesc
35537 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35538 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35539 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35540 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35541 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35542 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35543 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35544 modify XML target descriptions.
35545
35546 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35547 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35548 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35549 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35550
35551 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
35552 @kindex maint check libthread-db
35553 @item maint check libthread-db
35554 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
35555 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
35556 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
35557 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
35558 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
35559 on some platforms when debugging core files.
35560
35561 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35562 @item maint print dummy-frames
35563 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35564
35565 @smallexample
35566 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35567 @dots{}
35568 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35569 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35570 58 return (a + b);
35571 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35572 @dots{}
35573 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35574 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35575 (@value{GDBP})
35576 @end smallexample
35577
35578 Takes an optional file parameter.
35579
35580 @kindex maint print registers
35581 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35582 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35583 @kindex maint print register-groups
35584 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35585 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35586 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35587 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35588 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35589 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35590 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35591
35592 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35593 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35594 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35595 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35596 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35597 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35598 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35599 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35600
35601 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35602 write the information.
35603
35604 @kindex maint print reggroups
35605 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35606 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35607 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35608 information.
35609
35610 The register groups info looks like this:
35611
35612 @smallexample
35613 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35614 Group Type
35615 general user
35616 float user
35617 all user
35618 vector user
35619 system user
35620 save internal
35621 restore internal
35622 @end smallexample
35623
35624 @kindex flushregs
35625 @item flushregs
35626 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35627
35628 @kindex maint print objfiles
35629 @cindex info for known object files
35630 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35631 Print a dump of all known object files.
35632 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35633 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35634 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35635
35636 @kindex maint print user-registers
35637 @cindex user registers
35638 @item maint print user-registers
35639 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35640 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35641 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35642 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35643 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35644 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35645 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35646
35647 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35648 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35649 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35650 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35651 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35652 matching @var{regexp}.
35653 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35654 and the full path if known.
35655 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35656
35657 @kindex maint print statistics
35658 @cindex bcache statistics
35659 @item maint print statistics
35660 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35661 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35662 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35663 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35664 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35665 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35666 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35667 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35668 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35669 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35670 lengths.
35671
35672 @kindex maint print target-stack
35673 @cindex target stack description
35674 @item maint print target-stack
35675 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35676 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35677 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35678 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35679 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35680 address.
35681
35682 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35683 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35684
35685 @kindex maint print type
35686 @cindex type chain of a data type
35687 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35688 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35689 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35690 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35691 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35692 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35693
35694 @kindex maint selftest
35695 @cindex self tests
35696 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35697 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35698 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35699 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35700 name will by ran.
35701
35702 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35703 @cindex self tests
35704 @item maint info selftests
35705 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35706
35707 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35708 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35709 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35710 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35711 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35712 information.
35713
35714 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35715 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35716 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35717 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35718 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35719 always see the disassembly form.
35720
35721 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35722
35723 @smallexample
35724 (gdb) info addr argc
35725 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35726 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35727 @end smallexample
35728
35729 For more information on these expressions, see
35730 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35731
35732 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35733 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35734 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35735 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35736 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35737
35738 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35739 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35740 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35741 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35742 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35743 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35744 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35745 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35746 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35747
35748 @kindex maint set profile
35749 @kindex maint show profile
35750 @cindex profiling GDB
35751 @item maint set profile
35752 @itemx maint show profile
35753 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35754
35755 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35756 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35757 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35758 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35759 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35760 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35761 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35762
35763 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35764 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35765
35766 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35767 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35768 @cindex hardware debug registers
35769 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35770 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35771 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35772 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35773 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35774 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35775 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35776
35777 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35778 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35779 @item maint set show-all-tib
35780 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35781 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35782 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35783 command.
35784
35785 @kindex maint set target-async
35786 @kindex maint show target-async
35787 @item maint set target-async
35788 @itemx maint show target-async
35789 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35790 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35791 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35792 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35793
35794 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35795 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35796 @item maint set target-non-stop
35797 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35798
35799 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35800 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35801 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35802 if supported by the target.
35803
35804 @table @code
35805 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35806 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35807 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35808
35809 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35810 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35811 does not indicate support.
35812
35813 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35814 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35815 target supports it.
35816 @end table
35817
35818 @kindex maint set per-command
35819 @kindex maint show per-command
35820 @item maint set per-command
35821 @itemx maint show per-command
35822 @cindex resources used by commands
35823
35824 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35825 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35826
35827 @table @code
35828 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35829 @itemx maint show per-command space
35830 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35831 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35832 took, following the command's own output.
35833 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35834 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35835
35836 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35837 @itemx maint show per-command time
35838 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35839 for each command.
35840 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35841 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35842 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35843 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35844 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35845 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35846 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35847 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35848 spent by the program been debugged.
35849 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35850 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35851
35852 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35853 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35854 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35855 for each command.
35856 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35857
35858 @enumerate a
35859 @item
35860 number of symbol tables
35861 @item
35862 number of primary symbol tables
35863 @item
35864 number of blocks in the blockvector
35865 @end enumerate
35866 @end table
35867
35868 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
35869 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
35870 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
35871 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
35872 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
35873 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
35874 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
35875 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
35876 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
35877 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
35878
35879 @kindex maint space
35880 @cindex memory used by commands
35881 @item maint space @var{value}
35882 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35883 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35884
35885 @kindex maint time
35886 @cindex time of command execution
35887 @item maint time @var{value}
35888 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35889 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35890
35891 @kindex maint translate-address
35892 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35893 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35894 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35895 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35896 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35897 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35898 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35899
35900 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35901 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35902 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35903
35904 @end table
35905
35906 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35907 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35908
35909 @table @code
35910 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35911 @kindex set watchdog
35912 @cindex watchdog timer
35913 @cindex timeout for commands
35914 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35915 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35916 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35917
35918 @item show watchdog
35919 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35920 @end table
35921
35922 @node Remote Protocol
35923 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35924
35925 @menu
35926 * Overview::
35927 * Packets::
35928 * Stop Reply Packets::
35929 * General Query Packets::
35930 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35931 * Tracepoint Packets::
35932 * Host I/O Packets::
35933 * Interrupts::
35934 * Notification Packets::
35935 * Remote Non-Stop::
35936 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35937 * Examples::
35938 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35939 * Library List Format::
35940 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35941 * Memory Map Format::
35942 * Thread List Format::
35943 * Traceframe Info Format::
35944 * Branch Trace Format::
35945 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35946 @end menu
35947
35948 @node Overview
35949 @section Overview
35950
35951 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35952 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35953 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35954 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35955
35956 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35957 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35958
35959 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35960 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35961 @cindex remote serial protocol
35962 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35963 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35964 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35965 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35966 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35967
35968 @smallexample
35969 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35970 @end smallexample
35971 @noindent
35972
35973 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35974 @noindent
35975 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35976 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35977 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35978
35979 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35980 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35981
35982 @smallexample
35983 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35984 @end smallexample
35985
35986 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35987 @noindent
35988 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35989 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35990 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35991
35992 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35993 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35994 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35995 retransmission):
35996
35997 @smallexample
35998 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35999 <- @code{+}
36000 @end smallexample
36001 @noindent
36002
36003 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36004 once a connection is established.
36005 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36006
36007 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36008 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36009 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36010 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36011 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36012 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36013 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36014
36015 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36016 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36017 exceptions).
36018
36019 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36020 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36021 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36022 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36023
36024 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36025 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36026 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36027
36028 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36029 @anchor{Binary Data}
36030 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36031 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36032 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36033 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36034 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36035 binary data.
36036
36037 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36038 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36039 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36040 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36041 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36042 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36043 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36044 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36045 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36046 (described next).
36047
36048 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36049 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36050 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36051 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36052 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36053 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36054 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36055 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36056 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36057 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36058 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36059 3}} more times.
36060
36061 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36062 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36063 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36064 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36065 @samp{0*"00}.
36066
36067 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36068 error number. That number is not well defined.
36069
36070 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36071 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36072 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36073 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36074 on that response.
36075
36076 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36077 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36078 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36079 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36080 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36081 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36082
36083 @node Packets
36084 @section Packets
36085
36086 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36087 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36088 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36089 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36090
36091 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36092 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36093 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36094 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36095 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36096 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36097 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36098 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36099 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36100 @var{baz}.
36101
36102 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36103 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36104 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36105 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36106 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36107 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36108 pick any thread.
36109
36110 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36111 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36112 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36113 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36114 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36115 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36116 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36117 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36118 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36119 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36120 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36121 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36122 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36123
36124 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36125 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36126 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36127 more information.
36128
36129 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36130 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36131
36132 Here are the packet descriptions.
36133
36134 @table @samp
36135
36136 @item !
36137 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36138 @anchor{extended mode}
36139 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36140 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36141 debugged.
36142
36143 Reply:
36144 @table @samp
36145 @item OK
36146 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36147 @end table
36148
36149 @item ?
36150 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36151 @anchor{? packet}
36152 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36153 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36154 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36155
36156 Reply:
36157 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36158
36159 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36160 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36161 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36162 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36163 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36164
36165 Reply:
36166 @table @samp
36167 @item OK
36168 The arguments were set.
36169 @item E @var{NN}
36170 An error occurred.
36171 @end table
36172
36173 @item b @var{baud}
36174 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36175 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36176 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36177
36178 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36179 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36180 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36181
36182 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36183 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36184 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36185 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36186 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36187
36188 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36189 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36190 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36191 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36192
36193 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36194 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36195
36196 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36197 @anchor{bc}
36198 @item bc
36199 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36200 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36201
36202 Reply:
36203 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36204
36205 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36206 @anchor{bs}
36207 @item bs
36208 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36209 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36210
36211 Reply:
36212 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36213
36214 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36215 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36216 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36217 is omitted, resume at current address.
36218
36219 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36220 packet}.
36221
36222 Reply:
36223 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36224
36225 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36226 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36227 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36228 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36229
36230 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36231 packet}.
36232
36233 Reply:
36234 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36235
36236 @item d
36237 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36238 Toggle debug flag.
36239
36240 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36241 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36242
36243 @item D
36244 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36245 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36246 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36247 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36248 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36249
36250 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36251 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36252 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36253 big-endian hex string.
36254
36255 Reply:
36256 @table @samp
36257 @item OK
36258 for success
36259 @item E @var{NN}
36260 for an error
36261 @end table
36262
36263 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36264 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36265 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36266 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36267 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36268
36269 @item g
36270 @anchor{read registers packet}
36271 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36272 Read general registers.
36273
36274 Reply:
36275 @table @samp
36276 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36277 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36278 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36279 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36280 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36281 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36282
36283 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36284 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36285 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36286 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36287 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36288 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36289 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36290 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36291
36292 @smallexample
36293 -> @code{g}
36294 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36295 @end smallexample
36296
36297 @item E @var{NN}
36298 for an error.
36299 @end table
36300
36301 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36302 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36303 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36304 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36305
36306 Reply:
36307 @table @samp
36308 @item OK
36309 for success
36310 @item E @var{NN}
36311 for an error
36312 @end table
36313
36314 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36315 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36316 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36317 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36318 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36319 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36320 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36321 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36322 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36323
36324 Reply:
36325 @table @samp
36326 @item OK
36327 for success
36328 @item E @var{NN}
36329 for an error
36330 @end table
36331
36332 @c FIXME: JTC:
36333 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36334 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36335 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36336 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36337 @c described. For example:
36338 @c
36339 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36340 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36341 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36342 @c
36343 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36344 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36345 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36346
36347 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36348 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36349 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36350 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36351 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36352 step starting at that address.
36353
36354 @item I
36355 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36356 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36357 step packet}.
36358
36359 @item k
36360 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36361 Kill request.
36362
36363 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36364
36365 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36366 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36367
36368 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36369
36370 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36371 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36372 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36373
36374 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36375 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36376 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36377
36378 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36379 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36380 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36381 (@pxref{? packet}).
36382
36383 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36384 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36385 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36386 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36387 any particular boundary.
36388
36389 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36390 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36391 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36392 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36393 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36394 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36395 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36396 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36397
36398 Reply:
36399 @table @samp
36400 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36401 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36402 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36403 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36404 @item E @var{NN}
36405 @var{NN} is errno
36406 @end table
36407
36408 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36409 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36410 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36411 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36412 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36413
36414 Reply:
36415 @table @samp
36416 @item OK
36417 for success
36418 @item E @var{NN}
36419 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36420 written).
36421 @end table
36422
36423 @item p @var{n}
36424 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36425 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36426 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36427 register value is encoded.
36428
36429 Reply:
36430 @table @samp
36431 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36432 the register's value
36433 @item E @var{NN}
36434 for an error
36435 @item @w{}
36436 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36437 @end table
36438
36439 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36440 @anchor{write register packet}
36441 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36442 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36443 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36444 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36445
36446 Reply:
36447 @table @samp
36448 @item OK
36449 for success
36450 @item E @var{NN}
36451 for an error
36452 @end table
36453
36454 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36455 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36456 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36457 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36458 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36459 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36460
36461 @item r
36462 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36463 Reset the entire system.
36464
36465 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36466
36467 @item R @var{XX}
36468 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36469 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36470 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36471
36472 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36473
36474 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36475 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36476 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36477 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36478
36479 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36480 packet}.
36481
36482 Reply:
36483 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36484
36485 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36486 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36487 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36488 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36489 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36490
36491 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36492 packet}.
36493
36494 Reply:
36495 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36496
36497 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36498 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36499 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36500 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36501 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36502
36503 @item T @var{thread-id}
36504 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36505 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36506
36507 Reply:
36508 @table @samp
36509 @item OK
36510 thread is still alive
36511 @item E @var{NN}
36512 thread is dead
36513 @end table
36514
36515 @item v
36516 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36517 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36518
36519 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36520 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36521 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36522 The process ID is a
36523 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36524 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36525 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36526
36527 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36528 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36529 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36530 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36531 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36532 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36533 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36534 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36535
36536 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36537
36538 Reply:
36539 @table @samp
36540 @item E @var{nn}
36541 for an error
36542 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36543 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36544 @item OK
36545 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36546 @end table
36547
36548 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36549 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36550 @anchor{vCont packet}
36551 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36552
36553 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36554 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36555 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36556 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36557 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36558 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36559 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36560 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36561 error.
36562
36563 Currently supported actions are:
36564
36565 @table @samp
36566 @item c
36567 Continue.
36568 @item C @var{sig}
36569 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36570 @item s
36571 Step.
36572 @item S @var{sig}
36573 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36574 @item t
36575 Stop.
36576 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36577 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36578 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36579 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36580 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36581 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36582
36583 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36584 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36585 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36586 jumps to @var{start}).
36587
36588 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36589 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36590 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36591
36592 @end table
36593
36594 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36595 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36596 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36597
36598 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36599 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36600 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36601 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36602 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36603 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36604 as an implementation detail.
36605
36606 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36607 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36608 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36609 stopped.
36610
36611 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36612 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36613 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36614
36615 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36616 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36617
36618 Reply:
36619 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36620
36621 @item vCont?
36622 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36623 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36624
36625 Reply:
36626 @table @samp
36627 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36628 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36629 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36630 @item @w{}
36631 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36632 @end table
36633
36634 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36635 @item vCtrlC
36636 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36637 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36638 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36639 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36640 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36641 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36642 variant.
36643
36644 Reply:
36645 @table @samp
36646 @item E @var{nn}
36647 for an error
36648 @item OK
36649 for success
36650 @end table
36651
36652 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36653 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36654 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36655 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36656
36657 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36658 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36659 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36660 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36661 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36662 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36663 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36664 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36665 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36666 packet is received.
36667
36668 Reply:
36669 @table @samp
36670 @item OK
36671 for success
36672 @item E @var{NN}
36673 for an error
36674 @end table
36675
36676 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36677 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36678 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36679 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36680 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36681 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36682 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36683 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36684 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36685 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36686 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36687 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36688
36689
36690 Reply:
36691 @table @samp
36692 @item OK
36693 for success
36694 @item E.memtype
36695 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36696 @item E @var{NN}
36697 for an error
36698 @end table
36699
36700 @item vFlashDone
36701 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36702 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36703 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36704 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36705 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36706 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36707 request is completed.
36708
36709 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36710 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36711 @anchor{vKill packet}
36712 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36713 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36714 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36715 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36716
36717 Reply:
36718 @table @samp
36719 @item E @var{nn}
36720 for an error
36721 @item OK
36722 for success
36723 @end table
36724
36725 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36726 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36727 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36728 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36729 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36730
36731 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36732 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36733 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36734 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36735 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36736 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36737
36738 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36739 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36740 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36741 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36742 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36743 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36744 state.
36745
36746 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36747
36748 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36749
36750 Reply:
36751 @table @samp
36752 @item E @var{nn}
36753 for an error
36754 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36755 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36756 @end table
36757
36758 @item vStopped
36759 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36760 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36761
36762 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36763 @anchor{X packet}
36764 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36765 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36766 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36767 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36768 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36769
36770 Reply:
36771 @table @samp
36772 @item OK
36773 for success
36774 @item E @var{NN}
36775 for an error
36776 @end table
36777
36778 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36779 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36780 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36781 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36782 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36783 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36784 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36785
36786 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36787 separately.
36788
36789 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36790 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36791 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36792 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36793 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36794 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36795
36796 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36797 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36798 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36799 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36800 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36801 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36802
36803 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36804 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36805 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36806 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36807 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36808 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36809 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36810 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36811 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36812 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36813 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36814 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36815 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36816
36817 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36818 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36819
36820 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36821 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36822
36823 @table @samp
36824
36825 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36826 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36827 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36828
36829 @end table
36830
36831 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36832 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36833 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36834 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36835 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36836 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36837 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36838
36839 @table @samp
36840
36841 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36842 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36843 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36844
36845 @end table
36846
36847 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36848 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36849 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36850 target, is not defined.}
36851
36852 Reply:
36853 @table @samp
36854 @item OK
36855 success
36856 @item @w{}
36857 not supported
36858 @item E @var{NN}
36859 for an error
36860 @end table
36861
36862 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36863 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36864 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36865 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36866 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36867 address @var{addr}.
36868
36869 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36870 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36871 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36872 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36873
36874 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36875 movement.}
36876
36877 Reply:
36878 @table @samp
36879 @item OK
36880 success
36881 @item @w{}
36882 not supported
36883 @item E @var{NN}
36884 for an error
36885 @end table
36886
36887 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36888 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36889 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36890 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36891 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36892 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36893
36894 Reply:
36895 @table @samp
36896 @item OK
36897 success
36898 @item @w{}
36899 not supported
36900 @item E @var{NN}
36901 for an error
36902 @end table
36903
36904 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36905 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36906 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36907 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36908 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36909 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36910
36911 Reply:
36912 @table @samp
36913 @item OK
36914 success
36915 @item @w{}
36916 not supported
36917 @item E @var{NN}
36918 for an error
36919 @end table
36920
36921 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36922 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36923 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36924 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36925 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36926 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36927
36928 Reply:
36929 @table @samp
36930 @item OK
36931 success
36932 @item @w{}
36933 not supported
36934 @item E @var{NN}
36935 for an error
36936 @end table
36937
36938 @end table
36939
36940 @node Stop Reply Packets
36941 @section Stop Reply Packets
36942 @cindex stop reply packets
36943
36944 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36945 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36946 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36947 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36948 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36949 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36950 @value{GDBN} source code.
36951
36952 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36953 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36954 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36955
36956 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36957 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36958 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36959 components.
36960
36961 @table @samp
36962
36963 @item S @var{AA}
36964 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36965 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36966 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36967
36968 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36969 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36970 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36971 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36972 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36973 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36974 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36975 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36976
36977 @itemize @bullet
36978 @item
36979 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36980 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36981 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36982 two-digit hex number.
36983
36984 @item
36985 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36986 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36987
36988 @item
36989 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36990 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36991
36992 @item
36993 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36994 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36995 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36996 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36997
36998 @item
36999 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37000 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37001 future.
37002 @end itemize
37003
37004 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37005
37006 @table @samp
37007 @item watch
37008 @itemx rwatch
37009 @itemx awatch
37010 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37011 hex.
37012
37013 @item syscall_entry
37014 @itemx syscall_return
37015 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37016 syscall number, in hex.
37017
37018 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37019 @item library
37020 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37021 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37022 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37023
37024 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37025 @item replaylog
37026 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37027 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37028 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37029 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37030 for more information.
37031
37032 @item swbreak
37033 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37034 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37035 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37036 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37037 part must be left empty.
37038
37039 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37040 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37041 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37042 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37043 address.
37044
37045 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37046 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37047 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37048 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37049 indicating support.
37050
37051 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37052
37053 @item hwbreak
37054 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37055 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37056
37057 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37058 apply.
37059
37060 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37061 @item fork
37062 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37063 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37064 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37065 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37066 fork events.
37067
37068 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37069 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37070 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37071 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37072 indicating support.
37073
37074 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37075 @item vfork
37076 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37077 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37078 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37079 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37080 vfork events.
37081
37082 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37083 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37084 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37085 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37086 indicating support.
37087
37088 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37089 @item vforkdone
37090 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37091 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37092 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37093 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37094 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37095
37096 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37097 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37098 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37099 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37100 indicating support.
37101
37102 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37103 @item exec
37104 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37105 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37106 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37107
37108 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37109 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37110 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37111 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37112 indicating support.
37113
37114 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37115 @anchor{thread create event}
37116 @item create
37117 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37118 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37119 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37120 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37121 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37122 @var{r} part is ignored.
37123
37124 @end table
37125
37126 @item W @var{AA}
37127 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37128 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37129 applicable to certain targets.
37130
37131 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37132 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37133 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37134 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37135 hex strings.
37136
37137 @item X @var{AA}
37138 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37139 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37140
37141 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37142 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37143 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37144 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37145 hex strings.
37146
37147 @anchor{thread exit event}
37148 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37149 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37150
37151 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37152 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37153 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37154 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37155
37156 @item N
37157 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37158 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37159 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37160 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37161 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37162 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37163 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37164 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37165 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37166 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37167 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37168 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37169 support.
37170
37171 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37172 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37173 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37174 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37175 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37176
37177 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37178 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37179 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37180 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37181 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37182 system calls.
37183
37184 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37185 this very system call.
37186
37187 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37188 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37189 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37190 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37191 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37192 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37193
37194 @end table
37195
37196 @node General Query Packets
37197 @section General Query Packets
37198 @cindex remote query requests
37199
37200 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37201 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37202 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37203 sending information to and from the stub.
37204
37205 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37206 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37207 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37208 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37209 conventions:
37210
37211 @itemize @bullet
37212 @item
37213 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37214 @item
37215 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37216 letter.
37217 @item
37218 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37219 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37220 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37221 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37222 @end itemize
37223
37224 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37225 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37226 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37227 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37228 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37229 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37230 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37231 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37232 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37233 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37234 packet.}.
37235
37236 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37237 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37238 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37239 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37240 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37241
37242 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37243
37244 @table @samp
37245
37246 @item QAgent:1
37247 @itemx QAgent:0
37248 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37249 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37250
37251 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37252 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37253 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37254 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37255 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37256 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37257 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37258 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37259 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37260 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37261 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37262
37263 @item qC
37264 @cindex current thread, remote request
37265 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37266 Return the current thread ID.
37267
37268 Reply:
37269 @table @samp
37270 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37271 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37272 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37273 @item @r{(anything else)}
37274 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37275 @end table
37276
37277 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37278 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37279 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37280 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37281 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37282 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37283 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37284 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37285
37286 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37287 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37288 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37289 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37290 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37291 detect trailing zeros.
37292
37293 Reply:
37294 @table @samp
37295 @item E @var{NN}
37296 An error (such as memory fault)
37297 @item C @var{crc32}
37298 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37299 @end table
37300
37301 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37302 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37303 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37304 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37305 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37306 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37307 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37308 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37309 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37310 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37311 randomization.
37312
37313 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37314
37315 Reply:
37316 @table @samp
37317 @item OK
37318 The request succeeded.
37319
37320 @item E @var{nn}
37321 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37322
37323 @item @w{}
37324 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37325 by the stub.
37326 @end table
37327
37328 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37329 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37330 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37331 address space randomization.
37332
37333 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37334 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37335 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37336 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37337 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37338 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37339 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37340 inferior using a shell or not.
37341
37342 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37343 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37344 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37345 values are considered an error.
37346
37347 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37348 mode}).
37349
37350 Reply:
37351 @table @samp
37352 @item OK
37353 The request succeeded.
37354
37355 @item E @var{nn}
37356 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37357 @end table
37358
37359 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37360 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37361 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37362 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37363
37364 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37365 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37366
37367 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37368 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37369 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37370 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37371 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37372 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37373 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37374 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37375 environment}).
37376
37377 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37378 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37379 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37380 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37381 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37382 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37383 not be present.
37384
37385 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37386 mode}).
37387
37388 Reply:
37389 @table @samp
37390 @item OK
37391 The request succeeded.
37392 @end table
37393
37394 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37395 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37396 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37397 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37398 inferior.
37399
37400 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37401 @pxref{set environment}.
37402
37403 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37404 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37405 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37406 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37407 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37408 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37409 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37410 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37411
37412 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37413 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37414
37415 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37416 mode}).
37417
37418 Reply:
37419 @table @samp
37420 @item OK
37421 The request succeeded.
37422 @end table
37423
37424 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37425 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37426 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37427 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37428 inferior.
37429
37430 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37431 @pxref{unset environment}.
37432
37433 @item QEnvironmentReset
37434 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37435 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37436 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37437 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37438 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37439 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37440 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37441 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37442 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37443 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37444 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37445
37446 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37447 mode}).
37448
37449 Reply:
37450 @table @samp
37451 @item OK
37452 The request succeeded.
37453 @end table
37454
37455 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37456 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37457 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37458 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37459 inferior.
37460
37461 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37462 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37463 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37464 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37465 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37466 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37467
37468 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37469 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37470 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37471 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37472 directory to its original, empty value.
37473
37474 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37475 mode}).
37476
37477 Reply:
37478 @table @samp
37479 @item OK
37480 The request succeeded.
37481 @end table
37482
37483 @item qfThreadInfo
37484 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37485 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37486 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37487 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37488 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37489 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37490 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37491 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37492 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37493 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37494
37495 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37496
37497 Reply:
37498 @table @samp
37499 @item m @var{thread-id}
37500 A single thread ID
37501 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37502 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37503 @item l
37504 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37505 @end table
37506
37507 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37508 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37509 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37510 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37511 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37512 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37513 fields.
37514
37515 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37516 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37517 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37518 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37519 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37520
37521 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37522 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37523 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37524 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37525 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37526
37527 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37528 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37529
37530 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37531 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37532 information associated with the variable.)
37533
37534 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37535 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37536 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37537 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37538 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37539 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37540
37541 Reply:
37542 @table @samp
37543 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37544 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37545 local storage requested.
37546
37547 @item E @var{nn}
37548 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37549
37550 @item @w{}
37551 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37552 @end table
37553
37554 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37555 @cindex get thread information block address
37556 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37557 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37558
37559 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37560
37561 Reply:
37562 @table @samp
37563 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37564 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37565 thread information block.
37566
37567 @item E @var{nn}
37568 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37569 address could not be retrieved.
37570
37571 @item @w{}
37572 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37573 @end table
37574
37575 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37576 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37577 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37578 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37579 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37580 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37581 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37582
37583 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37584
37585 Reply:
37586 @table @samp
37587 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37588 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37589 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37590 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37591 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37592 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37593 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37594 @end table
37595
37596 @item qOffsets
37597 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37598 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37599 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37600 image.
37601
37602 Reply:
37603 @table @samp
37604 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37605 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37606 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37607 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37608 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37609 segments by the supplied offsets.
37610
37611 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37612 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37613 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37614
37615 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37616 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37617 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37618 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37619 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37620 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37621 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37622 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37623 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37624 @end table
37625
37626 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37627 @cindex thread information, remote request
37628 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37629 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37630 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37631 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37632
37633 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37634 (see below).
37635
37636 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37637
37638 @item QNonStop:1
37639 @itemx QNonStop:0
37640 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37641 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37642 @anchor{QNonStop}
37643 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37644 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37645
37646 Reply:
37647 @table @samp
37648 @item OK
37649 The request succeeded.
37650
37651 @item E @var{nn}
37652 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37653
37654 @item @w{}
37655 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37656 the stub.
37657 @end table
37658
37659 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37660 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37661 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37662 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37663
37664 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37665 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37666 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37667 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37668 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37669 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37670 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37671
37672 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37673 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37674 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37675
37676 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37677 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37678 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37679 report the requested syscalls.
37680
37681 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37682 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37683
37684 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37685 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37686 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37687 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37688
37689 Reply:
37690 @table @samp
37691 @item OK
37692 The request succeeded.
37693
37694 @item E @var{nn}
37695 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37696
37697 @item @w{}
37698 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37699 the stub.
37700 @end table
37701
37702 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37703 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37704 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37705 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37706
37707 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37708 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37709 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37710 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37711 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37712 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37713 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37714 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37715 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37716 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37717 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37718 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37719 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37720
37721 Reply:
37722 @table @samp
37723 @item OK
37724 The request succeeded.
37725
37726 @item E @var{nn}
37727 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37728
37729 @item @w{}
37730 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37731 the stub.
37732 @end table
37733
37734 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37735 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37736 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37737 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37738
37739 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37740 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37741 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37742 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37743 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37744 Others should be silently discarded.
37745
37746 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37747 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37748 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37749 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37750 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37751 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37752 signals.
37753
37754 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37755 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37756
37757 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37758 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37759 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37760 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37761 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37762
37763 Reply:
37764 @table @samp
37765 @item OK
37766 The request succeeded.
37767
37768 @item E @var{nn}
37769 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37770
37771 @item @w{}
37772 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37773 by the stub.
37774 @end table
37775
37776 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37777 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37778 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37779 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37780
37781 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37782 @item QThreadEvents:1
37783 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37784 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37785 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37786
37787 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37788 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37789 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37790 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37791 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37792 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37793 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37794 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37795 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37796 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37797
37798 Reply:
37799 @table @samp
37800 @item OK
37801 The request succeeded.
37802
37803 @item E @var{nn}
37804 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37805
37806 @item @w{}
37807 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37808 the stub.
37809 @end table
37810
37811 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37812 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37813
37814 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37815 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37816 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37817 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37818 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37819 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37820 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37821 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37822 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37823
37824 Reply:
37825 @table @samp
37826 @item OK
37827 A command response with no output.
37828 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37829 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37830 @item E @var{NN}
37831 Indicate a badly formed request.
37832 @item @w{}
37833 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37834 @end table
37835
37836 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37837 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37838 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37839 packets.)
37840
37841 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37842 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37843 @ifnotinfo
37844 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37845 @end ifnotinfo
37846 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37847 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37848 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37849 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37850 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37851
37852 Reply:
37853 @table @samp
37854 @item 0
37855 The pattern was not found.
37856 @item 1,address
37857 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37858 @item E @var{NN}
37859 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37860 @item @w{}
37861 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37862 @end table
37863
37864 @item QStartNoAckMode
37865 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37866 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37867 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37868 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37869
37870 Reply:
37871 @table @samp
37872 @item OK
37873 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37874 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37875 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37876 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37877 @item @w{}
37878 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37879 @end table
37880
37881 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37882 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37883 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37884 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37885 @anchor{qSupported}
37886 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37887 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37888 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37889 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37890 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37891 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37892 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37893 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37894 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37895 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37896 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37897 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37898 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37899 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37900
37901 Reply:
37902 @table @samp
37903 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37904 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37905 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37906 possible forms).
37907 @item @w{}
37908 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37909 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37910 @end table
37911
37912 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37913 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37914 are:
37915
37916 @table @samp
37917 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37918 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37919 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37920 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37921 @item @var{name}+
37922 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37923 need an associated value.
37924 @item @var{name}-
37925 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37926 @item @var{name}?
37927 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37928 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37929 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37930 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37931 @end table
37932
37933 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37934 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37935 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37936 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37937 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37938
37939 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37940 are defined:
37941
37942 @table @samp
37943 @item multiprocess
37944 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37945 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37946 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37947 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37948 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37949
37950 @item xmlRegisters
37951 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37952 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37953 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37954 description.
37955
37956 @item qRelocInsn
37957 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37958 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37959 instruction reply packet}).
37960
37961 @item swbreak
37962 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37963 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37964
37965 @item hwbreak
37966 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37967 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37968
37969 @item fork-events
37970 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37971 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37972 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37973 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37974
37975 @item vfork-events
37976 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37977 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37978 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37979 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37980
37981 @item exec-events
37982 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37983 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37984 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37985 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37986
37987 @item vContSupported
37988 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37989 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37990 @end table
37991
37992 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37993 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37994 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37995 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37996 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37997 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37998 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37999 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38000 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38001 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38002 all the features it supports.
38003
38004 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38005 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38006
38007 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38008 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38009 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38010 form response.
38011
38012 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38013 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38014 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38015 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38016
38017 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38018 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38019 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38020 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38021 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38022
38023 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38024
38025 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38026 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38027 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38028 @item Feature Name
38029 @tab Value Required
38030 @tab Default
38031 @tab Probe Allowed
38032
38033 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38034 @tab Yes
38035 @tab @samp{-}
38036 @tab No
38037
38038 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38039 @tab No
38040 @tab @samp{-}
38041 @tab Yes
38042
38043 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38044 @tab No
38045 @tab @samp{-}
38046 @tab Yes
38047
38048 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38049 @tab No
38050 @tab @samp{-}
38051 @tab Yes
38052
38053 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38054 @tab No
38055 @tab @samp{-}
38056 @tab Yes
38057
38058 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38059 @tab No
38060 @tab @samp{-}
38061 @tab Yes
38062
38063 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38064 @tab No
38065 @tab @samp{-}
38066 @tab Yes
38067
38068 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38069 @tab No
38070 @tab @samp{-}
38071 @tab Yes
38072
38073 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38074 @tab No
38075 @tab @samp{-}
38076 @tab No
38077
38078 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38079 @tab No
38080 @tab @samp{-}
38081 @tab Yes
38082
38083 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38084 @tab No
38085 @tab @samp{-}
38086 @tab Yes
38087
38088 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38089 @tab No
38090 @tab @samp{-}
38091 @tab Yes
38092
38093 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38094 @tab No
38095 @tab @samp{-}
38096 @tab Yes
38097
38098 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38099 @tab No
38100 @tab @samp{-}
38101 @tab Yes
38102
38103 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38104 @tab No
38105 @tab @samp{-}
38106 @tab Yes
38107
38108 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38109 @tab No
38110 @tab @samp{-}
38111 @tab Yes
38112
38113 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38114 @tab No
38115 @tab @samp{-}
38116 @tab Yes
38117
38118 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38119 @tab No
38120 @tab @samp{-}
38121 @tab Yes
38122
38123 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38124 @tab No
38125 @tab @samp{-}
38126 @tab Yes
38127
38128 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38129 @tab Yes
38130 @tab @samp{-}
38131 @tab Yes
38132
38133 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38134 @tab Yes
38135 @tab @samp{-}
38136 @tab Yes
38137
38138 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38139 @tab Yes
38140 @tab @samp{-}
38141 @tab Yes
38142
38143 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38144 @tab Yes
38145 @tab @samp{-}
38146 @tab Yes
38147
38148 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38149 @tab Yes
38150 @tab @samp{-}
38151 @tab Yes
38152
38153 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38154 @tab No
38155 @tab @samp{-}
38156 @tab Yes
38157
38158 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38159 @tab No
38160 @tab @samp{-}
38161 @tab Yes
38162
38163 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38164 @tab No
38165 @tab @samp{-}
38166 @tab Yes
38167
38168 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38169 @tab No
38170 @tab @samp{-}
38171 @tab Yes
38172
38173 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38174 @tab No
38175 @tab @samp{-}
38176 @tab No
38177
38178 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38179 @tab No
38180 @tab @samp{-}
38181 @tab No
38182
38183 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38184 @tab No
38185 @tab @samp{-}
38186 @tab No
38187
38188 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38189 @tab No
38190 @tab @samp{-}
38191 @tab No
38192
38193 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38194 @tab No
38195 @tab @samp{-}
38196 @tab No
38197
38198 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38199 @tab No
38200 @tab @samp{-}
38201 @tab No
38202
38203 @item @samp{QAgent}
38204 @tab No
38205 @tab @samp{-}
38206 @tab No
38207
38208 @item @samp{QAllow}
38209 @tab No
38210 @tab @samp{-}
38211 @tab No
38212
38213 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38214 @tab No
38215 @tab @samp{-}
38216 @tab No
38217
38218 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38219 @tab No
38220 @tab @samp{-}
38221 @tab No
38222
38223 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38224 @tab No
38225 @tab @samp{-}
38226 @tab No
38227
38228 @item @samp{tracenz}
38229 @tab No
38230 @tab @samp{-}
38231 @tab No
38232
38233 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38234 @tab No
38235 @tab @samp{-}
38236 @tab No
38237
38238 @item @samp{swbreak}
38239 @tab No
38240 @tab @samp{-}
38241 @tab No
38242
38243 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38244 @tab No
38245 @tab @samp{-}
38246 @tab No
38247
38248 @item @samp{fork-events}
38249 @tab No
38250 @tab @samp{-}
38251 @tab No
38252
38253 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38254 @tab No
38255 @tab @samp{-}
38256 @tab No
38257
38258 @item @samp{exec-events}
38259 @tab No
38260 @tab @samp{-}
38261 @tab No
38262
38263 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38264 @tab No
38265 @tab @samp{-}
38266 @tab No
38267
38268 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38269 @tab No
38270 @tab @samp{-}
38271 @tab No
38272
38273 @end multitable
38274
38275 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38276
38277 @table @samp
38278 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38279 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38280 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38281 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38282 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38283 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38284 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38285 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38286 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38287 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38288
38289 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38290 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38291 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38292
38293 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38294 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38295 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38296
38297 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38298 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38299 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38300
38301 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38302 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38303 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38304
38305 @item qXfer:features:read
38306 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38307 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38308
38309 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38310 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38311 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38312
38313 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38314 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38315 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38316
38317 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38318 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38319 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38320 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38321
38322 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38323 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38324 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38325
38326 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38327 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38328 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38329
38330 @item qXfer:spu:read
38331 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38332 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38333
38334 @item qXfer:spu:write
38335 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38336 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38337
38338 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38339 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38340 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38341
38342 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38343 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38344 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38345
38346 @item qXfer:threads:read
38347 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38348 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38349
38350 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38351 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38352 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38353
38354 @item qXfer:uib:read
38355 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38356 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38357
38358 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38359 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38360 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38361
38362 @item QNonStop
38363 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38364 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38365
38366 @item QCatchSyscalls
38367 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38368 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38369
38370 @item QPassSignals
38371 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38372 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38373
38374 @item QStartNoAckMode
38375 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38376 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38377
38378 @item multiprocess
38379 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38380 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38381 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38382 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38383 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38384 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38385 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38386 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38387 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38388 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38389 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38390
38391 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38392 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38393 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38394
38395 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38396 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38397 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38398 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38399
38400 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38401 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38402 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38403
38404 @item ReverseContinue
38405 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38406 (@pxref{bc}).
38407
38408 @item ReverseStep
38409 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38410 (@pxref{bs}).
38411
38412 @item TracepointSource
38413 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38414 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38415
38416 @item QAgent
38417 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38418
38419 @item QAllow
38420 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38421
38422 @item QDisableRandomization
38423 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38424
38425 @item StaticTracepoint
38426 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38427 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38428
38429 @item InstallInTrace
38430 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38431 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38432
38433 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38434 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38435 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38436 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38437
38438 @item QTBuffer:size
38439 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38440 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38441
38442 @item tracenz
38443 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38444 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38445 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38446
38447 @item BreakpointCommands
38448 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38449 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38450 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38451
38452 @item Qbtrace:off
38453 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38454
38455 @item Qbtrace:bts
38456 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38457
38458 @item Qbtrace:pt
38459 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38460
38461 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38462 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38463
38464 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38465 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38466
38467 @item swbreak
38468 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38469 breakpoints.
38470
38471 @item hwbreak
38472 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38473 breakpoints.
38474
38475 @item fork-events
38476 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38477
38478 @item vfork-events
38479 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38480 and vforkdone events.
38481
38482 @item exec-events
38483 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38484
38485 @item vContSupported
38486 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38487 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38488
38489 @item QThreadEvents
38490 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38491
38492 @item no-resumed
38493 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38494
38495 @end table
38496
38497 @item qSymbol::
38498 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38499 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38500 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38501 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38502
38503 Reply:
38504 @table @samp
38505 @item OK
38506 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38507 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38508 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38509 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38510 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38511 below.
38512 @end table
38513
38514 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38515 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38516
38517 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38518 target has previously requested.
38519
38520 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38521 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38522 will be empty.
38523
38524 Reply:
38525 @table @samp
38526 @item OK
38527 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38528 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38529 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38530 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38531 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38532 @end table
38533
38534 @item qTBuffer
38535 @itemx QTBuffer
38536 @itemx QTDisconnected
38537 @itemx QTDP
38538 @itemx QTDPsrc
38539 @itemx QTDV
38540 @itemx qTfP
38541 @itemx qTfV
38542 @itemx QTFrame
38543 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38544
38545 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38546
38547 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38548 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38549 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38550 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38551 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38552 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38553 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38554 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38555 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38556 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38557 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38558
38559 Reply:
38560 @table @samp
38561 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38562 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38563 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38564 the thread's attributes.
38565 @end table
38566
38567 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38568 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38569 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38570 packets.)
38571
38572 @item QTNotes
38573 @itemx qTP
38574 @itemx QTSave
38575 @itemx qTsP
38576 @itemx qTsV
38577 @itemx QTStart
38578 @itemx QTStop
38579 @itemx QTEnable
38580 @itemx QTDisable
38581 @itemx QTinit
38582 @itemx QTro
38583 @itemx qTStatus
38584 @itemx qTV
38585 @itemx qTfSTM
38586 @itemx qTsSTM
38587 @itemx qTSTMat
38588 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38589
38590 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38591 @cindex read special object, remote request
38592 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38593 @anchor{qXfer read}
38594 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38595 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38596 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38597 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38598 additional details about what data to access.
38599
38600 Reply:
38601 @table @samp
38602 @item m @var{data}
38603 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38604 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38605 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38606 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38607 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38608 request.
38609
38610 @item l @var{data}
38611 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38612 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38613 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38614
38615 @item l
38616 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38617 There is no more data to be read.
38618
38619 @item E00
38620 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38621
38622 @item E @var{nn}
38623 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38624 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38625
38626 @item @w{}
38627 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38628 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38629 @end table
38630
38631 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38632 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38633 formats, listed above.
38634
38635 @table @samp
38636 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38637 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38638 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38639 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38640
38641 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38642 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38643
38644 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38645 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38646
38647 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38648 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38649 packet may have one of the following values:
38650
38651 @table @code
38652 @item all
38653 Returns all available branch trace.
38654
38655 @item new
38656 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38657 the last read request.
38658
38659 @item delta
38660 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38661 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38662 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38663 used to stitch traces together.
38664
38665 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38666 @end table
38667
38668 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38669 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38670
38671 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38672 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38673
38674 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38675 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38676
38677 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38678 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38679
38680 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38681 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38682 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38683 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38684 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38685 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38686 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38687
38688 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38689 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38690
38691 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38692 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38693 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38694 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38695 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38696
38697 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38698 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38699
38700 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38701 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38702 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38703 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38704 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38705
38706 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38707 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38708 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38709
38710 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38711 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38712
38713 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38714 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38715 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38716 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38717 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38718 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38719 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38720 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38721
38722 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38723 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38724
38725 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38726 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38727
38728 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38729 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38730 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38731 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38732
38733 @table @code
38734 @item start=@var{address}
38735 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38736 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38737 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38738 chosen as the starting point.
38739
38740 @item prev=@var{address}
38741 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38742 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38743 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38744 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38745 exists prior to the starting point.
38746
38747 @end table
38748
38749 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38750 ignored.
38751
38752 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38753 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38754 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38755 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38756 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38757
38758 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38759 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38760
38761 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38762 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38763
38764 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38765 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38766 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38767 Action Lists}.
38768
38769 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38770 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38771 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38772
38773 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38774 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38775 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38776 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38777 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38778
38779 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38780 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38781 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38782
38783 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38784 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38785 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38786 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38787 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38788 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38789 in that context to be accessed.
38790
38791 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38792 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38793 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38794
38795 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38796 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38797 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38798 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38799 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38800
38801 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38802 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38803
38804 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38805 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38806
38807 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38808 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38809 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38810
38811 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38812 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38813
38814 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38815 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38816
38817 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38818 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38819
38820 This packet is not probed by default.
38821
38822 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38823 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38824 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38825 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38826 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38827
38828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38830
38831 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38832 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38833 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38834 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38835
38836 @end table
38837
38838 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38839 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38840 @anchor{qXfer write}
38841 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38842 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38843 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38844 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38845 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38846 to access.
38847
38848 Reply:
38849 @table @samp
38850 @item @var{nn}
38851 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38852 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38853
38854 @item E00
38855 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38856
38857 @item E @var{nn}
38858 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38859 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38860
38861 @item @w{}
38862 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38863 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38864 @end table
38865
38866 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38867 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38868 formats, listed above.
38869
38870 @table @samp
38871 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38872 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38873 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38874 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38875 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38876
38877 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38878 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38879 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38880
38881 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38882 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38883 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38884 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38885 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38886 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38887 in that context to be accessed.
38888
38889 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38890 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38891 @end table
38892
38893 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38894 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38895 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38896 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38897 must respond with an empty packet.
38898
38899 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38900 @cindex query attached, remote request
38901 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38902 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38903 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38904 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38905 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38906 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38907 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38908
38909 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38910 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38911 the @code{quit} command.
38912
38913 Reply:
38914 @table @samp
38915 @item 1
38916 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38917 @item 0
38918 The remote server created a new process.
38919 @item E @var{NN}
38920 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38921 @end table
38922
38923 @item Qbtrace:bts
38924 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38925
38926 Reply:
38927 @table @samp
38928 @item OK
38929 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38930 @item E.errtext
38931 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38932 @end table
38933
38934 @item Qbtrace:pt
38935 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38936
38937 Reply:
38938 @table @samp
38939 @item OK
38940 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38941 @item E.errtext
38942 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38943 @end table
38944
38945 @item Qbtrace:off
38946 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38947
38948 Reply:
38949 @table @samp
38950 @item OK
38951 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38952 @item E.errtext
38953 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38954 @end table
38955
38956 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38957 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38958 btrace recording method in bts format.
38959
38960 Reply:
38961 @table @samp
38962 @item OK
38963 The ring buffer size has been set.
38964 @item E.errtext
38965 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38966 @end table
38967
38968 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38969 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38970 btrace recording method in pt format.
38971
38972 Reply:
38973 @table @samp
38974 @item OK
38975 The ring buffer size has been set.
38976 @item E.errtext
38977 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38978 @end table
38979
38980 @end table
38981
38982 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38983 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38984
38985 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38986 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38987 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38988
38989 @menu
38990 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38991 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38992 @end menu
38993
38994 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38995 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38996
38997 @menu
38998 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38999 @end menu
39000
39001 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39002 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39003 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39004
39005 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39006
39007 @table @r
39008
39009 @item 2
39010 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39011
39012 @item 3
39013 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39014
39015 @item 4
39016 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39017
39018 @end table
39019
39020 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39021 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39022
39023 @menu
39024 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39025 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39026 @end menu
39027
39028 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39029 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39030 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39031
39032 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39033 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39034 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39035 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39036 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39037 most-significant -- least-significant.
39038
39039 @table @r
39040
39041 @item MIPS32
39042 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39043 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39044 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39045
39046 @item MIPS64
39047 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39048 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39049 as @code{MIPS32}.
39050
39051 @end table
39052
39053 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39054 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39055 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39056
39057 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39058
39059 @table @r
39060
39061 @item 2
39062 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39063
39064 @item 3
39065 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39066
39067 @item 4
39068 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39069
39070 @item 5
39071 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39072
39073 @end table
39074
39075 @node Tracepoint Packets
39076 @section Tracepoint Packets
39077 @cindex tracepoint packets
39078 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39079
39080 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39081 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39082
39083 @table @samp
39084
39085 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39086 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39087 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39088 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39089 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39090 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39091 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39092 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39093 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39094 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39095 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39096 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39097 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39098 actions.
39099
39100 Replies:
39101 @table @samp
39102 @item OK
39103 The packet was understood and carried out.
39104 @item qRelocInsn
39105 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39106 @item @w{}
39107 The packet was not recognized.
39108 @end table
39109
39110 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39111 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39112 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39113 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39114 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39115 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39116 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39117
39118 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39119 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39120 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39121 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39122 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39123 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39124 tracepoint actions.
39125
39126 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39127 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39128 following forms:
39129
39130 @table @samp
39131
39132 @item R @var{mask}
39133 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39134 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39135 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39136 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39137 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39138
39139 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39140 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39141 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39142 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39143 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39144 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39145 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39146
39147 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39148 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39149 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39150 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39151 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39152 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39153 packet).
39154
39155 @end table
39156
39157 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39158 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39159 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39160 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39161 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39162 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39163 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39164 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39165
39166 Replies:
39167 @table @samp
39168 @item OK
39169 The packet was understood and carried out.
39170 @item qRelocInsn
39171 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39172 @item @w{}
39173 The packet was not recognized.
39174 @end table
39175
39176 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39177 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39178 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39179 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39180 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39181 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39182 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39183 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39184
39185 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39186 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39187 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39188 fit in a single packet.
39189 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39190 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39191
39192 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39193 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39194 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39195 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39196
39197 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39198 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39199 query packets.
39200
39201 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39202 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39203 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39204 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39205 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39206 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39207 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39208 be found.
39209
39210 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39211 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39212 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39213 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39214 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39215 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39216 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39217 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39218 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39219 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39220 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39221 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39222 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39223 variable.
39224
39225 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39226 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39227 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39228 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39229 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39230
39231 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39232 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39233 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39234 one of the following forms:
39235
39236 @table @samp
39237 @item F @var{f}
39238 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39239 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39240 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39241
39242 @item T @var{t}
39243 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39244 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39245
39246 @end table
39247
39248 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39249 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39250 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39251 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39252
39253 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39254 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39255 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39256 is a hexadecimal number.
39257
39258 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39259 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39260 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39261 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39262 numbers.
39263
39264 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39265 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39266 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39267
39268 @item qTMinFTPILen
39269 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39270 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39271 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39272 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39273 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39274 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39275 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39276 arrange for that.
39277
39278 Replies:
39279
39280 @table @samp
39281 @item 0
39282 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39283 @item @var{length}
39284 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39285 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39286 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39287 regardless of size.
39288 @item E
39289 An error has occurred.
39290 @item @w{}
39291 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39292 @end table
39293
39294 @item QTStart
39295 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39296 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39297 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39298 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39299 instruction reply packet}).
39300
39301 @item QTStop
39302 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39303 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39304
39305 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39306 @anchor{QTEnable}
39307 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39308 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39309 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39310 of data from it will resume.
39311
39312 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39313 @anchor{QTDisable}
39314 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39315 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39316 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39317 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39318
39319 @item QTinit
39320 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39321 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39322
39323 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39324 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39325 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39326 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39327 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39328
39329 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39330 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39331 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39332 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39333
39334 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39335 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39336 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39337 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39338 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39339 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39340
39341 @item qTStatus
39342 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39343 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39344
39345 The reply has the form:
39346
39347 @table @samp
39348
39349 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39350 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39351 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39352 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39353
39354 @end table
39355
39356 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39357 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39358
39359 @table @samp
39360
39361 @item tnotrun:0
39362 No trace has been run yet.
39363
39364 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39365 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39366 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39367 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39368 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39369
39370 @item tfull:0
39371 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39372
39373 @item tdisconnected:0
39374 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39375
39376 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39377 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39378
39379 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39380 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39381 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39382 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39383 is hex encoded.
39384
39385 @item tunknown:0
39386 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39387
39388 @end table
39389
39390 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39391 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39392 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39393 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39394 trace.
39395
39396 @table @samp
39397
39398 @item tframes:@var{n}
39399 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39400
39401 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39402 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39403 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39404
39405 @item tsize:@var{n}
39406 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39407
39408 @item tfree:@var{n}
39409 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39410
39411 @item circular:@var{n}
39412 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39413 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39414 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39415 and may fill up.
39416
39417 @item disconn:@var{n}
39418 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39419 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39420 that the trace run will stop.
39421
39422 @end table
39423
39424 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39425 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39426 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39427 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39428 address @var{addr}.
39429
39430 Replies:
39431 @table @samp
39432 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39433 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39434 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39435 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39436 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39437
39438 @end table
39439
39440 @item qTV:@var{var}
39441 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39442 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39443 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39444
39445 Replies:
39446 @table @samp
39447 @item V@var{value}
39448 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39449 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39450 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39451 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39452 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39453 program is running.
39454
39455 @item U
39456 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39457 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39458 was not collected.
39459 @end table
39460
39461 @item qTfP
39462 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39463 @itemx qTsP
39464 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39465 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39466 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39467 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39468 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39469 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39470
39471 @item qTfV
39472 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39473 @itemx qTsV
39474 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39475 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39476 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39477 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39478 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39479 trace state variables.
39480
39481 @item qTfSTM
39482 @itemx qTsSTM
39483 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39484 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39485 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39486 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39487 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39488 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39489 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39490 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39491
39492 Reply:
39493 @table @samp
39494 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39495 A single marker
39496 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39497 a comma-separated list of markers
39498 @item l
39499 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39500 @item E @var{nn}
39501 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39502 @item @w{}
39503 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39504 stub.
39505 @end table
39506
39507 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39508 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39509
39510 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39511 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39512 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39513 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39514 @dfn{last}).
39515
39516 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39517 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39518 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39519 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39520 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39521 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39522 tracepoint markers.
39523
39524 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39525 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39526 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39527 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39528 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39529 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39530
39531 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39532 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39533 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39534 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39535 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39536 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39537 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39538 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39539 available.
39540
39541 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39542 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39543 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39544
39545 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39546 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39547 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39548 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39549 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39550 use whatever size it prefers.
39551
39552 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39553 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39554 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39555 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39556 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39557
39558 @end table
39559
39560 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39561 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39562 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39563 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39564 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39565 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39566 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39567 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39568 it had executed in the original location.
39569
39570 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39571 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39572 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39573 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39574 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39575 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39576 format of the request is:
39577
39578 @table @samp
39579 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39580
39581 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39582 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39583 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39584 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39585 memory starting at @var{to}.
39586 @end table
39587
39588 Replies:
39589 @table @samp
39590 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39591 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39592 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39593 @item E @var{NN}
39594 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39595 relocating the instruction.
39596 @end table
39597
39598 @node Host I/O Packets
39599 @section Host I/O Packets
39600 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39601 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39602
39603 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39604 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39605 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39606 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39607 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39608 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39609 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39610 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39611 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39612 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39613
39614 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39615 its arguments. They have this format:
39616
39617 @table @samp
39618
39619 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39620 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39621 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39622 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39623 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39624 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39625 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39626 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39627 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39628
39629 @end table
39630
39631 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39632
39633 @table @samp
39634
39635 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39636 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39637 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39638 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39639 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39640 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39641 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39642 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39643 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39644 @var{attachment}.
39645
39646 @item @w{}
39647 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39648
39649 @end table
39650
39651 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39652
39653 @table @samp
39654 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39655 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39656 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39657 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39658 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39659 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39660 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39661
39662 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39663 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39664 -1 if an error occurs.
39665
39666 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39667 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39668 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39669 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39670 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39671 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39672 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39673 @var{count} was zero.
39674
39675 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39676 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39677 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39678 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39679 some characters were escaped.
39680
39681 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39682 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39683 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39684 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39685 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39686 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39687 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39688 error occurred.
39689
39690 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39691 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39692 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39693 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39694 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39695 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39696
39697 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39698 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39699 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39700
39701 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39702 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39703 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39704
39705 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39706 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39707 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39708 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39709 some characters were escaped.
39710
39711 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39712 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39713 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39714 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39715 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39716 inferior(s).
39717
39718 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39719 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39720 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39721 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39722 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39723 operation.
39724
39725 @end table
39726
39727 @node Interrupts
39728 @section Interrupts
39729 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39730 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39731
39732 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39733 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39734 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39735 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39736
39737 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39738 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39739 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39740 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39741 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39742
39743 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39744 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39745 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39746 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39747 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39748 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39749 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39750 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39751
39752 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39753 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39754 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39755
39756 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39757 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39758 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39759 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39760 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39761 @code{0x03}.
39762
39763 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39764 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39765 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39766 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39767 currently-executing threads and processes.
39768 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39769 running program, it should send one of the stop
39770 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39771 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39772 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39773 Interrupts received while the
39774 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39775 it is resumed next time.
39776
39777 @node Notification Packets
39778 @section Notification Packets
39779 @cindex notification packets
39780 @cindex packets, notification
39781
39782 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39783 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39784 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39785 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39786 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39787 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39788 is not a problem.
39789
39790 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39791 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39792 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39793 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39794 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39795 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39796 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39797
39798 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39799 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39800
39801 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39802 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39803 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39804 not they understand it.
39805
39806 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39807 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39808 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39809 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39810 recipients.
39811
39812 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39813 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39814 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39815 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39816 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39817
39818 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39819 @table @samp
39820 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39821 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39822 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39823 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39824 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39825 @item @var{ack}
39826 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39827 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39828 @end table
39829
39830 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39831 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39832
39833 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39834 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39835 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39836 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39837 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39838 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39839 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39840 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39841 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39842 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39843
39844 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39845 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39846 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39847 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39848 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39849 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39850
39851 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39852 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39853 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39854 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39855 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39856
39857 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39858 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39859 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39860 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39861 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39862 normally.
39863
39864 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39865 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39866 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39867 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39868 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39869 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39870 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39871 the process shall be repeated.
39872
39873 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39874 following example:
39875 @smallexample
39876 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39877 @code{...}
39878 -> @code{vStopped}
39879 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39880 -> @code{vStopped}
39881 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39882 -> @code{vStopped}
39883 <- @code{OK}
39884 @end smallexample
39885
39886 The following notifications are defined:
39887 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39888
39889 @item Notification
39890 @tab Ack
39891 @tab Event
39892 @tab Description
39893
39894 @item Stop
39895 @tab vStopped
39896 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39897 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39898 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39899 @value{GDBN}.
39900 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39901
39902 @end multitable
39903
39904 @node Remote Non-Stop
39905 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39906
39907 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39908 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39909 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39910 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39911
39912 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39913 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39914 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39915 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39916 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39917 probe the target state after a mode change.
39918
39919 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39920 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39921 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39922 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39923 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39924 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39925 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39926 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39927 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39928 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39929 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39930
39931 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39932 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39933 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39934 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39935 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39936 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39937 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39938 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39939 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39940 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39941 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39942 @samp{OK}.
39943
39944 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39945 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39946 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39947 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39948 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39949 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39950 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39951 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39952 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39953 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39954 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39955 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39956 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39957
39958 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39959 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39960
39961 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39962 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39963 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39964 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39965 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39966 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39967 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39968
39969 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39970 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39971 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39972 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39973 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39974
39975 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39976 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39977 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39978 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39979
39980 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39981 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39982 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39983 @pxref{qSupported}.
39984 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39985 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39986 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39987 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39988 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39989 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39990 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39991
39992 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39993 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39994 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39995 connection.
39996 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39997 new connection is established,
39998 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39999 for the current connection, once disabled.
40000
40001 @node Examples
40002 @section Examples
40003
40004 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40005 does not get any direct output:
40006
40007 @smallexample
40008 -> @code{R00}
40009 <- @code{+}
40010 @emph{target restarts}
40011 -> @code{?}
40012 <- @code{+}
40013 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40014 -> @code{+}
40015 @end smallexample
40016
40017 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40018
40019 @smallexample
40020 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40021 <- @code{+}
40022 -> @code{s}
40023 <- @code{+}
40024 @emph{time passes}
40025 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40026 -> @code{+}
40027 -> @code{g}
40028 <- @code{+}
40029 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40030 -> @code{+}
40031 @end smallexample
40032
40033 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40034 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40035 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40036
40037 @menu
40038 * File-I/O Overview::
40039 * Protocol Basics::
40040 * The F Request Packet::
40041 * The F Reply Packet::
40042 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40043 * Console I/O::
40044 * List of Supported Calls::
40045 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40046 * Constants::
40047 * File-I/O Examples::
40048 @end menu
40049
40050 @node File-I/O Overview
40051 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40052 @cindex file-i/o overview
40053
40054 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40055 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40056 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40057 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40058 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40059 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40060
40061 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40062 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40063 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40064 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40065 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40066
40067 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40068 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40069 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40070 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40071 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40072 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40073 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40074
40075 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40076 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40077 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40078 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40079 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40080
40081 @smallexample
40082 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40083 <- target requests 'system call X'
40084 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40085 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40086 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40087 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40088 @end smallexample
40089
40090 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40091 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40092 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40093 system are not supported by this protocol.
40094
40095 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40096
40097 @node Protocol Basics
40098 @subsection Protocol Basics
40099 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40100
40101 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40102 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40103 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40104 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40105 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40106 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40107 to call the appropriate host system call:
40108
40109 @itemize @bullet
40110 @item
40111 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40112
40113 @item
40114 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40115 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40116 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40117 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40118
40119 @end itemize
40120
40121 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40122
40123 @itemize @bullet
40124 @item
40125 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40126 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40127 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40128 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40129 packet.
40130
40131 @item
40132 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40133 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40134
40135 @item
40136 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40137
40138 @item
40139 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40140
40141 @item
40142 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40143 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40144 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40145 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40146 packet.
40147
40148 @end itemize
40149
40150 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40151 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40152
40153 @itemize @bullet
40154 @item
40155 Return value.
40156
40157 @item
40158 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40159
40160 @item
40161 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40162
40163 @end itemize
40164
40165 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40166 the latest continue or step action.
40167
40168 @node The F Request Packet
40169 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40170 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40171 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40172
40173 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40174
40175 @table @samp
40176 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40177
40178 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40179 This is just the name of the function.
40180
40181 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40182 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40183 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40184 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40185 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40186 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40187 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40188
40189 @end table
40190
40191
40192
40193 @node The F Reply Packet
40194 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40195 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40196 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40197
40198 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40199
40200 @table @samp
40201
40202 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40203
40204 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40205
40206 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40207 representation.
40208 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40209
40210 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40211 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40212 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40213
40214 @smallexample
40215 F0,0,C
40216 @end smallexample
40217
40218 @noindent
40219 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40220
40221 @smallexample
40222 F-1,4,C
40223 @end smallexample
40224
40225 @noindent
40226 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40227
40228 @end table
40229
40230
40231 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40232 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40233 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40234
40235 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40236 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40237 the target should behave as if it had
40238 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40239 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40240 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40241 packet.
40242
40243 It's important for the target to know in which
40244 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40245
40246 @itemize @bullet
40247 @item
40248 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40249
40250 @item
40251 The system call on the host has been finished.
40252
40253 @end itemize
40254
40255 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40256 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40257 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40258 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40259 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40260 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40261
40262 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40263 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40264 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40265 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40266 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40267 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40268 or the full action has been completed.
40269
40270 @node Console I/O
40271 @subsection Console I/O
40272 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40273
40274 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40275 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40276 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40277 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40278 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40279 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40280 conditions is met:
40281
40282 @itemize @bullet
40283 @item
40284 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40285 @code{read}
40286 system call is treated as finished.
40287
40288 @item
40289 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40290 newline.
40291
40292 @item
40293 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40294 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40295
40296 @end itemize
40297
40298 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40299 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40300 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40301 is stopped at the user's request.
40302
40303
40304 @node List of Supported Calls
40305 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40306 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40307
40308 @menu
40309 * open::
40310 * close::
40311 * read::
40312 * write::
40313 * lseek::
40314 * rename::
40315 * unlink::
40316 * stat/fstat::
40317 * gettimeofday::
40318 * isatty::
40319 * system::
40320 @end menu
40321
40322 @node open
40323 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40324 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40325
40326 @table @asis
40327 @item Synopsis:
40328 @smallexample
40329 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40330 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40331 @end smallexample
40332
40333 @item Request:
40334 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40335
40336 @noindent
40337 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40338
40339 @table @code
40340 @item O_CREAT
40341 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40342 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40343 are concerned.
40344
40345 @item O_EXCL
40346 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40347 an error and open() fails.
40348
40349 @item O_TRUNC
40350 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40351 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40352 truncated to zero length.
40353
40354 @item O_APPEND
40355 The file is opened in append mode.
40356
40357 @item O_RDONLY
40358 The file is opened for reading only.
40359
40360 @item O_WRONLY
40361 The file is opened for writing only.
40362
40363 @item O_RDWR
40364 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40365 @end table
40366
40367 @noindent
40368 Other bits are silently ignored.
40369
40370
40371 @noindent
40372 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40373
40374 @table @code
40375 @item S_IRUSR
40376 User has read permission.
40377
40378 @item S_IWUSR
40379 User has write permission.
40380
40381 @item S_IRGRP
40382 Group has read permission.
40383
40384 @item S_IWGRP
40385 Group has write permission.
40386
40387 @item S_IROTH
40388 Others have read permission.
40389
40390 @item S_IWOTH
40391 Others have write permission.
40392 @end table
40393
40394 @noindent
40395 Other bits are silently ignored.
40396
40397
40398 @item Return value:
40399 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40400 occurred.
40401
40402 @item Errors:
40403
40404 @table @code
40405 @item EEXIST
40406 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40407
40408 @item EISDIR
40409 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40410
40411 @item EACCES
40412 The requested access is not allowed.
40413
40414 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40415 @var{pathname} was too long.
40416
40417 @item ENOENT
40418 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40419
40420 @item ENODEV
40421 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40422
40423 @item EROFS
40424 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40425 write access was requested.
40426
40427 @item EFAULT
40428 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40429
40430 @item ENOSPC
40431 No space on device to create the file.
40432
40433 @item EMFILE
40434 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40435
40436 @item ENFILE
40437 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40438 has been reached.
40439
40440 @item EINTR
40441 The call was interrupted by the user.
40442 @end table
40443
40444 @end table
40445
40446 @node close
40447 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40448 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40449
40450 @table @asis
40451 @item Synopsis:
40452 @smallexample
40453 int close(int fd);
40454 @end smallexample
40455
40456 @item Request:
40457 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40458
40459 @item Return value:
40460 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40461
40462 @item Errors:
40463
40464 @table @code
40465 @item EBADF
40466 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40467
40468 @item EINTR
40469 The call was interrupted by the user.
40470 @end table
40471
40472 @end table
40473
40474 @node read
40475 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40476 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40477
40478 @table @asis
40479 @item Synopsis:
40480 @smallexample
40481 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40482 @end smallexample
40483
40484 @item Request:
40485 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40486
40487 @item Return value:
40488 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40489 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40490 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40491
40492 @item Errors:
40493
40494 @table @code
40495 @item EBADF
40496 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40497 reading.
40498
40499 @item EFAULT
40500 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40501
40502 @item EINTR
40503 The call was interrupted by the user.
40504 @end table
40505
40506 @end table
40507
40508 @node write
40509 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40510 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40511
40512 @table @asis
40513 @item Synopsis:
40514 @smallexample
40515 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40516 @end smallexample
40517
40518 @item Request:
40519 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40520
40521 @item Return value:
40522 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40523 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40524 is returned.
40525
40526 @item Errors:
40527
40528 @table @code
40529 @item EBADF
40530 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40531 writing.
40532
40533 @item EFAULT
40534 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40535
40536 @item EFBIG
40537 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40538 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40539
40540 @item ENOSPC
40541 No space on device to write the data.
40542
40543 @item EINTR
40544 The call was interrupted by the user.
40545 @end table
40546
40547 @end table
40548
40549 @node lseek
40550 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40551 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40552
40553 @table @asis
40554 @item Synopsis:
40555 @smallexample
40556 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40557 @end smallexample
40558
40559 @item Request:
40560 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40561
40562 @var{flag} is one of:
40563
40564 @table @code
40565 @item SEEK_SET
40566 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40567
40568 @item SEEK_CUR
40569 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40570 bytes.
40571
40572 @item SEEK_END
40573 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40574 bytes.
40575 @end table
40576
40577 @item Return value:
40578 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40579 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40580 value of -1 is returned.
40581
40582 @item Errors:
40583
40584 @table @code
40585 @item EBADF
40586 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40587
40588 @item ESPIPE
40589 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40590
40591 @item EINVAL
40592 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40593
40594 @item EINTR
40595 The call was interrupted by the user.
40596 @end table
40597
40598 @end table
40599
40600 @node rename
40601 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40602 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40603
40604 @table @asis
40605 @item Synopsis:
40606 @smallexample
40607 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40608 @end smallexample
40609
40610 @item Request:
40611 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40612
40613 @item Return value:
40614 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40615
40616 @item Errors:
40617
40618 @table @code
40619 @item EISDIR
40620 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40621 directory.
40622
40623 @item EEXIST
40624 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40625
40626 @item EBUSY
40627 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40628 process.
40629
40630 @item EINVAL
40631 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40632 of itself.
40633
40634 @item ENOTDIR
40635 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40636 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40637 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40638
40639 @item EFAULT
40640 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40641
40642 @item EACCES
40643 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40644
40645 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40646
40647 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40648
40649 @item ENOENT
40650 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40651
40652 @item EROFS
40653 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40654
40655 @item ENOSPC
40656 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40657 directory entry.
40658
40659 @item EINTR
40660 The call was interrupted by the user.
40661 @end table
40662
40663 @end table
40664
40665 @node unlink
40666 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40667 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40668
40669 @table @asis
40670 @item Synopsis:
40671 @smallexample
40672 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40673 @end smallexample
40674
40675 @item Request:
40676 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40677
40678 @item Return value:
40679 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40680
40681 @item Errors:
40682
40683 @table @code
40684 @item EACCES
40685 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40686
40687 @item EPERM
40688 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40689
40690 @item EBUSY
40691 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40692 being used by another process.
40693
40694 @item EFAULT
40695 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40696
40697 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40698 @var{pathname} was too long.
40699
40700 @item ENOENT
40701 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40702
40703 @item ENOTDIR
40704 A component of the path is not a directory.
40705
40706 @item EROFS
40707 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40708
40709 @item EINTR
40710 The call was interrupted by the user.
40711 @end table
40712
40713 @end table
40714
40715 @node stat/fstat
40716 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40717 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40718 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40719
40720 @table @asis
40721 @item Synopsis:
40722 @smallexample
40723 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40724 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40725 @end smallexample
40726
40727 @item Request:
40728 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40729 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40730
40731 @item Return value:
40732 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40733
40734 @item Errors:
40735
40736 @table @code
40737 @item EBADF
40738 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40739
40740 @item ENOENT
40741 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40742 path is an empty string.
40743
40744 @item ENOTDIR
40745 A component of the path is not a directory.
40746
40747 @item EFAULT
40748 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40749
40750 @item EACCES
40751 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40752
40753 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40754 @var{pathname} was too long.
40755
40756 @item EINTR
40757 The call was interrupted by the user.
40758 @end table
40759
40760 @end table
40761
40762 @node gettimeofday
40763 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40764 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40765
40766 @table @asis
40767 @item Synopsis:
40768 @smallexample
40769 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40770 @end smallexample
40771
40772 @item Request:
40773 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40774
40775 @item Return value:
40776 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40777
40778 @item Errors:
40779
40780 @table @code
40781 @item EINVAL
40782 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40783
40784 @item EFAULT
40785 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40786 @end table
40787
40788 @end table
40789
40790 @node isatty
40791 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40792 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40793
40794 @table @asis
40795 @item Synopsis:
40796 @smallexample
40797 int isatty(int fd);
40798 @end smallexample
40799
40800 @item Request:
40801 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40802
40803 @item Return value:
40804 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40805
40806 @item Errors:
40807
40808 @table @code
40809 @item EINTR
40810 The call was interrupted by the user.
40811 @end table
40812
40813 @end table
40814
40815 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40816 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40817 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40818 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40819 needed.
40820
40821
40822 @node system
40823 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40824 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40825
40826 @table @asis
40827 @item Synopsis:
40828 @smallexample
40829 int system(const char *command);
40830 @end smallexample
40831
40832 @item Request:
40833 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40834
40835 @item Return value:
40836 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40837 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40838 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40839 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40840 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40841 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40842 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40843
40844 @item Errors:
40845
40846 @table @code
40847 @item EINTR
40848 The call was interrupted by the user.
40849 @end table
40850
40851 @end table
40852
40853 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40854 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40855 the host is simplified before it's returned
40856 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40857 is discarded, and the return value consists
40858 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40859
40860 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40861 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40862 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40863
40864 @table @code
40865 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40866 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40867 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40868 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40869
40870 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40871 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40872 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40873 protocol.
40874 @end table
40875
40876 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40877 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40878 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40879
40880 @menu
40881 * Integral Datatypes::
40882 * Pointer Values::
40883 * Memory Transfer::
40884 * struct stat::
40885 * struct timeval::
40886 @end menu
40887
40888 @node Integral Datatypes
40889 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40890 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40891
40892 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40893 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40894 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40895
40896 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40897 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40898
40899 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40900
40901 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40902 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40903
40904 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40905
40906 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40907 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40908 byte order.
40909
40910 @node Pointer Values
40911 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40912 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40913
40914 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40915 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40916 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40917 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40918
40919 @smallexample
40920 @code{1aaf/12}
40921 @end smallexample
40922
40923 @noindent
40924 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40925 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40926 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40927 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40928
40929 @smallexample
40930 @code{123456/d}
40931 @end smallexample
40932
40933 @node Memory Transfer
40934 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40935 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40936
40937 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40938 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40939 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40940 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40941 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40942 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40943 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40944
40945
40946 @node struct stat
40947 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40948 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40949
40950 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40951 is defined as follows:
40952
40953 @smallexample
40954 struct stat @{
40955 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40956 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40957 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40958 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40959 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40960 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40961 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40962 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40963 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40964 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40965 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40966 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40967 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40968 @};
40969 @end smallexample
40970
40971 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40972 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40973 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40974
40975 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40976 range of values.
40977
40978 @table @code
40979
40980 @item st_dev
40981 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40982
40983 @item st_ino
40984 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40985
40986 @item st_mode
40987 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40988 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40989
40990 @item st_uid
40991 @itemx st_gid
40992 @itemx st_rdev
40993 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40994
40995 @item st_atime
40996 @itemx st_mtime
40997 @itemx st_ctime
40998 These values have a host and file system dependent
40999 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41000 support exact timing values.
41001 @end table
41002
41003 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41004 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41005 continuing.
41006
41007 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41008 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41009 get truncated on the target.
41010
41011 @node struct timeval
41012 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41013 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41014
41015 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41016 is defined as follows:
41017
41018 @smallexample
41019 struct timeval @{
41020 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41021 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41022 @};
41023 @end smallexample
41024
41025 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41026 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41027 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41028
41029 @node Constants
41030 @subsection Constants
41031 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41032
41033 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41034 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41035 values before and after the call as needed.
41036
41037 @menu
41038 * Open Flags::
41039 * mode_t Values::
41040 * Errno Values::
41041 * Lseek Flags::
41042 * Limits::
41043 @end menu
41044
41045 @node Open Flags
41046 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41047 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41048
41049 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41050
41051 @smallexample
41052 O_RDONLY 0x0
41053 O_WRONLY 0x1
41054 O_RDWR 0x2
41055 O_APPEND 0x8
41056 O_CREAT 0x200
41057 O_TRUNC 0x400
41058 O_EXCL 0x800
41059 @end smallexample
41060
41061 @node mode_t Values
41062 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41063 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41064
41065 All values are given in octal representation.
41066
41067 @smallexample
41068 S_IFREG 0100000
41069 S_IFDIR 040000
41070 S_IRUSR 0400
41071 S_IWUSR 0200
41072 S_IXUSR 0100
41073 S_IRGRP 040
41074 S_IWGRP 020
41075 S_IXGRP 010
41076 S_IROTH 04
41077 S_IWOTH 02
41078 S_IXOTH 01
41079 @end smallexample
41080
41081 @node Errno Values
41082 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41083 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41084
41085 All values are given in decimal representation.
41086
41087 @smallexample
41088 EPERM 1
41089 ENOENT 2
41090 EINTR 4
41091 EBADF 9
41092 EACCES 13
41093 EFAULT 14
41094 EBUSY 16
41095 EEXIST 17
41096 ENODEV 19
41097 ENOTDIR 20
41098 EISDIR 21
41099 EINVAL 22
41100 ENFILE 23
41101 EMFILE 24
41102 EFBIG 27
41103 ENOSPC 28
41104 ESPIPE 29
41105 EROFS 30
41106 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41107 EUNKNOWN 9999
41108 @end smallexample
41109
41110 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41111 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41112
41113 @node Lseek Flags
41114 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41115 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41116
41117 @smallexample
41118 SEEK_SET 0
41119 SEEK_CUR 1
41120 SEEK_END 2
41121 @end smallexample
41122
41123 @node Limits
41124 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41125 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41126
41127 All values are given in decimal representation.
41128
41129 @smallexample
41130 INT_MIN -2147483648
41131 INT_MAX 2147483647
41132 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41133 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41134 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41135 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41136 @end smallexample
41137
41138 @node File-I/O Examples
41139 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41140 @cindex file-i/o examples
41141
41142 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41143 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41144
41145 @smallexample
41146 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41147 @emph{request memory read from target}
41148 -> @code{m1234,6}
41149 <- XXXXXX
41150 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41151 -> @code{F6}
41152 @end smallexample
41153
41154 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41155 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41156
41157 @smallexample
41158 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41159 @emph{request memory write to target}
41160 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41161 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41162 -> @code{F6}
41163 @end smallexample
41164
41165 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41166 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41167
41168 @smallexample
41169 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41170 -> @code{F-1,9}
41171 @end smallexample
41172
41173 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41174 host is called:
41175
41176 @smallexample
41177 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41178 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41179 <- @code{T02}
41180 @end smallexample
41181
41182 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41183 host is called:
41184
41185 @smallexample
41186 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41187 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41188 <- @code{T02}
41189 @end smallexample
41190
41191 @node Library List Format
41192 @section Library List Format
41193 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41194
41195 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41196 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41197 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41198 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41199 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41200 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41201 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41202 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41203 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41204 are loaded.
41205
41206 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41207 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41208 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41209 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41210
41211 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41212 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41213 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41214 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41215 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41216 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41217
41218 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41219 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41220
41221 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41222 offset, looks like this:
41223
41224 @smallexample
41225 <library-list>
41226 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41227 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41228 </library>
41229 </library-list>
41230 @end smallexample
41231
41232 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41233 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41234
41235 @smallexample
41236 <library-list>
41237 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41238 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41239 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41240 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41241 </library>
41242 </library-list>
41243 @end smallexample
41244
41245 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41246
41247 @smallexample
41248 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41249 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41250 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41251 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41252 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41253 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41254 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41255 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41256 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41257 @end smallexample
41258
41259 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41260 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41261 section for each library.
41262
41263 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41264 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41265 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41266
41267 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41268 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41269 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41270 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41271
41272 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41273 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41274 target, the following parameters are reported:
41275
41276 @itemize @minus
41277 @item
41278 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41279 @code{struct link_map}.
41280 @item
41281 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41282 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41283 @item
41284 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41285 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41286 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41287 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41288 @item
41289 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41290 @end itemize
41291
41292 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41293 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41294 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41295
41296 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41297 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41298
41299 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41300 looks like this:
41301
41302 @smallexample
41303 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41304 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41305 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41306 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41307 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41308 </library-list-svr>
41309 @end smallexample
41310
41311 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41312
41313 @smallexample
41314 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41315 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41316 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41317 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41318 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41319 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41320 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41321 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41322 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41323 @end smallexample
41324
41325 @node Memory Map Format
41326 @section Memory Map Format
41327 @cindex memory map format
41328
41329 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41330 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41331 memory map.
41332
41333 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41334 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41335 lists memory regions.
41336
41337 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41338 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41339
41340 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41341
41342 @smallexample
41343 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41344 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41345 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41346 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41347 <memory-map>
41348 region...
41349 </memory-map>
41350 @end smallexample
41351
41352 Each region can be either:
41353
41354 @itemize
41355
41356 @item
41357 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41358 bytes from there:
41359
41360 @smallexample
41361 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41362 @end smallexample
41363
41364
41365 @item
41366 A region of read-only memory:
41367
41368 @smallexample
41369 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41370 @end smallexample
41371
41372
41373 @item
41374 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41375 bytes in length:
41376
41377 @smallexample
41378 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41379 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41380 </memory>
41381 @end smallexample
41382
41383 @end itemize
41384
41385 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41386 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41387 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41388
41389 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41390
41391 @smallexample
41392 <!-- ................................................... -->
41393 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41394 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41395 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41396 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41397 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41398 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41399 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41400 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41401 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41402 and its type, or device. -->
41403 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41404 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41405 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41406 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41407 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41408 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41409 @end smallexample
41410
41411 @node Thread List Format
41412 @section Thread List Format
41413 @cindex thread list format
41414
41415 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41416 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41417 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41418 the following structure:
41419
41420 @smallexample
41421 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41422 <threads>
41423 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41424 ... description ...
41425 </thread>
41426 </threads>
41427 @end smallexample
41428
41429 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41430 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41431 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41432 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41433 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41434 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41435 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41436 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41437
41438
41439 @node Traceframe Info Format
41440 @section Traceframe Info Format
41441 @cindex traceframe info format
41442
41443 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41444 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41445 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41446 collected in a traceframe.
41447
41448 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41449 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41450
41451 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41452 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41453
41454 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41455
41456 @smallexample
41457 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41458 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41459 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41460 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41461 <traceframe-info>
41462 block...
41463 </traceframe-info>
41464 @end smallexample
41465
41466 Each traceframe block can be either:
41467
41468 @itemize
41469
41470 @item
41471 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41472 @var{length} bytes from there:
41473
41474 @smallexample
41475 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41476 @end smallexample
41477
41478 @item
41479 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41480 collected:
41481
41482 @smallexample
41483 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41484 @end smallexample
41485
41486 @end itemize
41487
41488 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41489
41490 @smallexample
41491 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41492 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41493
41494 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41495 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41496 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41497 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41498 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41499 @end smallexample
41500
41501 @node Branch Trace Format
41502 @section Branch Trace Format
41503 @cindex branch trace format
41504
41505 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41506 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41507 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41508 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41509
41510 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41511 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41512
41513 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41514 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41515
41516 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41517
41518 @smallexample
41519 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41520 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41521 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41522 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41523 <btrace>
41524 block...
41525 </btrace>
41526 @end smallexample
41527
41528 @itemize
41529
41530 @item
41531 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41532 and ending at @var{end}:
41533
41534 @smallexample
41535 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41536 @end smallexample
41537
41538 @end itemize
41539
41540 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41541
41542 @smallexample
41543 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41544 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41545
41546 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41547 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41548 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41549
41550 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41551
41552 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41553
41554 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41555 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41556 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41557 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41558 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41559
41560 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41561 @end smallexample
41562
41563 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41564 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41565 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41566
41567 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41568 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41569 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41570
41571 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41572 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41573
41574 @table @code
41575 @item bts
41576 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41577 @table @code
41578 @item size
41579 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41580 @end table
41581 @item pt
41582 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41583 PT}) format.
41584 @table @code
41585 @item size
41586 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41587 @end table
41588 @end table
41589
41590 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41591 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41592
41593 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41594
41595 @smallexample
41596 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41597 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41598
41599 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41600 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41601
41602 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41603 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41604 @end smallexample
41605
41606 @include agentexpr.texi
41607
41608 @node Target Descriptions
41609 @appendix Target Descriptions
41610 @cindex target descriptions
41611
41612 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41613 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41614 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41615 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41616 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41617 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41618 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41619
41620 @itemize @bullet
41621 @item
41622 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41623 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41624 @item
41625 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41626 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41627 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41628 @item
41629 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41630 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41631 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41632 @end itemize
41633
41634 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41635 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41636 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41637 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41638 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41639
41640 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41641 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41642
41643 @menu
41644 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41645 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41646 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41647 descriptions.
41648 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41649 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41650 @end menu
41651
41652 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41653 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41654
41655 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41656 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41657 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41658 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41659 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41660 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41661 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41662 Format}.
41663
41664 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41665 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41666 specify a file are:
41667
41668 @table @code
41669 @cindex set tdesc filename
41670 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41671 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41672
41673 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41674 @item unset tdesc filename
41675 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41676 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41677
41678 @cindex show tdesc filename
41679 @item show tdesc filename
41680 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41681 @end table
41682
41683
41684 @node Target Description Format
41685 @section Target Description Format
41686 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41687
41688 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41689 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41690 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41691 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41692 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41693 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41694 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41695
41696 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41697 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41698 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41699 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41700 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41701
41702 Here is a simple target description:
41703
41704 @smallexample
41705 <target version="1.0">
41706 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41707 </target>
41708 @end smallexample
41709
41710 @noindent
41711 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41712 the x86-64 architecture.
41713
41714 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41715 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41716 are explained further below.
41717
41718 @smallexample
41719 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41720 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41721 <target version="1.0">
41722 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41723 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41724 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41725 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41726 </target>
41727 @end smallexample
41728
41729 @noindent
41730 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41731 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41732 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41733 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41734 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41735 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41736 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41737 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41738 the version mismatch.
41739
41740 @subsection Inclusion
41741 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41742 @cindex XInclude
41743 @ifnotinfo
41744 @cindex <xi:include>
41745 @end ifnotinfo
41746
41747 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41748 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41749 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41750 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41751 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41752
41753 @smallexample
41754 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41755 @end smallexample
41756
41757 @noindent
41758 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41759 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41760 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41761 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41762 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41763 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41764 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41765 original description.
41766
41767 @subsection Architecture
41768 @cindex <architecture>
41769
41770 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41771
41772 @smallexample
41773 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41774 @end smallexample
41775
41776 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41777 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41778
41779 @subsection OS ABI
41780 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41781
41782 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41783 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41784
41785 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41786
41787 @smallexample
41788 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41789 @end smallexample
41790
41791 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41792 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41793
41794 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41795 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41796
41797 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41798 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41799
41800 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41801
41802 @smallexample
41803 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41804 @end smallexample
41805
41806 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41807 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41808
41809 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41810 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41811 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41812 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41813 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41814 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41815 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41816
41817 @smallexample
41818 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41819 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41820 @end smallexample
41821
41822 @subsection Features
41823 @cindex <feature>
41824
41825 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41826 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41827 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41828 has this form:
41829
41830 @smallexample
41831 <feature name="@var{name}">
41832 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41833 @var{reg}@dots{}
41834 </feature>
41835 @end smallexample
41836
41837 @noindent
41838 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41839 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41840 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41841 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41842
41843 @subsection Types
41844
41845 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41846 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41847 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41848 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41849 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41850 and enum types.
41851
41852 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41853 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41854 Types must be defined before they are used.
41855
41856 @cindex <vector>
41857 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41858 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41859 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41860 @var{count}:
41861
41862 @smallexample
41863 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41864 @end smallexample
41865
41866 @cindex <union>
41867 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41868 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41869 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41870 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41871
41872 @smallexample
41873 <union id="@var{id}">
41874 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41875 @dots{}
41876 </union>
41877 @end smallexample
41878
41879 @cindex <struct>
41880 @cindex <flags>
41881 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41882 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41883 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41884 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41885 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41886 specified.
41887
41888 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41889
41890 @smallexample
41891 <struct id="@var{id}">
41892 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41893 @dots{}
41894 </struct>
41895 @end smallexample
41896
41897 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41898 No implicit padding is added.
41899
41900 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41901
41902 @smallexample
41903 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41904 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41905 @dots{}
41906 </struct>
41907 @end smallexample
41908
41909 @smallexample
41910 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41911 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41912 @dots{}
41913 </flags>
41914 @end smallexample
41915
41916 The @var{name} value is required.
41917 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41918 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41919 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41920
41921 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41922 is optional.
41923 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41924 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41925
41926 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41927 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41928
41929 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41930
41931 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41932 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41933
41934 @itemize @bullet
41935 @item
41936 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41937 @item
41938 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41939 @end itemize
41940
41941 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41942 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41943
41944 @itemize @bullet
41945 @item
41946 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41947
41948 @smallexample
41949 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41950 $1 = 42
41951 @end smallexample
41952
41953 @end itemize
41954
41955 @subsection Registers
41956 @cindex <reg>
41957
41958 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41959
41960 @smallexample
41961 <reg name="@var{name}"
41962 bitsize="@var{size}"
41963 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41964 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41965 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41966 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41967 @end smallexample
41968
41969 @noindent
41970 The components are as follows:
41971
41972 @table @var
41973
41974 @item name
41975 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41976
41977 @item bitsize
41978 The register's size, in bits.
41979
41980 @item regnum
41981 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41982 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41983 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41984 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41985 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41986 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41987 in order of increasing register number.
41988
41989 @item save-restore
41990 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41991 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41992 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41993 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41994 ABI.
41995
41996 @item type
41997 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41998 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41999 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42000 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42001 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42002 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42003
42004 @item group
42005 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42006 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42007 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42008 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42009 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42010 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42011 @code{info registers}.
42012
42013 @end table
42014
42015 @node Predefined Target Types
42016 @section Predefined Target Types
42017 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42018
42019 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42020 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42021 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42022 types. The currently supported types are:
42023
42024 @table @code
42025
42026 @item bool
42027 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42028
42029 @item int8
42030 @itemx int16
42031 @itemx int32
42032 @itemx int64
42033 @itemx int128
42034 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42035
42036 @item uint8
42037 @itemx uint16
42038 @itemx uint32
42039 @itemx uint64
42040 @itemx uint128
42041 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42042
42043 @item code_ptr
42044 @itemx data_ptr
42045 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42046 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42047 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42048 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42049 may be marked as data pointers.
42050
42051 @item ieee_single
42052 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42053
42054 @item ieee_double
42055 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42056
42057 @item arm_fpa_ext
42058 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42059
42060 @item i387_ext
42061 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42062
42063 @item i386_eflags
42064 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42065
42066 @item i386_mxcsr
42067 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42068
42069 @end table
42070
42071 @node Enum Target Types
42072 @section Enum Target Types
42073 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42074
42075 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42076 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42077
42078 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42079
42080 @smallexample
42081 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42082 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42083 @dots{}
42084 </enum>
42085 @end smallexample
42086
42087 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42088
42089 @smallexample
42090 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42091 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42092 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42093 </enum>
42094 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42095 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42096 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42097 </flags>
42098 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42099 @end smallexample
42100
42101 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42102 would be printed as:
42103
42104 @smallexample
42105 (gdb) info register flags
42106 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42107 @end smallexample
42108
42109 @node Standard Target Features
42110 @section Standard Target Features
42111 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42112
42113 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42114 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42115 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42116 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42117 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42118 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42119 can recognize them.
42120
42121 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42122 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42123 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42124 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42125 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42126 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42127 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42128 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42129
42130 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42131 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42132 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42133
42134 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42135 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42136 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42137 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42138
42139 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42140 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42141 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42142
42143 @menu
42144 * AArch64 Features::
42145 * ARC Features::
42146 * ARM Features::
42147 * i386 Features::
42148 * MicroBlaze Features::
42149 * MIPS Features::
42150 * M68K Features::
42151 * NDS32 Features::
42152 * Nios II Features::
42153 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42154 * PowerPC Features::
42155 * S/390 and System z Features::
42156 * Sparc Features::
42157 * TIC6x Features::
42158 @end menu
42159
42160
42161 @node AArch64 Features
42162 @subsection AArch64 Features
42163 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42164
42165 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42166 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42167 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42168
42169 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42170 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42171 and @samp{fpcr}.
42172
42173 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42174 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42175 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42176
42177 @node ARC Features
42178 @subsection ARC Features
42179 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42180
42181 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42182 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42183 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42184 that one of the core registers features is present.
42185 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42186
42187 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42188 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42189 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42190 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42191 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42192 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42193 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42194
42195 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42196 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42197 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42198 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42199 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42200 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42201
42202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42203 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42204 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42205 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42206 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42207 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42208 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42209 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42210 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42211 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42212
42213 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42214 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42215
42216 @node ARM Features
42217 @subsection ARM Features
42218 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42219
42220 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42221 ARM targets.
42222 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42223 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42224
42225 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42226 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42227 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42228 and @samp{xpsr}.
42229
42230 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42231 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42232
42233 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42234 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42235 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42236 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42237
42238 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42239 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42240 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42241 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42242 halves of the double-precision registers.
42243
42244 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42245 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42246 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42247 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42248 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42249 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42250
42251 @node i386 Features
42252 @subsection i386 Features
42253 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42254
42255 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42256 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42257
42258 @itemize @minus
42259 @item
42260 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42261 @item
42262 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42263 @item
42264 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42265 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42266 @item
42267 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42268 @item
42269 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42270 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42271 @end itemize
42272
42273 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42274
42275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42276 describe registers:
42277
42278 @itemize @minus
42279 @item
42280 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42281 @item
42282 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42283 @item
42284 @samp{mxcsr}
42285 @end itemize
42286
42287 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42288 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42289 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42290
42291 @itemize @minus
42292 @item
42293 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42294 @item
42295 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42296 @end itemize
42297
42298 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42299 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42300
42301 @itemize @minus
42302 @item
42303 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42304 @item
42305 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42306 @end itemize
42307
42308 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42309 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42310
42311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42312 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42313
42314 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42315 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42316 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42317
42318 @itemize @minus
42319 @item
42320 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42321 @end itemize
42322
42323 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42324
42325 @itemize @minus
42326 @item
42327 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42328 @end itemize
42329
42330 It should
42331 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42332
42333 @itemize @minus
42334 @item
42335 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42336 @item
42337 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42338 @end itemize
42339
42340 It should
42341 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42342
42343 @itemize @minus
42344 @item
42345 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42346 @end itemize
42347
42348 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42349 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42350 valid for i386 and amd64.
42351
42352 @node MicroBlaze Features
42353 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42354 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42355
42356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42357 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42358 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42359 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42360 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42361
42362 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42363 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42364
42365 @node MIPS Features
42366 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42367 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42368
42369 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42370 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42371 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42372 on the target.
42373
42374 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42375 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42376 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42377
42378 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42379 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42380 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42381 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42382
42383 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42384 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42385 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42386 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42387
42388 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42389 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42390 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42391
42392 @node M68K Features
42393 @subsection M68K Features
42394 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42395
42396 @table @code
42397 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42398 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42399 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42400 One of those features must be always present.
42401 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42402 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42403 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42404 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42405
42406 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42407 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42408 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42409 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42410 @end table
42411
42412 @node NDS32 Features
42413 @subsection NDS32 Features
42414 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42415
42416 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42417 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42418 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42419 and @samp{pc}.
42420
42421 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42422 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42423 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42424 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42425
42426 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42427 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42428 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42429 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42430 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42431 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42432 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42433
42434 @node Nios II Features
42435 @subsection Nios II Features
42436 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42437
42438 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42439 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42440 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42441 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42442 @samp{mpuacc}).
42443
42444 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42445 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42446 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42447
42448 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42449 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42450 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42451
42452 @node PowerPC Features
42453 @subsection PowerPC Features
42454 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42455
42456 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42457 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42458 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42459 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42460
42461 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42462 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42463
42464 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42465 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42466 and @samp{vrsave}.
42467
42468 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42469 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42470 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42471 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42472 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42473 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42474
42475 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42476 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42477 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42478 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42479 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42480 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42481 user.
42482
42483 @node S/390 and System z Features
42484 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42485 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42486 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42487
42488 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42489 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42490 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42491 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42492 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42493 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42494 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42495 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42496 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42497
42498 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42499 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42500 @samp{fpc}.
42501
42502 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42503 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42504
42505 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42506 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42507 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42508 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42509 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42510 32-bit wide.
42511
42512 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42513 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42514 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42515
42516 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42517 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42518 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42519 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42520 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42521 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42522 @samp{v31}.
42523
42524 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42525 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42526 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42527
42528 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42529 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42530 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42531
42532 @node Sparc Features
42533 @subsection Sparc Features
42534 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42535 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42536 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42537 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42538
42539 @itemize @minus
42540 @item
42541 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42542 @item
42543 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42544 @item
42545 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42546 @item
42547 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42548 @end itemize
42549
42550 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42551
42552 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42553 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42554
42555 @itemize @minus
42556 @item
42557 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42558 @item
42559 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42560 @end itemize
42561
42562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42563 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42564
42565 @itemize @minus
42566 @item
42567 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42568 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42569 @item
42570 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42571 for sparc64
42572 @end itemize
42573
42574 @node TIC6x Features
42575 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42576 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42577 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42578 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42579 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42580 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42581
42582 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42583 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42584 through @samp{B31}.
42585
42586 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42587 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42588
42589 @node Operating System Information
42590 @appendix Operating System Information
42591 @cindex operating system information
42592
42593 @menu
42594 * Process list::
42595 @end menu
42596
42597 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42598 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42599 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42600 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42601 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42602 on a different aspect of target.
42603
42604 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42605 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42606 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42607 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42608
42609 @node Process list
42610 @appendixsection Process list
42611 @cindex operating system information, process list
42612
42613 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42614 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42615 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42616 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42617
42618 An example document is:
42619
42620 @smallexample
42621 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42622 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42623 <osdata type="processes">
42624 <item>
42625 <column name="pid">1</column>
42626 <column name="user">root</column>
42627 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42628 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42629 </item>
42630 </osdata>
42631 @end smallexample
42632
42633 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42634 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42635 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42636 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42637 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42638 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42639 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42640
42641 @node Trace File Format
42642 @appendix Trace File Format
42643 @cindex trace file format
42644
42645 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42646 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42647
42648 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42649 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42650 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42651 in the future.
42652
42653 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42654 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42655 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42656 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42657 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42658 of this section.
42659
42660 @table @code
42661 @item R @var{size}
42662 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42663 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42664 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42665 a single trace file.
42666
42667 @item status @var{status}
42668 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42669 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42670 file.
42671
42672 @item tp @var{payload}
42673 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42674 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42675 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42676 reply packets.
42677
42678 @item tsv @var{payload}
42679 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42680 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42681 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42682 reply packets.
42683
42684 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42685 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42686 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42687 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42688 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42689 file. Includes are not allowed.
42690
42691 @end table
42692
42693 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42694 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42695 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42696 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42697 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42698 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42699 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42700 endianness.
42701
42702 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42703
42704 @table @code
42705 @item R @var{bytes}
42706 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42707 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42708 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42709
42710 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42711 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42712 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42713 @var{length} bytes.
42714
42715 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42716 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42717 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42718
42719 @end table
42720
42721 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42722 of blocks.
42723
42724 @node Index Section Format
42725 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42726 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42727 @cindex index section format
42728
42729 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42730 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42731 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42732 description.
42733
42734 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42735 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42736 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42737 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42738 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42739 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42740
42741 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42742
42743 @enumerate
42744 @item
42745 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42746 unless otherwise noted:
42747
42748 @enumerate
42749 @item
42750 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42751 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42752 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42753 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42754 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42755 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42756 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42757
42758 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42759 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42760 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42761 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42762
42763 @item
42764 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42765
42766 @item
42767 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42768 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42769 to the next offset.
42770
42771 @item
42772 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42773
42774 @item
42775 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42776
42777 @item
42778 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42779 @end enumerate
42780
42781 @item
42782 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42783 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42784 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42785 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42786 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42787 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42788 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42789 CU indices.
42790
42791 @item
42792 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42793 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42794 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42795 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42796
42797 @item
42798 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42799 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42800
42801 @enumerate
42802 @item
42803 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42804
42805 @item
42806 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42807 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42808
42809 @item
42810 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42811 @end enumerate
42812
42813 @item
42814 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42815 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42816
42817 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42818 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42819 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42820 constant pool.
42821
42822 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42823 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42824 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42825
42826 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42827 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42828 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42829 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42830 index version:
42831
42832 @table @asis
42833 @item Version 4
42834 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42835
42836 @item Versions 5 to 7
42837 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42838 @end table
42839
42840 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42841
42842 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42843 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42844 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42845 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42846 collision.
42847
42848 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42849 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42850 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42851 the code.
42852
42853 @item
42854 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42855 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42856 strings.
42857
42858 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42859 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42860 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42861 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42862 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42863 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42864
42865 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42866 @end enumerate
42867
42868 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42869 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42870 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42871
42872 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42873 (bit 0 = LSB):
42874
42875 @table @asis
42876
42877 @item Bits 0-23
42878 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42879 @item Bits 24-27
42880 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42881 @item Bits 28-30
42882 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42883
42884 @table @asis
42885 @item 0
42886 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42887 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42888 with previous versions of the index.
42889 @item 1
42890 The symbol is a type.
42891 @item 2
42892 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42893 @item 3
42894 The symbol is a function.
42895 @item 4
42896 Any other kind of symbol.
42897 @item 5,6,7
42898 These values are reserved.
42899 @end table
42900
42901 @item Bit 31
42902 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42903
42904 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42905 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42906 @value{GDBN} sources.
42907
42908 @end table
42909
42910 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42911 global/static attributes in the index.
42912
42913 @smallexample
42914 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42915 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42916 switch (die->tag)
42917 @{
42918 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42919 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42920 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42921 kind = TYPE;
42922 is_static = 1;
42923 break;
42924 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42925 kind = VARIABLE;
42926 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42927 break;
42928 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42929 kind = FUNCTION;
42930 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42931 break;
42932 case DW_TAG_constant:
42933 kind = VARIABLE;
42934 is_static = ! is_external;
42935 break;
42936 case DW_TAG_variable:
42937 kind = VARIABLE;
42938 is_static = ! is_external;
42939 break;
42940 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42941 kind = TYPE;
42942 is_static = 0;
42943 break;
42944 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42945 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42946 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42947 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42948 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42949 kind = TYPE;
42950 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42951 break;
42952 default:
42953 assert (0);
42954 @}
42955 @end smallexample
42956
42957 @node Man Pages
42958 @appendix Manual pages
42959 @cindex Man pages
42960
42961 @menu
42962 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42963 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42964 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42965 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42966 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
42967 @end menu
42968
42969 @node gdb man
42970 @heading gdb man
42971
42972 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42973
42974 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42975 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42976 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42977 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42978 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42979 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42980 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42981 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42982 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42983 @c man end
42984
42985 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42986 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42987 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42988 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42989
42990 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42991 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42992
42993 @itemize @bullet
42994 @item
42995 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42996
42997 @item
42998 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42999
43000 @item
43001 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43002
43003 @item
43004 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43005 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43006 @end itemize
43007
43008 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43009 Modula-2.
43010
43011 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43012 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43013 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43014 by using the command @code{help}.
43015
43016 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43017 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43018 executable program as the argument:
43019
43020 @smallexample
43021 gdb program
43022 @end smallexample
43023
43024 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43025
43026 @smallexample
43027 gdb program core
43028 @end smallexample
43029
43030 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43031 to debug a running process:
43032
43033 @smallexample
43034 gdb program 1234
43035 gdb -p 1234
43036 @end smallexample
43037
43038 @noindent
43039 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43040 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43041 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43042
43043 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43044
43045 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43046 @table @env
43047 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43048 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43049
43050 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43051 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43052
43053 @item bt
43054 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43055
43056 @item print @var{expr}
43057 Display the value of an expression.
43058
43059 @item c
43060 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43061
43062 @item next
43063 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43064 function calls in the line.
43065
43066 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43067 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43068
43069 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43070 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43071
43072 @item step
43073 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43074 function calls in the line.
43075
43076 @item help [@var{name}]
43077 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43078 about using @value{GDBN}.
43079
43080 @item quit
43081 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43082 @end table
43083
43084 @ifset man
43085 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43086 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43087 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43088 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43089 @end ifset
43090 @c man end
43091
43092 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43093 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43094 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43095 encountered with no
43096 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43097 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43098 Many options have
43099 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43100 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43101 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43102 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43103 more usual convention.)
43104
43105 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43106 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43107 option is used.
43108
43109 @table @env
43110 @item -help
43111 @itemx -h
43112 List all options, with brief explanations.
43113
43114 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43115 @itemx -s @var{file}
43116 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43117
43118 @item -write
43119 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43120
43121 @item -exec=@var{file}
43122 @itemx -e @var{file}
43123 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43124 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43125 dump.
43126
43127 @item -se=@var{file}
43128 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43129 file.
43130
43131 @item -core=@var{file}
43132 @itemx -c @var{file}
43133 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43134
43135 @item -command=@var{file}
43136 @itemx -x @var{file}
43137 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43138
43139 @item -ex @var{command}
43140 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43141
43142 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43143 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43144 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43145
43146 @item -nh
43147 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43148
43149 @item -nx
43150 @itemx -n
43151 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43152
43153 @item -quiet
43154 @itemx -q
43155 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43156 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43157
43158 @item -batch
43159 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43160 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43161 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43162 commands in the command files.
43163
43164 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43165 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43166 more useful, the message
43167
43168 @smallexample
43169 Program exited normally.
43170 @end smallexample
43171
43172 @noindent
43173 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43174 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43175
43176 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43177 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43178 instead of the current directory.
43179
43180 @item -fullname
43181 @itemx -f
43182 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43183 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43184 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43185 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43186 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43187 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43188 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43189 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43190
43191 @item -b @var{bps}
43192 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43193 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43194
43195 @item -tty=@var{device}
43196 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43197 @end table
43198 @c man end
43199
43200 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43201 @ifset man
43202 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43203 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43204 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43205
43206 @smallexample
43207 info gdb
43208 @end smallexample
43209
43210 @noindent
43211 should give you access to the complete manual.
43212
43213 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43214 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43215 @end ifset
43216 @c man end
43217
43218 @node gdbserver man
43219 @heading gdbserver man
43220
43221 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43222 @format
43223 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43224 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43225
43226 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43227
43228 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43229 @c man end
43230 @end format
43231
43232 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43233 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43234 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43235
43236 @ifclear man
43237 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43238 @end ifclear
43239 @ifset man
43240 Usage (server (target) side):
43241 @end ifset
43242
43243 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43244 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43245 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43246 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43247
43248 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43249 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43250 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43251
43252 @smallexample
43253 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43254 @end smallexample
43255
43256 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43257
43258 @smallexample
43259 @ifset man
43260 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43261 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43262 @end ifset
43263 @ifclear man
43264 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43265 @end ifclear
43266 @end smallexample
43267
43268 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43269 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43270 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43271
43272 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43273
43274 @smallexample
43275 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43276 @end smallexample
43277
43278 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43279 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43280 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43281 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43282 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43283 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43284 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43285 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43286 print an error message and exit.
43287
43288 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43289 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43290
43291 @smallexample
43292 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43293 @end smallexample
43294
43295 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43296 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43297
43298 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43299 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43300 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43301 the program you want to debug.
43302
43303 @smallexample
43304 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43305 @end smallexample
43306
43307 @ifclear man
43308 @subheading Usage (host side)
43309 @end ifclear
43310 @ifset man
43311 Usage (host side):
43312 @end ifset
43313
43314 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43315 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43316 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43317 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43318 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43319 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43320 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43321 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43322 descriptor. For example:
43323
43324 @smallexample
43325 @ifset man
43326 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43327 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43328 @end ifset
43329 @ifclear man
43330 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43331 @end ifclear
43332 @end smallexample
43333
43334 @noindent
43335 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43336
43337 @smallexample
43338 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43339 @end smallexample
43340
43341 @noindent
43342 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43343 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43344 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43345 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43346 `Connection refused'.
43347
43348 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43349 described in
43350 @ifset man
43351 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43352 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43353 @end ifset
43354 @ifclear man
43355 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43356 @end ifclear
43357 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43358
43359 @smallexample
43360 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43361 @end smallexample
43362
43363 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43364 case.
43365 @c man end
43366
43367 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43368 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43369
43370 @itemize @bullet
43371
43372 @item
43373 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43374
43375 @smallexample
43376 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43377 @end smallexample
43378
43379 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43380 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43381 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43382 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43383 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43384 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43385 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43386
43387 @item
43388 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43389 program:
43390
43391 @smallexample
43392 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43393 @end smallexample
43394
43395 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43396 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43397 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43398 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43399
43400 @item
43401 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43402
43403 @smallexample
43404 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43405 @end smallexample
43406
43407 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43408 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43409 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43410 debug several processes in the same session.
43411 @end itemize
43412
43413 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43414
43415 @table @env
43416
43417 @item --help
43418 List all options, with brief explanations.
43419
43420 @item --version
43421 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43422
43423 @item --attach
43424 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43425
43426 @smallexample
43427 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43428 @end smallexample
43429
43430 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43431 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43432
43433 @item --multi
43434 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43435 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43436 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43437 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43438
43439 @smallexample
43440 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43441 @end smallexample
43442
43443 @item --debug
43444 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43445 process.
43446 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43447 the developers.
43448
43449 @item --remote-debug
43450 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43451 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43452 the developers.
43453
43454 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43455 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43456 of debugging output.
43457 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43458
43459 @item --wrapper
43460 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43461 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43462 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43463 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43464
43465 @item --once
43466 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43467 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43468 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43469 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43470
43471 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43472
43473 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43474 @c QDisableRandomization.
43475
43476 @end table
43477 @c man end
43478
43479 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43480 @ifset man
43481 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43482 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43483 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43484
43485 @smallexample
43486 info gdb
43487 @end smallexample
43488
43489 should give you access to the complete manual.
43490
43491 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43492 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43493 @end ifset
43494 @c man end
43495
43496 @node gcore man
43497 @heading gcore
43498
43499 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43500
43501 @format
43502 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43503 gcore [-a] [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
43504 @c man end
43505 @end format
43506
43507 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43508 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
43509 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
43510 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
43511 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
43512 running without any change.
43513 @c man end
43514
43515 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43516 @table @env
43517 @item -a
43518 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43519 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43520 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43521 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43522 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43523
43524 @item -o @var{filename}
43525 The optional argument
43526 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
43527 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
43528 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
43529 @end table
43530 @c man end
43531
43532 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43533 @ifset man
43534 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43535 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43536 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43537
43538 @smallexample
43539 info gdb
43540 @end smallexample
43541
43542 @noindent
43543 should give you access to the complete manual.
43544
43545 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43546 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43547 @end ifset
43548 @c man end
43549
43550 @node gdbinit man
43551 @heading gdbinit
43552
43553 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43554
43555 @format
43556 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43557 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43558 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43559 @end ifset
43560
43561 ~/.gdbinit
43562
43563 ./.gdbinit
43564 @c man end
43565 @end format
43566
43567 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43568 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43569 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43570 described in
43571 @ifset man
43572 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43573 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43574 @end ifset
43575 @ifclear man
43576 @ref{Sequences}.
43577 @end ifclear
43578
43579 Please read more in
43580 @ifset man
43581 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43582 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43583 @end ifset
43584 @ifclear man
43585 @ref{Startup}.
43586 @end ifclear
43587
43588 @table @env
43589 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43590 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43591 @end ifset
43592 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43593 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43594 @end ifclear
43595 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43596 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43597 See more in
43598 @ifset man
43599 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43600 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43601 @end ifset
43602 @ifclear man
43603 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43604 @end ifclear
43605
43606 @item ~/.gdbinit
43607 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43608 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43609
43610 @item ./.gdbinit
43611 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43612 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43613 See more in
43614 @ifset man
43615 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43616 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43617 @end ifset
43618 @ifclear man
43619 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43620 @end ifclear
43621 @end table
43622 @c man end
43623
43624 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43625 @ifset man
43626 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43627
43628 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43629 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43630 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43631
43632 @smallexample
43633 info gdb
43634 @end smallexample
43635
43636 should give you access to the complete manual.
43637
43638 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43639 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43640 @end ifset
43641 @c man end
43642
43643 @node gdb-add-index man
43644 @heading gdb-add-index
43645 @pindex gdb-add-index
43646 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
43647
43648 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
43649
43650 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
43651 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
43652 @c man end
43653
43654 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
43655 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
43656 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
43657 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
43658 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
43659 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
43660
43661 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
43662 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
43663 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
43664 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
43665 named @code{.debug_*}).
43666
43667 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
43668 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
43669 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
43670 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
43671
43672 See more in
43673 @ifset man
43674 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
43675 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
43676 @end ifset
43677 @ifclear man
43678 @ref{Index Files}.
43679 @end ifclear
43680 @c man end
43681
43682 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
43683 @ifset man
43684 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43685 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43686 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43687
43688 @smallexample
43689 info gdb
43690 @end smallexample
43691
43692 should give you access to the complete manual.
43693
43694 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43695 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43696 @end ifset
43697 @c man end
43698
43699 @include gpl.texi
43700
43701 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43702 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43703 @include fdl.texi
43704
43705 @node Concept Index
43706 @unnumbered Concept Index
43707
43708 @printindex cp
43709
43710 @node Command and Variable Index
43711 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43712
43713 @printindex fn
43714
43715 @tex
43716 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43717 % meantime:
43718 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43719 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43720 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43721 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43722 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43723 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43724 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43725 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43726 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43727 \page\colophon
43728 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43729 @end tex
43730
43731 @bye